SMC ECOLOGY PNEUMATICS SYSTEM
Transcription
SMC ECOLOGY PNEUMATICS SYSTEM
EUROPE AUSTRIA SMC Pneumatik GmbH BELGIUM SMC Pneumatics N.V./S.A. BULGARIA SMC Industrial Automation Bulgaria EOOD CROATIA SMC Industrijska automatika d.o.o. CZECH REPUBLIC SMC Industrial Automation CZ s.r.o. DENMARK SMC Pneumatik A/S ESTONIA SMC Pneumatics Estonia OÜ FINLAND SMC Pneumatics Finland OY FRANCE SMC Pneumatique SA GERMANY SMC Pneumatik GmbH HUNGARY SMC Hungary Ipari Automatizálási Kft. IRELAND SMC Pneumatics (Ireland) Ltd. ITALY SMC Italia S.p.A. LATVIA SMC Pnuematics Latvia SIA NETHERLANDS SMC Pneumatics BV. NORWAY SMC Pneumatics Norway A/S POLAND SMC Industrial Automation Polska Sp.z.o.o. ROMANIA SMC Romania s.r.l. RUSSIA SMC Pneumatik LLC. SLOVAKIA SMC Priemyselná automatizáciá, s.r.o. SLOVENIA SMC INDUSTRIJSKA AVTOMATIKA d.o.o. SPAIN/PORTUGAL SMC España, S.A. SWEDEN SMC Pneumatics Sweden AB SWITZERLAND SMC Pneumatik AG. UK SMC Pneumatics (U.K.) Ltd. ASIA CHINA SMC (China) Co., Ltd. HONG KONG SMC Pneumatics (Hong Kong) Ltd. INDIA SMC Pneumatics (India) Pvt. Ltd. INDONESIA PT. SMC Pneumatics Indonesia MALAYSIA SMC Pneumatics (S.E.A.) Sdn. Bhd. PHILIPPINES SHOKETSU-SMC Corporation SINGAPORE SMC Pneumatics (S.E.A.) Pte. Ltd. SOUTH KOREA SMC Pneumatics Korea Co., Ltd. TAIWAN SMC Pneumatics (Taiwan) Co., Ltd. THAILAND SMC Thailand Ltd. NORTH AMERICA CANADA SMC Pneumatics (Canada) Ltd. MEXICO SMC Corporation (Mexico) S.A. de C.V. USA SMC Corporation of America SOUTH AMERICA ARGENTINA SMC Argentina S.A. BOLIVIA SMC Pneumatics Bolivia S.R.L. BRAZIL SMC Pneumaticos Do Brazil Ltda. CHILE SMC Pneumatics (Chile) S.A. VENEZUELA SMC Neumatica Venezuela S.A. OCEANIA AUSTRALIA SMC Pneumatics (Australia) Pty. Ltd. NEW ZEALAND SMC Pneumatics (N.Z.) Ltd. 1-16-4 Shimbashi, Minato-ku, Tokyo 105-8659 JAPAN Tel: 03-3502-2740 Fax: 03-3508-2480 URL http://www.smcworld.com SMC supports innovations in energy saving production systems. As countermeasures for global warming are coming into effect, "energy savings" has become a key theme for corporate reforms. At the Kyoto Conference on Climate Change (December 1997), a 6% reduction of CO2 emissions from the 1990 emission rate was set as a target to be achieved by 2010. Also, as amendment of the energy saving law in Japan suggests, it is predicted that the trend for energy savings involving corporations will become increasingly demanding. In this climate, SMC will strive for innovations of production systems with energy savings in mind. With cooperation from customers, we will promote energy saving programs for pneumatic systems. © 2005 SMC Corporation All Rights Reserved Specifications are subject to change without prior notice and any obligation on the part of the manufacturer. Proposals for Energy Saving Pneumatic Systems SMC ECOLOGY PNEUMATICS SYSTEM SMC'S GLOBAL MANUFACTURING, DISTRIBUTION AND SERVICE NETWORK Proposals for Energy Saving Pneumatic Systems CAT.E02-21 B D-DN 1st printing FR printing JV 120DN Printed in Japan. This catalog is printed on recycled paper with concern for the global environment. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 1 Energy Saving Equipment Actuators Series MGZ Series MGF PFC/QFC valves Series ASR/ASQ (Made to Order) Series ZCUK Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Direct operated 2 port solenoid valve Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Zero differential pressure operated 2 port solenoid valve Direct air operated 2 port valve Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Large 3 port solenoid valve 3 port mechanical valve Coolant valve Flow switching 2 port air operated valve Booster valve Air blow, Air tool, Non-operation Air blow, Air tool Air blow, Air tool Cooling water Air purge Air purge, Paint stirring Air purge, Non-operation Air purge, Non-operation Air purge Coolant Paint stirring Hydraulic clamp Page 48 51 53 55 57 58 60 62 64 68 70 71 Air blow Air blow, Air tool, Coolant Air blow, Air tool, Air leakage Air leakage Air leakage Air leakage Air blow, Air tool Air leakage Air blow, Air tool Air blow, Air tool Actuator Air blow, Air tool Actuator Air line maintenance Air line maintenance Air line maintenance Page 74 80 83 104 105 106 107 107 108 109 110 111 113 114 115 116 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment/Air Preparation Equipment Blow gun Nozzles for blowing/Sensing heads S couplers FR double layer tubing FR double layer polyurethane tubing Double layer tubing stripper Polyurethane coil tubing Tube cutter Modular type regulator Pilot operated regulator Regulator with back flow mechanism Filter regulator Filter regulator with back flow mechanism Air filter element part number list Differential pressure gauge Filter with element service indicator Series VMG Series KN Series KK Series TRB Series TRBU Series TKS Series TCU Series TK Series AR10 to 60 Series AR425 to 935 Series AR20K to 60K Series AW10 to 40 Series AW20K to 40K GD40-2-01 Sensors/Measuring Instruments Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air tool, Air leakage, Cooling water Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air tool, Vacuum Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air tool, Vacuum Air line maintenance Air line maintenance, Liquid removal, Coolant Air line maintenance, Liquid removal, Coolant Air line maintenance, Liquid removal, Coolant Air blow, Air tool Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air leakage Air purge Air purge Liquid removal Page 118 154 162 171 173 182 189 Series ZH Series ZU Series ZL112/ 212 (Special order product) (Special order product) (Special order product) Liquid removal Liquid removal Vacuum Vacuum Vacuum Liquid removal Page 226 228 229 234 235 236 Series FG Series FN1 Coolant Air line maintenance, Coolant Page 238 240 Actuator Air blow, Air tool, Coolant Actuator Page 252 257 259 197 203 205 222 224 Vacuum Equipment Vacuum ejector In-line vacuum ejector Multistage ejector Vacuum ejector with check valve Pad with check valve Vacuum ejector for water soluble coolant removal Industrial Filters Industrial filter Refresh filter Other (CD-ROM) Model Selection Software Ver. 3.00 Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 SMC Pneumatics CAD System Ver. 2.6 Table of Contents 2 Other (CD-ROM) Series PF2A/PF2W Series ZSE30/ISE30 Series ZSE40/ISE40 Series ZSE3/ISE3 Series ZSE50F/ISE50 Series ISE70/75/75H Series ZSE5B/ISE5B Series PPA (Made to Order) Series ISA2 Series ISA (Special order product) Industrial Filters Digital flow switch High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids 2-color display digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch with backlight Compact manometer Air leakage tester Air catch sensor Air catch sensor Negative pressure detection valve Sensors Vacuum Equipment Measuring Instruments Series VXD21/22/23 Series VCA Series VQ20/30 Series VXZ Series VXA21/22 Series VP300/500/700 Series VG342 Series VP3145/3165/3185 Series VM1000 VM100/200/400 Series VNC (Special order product) Series VBA1110 to 4200 Directional Control Equipment Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Page 2 19 21 23 34 35 36 40 41 42 45 Directional Control Equipment (Made to Order) (Made to Order) (Made to Order) Series CCT Actuator Actuator Actuator Actuator Air blow Air blow Air leakage Air leakage Air leakage Hydraulic clamp Hydraulic clamp Actuators Non-rotating double power cylinder Guide table PFC/QFC valves Air saving valves Hollow rod cylinders Free mount cylinder for vacuum Water resistant air cylinders Cylinder with heavy duty scraper Cylinder with coil scraper Air-hydro booster Air-hydro converter ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM1 Energy Saving Proposals & Energy Saving Equipment List Proposal 1 Pressure/Flow Control Flow rate and pressure controls SMC FLOW SWITCH SMC FLOW SWITCH UNIT UNIT RESET RESET SET SET SMC FLOW SWITCH UNIT RESET SET Proposal 2 Idling Reduction of air leakage and air for purging when equipment is not operated. Master Air Blow Reduction of air for blowing Air blow Proposal 4 Air gun Air Tools Reduction of air for air tools Impact wrench (air motor) Proposal 5 Proposal 6 Air Leakage Stop air leakage from piping equipment Air Purging (Air Micro) Reduction of air for purging Workpiece Proposal 7 Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Large 3 port solenoid valve Page 48 Series VXD21/22/23 60 Series VG342 62 Series VP3145/3165/3185 Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Direct operated 2 port solenoid valve Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Blow gun Nozzles for blowing/Sensing heads S couplers Polyurethane coil tubing Modular type regulator Regulator with back flow mechanism Pilot operated regulator Filter regulator Filter regulator with back flow mechanism Digital flow switch for air High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch Compact manometer Air leakage tester Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 Hollow rod cylinders Free mount cylinder for vacuum Series VXD21/22/23 Series VCA Series VQ20/30 Series VMG Series KN Series KK Series TCU Series AR10 to 60 Series AR20K to 60K Series AR425 to 935 Series AW10 to 40 Series AW20K to 40K Series PF2A Series ZSE30/ISE30 Series ISE40 Series PPA (Made to Order) S couplers FR double layer tubing Double layer tubing stripper Tube cutter Air leakage tester Digital flow switch for air Water resistant air cylinders Air cylinder with heavy duty scraper Air cylinder with coil scraper Series KK Series TRB/TRBU Series TKS Series TK (Made to Order) Series PF2A Direct air operated 2 port valve 3 port mechanical valve Air catch sensor Air catch sensor Page 57 Series VXA21/22 64 Series VM1000 VM100/200/400 205 Series ISA2 222 Series ISA Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Flow switching 2 port air operated valve Paint Stirring Reduction of air consumption for paint stirrer Stirrer Paint pump Paint tank Front matter 1 Series PF2A/PF2W (Made to Order) Series PPA Series KN GD40-2-01 Series ZSE30/ISE30 Series ISE40 Series ISE3 Series ZSE50F/ISE50 Series ISE70/75/75H Series ISE5B Series FN1 M/C solenoid valve Proposal 3 Page 118 203 197 80 115 116 154 162 171 173 182 189 240 114 Digital flow switch Air leakage tester Compact manometer Nozzles for blowing/Sensing heads Differential pressure gauge Filter with element service indicator High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch LED display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids 2-color display digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch with backlight Low maintenance filter Air filter element part number list (Made to Order) Series ZCUK (Made to Order) (Made to Order) Series VP300/500/700 (Special order product) Page 48 51 53 74 80 83 107 108 110 109 111 113 118 154 162 197 203 256 34 35 Page 83 104 106 107 203 118 36 40 41 Page 58 70 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM2 Non-rotating double power cylinder Guide table PFC/QFC valves Air saving valves Regulator with back flow mechanism Model Selection Program Ver. 3.00 SMC Pneumatics CAD System Ver. 2.6 Series MGZ Series MGF High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch Vacuum ejector with check valve Pad with check valve Multistage ejector Series ZSE30/ISE30 Page 154 162 Series ZSE40 234 (Special order product) 235 (Special order product) 229 Series ZL112, 212 Vacuum ejector for water soluble coolant removal Vacuum ejector Linear vacuum ejector Negative pressure detection valve High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids Digital pressure switch with backlight (Special order product) Page 236 Series ZH 226 Series ZU 228 (Special order product) 224 Series ZSE50F/ISE50 173 Series ZSE5B/ISE5B 189 coolant pumps Coolant valve Nozzles for blowing/Sensing heads High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids 2-color display digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch with backlight Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 Industrial filter Low maintenance filter Series VNC Page 68 Series KN 80 Series ZSE50F/ISE50 173 Series ISE70/75/75H 182 Series ISE5B 189 257 Series FG 238 Series FN1 240 Cooling Water Zero differential pressure operated 2 port solenoid valve Digital flow switch for water Series VXZ Series PF2W Page 55 118 Air-hydro booster Air-hydro converter (Made to Order) Series CCT Page 42 45 5 port solenoid valve 5 port solenoid valve 2 port solenoid valve Series SY Front matter 26 Series VQ Front matter 26 Series VQ20/30 Page 53 Actuators Proposal 8 Air reduction for actuators Series ASR/ASQ Series AR20K to 60K Page 2 19 21 23 110 252 259 Lifter Vacuum Proposal 9 Air reduction for vacuum ejectors Suction transfer Liquid Removal Proposal 10 Air reduction for P liquid removal pumps Air type liquid removal pump Machine Oil pan Oil waste Coolant (Cleaning) Blow Proposal 11 Power reduction for Proposal 12 Power reduction for cooling water pump Welding gun Proposal 13 Hydraulic Clamp Power reduction for hydraulic pump M Hydraulic cylinder Work piece Hydraulic pump P Hydraulic control valve Low Power Consumption/Long Service Life Proposal 14 Reduction of power used for solenoid valve energization and service life improvement Low power consumption Long service life Front matter 2 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM3 Recognizing the current state... First step toward energy savings and improving awareness To promote energy savings in pneumatic systems, it is necessary to recognize and control the existing system's air consumption and to improve the awareness of energy saving (cost awareness) in the work place. Based on usage, electric power consumption for air (compressor) is thought to be 20% of the entire consumption (Figure 1). Furthermore, air consumption based on usage is as shown in Figure 2. It is necessary to understand and control the air consumption for these usages. Actuators 10% Air 20% Coolant 30% Air leakage 20% Other 50% (Figure 1) Electric power consumption Air blow 70% (Figure 2) Air consumption It is said that energy saving measures begin with measurement and end with measurement. Find out where, how much, and for what purpose the energy is being used. Then, find out how much can be reduced as a result of improvements. Effective energy saving improvements can be implemented by recognizing and controlling the current state of energy consumption and the result of the improvements, entirely with numerical values. Reason for improvement Measurement Recognize the potential of improvement Recognize current consumption Improvement Air line maintenance equipment to recognize the current state Digital flow switch Series PF2A Separately measures air consumption by facility and by line. • Measured flow rate: 12000 l (max.) Measurement Energy savings Verify the enegy consumption after the improvement Educational panels to improve energy saving awareness Air leakage tester (Made to Order) Measures leakage flow rate. • Measured flow rate: 9999 l (max.) Air blow demonstration panel Air leakage demonstration panel Guides the approach to and improvement methods for air blow. Air leakage can be heard and felt. Coolant blow demonstration panel Vacuum ejector demonstration panel Large fluctuations of energy in the discharge, caused by the relationship between the nozzle and upstream piping system, can actually be confirmed. The point where the difference occurs between a good system and a bad system can actually be measured. Demonstrates how suction is maintained by using an ejector with check valve. Air consumption can be compared with a general vacuum suction system. Compact manometer Series PPA Measures the workpiece collision pressure. Calculates air blow rate with flow rate formula. Front matter 3 Refer to Proposal 1 "Air Line Maintenance" on Front matter 5 for details. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM4 What are energy saving measures? After improvement Electric power consumption Electric power consumption Before improvement A B C A B C Time Time Compressor operation capacity Peak consumption of A Consumption of B + Consumption of C Continuous operation of compressor Compressors Compressors Consumption of A: Consumption from equipment operation 1) Cylinder operation 2) Air blow 3) Suction by ejector, etc. Reduction of consumption by optimizing. Reduce the peak flow rate for more even consumption by considering the cycle time and operating time. Consumption of B: Consumption from line operation 1) Purge air to prevent intrusion of coolant, etc. 2) Air blow to prevent foreign matter adhesion 3) Down blow inside the painting booth Reduction of consumption by optimizing. Reduce consumption in connection with equipment operation. Or, hold consumption to the minimum required. Consumption of C 1) Air leakage 2) Air curtain, etc. 3) Liquid stirring system operation, etc. Reduction of consumption by optimizing. Fix air leakage. Fix the cause of air leakage. Consider other methods for consumption such as air curtains that has purpose. Front matter 4 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM5 1 Air Line Maintenance Purpose Flow maintenance Before Improvement Since the current flow rate based on the usage is not recognized, the target for improvement and its effect are not expressed in numerical values and remain unclear. After Improvement Effective use of measuring instruments. Flow rate is maintained with numerical values, and the target for improvement and its effect are clarified. Equipment q Digital flow switch for air w e Air leakage tester Compact manometer Equipment Equipment Equipment Equipment q w Air leakage tester Main Points Measure main line and branch line flow rates. Measure air leakage rate and air blow rate Digital flow switch for air Series PF2A Page 118 Air leakage tester. (Made to Order) Page 203 Measure air blow rate. Compact manometer Series PPA Page 197 Measures workpiece collision pressure to calculate flow rate by using flow formula. Related Equipment Nozzles for blowing/Sensing heads Front matter 5 Series KN P. 80 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM6 Purpose Pressure maintenance Before Improvement The importance of regular maintenance for the pressure loss caused by clogged elements is not recognized. Therefore, a large burden is placed on the compressor and pump, etc. After Improvement Regular maintenance of clogged elements is implemented by mounting pressure and flow monitoring equipment on each type of filter used on each line. Sub line Main line Main line filter Series AFF Reciprocating air compressor Aftercooler (air cooled) Series HAA Aftercooler (water cooled) Series HAW Refrigerated air dryer Series IDF Air tank Series AT Operating line q Differential pressure gauge q Differential pressure gauge → IN Upstream side → OUT Downsteam side Main Points q Check clogged elements by using a differential pressure gauge. w Element service indicator Differential pressure gauge GD40-2-02 Page 115 w Confirm clogged condition visually. Element service indicator filter Page 116 e Verify pressure loss. High precision digital pressure switch e Pressure switch Series ISE40 Page 162 Related Equipment High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch LED display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch with backlight 2-color display digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch for general purpose fluid Digital flow switch for water Low maintenance filter Industrial filter Air filter element list Series ZSE30/ISE30 P. 154 Series ISE3 171 Series ZSE50F/ISE50 173 Series ISE70/75/75H 182 Series ISE5B 189 Series PF2W 118 Series FN1 240 Series FG 238 114 Front matter 6 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM7 2 Non-operation Purpose Reduction of air for purging and air leakage when equipment is non-operation. Before Improvement Since the compressor is in continuous operation even when the equipment is non-operation, air is constantly consumed due to air leakage and purging, etc. Air purge Air leakage M/C After Improvement Air supply to the equipment is stopped when it is non-operation. Master solenoid valve M/C Main Points Mount a master solenoid valve to each line and component. Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Series VXD21/22/23 Page 48 Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% 100% Reduction Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Series VG342 Page 60 Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Series VP3145/3165/3185 Page 62 Before Front matter 7 After ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM8 3 Proposal Air Blow Purpose Reduction of air consumption for air blow Before Improvement Air blow is performed without any attachment at the air outlet. S2 S1 Effective area ratio 0.5 : 1 Without nozzles ø4 Pressure loss: Large ø4 Workpiece P2 P3 Upstream side S1: 22.6 Nozzle side S2: 45.2 Effective area ratio S1 : S2 = 0.5 : 1 Nozzle size (mm) ø4 Number of nozzles 4 Regulator pressure (P1) 0.4 MPa Outlet pressure (P2) 0.08 MPa Collision pressure (P3) ∗ 0.002 MPa ∗ The pressure that the work piece receives is called collision pressure. Effective area (mm2) P1 S1 S2 After Improvement Nozzles are attached S1 S2 Nozzle ø1.5 Effective area ratio 3.5 : 1 Pressure loss: Small ø1.5 Workpiece P2 P3 Upstream side S1: 22.6 Nozzle side S2: 6.4 Effective area ratio S1 : S2 = 3.5 : 1 Nozzle size (mm) ø1.5 Number of nozzles 4 Regulator pressure (P1) 0.25 MPa Outlet pressure (P2) 0.225 MPa Collision pressure (P3)∗ 0.002 MPa ∗ The pressure that the work piece receives is called collision pressure. Effective area (mm2) P1 S1 S2 Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% 75% Reduction Before After Front matter 8 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM9 Blowing with Air Gun Before Improvement In the case of air guns, energy saving measures are not considered and the factory line pressure is used directly in most cases. S1 S2 Effective area ratio Pressure Large loss: 2.3 : 1 ø3 Without nozzle ø3 Pressure Loss of Air Gun Only Upstream side S1: 15 Nozzle side S2: 6.4 Effective area (mm2) Effective area ratio Nozzle size (mm) Number of nozzles Supply pressure Regulator pressure Outlet pressure Pressure loss S1 : S2 = 2.3 : 1 ø3 1 0.700 MPa 0.300 MPa 0.260 MPa 0.040 MPa After Improvement A nozzle is attached to the tip of the air gun. A regulator is added and pressure control is improved. Fittings and tubing are changed to those with large effective areas. S1 S2 Effective area ratio Filter regulator 10.7 : 1 S coupler Pressure Small loss: Coil tube Nozzle ø2 ø2 Pressure Loss of Air Gun Only Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Pressure loss Min. Reduction Before Front matter 9 After Effective area (mm2) Effective area ratio Nozzle size (mm) Number of nozzles Supply pressure Regulator pressure Outlet pressure Pressure loss Upstream side S1: 30 Nozzle side S2: 2.8 S1 : S2 = 10.7 : 1 ø2 1 0.700 MPa 0.300 MPa 0.297 MPa 0.003 MPa ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM10 Main Points Pressure loss improvement q The pressure loss has been improved by the straight air flow direction. Blow gun Series VMG Page 74 w Use small size nozzles to improve the effective area ratio with the upstream side. Nozzles for blowing Series KN Page 80 e Reduce pressure for optional usage. Regulator Series AR Page 108 Filter regulator Series AW Page 111 r Improve effective area by changing fittings. S couplers Series KK Page 83 Large effective area Related Equipment Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Pilot operated regulator Digital flow switch for air High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch Compact manometer Polyurethane coil tubing Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 Hollow rod cylinders Free mount cylinder for vacuum Air leakage tester Series VXD21/22/23 P. 48 Series AR425 to 935 109 Series PF2A 118 Series ZSE30/ISE30 154 Series ISE40 162 Series PPA 197 Series TCU 107 256 (Made to Order) 34 Series ZCUK 35 (Made to Order) 203 Front matter 10 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM11 4 Air Tools Purpose Reduction of air consumption for air tools Before Improvement As in the case of air guns, energy saving measures are not considered and the factory line pressure is used directly. Change in immediate pressure Pressure loss: Large Pressure (MPa) 0.6 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 Time 1 cycle (6 sec) Impact wrench Since the torque for impact wrenches, etc., is determined by the immediate pressure, a large pressure loss will cause problems such as torque instability and long cycle time. After Improvement Fittings and tubing are changed to those with large effective areas. A regulator is added and pressure control is improved. Change in immediate pressure Pressure loss: Small Filter regulator Coil tube Pressure (MPa) 0.6 S coupler 0.5 0.4 0.3 Before improvement 0.2 0.1 0 1 cycle (4 sec) Torque stability Shortened cycle time Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption Pressure loss improvement 100% 25% Reduction Before Front matter 11 Main Points After Methods and related equipment are the same as Proposal 3 "Air Blow" on Front matter 10. 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM12 5 Air Leakage Purpose Stop air leakage from piping components Before Improvement 20 to 50% of air consumption is accounted to air leakage. Since the compressor is in continuous operation regardless of whether equipment is in operation or at rest, a fixed amount of air is constantly consumed due to leakage from piping. Air consumption status Compressor operation status Tubing, fittings Couplers Rubber hoses Other Flow rate ECOPS.qxd Air leakage is equivalent to 20 to 50%. Air leakage Air leakage, purging 1 20% 25% 30% 25% 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 Other Non-operation time Operating time Time Air leakage examples • Air leakage from One-touch fittings due to bad cutting surface of tubing • Air leakage from couplers due to bad sealing • Air leakage from tubing due to chips, wear-out and spatter, etc. Leakage Leakage Leakage Front matter 12 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM13 Main Points q Select leakage resistant equipment. S couplers Series KK Page 83 w Use double layer tubing to prevent damage to tubing by chips, spatter and wear-out. Double layer tubing Series TRB/TRBU Page 104 Sealed construction for reduced leakage Inner tube Soft nylon polyurethane Exterior layer FR double layer tubing cross section e Correct tube cutting surface by using special tools. Double layer tube stripper Tube cutter Series TK Page 107 Series TKS Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% 100% Reduction Before Front matter 13 After Page 106 Related Equipment Air leakage tester Digital flow switch for air Water resistant air cylinders Air cylinder with heavy duty scraper Air cylinder with coil scraper (Made to Order) P. 203 Series PF2A 118 36 (Made to Order) 40 (Made to Order) 41 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM14 6 Air Purge (Air Micro) Purpose Reduction of air consumption for air micro Before Improvement An air micro is used on machining equipment to confirm precision after machining. Air is constantly released regardless of the presence of a workpiece. Workpiece After Improvement The circuit is changed to supply air only when measuring workpieces. Workpiece 2 port air operated valve 3 port mechanical valve Main Points Stop the air supply depending on the presence of workpieces. 3 port mechanical valve Series VM Page 64 Direct air operated 2 port valve Series VXA21/22 Page 57 Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% 95% Reduction Related Equipment Before After Air catch sensor Air catch sensor Series ISA2 Series ISA P. 205 222 Front matter 14 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM15 7 Paint Stirring Purpose Reduction of air consumption for paint stirrer Before Improvement In a painting booth, it is necessary to have the stirrer in operation at all times to prevent paint from coagulating. Even when the line is not in operation, air is supplied in the same manner as when it is in operation. Stirrer Paint pump Paint tank After Improvement The circuit is changed to operate the stirrer with a minimal air supply when the line is not in operation. Stirrer Paint pump Paint tank Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Flow switching 2 port air operated valve Main Points Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption Flow switching 2 port air operated valve (Special order product) Series VKFA332-X1 Page 70 100% 50% Reduction Before Front matter 15 Switch the line flow rate depending on the operating time and non-operating time. After Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Series VP300/500/700 Page 58 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM16 8 Actuators Purpose Reduction of air consumption by actuators Before Improvement Cylinder output uses the same pressure for lifting or lowering. Use of an exterior guide adds extra weight. After Improvement By using a double power extension cylinder, a reduction in operating pressure or use of a smaller size cylinder is made possible. Use of a large bore tube rod and non-rotating mechanism makes the guide unnecessary. Main Points Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% 35% Change to a non-rotating double power cylinder. Non-rotating double power cylinder Series MGZ Page 2 Reduction Before After Front matter 16 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM17 After Improvement q To reduce the non-working side output for a lifter when the jig weight is heavy and the workpiece is light Pressure is reduced in the direction that is influenced by the jig and workpiece load. When a large load effects both lifting and lowering Regulator with check valve w To reduce the non-workting side output for horizontal transfer or a clamp A PFC valve is used to reduce pressure in the direction that is not affected by a smaller cylinder output, such as the transfer retraction side or unclamping side. PFC valve Only output to one side is necessary. QFC valve Main Points Reduce pressure on the nonworking side. (Change to a one side regulated circuit.) Regulator with check valve Series AR Page 110 PFC/QFC valves Air saving valves Series ASR/ASQ Page 23 Page 21 Related Equipment Guide table Model Selection Program Ver. 3.00 SMC Pneumatics CAD System Ver. 2.6 Front mater 17 Series MGF P. 19 252 259 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM18 9 Vacuum Ejectors Purpose Reduction of air consumption for vacuum ejectors Before Improvement Normally, in the case of vacuum ejector suction, air needs to be constantly supplied to maintain the suction of a workpiece. Standard ejector Vacuum generation Assumed to be 2 sec. After Improvement Use of an ejector with vacuum holding specification enables stopping air supply to maintain the suction at a workpiece. Air consumption is reduced by shortening the vacuum generation ti me. Ejector with check valve Ejector unit circuit Vacuum generation Vacuum holding 0.5 sec –80 kpa Workpiece 1.5 sec Note) Since vacuum pressure may drop due to leakage, etc., use a pressure switch to maintain the vacuum pressure necessary for the suction of a work piece. Main Points Change to an ejector with built-in check valve. Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% 50 to 75% Reduction Before Vacuum ejector with check valve (Special order product) Page 234 Related Equipment High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch Pad with check valve Series ZSE30/ISE30 P. 154 Series ZSE40/ISE40 162 INO-3769 (Special order product) 235 After Front matter 18 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM19 Before Improvement For suction of a workpiece with leakage, a large suction flow is necessary, which in turn necessitates the use of a larger nozzle size and increased air consumption. SUP. EXH. Leakage Vacuum pressure (kpa) Single stage ejector ZH18 Nozzle size ø1.8 Air consumption 150 l/min –14 VAC. 55 Suction flow (l/min) After Improvement Use of an ejector with 3-stage diffuser construction enables a reduction of the air consumption even with the same suction flow and vacuum pressure. Vacuum pressure (kpa) Multistage ejector ZL112 Leakage Nozzle size ø1.2 Air consumption 63 l/min –14 55 Suction flow (l/min) Main Points Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption Multistage ejector Series ZL112/212 100% 58% Reduction Before Front matter 19 Change to an ejector with 3-stage diffuser construction. After Page 229 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM20 10 Liquid Removal Purpose Reduction of air for a liquid removal pump Before Improvement Removal of oil waste accumulated in the oil pan under a machine or conveyor. The pump is in operation regardless of the amount of liquid and this causes a great energy loss. P Air operated liquid removal pump • Damage to the diaphragm due to operating without accumulated liquid • Clogged check valve due to foreign matter (chips, etc.) Machine Oil pan Oil waste After Improvement Suction method is changed to an ejector operated type and an automatic stop circuit is installed to stop operation when there is no liquid. Removal of water soluble coolant Ejector Machine Water soluble coolants are directly suctioned for removal by the ejector. Removal of oil based coolant Ejector Tank Machine Since oil based coolants are easily vaporized, they are temporarily stored in a tank. Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% 70 to 95% Reduction Before After Front matter 20 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM21 Main Points Start or stop the pump depending on the presence of liquid (waste). q Suction by an ejector prevents clogging (without check valve mechanism) Vacuum ejector for water soluble coolant removal (Special order product) Page 236 Vacuum ejector (for oil based coolant removal) ZH Page 226 w An automatic shut off circuit prevents operation when there is no liquid. Circuit example Discharge side Negative pressure detection valve Removal side Negative pressure detection valve (Special order product) Page 224 Related Equipment In-line vacuum ejector High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids Digital pressure switch with backlight Front matter 21 P. 228 Series ZU Series ZSE50F/ISE50 173 Series ZSE5B/ISE5B 189 05.9.5 11:27 AM 11 Coolant (Cleaning) Pump Purpose Reduction of electric power consumption for coolant pump Before Improvement Coolant is blown without any attachment at the coolant outlet. Small diameter piping Without nozzle S2 For cutting (Blade cooling) S1 For jig (Reference surface cleaning) Washing bed (Washing chips) Large diameter nozzle Pressure loss: Large Effective area ratio 0.2 : 1 Workpiece ø20 Pump capacity P Pressure Pressure Pump head (electric power) Proposal Page FM22 Pressure loss: Large Discharge Pump rate outlet Nozzle outlet After Improvement Pressure loss is reduced by attaching nozzles. Large diameter piping Small diameter nozzle S1 With nozzle S2 Pressure loss: Small Effective area ratio 2:1 ø6 Pump head (electric power) ECOPS.qxd P Pump capacity Previous rate Pressure Pressure loss: Small Discharge Pump rate outlet Nozzle outlet Main Points Improve pressure loss. Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Electric power consumption Improve the effective area ratio with the upstream side by using a small diameter nozzle. Nozzles for blowing Series KN 100% Page 80 75% Reduction Before After Related Equipment High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids 2-color display digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch with backlight Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 Industrial filter Low maintenance filter Series ZSE50F/ISE50 P. 173 Series ISE70/75/75H 182 Series ZSE5B/ISE5B 189 256 Series FG 238 Series FN1 240 Front matter 22 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM23 Before Improvement For bed washing (chip washing), coolant is discharged constantly without any restraint. For cutting For jig (Blade cooling) Nozzle KN (Reference surface cleaning) Bed washing (Washing chips) Coolant flow/cycle For cutting Flow rate For cutting For jig For cutting For jig Bed washing P Bed washing 1 cycle After Improvement Bed washing is stopped when blowing for cutting or jig. Coolant flow/cycle For jig P Bed washing Flow rate For cutting For cutting Bed washing For cutting For jig The amount of reduction is shown by the shaded area. Bed washing 1 cycle Coolant valve Main Points Improve pressure loss. Supply and stop coolant for bed washing. Coolant valve Series VNC Page 68 Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Electric power consumption 100% 20 to 50% Reduction Before Front matter 23 After Related Equipment High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids 2-color display digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch with backlight Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 Industrial filter Low maintenance filter Series ZSE50F/ISE50 P. 173 Series ISE70/75/75H 182 Series ZSE5B/ISE5B 189 256 Series FG 238 Series FN1 240 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM24 12 Proposal Cooling Water Purpose Reduction of electric power consumption for cooling water pump Before Improvement Regardless of operating or non-operating state of a welding gun, cooling water is constantly discharged. Header IN P P Pump OUT Cooling water tank Welder After Improvement Stop cooling water supply when not welding. Header 2 port solenoid valve IN P P Pump OUT Cooling water tank Welder Main Points Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Electric power consumption 100% 30 to 50% Stop the supply of cooling water when not welding. Zero differential pressure operated 2 port solenoid valve Series VXZ Page 55 Reduction Before After Related Equipment Digital flow switch for water Series PF2W P. 118 Front matter 24 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page FM25 13 Proposal Hydraulic Clamp Purpose Reduction of electric power consumption for hydraulic clamp Before Improvement Hydraulic cylinder Hydraulic control valve A hydraulic unit is used for workpiece clamping when cutting is performed. M Hydraulic cylinder Workpiece Hydraulic control valve Hydraulic pump P After Improvement By performing air-hydro conversion for the clamping process, the use of the hydraulic unit is eliminated. Cutting feed is electrically driven. Air-hydro converter Air-hydro booster M M Workpiece Hydraulic cylinder Main Points Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Electric power consumption Convert to high output hydraulic drive. Air-hydro booster (Made to Order) 100% 30 to 50% Page 42 Reduction Before After Air-hydro converter Series CCT Page 45 Front matter 25 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Proposal Page FM26 14 Low Power Consumption/Long Service Life Purpose Reduction of power used for solenoid valve energization, and service life improvement After Improvement Electric power used for solenoid valve energization is reduced by using low power consumption solenoid valves. Also, the use of a metal seal construction improves the service life. Main Points 5 port solenoid valve Series SY 0.35 W/0.1 W (with energy saving circuit) 5 port solenoid valve Series VQ/Metal seal 0.5 W(21 mA, 24 VDC) 200 million cycles ∗ 2 port solenoid valve Series VQ20/30 2.5 W (104 mA, 24 VDC) 20 million cycles ∗ ∗ These values are based on SMC life test conditions. For more details refer to Best Pneumatics 2004 catalog Vol. 1/2/17. Front matter 26 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Front matter 27 Page FM27 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 1 Actuators Actuators Non-rotating double power cylinder Guide table PFC/QFC valves Air saving valves Hollow rod cylinders Free mount cylinder for vacuum Water resistant air cylinders Air cylinder with heavy duty scraper Air cylinder with coil scraper Air-hydro booster Air-hydro converter Series Application MGZ MGF PFC/QFC valves ASR/ASQ (Made to Order) ZCUK Actuator Actuator Actuator Actuator Air blow Air blow Air leakage (Made to Order) (Made to Order) (Made to Order) CCT Air leakage Air leakage Hydraulic clamp Hydraulic clamp Page 2 19 21 23 34 35 36 40 41 42 45 1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 2 Non-rotating Double Power Cylinder Series MGZ Actuator ø40, ø50, ø63 Front end lock type and mounting brackets now available • End lock holds the rod when extended • Transaxial foot style, front flange style and rear flange style New Non-rotation guide is unnecessary ! Slide key x 2 Long stroke capability with space savings Employs a large bore tube rod up to 80% of the cylinder's external square dimension plus slide bearings. In addition, a built-in non-rotation mechanism using slide keys allows direct mounting of loads. Strokes up to 1000 mm are possible. The overall cylinder length is not two or more times the stroke length, as is the case with conventional double output cylinders (tandem type). Tube rod diameter External square dimension (Approx. 30% reduction) Double output power for extension! Air pressure supplied from A operates on surfaces q and w. (extension) q w A B Clean external appearance Auto switches are contained in grooves on four sides Air pressure supplied from B operates on surface e. (retraction) e A B Piping is centralized on the head cover. Mounting accuracy improved Positioning holes are provided on the workpiece mounting surface for easy alignment. Regulator with check valve is unnecessary A regulator with check valve normally required for a lifting circuit becomes unnecessary. Applications Pressing High strength with space savings Gripping Pusher Moment resistance is equal to that of a guide cylinder (cylinder + two guide shafts). Furthermore, the mounting cross section is reduced by approximately 40%. Shooter Lifter 2 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 3 Non-rotating Double Power Cylinder MGZ Series How to Order MGZ Standard Type 40 Z 100 Y7BW Number of auto switches Mounting Nil 2 pcs. 1 pc. Nil S Actuators L F G Basic style Transaxial foot style Front flange style Rear flange style Auto switch type Bore size 40 50 63 Nil 40 mm 50 mm 63 mm ∗ Select applicable auto switch models from the table below. ∗ Auto switches are shipped together, (but not assembled). Coil scraper Nil Z Without auto switch (Built-in magnet cylinder) Stroke (mm) Refer to the standard stroke table. None Yes Applicable Auto Switches: Direct Mount Type Auto switch model Load voltage Reed switch Type Special function — Electrical entry Wiring (output) Indicator light Grommet DC In-line 0.5 (Nil) 3 (L) 5 (Z) Applicable load — 5V — — Z76 — IC circuit 2-wire 24 V 12 V 100 V — Z73 — Y69A Y59A Y7PV Y7P 5 V, 12 V 3-wire (PNP) 2-wire 3-wire (NPN) 24 V Yes Diagnostic indication (2 color indicator) 3-wire (PNP) 2-wire Water resistant (2 color indicator) Note 1) Lead wire length symbols: 0.5 m ......... Nil 3 m ......... L 5 m ......... Z Perpendicular — Yes — Grommet Lead wire length (m)∗ 3-wire (NPN) 3-wire (NPN) Solid state switch AC Electrical entry direction 12 V — 5 V, 12 V 12 V Y69B Y59B Y7NWV Y7NW Y7PWV Y7PW Y7BWV Y7BW — Y7BA — Relay, PLC IC circuit — Relay, PLC IC circuit — (Example) Y59B Y59BL Y59BZ Note 2) Solid state switches marked with a "" symbol are produced upon receipt of order. Note 3) When later installing auto switches on a cylinder ordered without auto switches, the switch spacers in the table below are necessary. Switch spacer Switch Spacer Applicable bore size (mm) Switch spacer 40, 50, 63 BMP1-032 Mounting Bracket Part No. Bore size (mm) 40 50 60 Foot MGZ-L04 MGZ-L05 MGZ-L06 Flange MGZ-F04 MGZ-F05 MGZ-F06 3 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 4 MGZ Specifications 40 Bore size (mm) Action 50 63 Double acting, Single rod Fluid Air 1.5 MPa Proof pressure 1.0 MPa Maximum operating pressure Standard stroke: 0.08 MPa Minimum operating pressure Long stroke: 0.12 MPa Without auto switch: –10 to 70°C (with no freezing) Ambient and fluid temperature With auto switch: –10 to 60°C (with no freezing) Lubrication Non-lube Extending: 50 to 700 mm/s Piston speed Retracting: 50 to 450 mm/s +1.4 to 250 +1.0 0 , 251 to 1000 0 Stroke length tolerance Cushion Rubber bumper Thread tolerance JIS class 2 Port size Rc 1/4 Mounting Basic style, Transaxial foot style, Front flange style, Rear flange style Standard Stroke Bore size (mm) 40, 50, 63 Standard stroke (mm) Long stroke (mm) 75, 100, 125, 150, 175 350, 400, 450, 500, 600 200, 250, 300 700, 800, 900,1000 Intermediate strokes and strokes of less than 75 mm can also be manufactured. Weight (kg) Bore size (mm) Standard weight Additional weight per 50 mm of stroke Basic style Foot style Flange style All brackets 40 50 63 1.90 2.39 2.34 0.39 3.03 3.92 3.79 0.59 4.83 6.08 5.83 0.78 Theoretical Output Model MGZ40 MGZ50 MGZ63 4 Bore size (mm) 45 x 40 40 55 x 50 50 68 x 63 63 (N) Rod size Operating Piston area (mm) direction (mm2) 20 25 32 OUT IN OUT IN OUT IN 2533 942 3848 1473 5945 2313 0.2 507 188 770 295 1189 463 0.3 760 283 1154 442 1784 694 0.4 1013 377 1539 589 2378 925 Operating pressure (MPa) 0.7 0.6 0.5 1773 1520 1267 659 565 471 2694 2309 1924 1031 884 737 4162 3567 2973 1619 1388 1157 0.8 2026 754 3078 1178 4756 1850 0.9 2280 848 3463 1326 5351 2082 1.0 2533 942 3848 1473 5945 2313 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 5 Non-rotating Double Power Cylinder MGZ Series Dimensions Basic style GA 2-RcP Y Y GB Actuators øXAH7 depth XL 4-MM depth M +0.2 0 øD øI 2 x 4-J E MB KA MC C K B MA N N S + Stroke H ZZ + Stroke Allowable angle displacement of E to B is ±1.5°. (mm) Bore size (mm) Stroke range B C D E KA GA GB H I J K M 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 59 71 82 46 55 66 45 55 68 21 26 32 36 46 53 34.5 40 46.5 23.5 28 34.5 40 45 50 78 92 110 M6 x 1.0 M8 x 1.25 M8 x 1.25 25 25 25 10 14 14 Bore size (mm) Stroke range MA MB MC MM N P S XA XL Y ZZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 16 16 16 4 5 5 12 15 15 M6 x 1.0 M8 x 1.25 M8 x 1.25 44 50 56 1/4 1/4 1/4 138 150 171 12 16 16 6 6 6 9.5 12.5 15 178 195 221 5 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 6 MGZ Dimensions: With Mounting Bracket Transaxial foot style: (L) LH LT LY 4-øLD through X/2 X X Y LX LS + Stroke LZ ZZ + Stroke (mm) Bore size (mm) Stroke range X Y z LH LT LX LY LZ LS ZZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 24 32 36 0 1 3 9 11 13 34 40 47 19 22 24 80 96 110 63.5 75.5 88 100 120 140 138 148 165 190 210 236 Front flange style: (F) B FY 4-øFD FX FT (mm) FZ Rear flange style: (G) Bore size (mm) Stroke range B FD FT FX FY FZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 74 78 100 9 9 12 12 16 16 80 100 112 58 61 75 100 125 138 B FY 4-øFD FT FX FZ ZZ + Stroke (mm) 6 Bore size (mm) Stroke range B FD FT FX FY FZ ZZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 74 78 100 9 9 12 12 16 16 80 100 112 58 61 75 100 125 138 190 211 237 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 7 Non-rotating Double Power Cylinder Series MGZ Construction y @0 q o @2 i r t !7 @4 @1 e u !9 !8 @5 @3 w !6 !5 !1 !2 !0 Actuators @6 !3 !4 With coil scraper Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Description Rod cover Head cover Cylinder tube Piston rod Tube rod Tube rod cover Piston Stationary piston Bushing Thrust plate Holder Pin Tie-rod Material Aluminum alloy Aluminum alloy Aluminum alloy Aluminum alloy Carbon steel pipe Carbon steel Aluminum alloy Aluminum alloy Lead bronze casting Lead bronze casting Aluminum alloy Carbon steel Carbon steel Note Clear anodized Clear anodized Hard anodized Hard anodized Hard chrome plated Electroless nickel plated Chromated Chromated Chromated Zinc chromated Corrosion resistant chromated No. 14 15 16 17 18 19 20∗ 21 22 23 24 25∗ 26 Material Description Note Tie-rod nut Nickel plated Carbon steel Hexagon socket head cap screw Chrome molybdenum steel Nickel plated Spring washer Nickel plated Steel wire Bumper Urethane Wear ring Resin Magnet Magnetic material Rod seal A NBR Rod seal B NBR Piston seal NBR Piston gasket NBR Tube rod gasket NBR Cylinder tube gasket NBR Coil scraper Metal Replacement Parts: Seal Kit Bore size (mm) 40 50 63 Kit no. MGZ40-PS MGZ50-PS MGZ63-PS Content A set of above nos. 20 and 25. ∗ Seal kits consist of a set of items 20 and 25, which can be ordered using the seal kit number for each bore size. 7 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 8 MGZ How to Order MGZ With End Lock 40 100 R Y7BW Number of auto switches Mounting Nil L F G S Auto switch type Nil Without auto switch (Built-in magnet cylinder) ∗ Select applicable auto switch models from the table below. ∗ Auto switches are shipped together, (but not assembled). Bore size 40 50 63 2 pcs. 1 pc. Nil Basic style Transaxial foot style Front flange style Rear flange style 40 mm 50 mm 63 mm With front end lock Stroke (mm) Refer to the standard stroke table. Applicable Auto Switches: Direct Mount Type Auto switch model Load voltage Reed switch Type Special function — Electrical entry Wiring (output) Indicator light Grommet DC In-line 0.5 (Nil) 3 (L) 5 (Z) — — Z76 — IC circuit 2-wire 24 V 12 V 100 V — Z73 — Y69A Y59A Y7PV Y7P Yes 2-wire 3-wire (NPN) 24 V 3-wire (PNP) 2-wire Water resistant (2-color indicator) 5 V, 12 V 12 V — 5 V, 12 V 12 V Y69B Y59B Y7NWV Y7NW Y7PWV Y7PW Y7BWV Y7BW — Y7BA — (Example) Y59B Y59BL Y59BZ Note 2) Solid state switches marked with a "" symbol are produced upon receipt of order. Note 3) When later installing auto switches on a cylinder ordered without auto switches, the switch spacers in the table below are necessary. Switch Spacer 40, 50, 63 BMP1-032 Mounting Bracket Part No. Bore size (mm) 8 — Yes Diagnostic indication (2-color indicator) Applicable bore size (mm) Switch spacer Applicable load 5V 3-wire (PNP) Note 1) Lead wire length symbols: 0.5 m ......... Nil 3 m ......... L 5 m ......... Z Perpendicular — — Grommet Lead wire length (m)∗ 3-wire (NPN) 3-wire (NPN) Solid state switch AC Electrical entry direction 40 50 63 Foot MGZ-L04 MGZ-L05 MGZ-L06 Flange MGZ-F04 MGZ-F05 MGZ-F06 Switch spacer Relay, PLC IC circuit — IC circuit — Relay, PLC ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 9 Non-rotating Double Power Cylinder Series MGZ Cylinder Specifications 40 Bore size (mm) Action 50 63 Double acting, Single rod Fluid Air 1.5 MPa Proof pressure Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa Minimum operating pressure 0.2 MPa∗ Without auto switch: –10 to 70°C (with no freezing) Ambient and fluid temperature With auto switch: –10 to 60°C (with no freezing) Lubrication Actuators Non-lube Extending: 50 to 700 mm/s Piston speed Retracting: 50 to 450 mm/s +1.4 to 250 +1.0 0 , 251 to 1000 0 Stroke length tolerance Cushion Rubber bumper Thread tolerance JIS class 2 Port size Rc 1/4 Mounting Basic style, Transaxial foot style, Front flange style, Rear flange style ∗ Except for the lock section, the minimum operating pressure is 0.08 MPa (0.12 MPa for long strokes). Lock Specifications End lock position ø40 1770 Holding force (maximum) N Backlash Manual release Front only ø50 2690 2mm or less Non-locking type ø63 4160 Adjust an auto switch's position so that it operates for movement to both the stroke end and backlash (2 mm) positions. Standard Stroke Bore size (mm) 40, 50, 63 Standard stroke (mm) Long stroke (mm) 75, 100, 125, 150, 175 350, 400, 450, 500, 600 200, 250, 300 700, 800, 900, 1000 Intermediate strokes and strokes of less than 75 mm can also be manufactured. Weight (kg) Bore size (mm) Standard weight Additional weight per 50 mm of stroke Basic style Foot style Flange style All brackets 40 50 63 2.80 3.29 3.24 0.41 4.08 4.97 4.84 0.61 6.13 7.39 7.13 0.80 Theoretical Output Model MGZ40 MGZ50 MGZ63 Bore size (mm) 45 x 40 40 55 x 50 50 68 x 63 63 Rod size Operating Piston area direction (mm) (mm2) OUT 2533 20 IN 942 OUT 3848 25 IN 1473 OUT 5945 32 IN 2313 (N) 0.2 507 188 770 295 1189 463 0.3 760 283 1154 442 1784 694 0.4 1013 377 1539 589 2378 925 Operating pressure (MPa) 0.5 0.6 0.7 1267 1520 1773 471 565 659 1924 2309 2694 737 884 1031 2973 3567 4162 1157 1388 1619 0.8 2026 754 3078 1178 4756 1850 0.9 2280 848 3463 1326 5351 2082 1.0 2533 942 3848 1473 5945 2313 9 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 10 MGZ Construction y@9 qo #1i rt @4 !7 #3 #0 @3 ue@6 !9!8#4$0#9 @5 #2w!6!5 !3 !1 !2 !0 !4 #7@1#5@2 @8@# 7 @ 6 # 0 8 End lock Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 Description Rod cover Head cover Cylinder tube Piston rod Tube rod Tube rod cover Piston Stationary piston Bushing Thrust plate Holder Pin Tie-rod Tie-rod nut Material Note Aluminum alloy Clear anodized Aluminum alloy Clear anodized Aluminum alloy Hard anodized Aluminum alloy Hard anodized Carbon steel pipe Hard chrome plated Carbon steel Electroless nickel plated Aluminum alloy Chromated Aluminum alloy Chromated Lead-bronze casting Lead-bronze casting Aluminum alloy Chromated Carbon steel Zinc chromated Carbon steel Corrosion resistant chromated Carbon steel Nickel plated Hexagon socket head cap screw Chrome molybdenum steel Nickel plated Spring washer Steel wire Nickel plated Bumper Urethane Wear ring Resin Magnet Magnetic material Cap Bronze alloy Electroless nickel plated Replacement Parts: Seal Kit Bore size (mm) Kit no. Content 40 MGZ40R-PS A set of above nos. 29, 34, 35, 36, 50 MGZ50R-PS 37, 38, 39 and 40. 63 MGZ63R-PS ∗ Seal kits consist of a set of items 29 and 34 through 40, which can be ordered using the seal kit number for each bore size. 10 No. 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 ∗ 30 31 32 33 34 ∗ 35 ∗ 36 ∗ 37 ∗ 38 ∗ 39 ∗ 40 ∗ Description Lock holder Lock piston Stopper Collar Port block Pipe Lock spring Rubber cap Rod seal A Rod seal B Piston seal Piston gasket Tube rod gasket Cylinder tube gasket Lock piston seal A Lock piston seal B Lock piston seal C Lock holder gasket Port block gasket Pipe gasket Material Note Stainless steel Quenched, Hard chrome plated Carbon steel Quenched Carbon steel Lead-bronze casting Electroless nickel plated Bronze alloy Bronze alloy Steel wire Synthetic rubber NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 11 Non-rotating Double Power Cylinder Series MGZ Dimensions Basic style DL GA 2-Rc P Y Y WL LM øI øD HR LL 2 x 4-J E MB KA MA MC C NB K B N S + Stroke H ZZ + Stroke (mm) Bore size (mm) Stroke range B C D DL E GA GB H HR I J K KA LL LM 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 59 71 82 46 55 66 45 55 68 58 67 73 21 26 32 34.5 40 46.5 23.5 28 34.5 40 45 50 57.5 63.5 69 78 92 110 M6 x 1.0 M8 x 1.25 M8 x 1.25 25 25 25 36 46 53 30 30 30 30 30 30 Bore size (mm) Stroke range M MA MB MC MM N NB P S XA XL Y WL WM ZZ to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 10 14 14 16 16 16 4 5 5 12 15 15 M6 x 1.0 M8 x 1.25 M8 x 1.25 44 50 56 74 83 89 1/4 1/4 1/4 168 183 204 12 16 16 6 6 6 9.5 12.5 15 42 42 52 39 42 52 208 228 254 40 50 63 11 Actuators øXAH7 depth XL+0.2 0 4-MM depth M WM GB ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 12 MGZ Dimensions: With Mounting Bracket Transaxial foot style: (L) LT LH LY 4-øLD through X/2 X X Y LX LZ LS + Stroke ZZ + Stroke (mm) Bore size (mm) Stroke range X Y LD LH LT LX LY LZ LS ZZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 24 32 36 0 1 3 9 11 13 34 40 47 19 22 24 80 96 110 63.5 75.5 88 100 120 140 168 181 198 220 243 269 Front flange style: (F) FY B 4-øFD FX FZ FT (mm) Rear flange style: (G) Bore size (mm) Stroke range B FD FT FX FY FZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 74 78 100 9 9 12 12 16 16 80 100 112 58 61 75 100 125 138 FY B 4-øFD FX FZ FT ZZ + Stroke (mm) 12 Bore size (mm) Stroke range B FD FT FX FY FZ ZZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 74 78 100 9 9 12 12 16 16 80 100 112 58 61 75 100 125 138 220 244 270 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 13 Double Power Cylinder (Without non-rotating mechanism) Series MGZR ø40, ø50, ø63 Actuator How to Order MGZ R Standard Type 40 100 Y7BW Number of auto switches Without non-rotating mechanism Nil Nil L F G D Auto switch type Basic style Transaxial foot style Front flange style Rear flange style Double clevis style Nil Without auto switch (Built-in magnet cylinder) ∗ For the applicable auto switch model, refer to the table below. ∗ Auto switches are shipped together, (but not assembled). Bore size 40 50 63 2 pcs. 1 pc. Actuators S Mounting 40 mm 50 mm 63 mm Stroke (mm) Refer to “Standard Stroke” on the next page. Solid state switch Reed switch Type Special function Electrical entry Indicator light Applicable Auto Switches Load voltage Wiring (Output) DC AC 3-wire 5V — — Grommet Yes (NPN equiv) 100 V 24 V 12 V 2-wire 3-wire (NPN) 5 V,12 V 3-wire (PNP) — 12 V 2-wire — Grommet Yes 3-wire (NPN) 24 V 5 V,12 V Diagnostic indication 3-wire (PNP) (2-color indication) 12 V 2-wire Improved water resistance — (2-color indication) ∗ Lead wire length symbols: 0.5 m ···············Nil (Example) Y59A 3 m ··············· L (Example) Y59AL 5 m ··············· Z (Example) Y59AZ Auto switch model Lead wire length (m)∗ Pre-wired 0.5 3 5 (Nil) (L) (Z) connector Perpendicular In-line — Z76 — — — Y69A Y7PV Y69B Y7NWV Y7PWV Y7BWV Z73 Y59A Y7P Y59B Y7NW Y7PW Y7BW — — Y7BA — Applicable load IC — circuit — Relay, PLC IC circuit — IC circuit Relay PLC — ∗ Solid state switches marked “” are produced upon receipt of order. • Retrofitting of an auto switch on a clinder that is originally ordered without one requires a switch spacer per the table below. Switch spacer Switch Spacer Applicable bore size (mm) 40, 50, 63 Switch spacer BMP1-032 Mounting Bracket Part No. Bore size(mm) Foot 40 50 63 MGZ-L04 MGZ-L05 MGZ-L06 Flange MGZ-F04 MGZ-F05 MGZ-F06 Double clevis Note 1) MGZ-D04 MGZ-D05 MGZ-D06 Note 1) Double clevis bracket is provided with clevis pins and cotter pins. 13 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 14 MGZR Specifications 40 Bore size (mm) 50 Action 63 Double acting, Single rod Fluid Air Proof pressure 1.5 MPa Max. operating pressure 1.0 MPa Standard stroke: 0.08 MPa Min. operating pressure Long stroke: 0.12 MPa Without auto switch: –10° to 70°C (With no freezing) Ambient and fluid temperature With auto switch: –10° to 60°C (With no freezing) Lubrication Non-lube OUT: 50 to 700 mm/s Piston speed IN: 50 to 450 mm/s +1.4 Up to 250 +1.0 0 , 251 to 1000 0 Stroke length tolerance Cushion Rubber bumper Screw tolerance JIS class 2 Port size Rc 1/4 Mounting Basic style, Transaxial foot style, Front flange style Rear flange style, Double clevis style Standard Stroke Bore sizes (mm) 40, 50, 63 Standard stroke (mm) Long stroke (mm) 75, 100, 125, 150, 175 350, 400, 450, 500, 600 200, 250, 300 700, 800, 900,1000 Intermediate strokes and strokes shorter than 75 mm are also available. Weight (kg) Bore size (mm) Standard weight Weight per each 50 mm of stroke Basic style Foot style Flange style Double clevis style All mounting brackets 40 50 63 1.91 2.39 2.34 2.19 3.03 3.92 3.79 3.47 4.83 6.08 5.83 5.62 0.39 0.59 0.78 Theoretical Output Model MGZR40 MGZR50 MGZR63 14 Bore size (mm) 45 x 40 40 55 x 50 50 68 x 63 63 (N) Rod size Operating Piston area (mm) direction (mm2) 20 25 32 OUT IN OUT IN OUT IN 2533 942 3848 1473 5945 2313 0.2 507 188 770 295 1189 463 0.3 760 283 1154 442 1784 694 0.4 1013 377 1539 589 2378 925 Operating pressure (MPa) 0.7 0.6 0.5 1773 1520 1267 659 565 471 2694 2309 1924 1031 884 737 4162 3567 2973 1619 1388 1157 0.8 2026 754 3078 1178 4756 1850 0.9 2280 848 3463 1326 5351 2082 1.0 2533 942 3848 1473 5945 2313 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 15 Double Power Cylinder (Without non-rotating mechanism) Series MGZR Dimensions Basic style GA 2-Rc P Y GB Y Actuators MM depth M øD øI 2 x 4-J MB KA MC C K B MA N N S + Stroke H ZZ + Stroke (mm) Bore size (mm) Stroke range 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 B C 59 71 82 46 55 66 D KA GA GB H I J K M 45 55 68 36 46 53 34.5 23.5 40 28 46.5 34.5 40 45 50 78 92 110 M6 x 1.0 M8 x 1.25 M8 x 1.25 25 25 25 30 35 35 MA MB MC 16 16 16 4 5 5 12 15 15 MM N P M16 x 2 M20 x 2.5 M20 x 2.5 44 50 56 1/4 1/4 1/4 S Y ZZ 138 9.5 178 150 12.5 195 171 15 221 15 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 16 MGZR Dimensions: With Mounting Bracket Transaxial foot style: (L) LH LT LY 4-øLD through X 2 X X Y LX LS + Stroke ZZ + Stroke LZ (mm) Bore size (mm) Stroke range X Y LD LH LT LX LY LZ LS ZZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 24 32 36 0 1 3 9 11 13 34 40 47 19 22 24 80 96 110 63.5 75.5 88 100 120 140 138 148 165 190 210 236 B FY Front flange style: (F) FT (mm) 4-øFD FX FZ Bore size (mm) Stroke range B FD FT FX FY FZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 74 78 100 9 9 12 12 16 16 80 100 112 58 61 75 100 125 138 B FY Rear flange style: (G) FT ZZ + Stroke 4-øFD (mm) FX FZ Bore size (mm) Stroke range B FD FT FX FY FZ ZZ 40 50 63 to 1000 to 1000 to 1000 74 78 100 9 9 12 12 16 16 80 100 112 58 61 75 100 125 138 190 211 237 Double clevis style: (D) ∗ Clevis pins and cotter pins are included. U øCDH10 L Z + Stroke ZZ + Stroke 16 CX CZ RR (mm) Bore size (mm) Stroke range L RR U 40 50 63 to 600 to 700 to 900 30 42 42 15 18 23 17 26 26 CDH10 CX+0.3 +0.1 CZ Z ZZ 14 22 22 20 30 30 40 60 60 208 237 263 223 255 286 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 17 Double Power Cylinder (Without non-rotating mechanism) MGZR Series Double Clevis Bracket Z + Stroke B DX DB øDD DH B 4-øDT Bore size (mm) Model MB-B05 B 40 50 63 MB-B08 DA 59 71 82 DB 53 73 73 DC 60 86 86 43 64 64 DL DA DS 4-øDR DU Actuators DU DO DO DC DE DDH10 DE DH DL DO DR DS DT DU DX Z +0.070 0 +0.084 0 +0.084 0 81 111 111 45 65 65 30 45 45 10.5 12.5 12.5 9 11 11 8 10 10 18 22 22 11.5 14 14 20 30 30 208 237 263 A° Bˆ 14 22 22 90 ° B° Rotation A° Bore size (mm) 40 50, 63 30 35 50 50 A°+B°+90° 170 175 Clevis Pin øDd9 2-ød l m L d Model Bore size (mm) Dd9 L l m CD-M05 CD-M08 40 50, 63 14–0.050 –0.093 22–0.065 –0.117 60 82 51 72 4.5 5 (Drill Cotter pin Note) through) 4 4 ø4 x 25 ø4 x 35 l l Note) When using cotter pins, flat washers are used together. ø Floating Joint (mm) Applicable bore size Model 40 50, 63 JB80-16-200 JB100-20-250 M Nominal size 16 20 B C 2 80.5 16 21 2.5 101 20 26 Pitch A D E 50 9.5 59.5 11.5 F G H 19 24 16 20 32 41 Max. Allowable Max. operating tension and compression N screw-in eccentricity Compression Tension depth P U 18 1.25 18000 5000 24 2 28000 7900 Weight (kg) 0.56 1.04 17 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 18 MGZR Construction: MGZR y !6 q o !8 i r t !4 @0 !7 e u @2 !5 @1 !9 w !3 !2 !0 !1 Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Description Rod cover Head cover Cylinder tube Piston rod Tube rod Tube rod cover Piston Stationary piston Bushing Tie-rod Tie-rod nut Material Note Aluminum alloy Clear anodized Aluminum alloy Clear anodized Aluminum alloy Hard anodized Aluminum alloy Hard anodized Carbon steel Hard chromium electroplated Carbon steel Electroless nickel plated Aluminum alloy Chromated Aluminum alloy Chromated Lead bronze casted Carbon steel Corrosion resistant chromated Carbon steel Nickel plated Replacement Parts: Seal Kit Bore size (mm) 40 50 63 Kit no. MGZ40-PS MGZ50-PS MGZ63-PS Contents Items 16 and 21 from the above chart ∗ Seal kits consist of items 16 and 21, and can be ordered by using the seal kit number corresponding to each bore size. 18 No. 12 13 14 15 16∗ 17 18 19 20∗ 21 22 Description Hexagon socket head screw Spring washer Bumper Wear ring Rod seal A Rod seal B Piston seal Piston gasket Tube rod gasket Cylinder tube gasket Magnet Material Chrome molybdenum steel Steel wire Urethane rubber Resin NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR NBR Magnet Note Nickel plated Nickel plated ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 19 Guide Table Series MGF Actuator ø40, ø63, ø100 Compact type with reduced height. A large bore guide cylinder with superior eccentric load resistance and low profile. Dramatically reduced Actuators mounting height The compact design of the cylinder makes it possile to reduce the overall size of equipment. Mounting height 15 to 20% reduction (compared to SMC series MGQ) Built-in non-rotating mechanism Internal guide pin prevents the top plate from rotating. With T-slots T-slots are provided on three sides (except the port side), allow mounting of various brackets, etc. (The slots cannot be used for securing the cylinder body.) Non-rotating accuracy Bore size (mm) 40 63 100 Non-rotating accuracy θ ±0.08° ±0.06° ±0.05° Series Variations Model Bore size (mm) MGF 40 40 MGF 63 63 MGF100 100 Standard stroke (mm) 30 50 75 100 Auto switches Reed switches: D-Z7/Z8 Solid state switches: D-Y5/Y6/Y7 2-color indication solid state switch: D-Y7 Water resistant 2-color indication solid state switch: D-Y7BA 19 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 20 MGZR How to Order MGF 63 30 Z73 Guide table Number of auto switches Nil 2 pcs. S 1 pc. Auto switch type Nil Without auto switch ∗ Refer to the table below for auto switch models. Cylinder bore size/Standard stroke (mm) 40 30, 50, 75, 100 63 30, 50, 75, 100 100 30, 50, 75, 100 Applicable Auto Switches Special function Reed switch Type Electrical entry Indicator light Load voltage Wiring (output) DC 3-wire — 2-wire 24 V AC Lead wire length (m)∗ 0.5 (Nil) 3 (L) 5 (Z) Applicable load 5V — — Z76 — IC circuit 12 V 100 V — Z73 — 5V 12 V 100 V or less — Z80 — IC circuit Y69A Y59A Y7PV Y7P Y69B Y59B Y7NWV Y7NW Y7PWV Y7PW Y7BWV Y7BW — Y7BAL — Yes — Grommet No 3-wire (NPN) Solid state switch 5V 12 V 3-wire (PNP) — 2-wire Grommet Yes Diagnostic indication (2-color indicator) 12 V 3-wire (NPN) 24 V — 5V 12 V 3-wire (PNP) 12 V 2-wire Water resistant (2-color indicator) ∗ Lead wire length symbols 0.5 m .......... Nil 3 m ............. LY 5 m ............. ZY Action Fluid Double acting Air 1.5 MPa Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa Minimum operating pressure 0.1 MPa Operating piston speed Cushion Lubrication Stroke length tolerance IC circuit — IC circuit Relay, PLC PLC: Programmable Logic Controller Standard Stroke Proof pressure Ambient and fluid temperature Relay, PLC — (Example) Y59A Y59AL Y59AZ Specifications 20 Auto switch model Lead wire entry direction Perpendicular In-line –10 to 60°C 20 to 200 mm/s Rubber bumper on both ends Non-lube +1.0 0 mm Model Standard stroke (mm) MGF 40 MGF 63 MGF100 30, 50, 75, 100 Intermediate stroke A spacer with a width of 5, 10, 15, 20 or 25 mm is installed to manufacture intermediate strokes (5 mm increments) other than standard strokes. Example) For MGF63 with 15 mm stroke A spacer of 15 mm width is installed inside MGF63 with a 30 mm stroke. Therefore, the overall length will be the same as the model with a 30 mm stroke. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 21 Air Consumption Reduction System PFC/QFC Valves Actuator Model Effective area (mm2) Description PFC valve QFC valve Model Port size ASR100 ASR300 ASR500 ASR600 ASQ100 ASQ300 ASQ500 ASQ600 Regulated flow Free flow Weight g 2.4 –– 97 1/4, 3/8 14.5 –– 220 1/2, 3/4 52.0 –– 580 3/4, 1 80.0 –– 950 1/8 2.4 5.4 97 1/4, 3/8 14.5 22.0 220 1/2, 3/4 52.0 68.0 580 3/4, 1 80.0 106.0 950 1/8 Specifications Air Fluid 0.7 MPa Maximum operating pressure PFC valve Ambient and fluid temperature 0 to 60°C Set pressure PFC valve 0.2 to 0.5 MPa QFC valve 0.1 to 0.5 MPa How to Order ASR 100 –– 01 B Product type ASR ASQ QFC valve Accessory Nil B PFC valve QFC valve Patent pending 1/8 3/8 3/4 1 Thread type Nil N F Symbol PFC valve Port size Body size 100 300 500 600 Without bracket With bracket Rc NPT G 01 02 03 04 06 10 Port size 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 Applicable series ASR100, ASQ100 ASR300, ASQ300 ASR300, ASQ300 ASR500, ASQ500 ASR500, 600, ASQ500, 600 ASR600, ASQ600 QFC valve 21 Actuators PFC valve: A control valve with pressure adjustment and cylinder speed control functions QFC valve: A control valve with quick exhaust and cylinder speed control functions ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 22 PFC/QFC valves System Circuit 25% reduction of air consumption Work stroke It is not necessary to supply high pressure to both the extension and retraction sides of a piston. On the nonworking side, it is sufficient to supply just enough pressure (0.2 MPa) for the piston to operate smoothly within the set time. A reduction system using PFC and QFC valves reduces air consumption by 25%, which translates into reduced running cost and dramatic reduction of equipment cost. Return stroke QFC valve PFC valve Effect of Reduction Rod side set pressure: 0.2 MPa 500 200 3 ø6 ø5 0 400 0 ø10 0 ø8 Bo re siz e Cylinder stroke (mm) 600 100 0 2,000 3 6 8,000 6,000 10,000 12,000 Air consumption reduction [m3/year (ANR) (Nm3/year)] 9 12 21 24 15 18 27 30 33 36 39 Annual air consumption cost reduction (Thousand yen) 16,000 14,000 42 45 48 Conditions — Cylinder operating frequency: 10 cycles/min Operating time: 8 hrs/day Number of operating days: 250 days/year Cylinder pressure: Head side pressure of 0.5 MPa Pressure and Time Line Charts Return stroke Work stroke Time difference of cylinder at stop Time 22 Pressure Stroke Pressure Stroke During the work stroke, the cylinder moves quickly from A to B due to the difference between the head side pressure (PH) and rod side pressure (PR). Cylinder speed is then controlled by a PFC valve from B to C. Therefore, the cylinder speed remains the same for a shorter length of time than it did previously. D a g sin tu en e v em al ov ol v lve r m tr n va de co FC lin ed aQ Cy e ing sp us nt me ve mo A PH PR PH PR er lind Cy tC en PH m e ov g PR er m d sin lin tue y n C e lv em va ov trol B m r on de c lin eed y C sp a PR E PH F Time To prevent time lag, air is quickly exhausted from D to E, after which the piston moves at a constant speed. When a speed controller is used instead of a QFC valve, the time required for exhaust becomes longer as shown by the D to F line of the head side pressure (PH). This causes a longer stopping time for the cylinder and time loss. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 23 Air Saving Valves Series ASR/ASQ Actuator Cuts air consumption by operating the return stroke at a reduced pressure. Conventional Valve Working and return strokes operated at the same pressure Air Saving Valve Return stroke operated at a reduced pressure Working stroke Working stroke Return stroke Return stroke Actuators Flow valve Pressure valve Working stroke Return stroke Pressure Valve Regulator with check valve + Speed controller Series ASR Flow Valve Quick supply and exhaust valve + Speed controller (Meter-in, Meter-out) Series ASQ 23 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 24 Smooth operation of working and return strokes possible. Consistent speed control achieved by preventing jerky movement of working strokes. Improved response time Operation delay in a return stroke is reduced by the use of a quick supply and exhaust valve. Cylinder operation by conventional 2 pressure control Cylinder operation by air saving valve Cylinder operation by speed controller Delay in return operation Return stroke pressure 0.1 MPa 1.4 Pressure valve 1.2 Flow valve Delay time (sec) 0.2 MPa 1.0 0.3 MPa 0.8 0.6 0.1 MPa 0.4 0.2 MPa 0.3 MPa 0.5 MPa 0.2 0.0 40 50 63 80 Cylinder bore size (mm) Quick supply and exhaust valve Working stroke Return stroke Cylinder operating pressure (MPa) Air consumption Working stroke Return stroke reduction ratio (%) 0.5 100 0 17 25 33 0.5 0.3 0.2 0.1 Cylinder speed: 200 mm/sec Cylinder stroke: 200 mm Easy piping The set pressure can be either fixed or variable. The body and one-touch fitting allow 360° rotation. The sealant on the male thread is standardized. Fixed set pressure type Variable set pressure type (Fixed at 0.2 MPa) (Variable between 0.1 and 0.3 MPa) Graduated knob 2 3 Body Pressure valve One-touch fittings Flow valve Pressure valve Flow valve A knob cap is attached to the variable set pressure type. Other applications Jerk prevention in vertical operation of the cylinder Quick air charge at the end of stroke for press applications Model Pressure valve Flow valve Balancing pressure Pressure valve Flow valve Speed controller 24 Series Variations Speed controller ASR430F-02 ASR530F-02 ASR530F-03 ASR630F-03 ASR630F-04 ASQ430F-02 ASQ530F-02 ASQ530F-03 ASQ630F-03 ASQ630F-04 Port size R 1/4 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 3/8 R 1/2 Applicable tubing O.D. (mm) 6 8 10 12 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 25 Air Saving Valves Pressure Valve Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ How to Order Pressure valve: Series ASR ASR 4 3 0 F 02 06 S F20 With seal Model ASR Pressure valve ASQ Flow valve Body size 1/4 standard 4 5 6 3/8 standard Nil F20 Fixed set pressure type (0.2 MPa) 1/2 standard Applicable tubing O.D. 6 mm 06 08 10 12 Type 3 Universal With One-touch fitting 8 mm 10 mm 12 mm Port size R 1/4 02 03 04 R 3/8 R 1/2 Flow valve: Series ASQ Model Model Pilot valve and two-way flow control valve integrated into a single construction Pressure valve Flow valve ASR430F-02 ASR530F-02 ASR530F-03 ASR630F-03 ASR630F-04 ASQ430F-02 ASQ530F-02 ASQ530F-03 ASQ630F-03 ASQ630F-04 Port size Applicable tubing O.D. (mm) 6 8 10 12 R 1/4 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 3/8 R 1/2 Specifications Proof pressure 1.5 MPa Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa Set pressure Variable range Fixed (option) 0.1 to 0.3 MPa Ambient and fluid temperature 0.2 MPa –5 to 60°C (with no freezing) Number of needle rotations 10 rotations Applicable tubing material Nylon, Soft nylon, Polyurethane 25 Actuators Regulator with check valve and flow control valve integrated into a single construction Option Variable set pressure type (0.1 to 0.3 MPa) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Pressure Valve Page 26 Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Effective Area Pressure Valve: Series ASR Flow Valve: Series ASQ Controlled flow (mm2) 5.9 6.7 6.7 8.1 11.8 13.3 13.7 8.1 11.8 13.3 13.7 17.8 19.1 17.8 19.1 Free flow (mm2) 5.4 5.9 5.9 7.3 8.9 9.2 9.5 7.3 8.9 9.2 9.5 15.3 16.0 15.3 16.0 Type ASR430F-02-06S(-F20) ASR430F-02-08S(-F20) ASR430F-02-10S(-F20) ASR530F-02-06S(-F20) ASR530F-02-08S(-F20) ASR530F-02-10S(-F20) ASR530F-02-12S(-F20) ASR530F-03-06S(-F20) ASR530F-03-08S(-F20) ASR530F-03-10S(-F20) ASR530F-03-12S(-F20) ASR630F-03-10S(-F20) ASR630F-03-12S(-F20) ASR630F-04-10S(-F20) ASR630F-04-12S(-F20) Type ASQ430F-02-06S(-F20) ASQ430F-02-08S(-F20) ASQ430F-02-10S(-F20) ASQ530F-02-06S(-F20) ASQ530F-02-08S(-F20) ASQ530F-02-10S(-F20) ASQ530F-02-12S(-F20) ASQ530F-03-06S(-F20) ASQ530F-03-08S(-F20) ASQ530F-03-10S(-F20) ASQ530F-03-12S(-F20) ASQ630F-03-10S(-F20) ASQ630F-03-12S(-F20) ASQ630F-04-10S(-F20) ASQ630F-04-12S(-F20) Meter-in (mm2) 4.9 5.5 5.5 7.8 10.1 10.8 11.6 7.8 10.1 10.8 11.6 17.1 18.0 17.1 18.0 Meter-out (mm2) 4.1 4.6 4.6 6.6 9.2 9.8 10.8 6.6 9.2 9.8 10.8 15.3 16.2 15.3 16.2 Operating Principle PH B D C A PH PR PR Pressure, Stroke C m ylind ov e em r en t Return Stroke y tb en em lve ov l va r m ro t de n t lin co en Cy eed em sp ov r m ve de al lin w v Cy flo by Pressure, Stroke Working Stroke PH PR E PR F PH Time Time 1. The cylinder starts smoothly because jerks are prevented by meter-in control. Jerk prevention 3. To prevent delay due to the pressure gap, air is rapidly exhausted to decrease the pressure from D to E, after which the piston moves at a constant speed. If a speed controller is used instead of the flow valve, exhausting air will take more time as illustrated by line D-F, resulting in longer stop time of the cylinder and a consequent time loss. Quick exhaust Working stroke Return stroke 2. When the cylinder reaches the stroke end, the quick air charge by the flow valve rapidly increases the rear side pressure (PH) from A to B. If a speed controller is used instead of the flow valve, charging air will take more time as illustrated by line AC, causing delay in the pressure rise. Quick supply 26 4. The cylinder operates at a low pressure required for a return. Low pressure operation ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 27 Air Saving Valves Pressure Valve Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Flow Characteristics Pressure Valve: Series ASR (Inlet pressure: 0.5 MPa) 200 2 100 0 4 0 5 10 Number of needle rotations 8 500 10 5 Number of needle rotations 20 1000 15 10 500 5 0 Effective area (mm2) 4 12 Flow rate l/min (ANR) 300 ASR630F Effective area (mm2) 6 Effective area (mm2) 400 Flow rate l/min (ANR) ASR530F 5 10 Number of needle rotations Flow Valve: Series ASQ Meter-out Type (Inlet pressure: 0.3 MPa) 100 0 2 300 100 0 5 10 Number of needle rotations 5 200 10 5 Number of needle rotations 20 15 500 10 5 0 Effective area (mm2) 4 10 400 Flow rate l/min (ANR) 200 ASQ630F Effective area (mm2) 6 Flow rate l/min (ANR) ASQ530F Effective area (mm2) Flow rate l/min (ANR) ASQ430F 5 10 Number of needle rotations Meter-in Type (Inlet pressure: 0.5 MPa) 4 200 2 100 0 5 10 Number of needle rotations 8 500 4 0 20 1000 10 5 Number of needle rotations 15 10 500 5 0 Effective area (mm2) 300 12 Flow rate l/min (ANR) 6 ASQ630F Effective area (mm2) 400 Flow rate l/min (ANR) ASQ530F Effective area (mm2) Flow rate l/min (ANR) ASQ430F 5 10 Number of needle rotations Pressure Characteristics (ASR) ASR430F/530F ASR630F 0.4 0.4 Set pressure 0.3 MPa 0.3 0.3 Set pressure 0.2 MPa 0.2 Set pressure 0.1 MPa 0.1 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 P1: Inlet pressure P2: Outlet pressure P2: Outlet pressure Set pressure 0.3 MPa Set pressure 0.2 MPa 0.2 Set pressure 0.1 MPa 0.1 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 P1: Inlet pressure 27 Actuators Flow rate l/min (ANR) ASR430F ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Pressure Valve Page 28 Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Selection and Adjustment Install a flow valve on the working side which requires the cylinder output and a pressure valve on the return side. The product cannot be used in cases where the same pressure is necessary for both working and return strokes. In such cases use a speed controller. Horizontal mounting Low pressure side: Pressure valve High pressure side: Flow valve Low pressure side Pressure valve Series ASR High pressure side Flow valve Series ASQ Working stroke Refer to Adjustment Procedure 1 for pressure and speed adjustment. Return stroke Vertical mounting Working stroke Return stroke Low pressure side: Pressure valve High pressure side: Flow valve Pressure valve Low pressure side Series ASR In case the load ratio is 50% or lower at the set pressure of the flow valve: Refer to Adjustment Procedure 1 for pressure and speed adjustment. Flow valve Series High pressure side ASQ If the load ratio at the set pressure of the flow valve exceeds 50%, install a dual speed controller (meter-in and meter out control) on the high pressure side. Working stroke Return stroke Low pressure side: Pressure valve High pressure side: Dual speed controller Pressure valve Low pressure side Series ASR Refer to Adjustment Procedure 2 Dual speed controller (Meter-in • Meter-out) Series ASQ 28 High pressure side for pressure and speed adjustment. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 29 Air Saving Valves Pressure Valve Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Adjustment Procedure 1 Speed Control 1. The fixed set pressure type (-F20) does not require adjustment because the pressure is fixed at 0.2 MPa for both the pressure valve and the flow valve. 2. The set pressures of the variable set pressure type pressure valve and flow valve are adjusted with knob A and knob B respectively. Turn the knob clockwise to increase the pressure and counterclockwise to decrease the pressure. 3. The graduations 1, 2 and 3 correspond to 0.1, 0.2 and 0.3 MPa respectively. Align the bottom end of the knob with the graduated line for adjustment. 1. The cylinder speed is adjusted with knobs C , D and E . First have all the knobs fully closed and then open them gradually for adjustment. Turn the knob clockwise to close (decrease the speed of the piston rod) and counterclockwise to open (increase the speed of the piston rod). 2. Speed adjustment for the working stroke The speed is adjusted with the pressure valve and the flow valve. Open knobs C and E gradually until the required speed is achieved. Make sure that knobs C and E are opened by the same number of rotations. Note 1) If the piston rod jerks, close knob E until the smooth operation is achieved. 3. Speed adjustment for return stroke The speed is adjusted with the flow valve. Open knob D gradually until the required speed is achieved. 4. Be sure to tighten the lock nut after adjustment. Knob Align the bottom end of the knob with the graduated line. The figure illustrates the case in which the pressure is set at 0.2 MPa. 2 3 4. Set the same pressure for the pressure valve and the flow valve (0.2 MPa as the recommended value). 5. The inlet side should be supplied with a pressure which is higher than the set pressure by 0.1 MPa or more. 6. Cap the valve after adjustment. Pressure Valve: Series ASR Flow Valve: Series ASQ Knob B Knob C Knob D Knob A E Knob Adjustment Procedure 2 Pressure Adjustment Speed Control 1. The fixed set pressure type (-F20) does not require adjustment because the pressure is fixed at 0.2 MPa. 2. The pressure at the low pressure side (return stroke side) is adjusted by the pressure valve. 3. The set pressure is adjusted with knob A . Turn the knob clockwise to increase the pressure and counterclockwise to decrease the pressure. 4. The graduations 1, 2 and 3 correspond to 0.1, 0.2 and 0.3 MPa respectively. Align the bottom end of the knob with the graduated line for adjustment. 5. Keep the set pressure as low as possible in order to achieve good air saving effect. 6. Cap the valve after adjustment. 1. The cylinder speed is adjusted with knobs C , F and G . First have all the knobs fully closed and then open them gradually for adjustment. Turn the knob clockwise to close (decrease the speed of the pistoin rod) and counterclockwise to open (increase the speed of the piston rod). 2. Speed adjustment for the working stroke The speed is adjusted with the pressure valve and the dual speed controller. Open knobs C and G gradually until the required speed is achieved. Make sure that knobs C and G are opened by the same number of rotations. Note 1) If the piston rod jerks, close knob G until the smooth operation is achieved. 3. Speed adjustment for return stroke The speed is adjusted with the dual speed controller. Open knob F gradually until the required speed is achieved. 4. Be sure to tighten the lock nut after adjustment. Pressure Valve: Series ASR Dual Speed Controller: Series ASD Knob Knob F C Knob Knob G A 29 Actuators Pressure Adjustment ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Pressure Valve Page 30 Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Construction Pressure Valve: Series ASR Variable type @1 @2 @5 @4 @3 ASR430F-02 type ASR530F-03 type ASR630F-04 type u Fixed type @2 @5 @4 @3 ASR430F-02 type ASR530F-03 type ASR630F-04 type o !3 u o !3 !8 !8 !9 !7 !9 !7 w w q @0 e q @0 !4 ASR530F-02 type ASR630F-03 type @1 !8 e i y !0 !1 !2 u ASR530F-02 type ASR630F-03 type o !3 !7 !7 !9 !9 t t q @0 q @0 r r !4 !8 i !5 !6 u o !3 !4 i !5 !6 !4 i y !0 !1 !2 Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 30 Description Material Note Body A PBT Body B Brass Electroless nickel plated Seat ring Brass Electroless nickel plated Body B1 Brass Electroless nickel plated Body B2 Brass Electroless nickel plated Body C Brass Electroless nickel plated Stopper Stainless steel Valve HNBR/Brass Piston Brass Adjustment screw Brass Electroless nickel plated Knob Brass Electroless nickel plated Polypropylene Cap Steel wire Adjustment spring Zinc chromated No. 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 Description Material Note U seal HNBR Body C Brass Electroless nickel plated Adjustment plug Brass Electroless nickel plated Needle Brass Electroless nickel plated Knob PBT Lock nut Note 1) Steel U seal HNBR Elbow body Spacer Note 2) Cassette Electroless nickel plated PBT PBT Stainless steel/POM Seal NBR Drive body Note 3) Brass Electroless nickel plated Note 1) Brass is used for the material ASR530F and ASR630F. Note 2) Not used for ø6 and ø8. Note 3) Not used for ø10 and ø12. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 31 Air Saving Valves Pressure Valve Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Flow Valve: Series ASQ Variable type @2 @3 @6 @5 Fixed type @4 !7 !6 !8 w q @0 e @4 Actuators i u y !5 !2 !4 !1 ASQ430F-02 type ASQ530F-03 type ASQ630F-04 type @2 @3 @6 @5 ASQ430F-02 type ASQ530F-03 type ASQ630F-04 type o !5 !3 !7 !4 !1 !6 !8 w q @0 e @1 !0 !9 !6 !7 @1 !0 !9 !6 !7 i ASQ530F-02 type ASQ630F-03 type ASQ530F-02 type ASQ630F-03 type u y !5 !7 !7 !2 !4 !1 !8 !6 t q @0 r y !5 !3 !4 !1 !8 !6 t q @0 r @1 !0 !9 !6 !7 @1 !0 !9 !6 !7 Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Description Material Note Body A PBT Body B Brass Electroless nickel plated Seat ring Brass Electroless nickel plated Body B1 Brass Electroless nickel plated Body B2 Brass Electroless nickel plated Adjustment screw Brass Electroless nickel plated Knob Brass Electroless nickel plated Cap Polypropylene Adjustment plug Brass Electroless nickel plated Body C Brass Electroless nickel plated Body D1 Brass Electroless nickel plated Body D2 Body D3 Brass Brass Electroless nickel plated Electroless nickel plated No. 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 Description Piston valve Adjustment spring Needle Material Note HNBR/Brass Steel wire Zinc chromated Brass Electroless nickel plated Knob PBT Lock nut Note 1) Steel Electroless nickel plated Lock nut Note 1) Steel Black zinc chromated U seal HNBR U seal HNBR Elbow body Spacer Note 2) Cassette Seal Drive body Note 3) PBT PBT Stainless steel/POM NBR Brass Electroless nickel plated Note 1) Brass is used for the material ASQ530F and ASQ630F. Note 2) Not used for ø6 and ø8. Note 3) Not used for ø10 and ø12. 31 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 32 Series Pressure Valve ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Dimensions Pressure Valve: Series ASR Variable set pressure type Fixed set pressure type (-F20) L1 L1 L2 d L2 d M øD1 øD1 M øD øD L6 2 L6 2 L3 L4 A1 A2 L5 A1 A2 L5 øD3 H (Width across flats) øD3 H (Width across flats) T Model ASR430F-02-06S,-F20 ASR430F-02-08S,-F20 ASR430F-02-10S,-F20 ASR530F-02-06S,-F20 ASR530F-02-08S,-F20 ASR530F-02-10S,-F20 ASR530F-02-12S,-F20 ASR530F-03-06S,-F20 ASR530F-03-08S,-F20 ASR530F-03-10S,-F20 ASR530F-03-12S,-F20 ASR630F-03-10S,-F20 ASR630F-03-12S,-F20 ASR630F-04-10S,-F20 ASR630F-04-12S,-F20 Note 1) Note 2) Note 3) Note 4) Note 5) 32 Note 1) H D1 D2 D3 17 18.5 20 21.5 L5 L4 MAX. MIN. Note 2) Note 3) 57.7 34.9 58.7 35.9 10 53.8 31 21 105 82 6 62.9 36.5 17 150 127 63.9 37.5 18.5 153 130 59 32.6 21 143 120 60.8 34.4 22 146 122 62.9 36.5 17 160 137 63.9 37.5 18.5 163 140 59 32.6 21 153 130 6 8 R 1/4 8 10 R 1/4 21 18.5 24.3 25.3 20.9 12 6 8 10 R 3/8 21 18.5 24.3 25.3 A2 M Weight (g) Note 5) ∗1 ∗2 L2 L3 L6 A1 MAX. MIN. L1 d T T 17 63.7 67.3 67.3 45.6 49.2 49.2 50.6 55.8 57.4 45.6 50.8 52.4 23 25.9 25.9 44.6 49.8 51 39.6 44.8 46 16.8 18.5 18.8 20 111 89 114 93 12 20.9 60.8 34.4 22 156 133 10 18.5 62.8 32.6 21 237 219 64.6 34.4 22 239 221 62.8 32.6 21 257 239 64.6 34.4 22 259 239 12 10 12 R 3/8 R1/2 25 25 20.9 18.5 20.9 29.7 29.7 30 30 86.3 86.3 65.5 65.5 67.6 71.1 “d” indicates the applicable tubing O.D. L3 is the dimension for the variable set pressure type. L4 is the dimension for the fixed set pressure type. A1 and A2 are reference dimensions after installation. ∗1 is the weight for the variable set pressure type and ∗2 is that for the fixed set pressure type. 60.1 63.6 27.7 27.7 61.2 62.9 53.7 55.4 20.6 24.1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 33 Air Saving Valves Pressure Valve Series ASR / Flow Valve Series ASQ Flow Valve: Series ASQ Variable set pressure type Fixed set pressure type L1 L1 L2 d L2 M d M øD L8 2 L8 2 Actuators øD L3 L3 L4 L4 H H (Width across flats) (Width across flats) øD4 øD1 A2 T Model ASQ430F-02-06S,-F20 ASQ430F-02-08S,-F20 ASQ430F-02-10S,-F20 ASQ530F-02-06S,-F20 ASQ530F-02-08S,-F20 ASQ530F-02-10S,-F20 ASQ530F-02-12S,-F20 ASQ530F-03-06S,-F20 ASQ530F-03-08S,-F20 ASQ530F-03-10S,-F20 ASQ530F-03-12S,-F20 ASQ630F-03-10S,-F20 ASQ630F-03-12S,-F20 ASQ630F-04-10S,-F20 ASQ630F-04-12S,-F20 Note 1) Note 2) Note 3) Note 4) Note 5) øD3 A1 L7 øD3 øD1 A1 A2 L7 L6 L5 øD4 Note 1) d T T H D1 D2 D3 D4 6 18.5 20 6 R 1/4 21 12 18.5 24.3 24.8 20.4 20.9 6 8 10 L3 L4 L7 A1 Note 4) Note 4) Note 2) Note3) L8 M MAX. MIN. L5 L6 MAX. MIN. MAX. MIN. A2 R 3/8 21 18.5 17 21.5 19.5 62.6 35.9 20.3 49.4 44.4 10 10 L2 61.6 34.9 8 R 1/4 17 8 L1 24.3 24.8 20.4 88.8 68.7 50.6 45.6 23 Weight (g) Note 5) ∗1 ∗2 136 114 44.6 39.6 17.9 18.5 139 117 57.7 31 21 130 108 65.6 36.5 17 178 155 66.6 37.5 18.5 181 158 61.7 32.6 23.4 53.5 48.5 92.2 72 55.8 50.8 25.6 49.8 44.8 19 21 172 149 63.5 34.4 22 174 151 65.6 36.5 17 188 165 66.6 37.5 18.5 191 168 61.7 32.6 23.4 53.5 48.5 93.8 73.6 57.4 52.4 25.6 51 46 20.2 21 182 159 12 20.9 63.5 34.4 22 184 161 10 18.5 74.8 32.6 21 310 292 22 312 294 21 330 312 22 332 314 12 10 12 R 3/8 25 R 1/2 25 20.9 18.5 20.9 29.7 30.7 30 29.7 30.7 30 76.6 34.4 74.8 32.6 76.6 34.4 30.8 74.3 66.8 107.9 86.9 67.6 60.1 28 30.8 74.3 66.8 111.4 90.4 71.1 63.6 28 61.2 53.7 20.8 62.9 55.4 24.1 “d” indicates the applicable tubing O.D.. L5 is the dimension for the variable set pressure type. L6 is the dimension for the fixed set pressure type. A1 and A2 are reference dimensions after installation. ∗1 is the weight for the variable set pressure type and ∗2 is that for the fixed set pressure type. 33 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 34 Hollow Rod Cylinders Made to Order (Rod Through Hole Type) Air Blow A hollow rod for vacuum piping is utilized for air flow. The nozzle position can be moved. Nozzle Air Cylinder: CM2W-XC38 Specifications Model Pneumatic type Cylinder bore size (mm) ø20, ø25, ø32, ø40 Action Double acting, Double rod Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa Minimum operating pressure 0.08 MPa Cushion Rubber bumper (standard) Mounting Basic style, Axial foot style, Flange style, Trunnion style Auto switch Specifications are the same as series CM2W. ød Specifications other than above Capable HA + Stroke ZZ + 2 x Stroke Bore size (mm) d J HA ZZ 20 25 32 40 3 M5 x 0.8 32 135 3 M5 x 0.8 32 139 3 M5 x 0.8 32 141 4 Rc 1/8 36 174 Precision Cylinder: MTS8-XC38 Bore size (mm) Port direction Rod end configuration 8 Standard type, Top ported type Female thread Dimensions 7 + Stroke 60 + 2 x Stroke 34 ø1 ø4 Use ø4 or ø2.5 urethane tubing (TU0425), or soft nylon tubing (TS0425). ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 35 Free Mount Cylinder for Vacuum Series ZCUK Air Blow How to Order Basic Type ZCUK C 16 20 D With Auto Switch ZC D UK C 16 20 D M9B S Action D –– Double acting Auto switch type Nil Bore size 10 –– 10 mm 16 –– 16 mm 20 –– 20 mm 25 –– 25 mm 32 –– 32 mm Without auto switch ∗ Select applicable auto switch models from the table below. ∗ Auto switches are shipped together (but not assembled). Port thread type Bore size Symbol Type ø10, ø16, ø20, ø25 M5 x 0.8 Nil ø32 Rc 1/8 ø32 NPT 1/8 TN ø32 TF Note) G 1/8 Standard stroke (mm) 10, 16 ––––– 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30 20, 25, 32 –– 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40, 50 Note) In the case of rod piping (Q, R), TF (G 1/8) is not available. Grommet — Diagnostic indication 2 color indicator Note 1) Lead wire length symbols Piping type Grommet Yes Solid state switch No — Electrical entry Yes Special function Reed switch Type Indicator light Applicable Auto Switches Load voltage Wiring (output) Auto switch model AC DC Perpendicular In-line — 5V — A96V A96 — — 2-wire 24 V 12 V 5 V, 12 V 100 V A93V A90V M9NV M9PV M9BV F9NWV F9PWV F9BWV A93 A90 M9N M9P M9B F9NW F9PW F9BW — — — 100 V or less — — IC circuit 3-wire (NPN) 5 V, 12 V 3-wire (PNP) 2-wire 12 V 24 V 3-wire (NPN) 5 V, 12 V 3-wire (PNP) 2-wire 12 V 0.5 m .......... Nil 3 m ............. L 5 m ............. Z — (Example) M9N (Example) M9NL (Example) M9NZ Free mount cylinder for vacuum IC circuit — Relay, PLC IC circuit — IC circuit Relay, PLC — Note 2) Solid state switches marked with a "" symbol are produced upon receipt of order. Rod end configuration Applicable pad type For detailed specifications, refer to the next page. Male thread Vacuum Series ZPT ZCUKD Cap piping Applicable load 3-wire (NPN equiv.) ZCUKC Cap piping Lead wire length (m) Note 1) Pre-wired 0.5 3 5 conector (Nil) (L) (Z) Direct pad mount Vacuum (Perpendicular vacuum entry female thread) Vacuum ZCUKQ Rod piping Male thread Vacuum Series ZP (With pad single unit lock ring) ZCUKR Rod piping Vacuum Vacuum Direct pad mount 35 Actuators Number of auto switches Nil –– 2 pcs. S ––– 1 pc. Built-in magnet Type (Vacuum side piping)/(Rod end configuration) C –– Cap piping/Male thread D –– Cap piping/Direct pad mount Q –– Rod piping/Male thread R –– Rod piping/Direct pad mount ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 36 Water Resistant Air Cylinders Series CM2 Series CG1 ø20 to ø40 How to Order Air Leakage ø32 to ø100 How to Order CDM2 Mounting Bore size Port thread type R Stroke H7BAL -XC6 CDG1 Mounting Type Bore size Port thread type R Stroke H7BAL -XC6 With auto switch (Built-in magnet) With auto switch (Built-in magnet) Water resistant cylinder Water resistant cylinder R Seal, NBR (Nitrile rubber) V Seal, FKM (Fluoro rubber) R Seal, NBR (Nitrile rubber) V Seal, FKM (Fluoro rubber) Water resistant 2-color indication solid state switch Water resistant 2-color indication solid state switch H7BAL ø32 to ø63 G5BAL ø80, ø100 Made to order specification Made to order specification Specifications Double acting, Single rod Action Caution ø32, ø40, ø50, ø63, ø80, ø100 Cylinder bore size (mm) Rod seal and scraper is not replaceable. • Scraper is press-fit into the rod cover, thus cannot be replaced. Rubber bumper, Air cushion Cushion Band mount type Auto switch mounting Stainless steel piston rod and rod end nut (-XC6) Made to order Specifications Note) Specifications other than above are the same as the standard basic type. ø20, ø25, ø32, ø40 Rubber cushion GA Rubber bumper Cushion Auto switch mounting Band mount type (øE1) Stainless steel piston rod and rod end nut (-XC6) Note) Specifications other than above are the same as the standard basic type. (F1) TA ZZ + Stroke NN2 WA 0 (øE1) øE1h8 (mm) 20 E1 0 22 –0.033 E2∗ 0 20 –0.033 NN1 M22 x 1.5 GA Air cushion øE2h8 NN1 Bore size (mm) F S + Stroke Dimensions øE–0.05 Made to order Dimensions 0 Cylinder bore size (mm) Double acting, Single rod øE-0.05 Action NN2∗ M20 x 1.5 Note) Dimensions other than the above are the same as the standard double acting single rod type. [An asterisk (∗) indicates those that are the same as standard.] Please contact SMC for part numbers of the foot, the flange and the mounting nut for ø20. (F1) TA S + Stroke F ZZ + Stroke (mm) Bore size (mm) (E1) 32 40 50 63 80 100 17 21 26 26 32 37 E∗ 18 25 30 32 40 50 (F1) 2 2 2 2 3 3 F∗ 2 2 2 2 3 3 S GA 77 (85) 18 84 (93) 19 97 (109) 21 97 (109) 21 28 116 (130) 29 117 (131) TA WA ZZ 17 22 119 (127) 18 22 136 (145) 20 25 157 (169) 20 25 157 (169) 30 190 (204) — 31 191 (205) — Note 1) Dimensions other than the above are the same as the standard double acting single rod type. [An asterisk (∗) indicates those that are the same as standard.] Note 2) Dimensions inside ( ) are for long strokes. 36 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 37 Water Resistant Air Cylinders Compact Cylinder Series CQ2 ø20 to ø100 How to Order Specifications Stroke D Option Double acting, Single rod Action F9BAL -XC6 ø20, ø25, ø32, ø40, ø50, ø60, ø80, ø100 Cylinder bore size (mm) With auto switch (Built-in magnet) Mounting ø20 to ø32 ... B (Through-hole only) ø40 to ø100 ... B (Through-hole) F (Front flange style) A (Both end tapped) G (Rear flange style) L (Foot style) D (Double clevis style) Cushion None Water resistant cylinder R Seal, NBR (Nitrile rubber) V Seal, FKM (Fluoro rubber) Water resistant 2-color indication solid state switch F7BA(V)L ø20 to ø100 F9BAL ø32 to ø100 Auto switch mounting Rail mount type (D-F7BAL, F7BAVL)/Direct mount type (D-F9BAL) Made to order Stainless steel snap ring, piston rod and rod end nut (-XC6) Note) Specifications other than the above are the same as the standard basic type. Made to order specification Dimensions 2-øN through 232-øO counter bore 2-øN through 232-øO counter bore (same on the bottom side) (same on the bottom side) (same on the bottom side) Q Q øT 2-øN through 232-øO counter bore ø20, ø25 ø20, ø25 (without switch) (with switch) ø32 L1 L1 L A + Stroke (same on the bottom side) (same on the bottom side) Rod end male thread Rod end male thread H H Rod end nut ø40, ø50 ø63 to ø100 C X L2 Bore size (mm) 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100 50 75, 100 50 75, 100 stroke — — stroke or less stroke — — 39(51) 42.5(52.5) 45(55) 46.5(56.5) 48.5(58.5) 54(64) 63.5(73.5) 75(85) 55 56.5 58.5 64 73.5 85 29.5(41.5) 32.5(42.5) 33(43) 29.5(39.5)∗ 30.5(40.5)∗ 36(46)∗ 43.5(53.5)∗ 53(63)∗ 43 39.5∗ 40.5∗ 46∗ 53.5∗ 63∗ G1 L∗ L1 N∗ O∗ L3 L2 ø20 to ø32 B stroke or less C X Rod end nut L3 (mm) A G1 B + Stroke L A + Stroke 4-øN through 234-øO counter bore 4-øN through 234-øO counter bore B + Stroke Q — 9.5 4.5 5.5 9 depth 7 19(20.5) 5.5 9 depth 7 5 21 — 10 6.5 5.5 9 depth 7 20.5Note) — 12 5.5 9 depth 7 7 5 17 11∗ 6.6 11 depth 8 10.5∗ 8 5 18 9 14 depth 10.5 15∗ 8 5 18 5 20 10 11 17.5 depth 13.5 16∗ 5 22 12 11 17.5 depth 13.5 23∗ Th9 — — — 28 35 35 43 59 Note 1) Dimensions other than above are the same as the standard double acting single rod type. [An asterisk (∗) indicates those that are the same as standard.] Note 2) Dimensions inside ( ) are for cylinders with auto switch. Note 3) For a cylinder with ø32 bore size and 5 mm stroke, without switch, dimension Q will be 21.5. Note 4) The dimensions with a mounting bracket for ø40 to ø100 are the same as above dimensions. (No dimensional changes in L1 and L2 dimensions.) ø40 to ø100 With Rod End Male Thread Bore size (mm) C 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100 12 15 20.5 20.5 26 26 32.5 32.5 X H L (mm) L1 M831.25 23.5 4.5 14 17.5 M1031.25 27.5 5 23.5 M1431.5 33.5 5 23.5 M1431.5 38.5 5 28.5 M1831.5 43.5 5 28.5 M1831.5 43.5 5 35.5 M2231.5 53.5 8 35.5 M2631.5 53.5 8 37 Actuators CDQ2 Mounting Bore size Port thread type R ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 38 Water Resistant Air Cylinders Compact Guide Cylinder Series CA2 Series MGP ø40 to ø100 How to Order CDA2 Mounting How to Order Type Bore size Port thread type R Stroke Suffix Y7BAL -XC6 MGPM Bore size Port thread type R Water resistant cylinder R Seal, NBR (Nitrile rubber) V Seal, FKM (Fluoro rubber) Water resistant 2-color indication solid state switch Made to order specification Specifications Action Double acting, Single rod Cylinder bore size (mm) ø40, ø50, ø63, ø80, ø100 Made to order Y7BAL Water resistant cylinder R Seal, NBR (Nitrile rubber) V Seal, FKM (Fluoro rubber) Auto switch mounting Stroke Slide bearing With auto switch (Built-in magnet) Cushion ø20 to ø100 Air cushion Tie-rod mount style Stainless steel piston rod and rod end nut (-XC6) ∗ Specifications other than above are the same as the standard basic type. Note 1) Air-hydro type, rod boot specifications of the CA2 series are excluded. Note 2) Combination of auto switches and steel tube is not available. Dimensions Water resistant 2-color indication solid state switch ∗ The piston rod and guide rod are made of stainless steel. ∗ Stainless steel piston rods are available as a special order. Specifications Action Double acting Bearing type Slide bearing Cylinder bore size (mm) Cushion MGPMR MGPMV Auto switch mounting ø20, ø25, ø32, ø40, ø50, ø63, ø80, ø100 Rubber bumper Without cushion Direct mount type Dimensions ∗ Dimensions are the same as the standard double acting single rod type. FB B + Stroke A + Stroke (mm) Bore size (mm) 20 25 32 40 50 63 80 100 (A) A 50 50 stroke or more 200 B stroke or less 200 stroke or less stroke or more 66 66 97.5 135 67.5 67.5 99 136 71.5 109 114 152 78 109 114 152 83 117.5 129 172 88 117.5 129 172 102.5 121 148 199 120 141 166 207 FB 19 20 22 22 23 23 24 29 ∗ Dimensions other than above are the same as the standard double acting single rod type. 38 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 39 Water Resistant Air Cylinders Guide Cylinder Series MGG ø32 to ø100 How to Order Stroke Actuators MGGM Mounting Bore size Port thread type R H7BAL -XC6 Slide bearing Water resistant cylinder R Seal, NBR (Nitrile rubber) V Seal, FKM (Fluoro rubber) Water resistant 2-color indication solid state switch H7BAL ø32 to ø63 G5BAL ø80, ø100 Made to order specification Specifications Action Double acting Cylinder bore size (mm) ø32, ø40, ø50, ø63, ø80, ø100 Bearing type Slide bearing Cushion Rubber bumper, Built-in shock absorber Auto switch mounting Band mount type -XC6 Made to order specification Stainless steel piston rod and rod end nut -XC6A Stainless steel used on all standard iron parts -XC6B Stainless steel rod end moving parts -XC6C Stainless steel rod parts ∗ Specifications other than the above are the same as the standard basic type. Note 1) RBL (coolant resistant) shock absorbers are used. Dimensions ø32 to ø50 ø63 to ø100 Front mounting flange style Front mounting flange style Q Q X Y + Stroke X Y + Stroke (mm) Bore size (mm) 32 40 50 63 80 100 Q 25 29 31 34 46 47 X 39 46 57 56 68 68 Y 86 (94) 96 (105) 109 (121) 112 (124) 137 (151) 138 (152) ∗ Dimensions inside ( ) are for long strokes. ∗ Dimensions other than the above are the same as the standard basic type. 39 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 40 Air Cylinder with Heavy Duty Scraper Made to Order Air Leakage Symbol -XC4 With heavy duty scraper CM2 Mounting Bore size Stroke Cushion CB XC4 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 (With rear lock only) CG1 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 CQ2 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 CA2 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 CV Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 CS1 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 MGG Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 MB XC4 MGC Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC4 Follow the standard ordering procedures. With heavy duty scraper With heavy duty scraper The heavy duty scraper feature is ideal for cylinders used in a dusty environment, or in environments where there is contact with earth and sand, such as molding machines, construction equipment, and industrial vehicles, etc. Specifications Applicable cylinder Air cylinder/Standard type Series End lock cylinder (with rear lock only) Cylinder with valve Compact cylinder CM2 CG1 MB CA2 CS1 CB CV CQ2 MGG MGC CM2, CM2W CG1 MB, MBW CA2, CA2W CS1, CS1W CBM2, CBA1 CV3, CVM5, CVS1 CQ2 MGG MGC Double acting, Single rod Double acting, Single rod, Double rod (Not applicable for CG1) Action Bore size (mm) 20, 25, 32, 40 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 32, 40, 50, 63 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 Wiper ring Cushion Double acting 125, 140, 160, 180, 20, 25, 32, 40, 20, 25, 32, 40, 20, 25, 32, 40, 200, 250, 300 50, 63, 80, 100 50, 63, 80, 100 50, 63, 80, 100 32, 40, 50 SCB scraper Rubber bumper Air cushion Rubber bumper Air cushion CBM2: CVM5: Rubber bumper Rubber bumper CBA1: CV3, CVS1: Air cushion Air cushion Air cushion None Rubber bumper Rubber bumper Air cushion (base cylinder (base cylinder unit) unit) Mountable (Bores sizes 200mm or less.) Auto switch Specifications and dimensions other than above Guide cylinder Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type except dimension K has been changed. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Refer to Best Pneumatics 2004 catalog Vol. 6/7/8/10 for the pages listed in the table above for details. Caution Do not replace the heavy duty scraper. • Since the heavy duty scraper is press fit, replace the rod cover assembly instead of the cover only. (In the case of the CM2 series, it cannot be replaced.) (For the CS1 series, replace the retaining plate assembly.) M MGP L Bore size Stroke XC4 With heavy duty scraper Scraper specification Nil W 40 Single side scraper Double side scraper Specifications Applicable series Bearing type Cylinder bore size (mm) Single side Minimum operating pressure Double side MGPM, MGPL Slide bearing, Ball bushing 20, 25, 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 0.12 MPa 0.14 MPa ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 41 Air Cylinder with Coil Scraper Air Leakage Made to Order Symbol With coil scraper Mounting CM2 -XC35 Bore size Stroke XC35 MB Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC35 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC35 CA2 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC35 CG1 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC35 CS1 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC35 CBA1 Follow the standard ordering procedures. XC35 With coil scraper Removes frost, welding spatter, and machining chips from the piston rod, and protects the seals. With coil scraper Specifications Applicable series Air cylinder/Series CM2 Air cylinder/Series CG1 Compact air cylinder/Series CQ2 Air cylinder/Series CA2 Action Double acting, Single rod Double acting, Single rod Double acting, Single rod Double acting, Single rod, Double rod Applicable bore size (mm) 20, 25, 32, 40 20, 25, 32, 40, 50, 63 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa 1.0 MPa 1.0 MPa 1.0 MPa Minimum operating pressure Cushion 0.05 MPa 0.05 MPa 0.05 MPa Single rod: 0.05 MPa, Double rod: 0.08 MPa Rubber bumper Rubber bumper, Air cushion None, Rubber bumper Air cushion Scraper Coil scraper (Metal) Auto switch Mountable Mounting Basic, Axial foot, Front flange, Rear flange, Single clevis, Double clevis, Front trunnion, Rear trunnion, Integral clevis, Boss cut Basic, Axial foot, Front flange, Rear flange, Front trunnion, Rear trunnion, Clevis (used when the port location is moved 90°) Specifications other than above Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Basic, Foot, Front flange, Rear flange, Single clevis, Double clevis, Center trunnion Through holes, Double end tapped Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications are the same as the standard type. Refer to Best Pneumatics 2004 catalog Vol. 6/7 for the pages listed in the table above. Specifications Applicable series Air cylinder/Series MB Air cylinder/Series CS1 End lock cylinder/Series CBA2 Double acting, Single rod Double acting, Single rod, Double rod Double acting, Single rod 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 125, 140, 160, 180, 200, 250, 300 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa 0.97 MPa 1.0 MPa Minimum operating pressure 0.05 MPa 0.05 MPa 0.15 MPa Air cushion Air cushion Action Applicable bore size (mm) Cushion Air cushion, Rubber bumper Coil scraper (Metal) Scraper Capable (Bores sizes 200mm or less.) Auto switch Basic, Foot, Front flange, Rear flange, Single clevis, Double clevis, Shaft type trunnion Mounting Specifications other than above Specifications are the same as the standard type. Refer to Best Pneumatics 2004 catalog Vol. 6 for the pages listed in the table above. Basic, Foot, Front flange, Rear flange, Single clevis, Double clevis, Center trunnion (For double rod, only Basic, Foot, Front flange, Center trunnion are available.) Specifications are the same as the standard type. Basic, Foot, Front flange, Single clevis, Double clevis, Center trunnion Specifications are the same as the standard type. Specifications Applicable series MGPM Bore size Stroke XC35 With coil scraper Scraper specification Nil W Single side scraper Double side scraper Bearing type Cylinder bore size (mm) Single side Minimum operating pressure Double side MGPM Slide bearing 20, 25, 32, 40, 50, 63, 80, 100 0.12 MPa 0.14 MPa 41 Actuators CQ2 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 42 Air-hydro Booster Made to Order Hydraulic Clamp Converts air pressure to hydraulic pressure for high pressure hydraulic cylinder actuation. CA1B H63 50 1 XB4 Type of pressurization Mounting B Basic style L Axial foot style G Rear flange style Nil Pressurized when energized B Not pressurized when energized Electrical entry Oil discharge volume 25 25 cm3 40 40 cm3 50 50 cm3 75 75 cm3 100 100 cm3 Nil Molded type D DIN terminal Voltage 1 2 5 9 100 VAC 200 VAC 24 VDC Other Oil pot specification JIS symbol Nil Without oil pot P With oil pot Specifications Operating fluid Compressed air Driving fluid ISO VG32 Operating pressure (air) 0.3 to 0.7 MPa Withstand pressure (air) 1.6 MPa Ambient and fluid temperature 5 to 60°C Intensified pressure ratio Specifications other than -XB4 are available by special order. Select according to the usage. (Refer to the following two pages for the list of special order products.) 1:6 110 cm3 Reservoir capacity (oil pot capacity) Dimensions CA1BH63(XB4)/Basic style 30.4 View A (Oil port position) 30° Supply port O.D. ø6 tubing 12 2-Rc 1/8 Exhaust port Oil supply plug ø73 90 ≈161 15 12 ≈ 153 77 ø50 Rc 1/4 Oil port 13 Rc 1/4 Oil port 6.5 11 42.5 40 View A 4-M8 x 1.25 Thread depth 15 18 18 L S 10 22 11 H Z Amount of Stroke range (mm) oil discharge 25 40 50 75 100 42 64 98 115 170 220 S 163 197 214 269 319 L H Z 143 37 200 177 62 270 194 80 305 249 135 415 299 185 515 4-M10 x 1.25 4-M8 x 1.25 2 60 85 18 L S Z H For oil discharge volume of 25 cm3 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 43 Air-hydro Booster Special Order Product CQ2L100-P2866-60 Intensified pressure ratio 1 : 12.8 Oil discharge volume: 60 cm3 243 65.5 71 2-Rc 3/8 23 (air port) ≈154 Actuators Air release Rc 1/2 18 162 137 65 (oil port) 23 Air release 4-ø13 72 117 6 35 77 42.5 23 209 112 1 7 380 CS1LH160-Q5731-160 Intensified pressure ratio 1 : 16 Oil discharge volume: 160 cm3 ø73 4-M16 x 1.5 2-Rc 3/4 18.5 15 140 ≈211 12 18.5 197 Rc 1 9 106 4-Long hole View A 8.5 8.5 10.5 243 25 50 39 39 283 383 144 50 25 R9 611.5 182 R9 .5 .5 19 54 72 118 View A CS1LH200-Q3496-130 Intensified pressure ratio 1 : 25 Oil discharge volume: 131 cm3 18.5 4-M20 x 1.5 2-Rc 3/4 18.5 4-M12 x 1.5 132 ≈272.5 245 Rc 1/2 10 4-ø24 63 85 150 182 226 30 14 60 39 229 39 60 30 241 361 574 43 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 44 Air-hydro Booster Special Order Product CS1LH200-Q8405-350 Intensified pressure ratio 1 : 44 Oil discharge volume: 350 cm3 4-M12 x 1.5 4-M20 x 1.5 98.5 Rc 11/4 (oil supply port) 2-Rc 3/4 18.5 18.5 31.5 11/4 245 Rc (discharge port) 10 132 4-ø24 63 85 150 182 226 30 14 646 60 39 39 60 30 656 776 1406 For dimensions and other information etc., of special order products in the table on the right, contact SMC. Intensified pressure range CDS1BH140-Q5902 1 to 9.9 10 to 19.9 20 to 29.9 30 or more 44 Part no. Intensified Oil discharge pressure ratio volume (cm3) CA1LH63-Q0717-25 1 : 1.96 1:6 CA1LH63-Q5857-40 CA1LH63-Q7045-100 1000 Note Without tank 25 With tank, Foot style 1:6 40 With tank, Foot style 1:6 100 With tank, Foot style CA1BH63-Q5856-125 CA1BH140-Q7055-200 1:6 1:6 125 200 Without tank, Basic style Without tank, Basic style CDS1LH160-K5457-100 CQ2LH100-P6978-160 1:6 1 : 9.76 315 160 Without tank, Foot style Without tank, Foot style HC03-80-Q4602-25 1 : 10 25 With tank, Foot style CA1LH63-Q7886-50 TMS80-A2484-178 1 : 10 1 : 10 50 87 With tank, Foot style With tank, Foot style CA1LH63-Q8409-100 1 : 10 100 With tank, Foot style CS1LN160-Q3930-147 CA1BH100-Q5896-60 CDQ2LH140-P6024-90 1 : 10 1 : 11 1 : 12.25 147 60 90 Without tank, Foot style Without tank, Basic style Without tank, Foot style CDQ2LH140-P4578-180 1 : 12.25 180 Without tank, Foot style CS1LN160-Q3931-57 1 : 16 57 Without tank, Foot style CQ2LH100-P6517-64 1 : 16 64 Without tank, Foot style CQ2L100-P0987-238 CQ2L160-P3270-150 1 : 16 1 : 16 100 150 With tank, Foot style Without tank, Foot style CDS1L160-01-27928 1 : 16 160 Without tank, Foot style CDQ2L140-P1009-116 1 : 21.7 116 Without tank, Foot style CS1LH200-Q3495-77 1 : 25 77 With tank, Foot style CS1L200-Q3932-151 1 : 25 151 Without tank, Foot style CS1LH200-Q64100-165 1 : 25 165 Without tank, Foot style CS1LH200-Q6411-325 CS1LH300-L9421-180 1 : 25 1 : 25 325 420 Without tank, Foot style Without tank, Foot style CS1FH160-K4133-175 1 : 28 CS1LH300-Q1382-250 CS1LH160-Q6528-80 1 : 29 1 : 32.7 99 With tank, Flange type 250 80 With tank, Foot style With tank, Foot style ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 45 Air-hydro Converter Series CCT Hydraulic Clamp How to Order CCT 63 100 Effective oil level stroke (mm) Air-hydro converter Actuators Nominal converter size/Stroke (mm) 63 100 160 50, 100, 200, 300, 400, 500 100, 200, 300, 400, 500, 600 200, 300, 400, 500, 600, 700, 800 Specifications 0 to 0.7 MPa Operating pressure 1.05 MPa Proof pressure 5 to 50°C Ambient and fluid temperature Turbine oil (40 to 100 cSt) Fluid Converter Standard Effective Oil Level Stroke/Effective Volume (cm3) Nominal size of converter (mm) 63 100 160 600 700 800 Maximum flow∗ (l/min) 1480 — — — 36 3770 4520 — — 9150 10980 12810 14640 Standard effective oil level stroke (mm) 50 100 200 300 400 500 150 300 — 750 600 890 1190 1510 2260 3010 — — 3660 5490 7320 88 217 ∗ Maximum flow indicates the converter oil speed (0.2m/s) limit, which can maintain converter oil level stability, expressed as a flow rate. CCT40 – Effective oil level stroke CCT40 cannot be used as an air-hydro unit since it is a converter for small capacity actuators. Use an individual CC valve unit or a speed controller (AS2000, AS3000 or AS4000, etc.) through a piping connection instead. Specifications 0 to 0.7 MPa Operating pressure 1.05 MPa Proof pressure 5 to 50°C Ambient and fluid temperature Turbine oil (40 to 100 cSt ) Fluid 40 mm Nominal size of converter Converter Standard Effective Oil Level Sroke/Effective Volume Standard effective oil level stroke (mm) 50 100 150 200 300 Effective volume (cm3) 60 120 180 250 370 Maximum flow (l/min) 15 ∗ Maximum flow indicates the converter oil speed (0.2m/s) limit, which can maintain converter oil level stability, expressed as a flow rate. 45 ECOPS.qxd 46 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 46 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 47 Directional Control Equipment Application VXD21/22/23 VCA VQ20/30 Air blow, Air tool, Non-operation Air blow, Air tool 48 51 53 VXZ Cooling water 55 VXA21/22 VP300/500/700 VG342 VP3145/3165/3185 VM1000 VM100/200/400 VNC (Special order product) VBA1110 to 4200 Air purge 57 58 60 62 64 68 70 71 Air blow, Air tool Air purge, Paint stirring Air purge, Non-operation Air purge, Non-operation Air purge Coolant Paint stirring Hydraulic clamp Page 47 Directional Control Equipment Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Direct operated 2 port solenoid valve Pilot operated 2 port solenoid valve Zero differential pressure operated 2 port solenoid valve Direct air operated 2 port valve Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Pilot operated 3 port solenoid valve Large 3 port solenoid valve 3 port mechanical valve Coolant valve Flow switching 2 port air operated valve Booster valve Series ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 48 Pilot Operated 2 Port Solenoid Valve For air, gas, water, oil The updated individual catalog (CAT.ES70-29A) will be available shortly. Non-operation Air Blow Series VXD21/22/23 Normally Closed (N.C.) Air Tool Models/Valve specifications Flow coefficient Connection Orifice Effective Thread Flange (ømm) Cv area (mm2) 14 — — 38 — — 12 — 34 — 1 — — 32A — 40A — 50A 10 10 15 10 15 20 25 35 40 50 1.9 2.4 4.5 2.4 5.5 9.5 12.5 23 31 49 34 43 80 43 100 170 225 415 560 880 Model VXD2130-02 VXD2130-03 VXD2140-03 VXD2130-04 VXD2140-04 VXD2150-06 VXD2260-10 VXD2270-32 VXD2380-40 VXD2390-50 Min. operating pressure differential (MPa) 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.02 0.03 0.03 0.03 Max. Max. operating pressure differential (MPa) system Weight∗ Water Air Oil pressure (g) AC DC AC DC AC DC 0.7 0.7 1.0 0.7 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.5 0.5 1.0 0.5 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.9 0.9 1.0 0.9 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.7 0.7 1.0 0.7 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.5 0.5 0.7 0.5 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.4 0.4 0.7 0.4 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 (MPa) 1.5 420 420 670 500 670 1150 1650 5400 6800 8400 ∗ Weight for grommet type. Add 10 g for conduit type, 30 g for DIN terminal type, and 60 g for terminal type. Solenoid specifications Symbol Model OUT VXD21 Power supply AC DC IN VXD22 AC DC VXD23 AC DC Frequency (Hz) 50 60 — 50 60 — 50 60 — Apparent power (VA) Power consumption Temperature increase (°C) (W) (energized) (rated voltage) Inrush Energized 4.5 45 20 (32) 11 3.2 35 17 (28) 7 6 55 — — 7.5 60 40 18 6 50 35 12 8 60 — — 11 65 50 21 9.5 60 45 17 11.5 65 — — Note 1) Reset voltage is 20% or more of rated voltage for AC, and 2% or more of rated voltage for DC. Note 2) Allowable voltage fluctuation is ±10% of rated value for both AC and DC. Note 3) The values are for ambient temperature of 20°C ±5°C and rated voltage. Note 4) For VXD2130, AC to DC or DC to AC coil exchange is not possible due to different armature configuration. For VXD21540, 22760, 23980, AC to DC coil exchange is possible, but not DC to AC exchange. (DC will generate humming sound since it does not have a shading coil.) Note 5) Values for apparent power inside ( ) are for VXD2130. Normally Open (N.O.) Models/Valve specifications Min. operating Max. operating pressure Max. pressure system Weight∗ differential (MPa) pressure differential (g) (MPa) Water, Air Oil (MPa) 0.6 0.02 0.7 — 15 4.5 80 VXD2142-03 690 0.02 0.6 0.7 — 15 5.5 100 VXD2142-04 690 0.02 0.6 0.7 — 20 9.5 170 VXD2152-06 1170 0.02 0.6 0.7 — 25 12.5 225 VXD2262-10 1.5 1690 0.03 0.6 0.7 32A 35 23 415 VXD2272-32 5400 0.03 0.6 0.7 40A 560 40 31 VXD2382-40 6800 0.03 0.6 0.7 50A 50 49 880 VXD2392-50 8400 ∗ Weight for grommet type. Add 10 g for conduit type, 30 g for DIN terminal type, and 60 g for terminal type. Flow coefficient Orifice Effective area Thread Flange (ømm) Cv (mm2) Connection 38 12 34 1 — — — Model Solenoid specifications Symbol Model OUT VXD21 Power supply AC DC IN VXD22 AC DC VXD23 AC DC Frequency (Hz) 50 60 — 50 60 — 50 60 — Apparent power (VA) Power consumption Temperature increase (°C) (rated voltage) (W) (energized) Inrush Energized 5 50 25 12 3.5 35 20 8 6 50 — — 8 55 45 20 6.5 45 40 15 8 50 — — 10.5 60 60 25 9.5 50 50 20 11.5 55 — — Note 1) The values are for ambient temperature of 20°C ±5°C and rated voltage. Note 2) When in operation, AC to DC or DC to AC exchange is not possible due to different armature configuration. Note 3) Reset voltage is 20% or more of rated voltage for AC, and 5% or more of rated voltage for DC. Note 4) Allowable voltage fluctuation is ±10% of rated value for both AC and DC. 48 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 49 Pilot Operated 2 Port Solenoid Valve Series VXD21/22/23 The updated individual catalog (CAT.ES70-29A) will be available shortly. How to Order (Normally Closed) VXD21 VXD22 VXD23 0 Bracket Nil –––– None B ––––– With bracket Thread connection for 02 to 10 is possible. Type of actuation/Body type 0 ––– Normally closed/Single Connection Thread Flange 32 ––– For 32A 40 ––– For 40A 50 ––– For 50A Electrical entry G –– Grommet C –– Conduit D –– DIN terminal T –– Conduit terminal ∗ Refer to “Table 2” below for applicability. Solenoid valve option Nil ––– Standard specification 02 ––– 1/4 03 ––– 3/8 04 ––– 1/2 06 ––– 3/4 10 ––– 1 ∗ Refer to “Table 2” below for applicability. Thread type Nil –– Rc T ––– NPTF F ––– G N ––– NPT Rated voltage 1 –– 100VAC, 50/60Hz 2 –– 200VAC, 50/60Hz 3 –– 110VAC, 50/60Hz 4 –– 220VAC, 50/60Hz 5 –– 24VDC 6 –– 12VDC 7 –– 240VAC, 50/60Hz 8 –– 48VAC, 50/60Hz 9 –– Other (Consult with SMC) ∗ Refer to “Table 2” below for applicability. ∗ Refer to “Table 1” below for applicability. Table 1. Connection size/Applicable models Connection Thread Flange Size 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 32A 40A 50A Applicable model VXD2130-02 VXD2130-03, VXD2140-03 VXD2130-04, VXD2140-04 VXD2150-06 VXD2260-10 VXD2270-32 VXD2380-40 VXD2390-50 Table 2. Rated voltage/Electrical entry/Electrical options Insulation classification Electrical entry Electrical option 1 (100V) 2 (200V) 3 (110V) AC 4 (220V) 7 (240V) 8 (48V) 5 (24V) DC 6 (12V) G S Class B C D, T — S L, Z — — — G, C — — — — Class H T S L, Z — — — — — — Note) Surge voltage suppressor is attached to the lead wire. How to Order (example) For series VXD21, Rc 3/4, 200VAC, DIN terminal, with surge voltage suppressor (Model number) VXD2150-06-2DS Made to Order Specification to JIS-C-0920 Splash Proof Specification ( Conforming Conforming to IEC529IP-X4 ) VXD Type – Bore size – Electrical specification -X36 DIN terminal and class H coil are not available. 49 Directional Control Equipment Body size 10A 3 15A 4 20A 5 25A 6 32A 7 40A 8 50A 9 Electrical option Nil –– None S ––– With surge voltage suppressor L ––– With indicator light Z ––– With surge voltage suppressor/indicator light ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 50 VXD21/22/23 The updated individual catalog (CAT.ES70-29A) will be available shortly. How to Order (Normally Open) VXD21 VXD22 VXD23 2 Bracket Nil ––– None B –––– With bracket Thread connection for 03 to 10 is possible. Electrical option Nil –– None S ––– With surge voltage suppressor L ––– With indicator light Z ––– With surge voltage suppressor/ indicator light Body size 4 ––– 15A 5 ––– 20A 6 ––– 25A 7 ––– 32A 8 ––– 40A 9 ––– 50A ∗ Refer to “Table 2” below for applicability. Electrical entry G ––– Grommet C ––– Conduit D ––– DIN terminal T ––– Conduit terminal Type of actuation/Body type 2 –– Normally open/Single ∗ Refer to “Table 2” below for applicability. Solenoid valve option Nil –– Standard specification Rated voltage 1 ––– 100VAC, 50/60Hz 2 ––– 200VAC, 50/60Hz 3 ––– 110VAC, 50/60Hz 4 ––– 220VAC, 50/60Hz 5 ––– 24VDC 6 ––– 12VDC 7 ––– 240VAC, 50/60Hz 8 ––– 48VAC, 50/60Hz 9 ––– Other (Consult with SMC) Connection Thread 03 –– 3/8 04 –– 1/2 06 –– 3/4 10 –– 1 Flange 32 –– For 32A 40 –– For 40A 50 –– For 50A ∗ Refer to “Table 2” below for applicability. ∗ Refer to “Table 1” below for applicability. Table 1. Connection size/Applicable models Connection Thread Flange Size 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 32A 40A 50A Applicable model VXD2142-03 VXD2142-04 VXD2152-06 VXD2262-10 VXD2272-32 VXD2382-40 VXD2392-50 Thread type Nil –– Rc T ––– NPTF F ––– G N ––– NPT Table 2. Rated voltage/Electrical entry/Electrical options Insulation classification Electrical entry G S Note) Electrical option 1 (100V) 2 (200V) 3 (110V) AC 4 (220V) 7 (240V) 8 (48V) 5 (24V) DC 6 (12V) Class B C D, T — S L, Z — — — G, C — — — — Class H T S L, Z — — — — — — Note) Surge voltage suppressor is attached to the lead wire. How to Order (example) For series VXD21, Rc 1/2, 200VAC, DIN terminal, with surge voltage suppressor (Model number) VXD2142-04-1TZ Made to Order Specification to JIS-C-0920 Splash Proof Specification ( Conforming Conforming to IEC529IP-X4 ) VXD Type – Bore size – Electrical specification -X36 DIN terminal and class H coil are not available. 50 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 51 Direct Operated 2 Port Solenoid Valve for Air Air Blow Series VCA Air Tool How to Order Valves (Single Type) VC A 2 1 1 G 3 02 For air Option Series 2 3 4 Nil Class 2 Class 3 Class 4 F None Foot type bracket ∗ When only brackets are required, refer to “Table 2” below. Type of actuation Rc G NPT NPTF Nil F N T 1 IN(1) Port size Fluid Nil A Symbol General air Dry air 02 03 04 06 Class 3 — — Class 2 — — — Port size 1/4 (8 A) 3/8 (10 A) 1/2 (15 A) 3/4 (20 A) Voltage 1 2 3 4 5 6 100 VAC 200 VAC 110 VAC 220 VAC 24 VDC 12 VDC Electrical entry Class 4 — Orifice size ∗ Consult with SMC regarding other voltages. G – Grommet Directional Control Equipment Thread type (single type) N.C. OUT(2) Symbol Orifice size (mmø) 3 4 5 7 10 3 4 5 7 10 Class 2 — — — Class 3 — — — Class 4 — — ∗ Refer to the table below for orifice and port size combinations. Manual override C – Conduit Nil B None Slotted locking type Table 1. Orifice and port size combinations T – With conduit terminal TL– With conduit terminal and light D – DIN DL – DIN with light DO – DIN (without connector) Orifice size (mmø) Class Port size 3 4 5 7 10 2 1/4 ( 8A) — — — 1/4 ( 8A) — — — 3/8 (10A) — — — 3/8 (10A) — — 1/2 (15A) — — 3/4 (20A) — — — — 3 4 Table 2. Bracket assembly part nos. Valve model Connector VCA21 VCA31 VCA41 Bracket assembly part no. VCA20-12-1A VCA30-12-1A VCA40-12-1A ∗ All types equipped with surge voltage suppressor. 51 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 52 VCA Standard Specifications Valve construction Direct operated poppet Fluid Air/Inert gas 2.0 Valve specifications Withstand pressure (MPa) Body material Al Seal material HNBR Ambient temperature (°C) –20 to 60 Fluid temperature (°C) –10 to 60 (with no freezing) Enclosure Dust proof, Splash proof (equivalent to IP65) Environment Location without corrosive or explosive gases Valve leakage cm3/ min (ANR) 0.2 or less Mounting orientation Free Vibration/Impact resistance (m/s2) Note 2) Coil specifications Rated voltage 30/150 or less 24 VDC, 12 VDC, 100 VAC, 110 VAC, 200 VAC, 220 VAC (50/60 Hz) ±10% of rated voltage Allowable voltage fluctuation Coil insulation type Class B Power consumption DC Apparent power VCA2: 6.5 W, VCA3: 8 W, VCA4: 11.5 W AC Note 1) 50 Hz VCA2: 7.5 VA, VCA3: 10 VA, VCA4: 13 VA 60 Hz Note 1) Since AC coil specifications include a rectifying device, there is no difference in apparent power for inrush and energized conditions. Note 2) Vibration resistance … Conditions when tested with one sweep of 10 to 300 Hz in the axial direction and at a right angle to the armature, in both energized and deenergized states Impact resistance …… Conditions when tested with a drop tester in the axial direction and at a right angle to the armature, one time each in energized and deenergized states Characteristic Specifications Model Class Port size VCA (for air) 2 port solenoid valve Orifice size ø mm Maximum operating pressure differential MPa 3 1.0 6 (0.33) 5 0.15 15 (0.83) 2 1/4 (8A) 1/4 (8A) 3/8 (10A) 4 1.0 3 10 (0.55) 7 0.15 27 (1.5) 3/8 (10A) 1/2 (15A) 3/4 (20A) 5 1.0 15 (0.83) 4 7 0.3 27 (1.5) 10 0.15 38 (2.11) Note) Weight values are for the grommet type. 52 Effective area mm2 (Cv factor) Note) Max. operating pressure MPa Weight kg 1.0 0.21 1.0 0.30 1.0 0.50 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 53 2 Port Solenoid Valve For dry air, pilot operated Air Blow Series VQ20/30 Air Tool How to Order Valves VQ 2 1 A 1 1 G C6 Series/Orifice size Symbol Series 2 VQ20 3 VQ30 Option Nil: None Effective orifice ø3.4 mm ø4.8 mm F: With bracket Type of actuation N.C. (A) 2 L: L type (VQ20 only) 1 (P) Note) Consult with SMC for N.O. type. Note) Specify “LF” for L type with bracket. Port size Body type Symbol C6 C8 C10 C12 A: Single valve Port size VQ20 VQ30 ø6 One-touch fitting ø8 One-touch fitting ø10 One-touch fitting ø12 One-touch fitting Manual override Nil M: For manifold B Note) None Slotted locking type (Tool type) Note) Available only for normally closed DIN terminal in-line type. Coil voltage 1 2 3 5 6 9 Note) 100 VAC (50/60 Hz) 200 VAC 110 VAC 24 VDC 12 VDC Other, Special voltage Note) Consult with SMC for a special voltage. Indicator light/Surge voltage suppressor Nil S Z None With surge voltage suppressor With indicator light/surge voltage suppressor Note 1) For a coil voltage of 100 VAC, the unit will be with surge voltage suppressor. Note 2) “YOZ” is not available. Electrical entry G: Grommet Y: DIN terminal YO: DIN terminal without connector 53 Directional Control Equipment 1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 54 VQ20/30 Standard Specifications VQ20 Series Valve construction VQ30 Pilot operated 2 port poppet type Fluid Air, Inert gas Minimum operating pressure 0.01 MPa 0.6 MPa VQ20 Valve specifications Maximum operating pressure Effective area (Cv factor/Effective orifice) Body orifice size Response time Note 1) Maximum operating frequency C6 C8 7.2 9 mm2 mm2 ø13.8 100 cps 54 Electrical specifications 30 cps –10 to 50°C Note 2) Ambient and fluid temperature Not required Lubrication Slotted locking type Note 3) 150/30 m/s2 Note 4) Dust proof Note 5) Free 46 g Weight N.C. 17.5 mm2 (Cv1/ø4.8) 20 ms or less Mounting orientation 1 (P) C12 ø6 Enclosure (A) 2 C10 14.4 mm2 (Cv0.8/ø4.3) 5 ms or less Impact resistance/Vibration resistance Symbol (Cv0.4/ø3) (Cv0.5/ø3.4) Manual override VQ30 0.5 MPa 80 g 12 VDC, 24 VDC, 100 VAC, 110 VAC, 200 VAC Rated coil voltage Allowable voltage fluctuation ±10% of rated voltage Coil insulation Equivalent to class B 24 VDC Power consumption (current value) Electrical entry 2.5 W DC (104 mA) 12 VDC 2.5 W DC (208 mA) 100 VAC Inrush: 2 VA (20 mA), Energized: 2 VA (20 mA) Grommet, DIN terminal Note 1) Based on JISB8375-1981 (Values for supply pressure of 0.5 MPa, without indicator light/surge voltage suppressor) Note 2) Use dry air without condensation when operating at low temperatures. Note 3) Manual override is available for DIN terminal type only. Note 4) Vibration resistance: No malfunction resulted in a one sweep test between 8.3 and 2000 Hz. Test was performed in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and de-energized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Impact resistance: No malfunction resulted from the impact test using a drop impact tester. The test was performed one time each in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and deenergized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Note 5) DIN terminal type is dust and splash proof (IP65) compatible. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 55 Pilot Operated Zero Differential Pressure Operated 2 Port Solenoid Valve The updated individual catalog (CAT.ES70-31A) will be available shortly. Series VXZ For air, gas, vacuum, water, oil Normally Closed (N.C.) Cooling Water Models/Valve specifications Flow coefficient Port Orifice Effective area size (ømm) Cv (mm2) Max. Min. operating Max. operating pressure differential (MPa) system Weight∗ pressure Water Air Oil pressure differential (g) AC DC AC DC AC DC (MPa) (MPa) Model 14 10 1.9 34 VXZ2230-02 1.0 0.7 1.0 0.7 0.7 0.7 550 38 10 2.4 43 VXZ2230-03 1.0 0.7 1.0 0.7 0.7 0.7 550 12 15 5.3 95 VXZ2240-04 34 20 9.2 165 VXZ2350-06 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.7 0.7 1,300 1 25 12 215 VXZ2360-10 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 0.7 0.7 1,480 0 1.0 0.7 1.0 0.7 0.7 0.7 1.5 760 ∗ Weight for grommet type. Add 10 g for conduit type, 30 g for DIN terminal type, and 60 g for terminal type. Power supply Model OUT AC VXZ22 DC IN AC VXZ23 DC Frequency (Hz) 50 60 — 50 60 — Apparent power (VA) Power consumption Temperature increase (°C) (rated voltage) Inrush Energized (W) (energized) 7.5 60 60(53) 18 6 50 51(44) 12 8 60 — — 11 65 80 21 9.5 60 67 17 11.5 65 — — Note 1) Reset voltage is 20% or more of rated voltage for AC, and 2% or more of rated voltage for DC. Note 2) Allowable voltage fluctuation is ±10% of rated value for both AC and DC. Note 3) The values are for ambient temperature of 20°C ±5°C and rated voltage. Note 4) AC to DC or DC to AC coil exchange is not possible due to different armature configuration. Note 5) Values for apparent power inside ( ) are for VXZ2230. Normally Open (N.O.) Models/Valve specifications Flow coefficient Port Orifice Effective area size (ømm) Cv (mm2) Max. Min. operating Max. operating pressure differential (MPa) system Weight∗ pressure Water Air Oil pressure differential (g) AC DC AC DC AC DC (MPa) (MPa) Model 14 10 1.9 34 VXZ2232-02 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 600 38 10 2.4 43 VXZ2232-03 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 600 12 15 5.3 95 VXZ2242-04 34 20 9.2 165 VXZ2352-06 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 1,370 1 25 215 VXZ2362-10 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 1,550 12 0 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 0.7 0.6 1.5 850 ∗ Weight for grommet type. Add 10 g for conduit type, 30 g for DIN terminal type, and 60 g for terminal type. Solenoid specifications Symbol OUT Model VXZ22 Power supply AC DC IN VXZ23 AC DC Frequency (Hz) 50 60 — 50 60 — Apparent power (VA) Power consumption Temperature increase (°C) (rated voltage) Inrush Energized (W) (energized) 8 55 66(60) 20 6.5 45 57(51) 15 8 50 — — 11 60 93 25 9.5 50 79 20 11.5 55 — — Note 1) Reset voltage is 20% or more of rated voltage for AC, and 5% or more of rated voltage for DC. Note 2) Allowable voltage fluctuation is ±10% of rated value for both AC and DC. Note 3) The values are for ambient temperature of 20°C ±5°C and rated voltage. Note 4) AC to DC or DC to AC coil exchange is not possible due to different armature configuration. Note 5) Values for apparent power inside ( ) are for VXZ2232. 55 Directional Control Equipment Solenoid specifications Symbol ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series VXZ Page 56 The updated individual catalog (CAT.ES70-31A) will be available shortly. How to Order Model 2230 2230 2240 2350 2360 Port size 02 (Rc 1/4) 03 (Rc 3/8) 04 (Rc 1/2) 06 (Rc 3/4) 10 (Rc 1) Electrical option Thread type Nil T F N Nil S L Rc NPTF G NPT None With surge voltage suppressor With indicator light With surge voltage suppressor/ indicator light Z ∗ Refer to “Table 1” below for applicability. Normally VXZ 2230 02 1 G Normally VXZ 2232 02 1 G N.C. Closed N.O. Open Bracket Nil B Electrical entry G C D T Solenoid valve option Nil Standard specification Model 2232 2232 2242 2352 2362 Grommet Conduit DIN terminal Conduit terminal ∗ Refer to “Table 1” below for applicability. Port size 02 (Rc 1/4) 03 (Rc 3/8) 04 (Rc 1/2) 06 (Rc 3/4) 10 (Rc 1) Rated voltage 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 110 VAC, 50/60 Hz 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 24 VDC 12 VDC 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz 48 VAC, 50/60 Hz Other (Consult with SMC.) Table 1 Rated voltage/Electrical entry/Electrical options Fluid Standard specifications Air (general, dry) Vacuum (up to 1 Torr) Turbine oil, Carbon dioxide (CO2), Gaseous nitrogen (N2) Freon 11, 113, 114 Option Note) Air (dry) High temperature water Argon, Helium (T) (D, E) (F) (Other) Fluid and ambient temperature Fluid temperature (°C) Temperature condition Maximum Minimum Power supply Water (standard) AC DC AC·DC 60 40 1 Air (standard) Note 3) Oil High temp. water (standard) 80 60 –10 Note 2) Note 1) Dew point is –10°C or below. Note 2) 50 cSt or less Note 3) D.E.N.P., etc., inside ( ) indicate option codes. 56 None With bracket (D.E.N.P.) 60 40 –5 Note 3) 99 — — Note 3) Ambient High temp. temperature (°C) oil (D.N.) 100 — — 60 40 –10 Insulation classification Electrical entry Electrical option 1 (100 V) 2 (200 V) 3 (110 V) AC 4 (220 V) 7 (240 V) 8 (48 V) 5 (24 V) DC 6 (12 V) Class H Class B G C D, T G, C T Note) S — S L, Z — S L, Z — — — — — — — — — — — — Note) Surge voltage suppressor is attached to the lead wire. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 57 Direct Air Operated 2 Port Valve Series VXA21/22 For air, gas, vacuum, water, oil Normally Closed (N.C.)/Normally Open (N.O.) N.C. Models/Valve specifications Port size (Rc) Orifice (ømm) 18 (6A) 14 (8A) N.O. 38 (10A) 1 2 (15A) N.C. Flow coefficient Effective area Cv Max. operating Max. system pressure pressure differential (MPa) (MPa) Model (mm ) 2 3 4.5 3 0.33 0.61 0.33 6 11 6 4.5 0.61 11 6 8 10 4.5 6 8 10 10 1.05 1.7 1.9 0.61 1.05 1.7 2.4 2.4 19 31 34 11 19 31 43 43 VXA212 20 VXA213 20 VXA212 20 VXA213 20 VXA223 20 VXA224 20 VXA225 20 VXA226 20 VXA223 20 VXA224 20 VXA225 20 VXA226 20 VXA226 20 1.0 0.5 1.0 0.5 1.0 0.6 0.2 0.1 1.0 0.6 0.2 0.1 0.1 Proof pressure (MPa) Weight (g) 170 1.0 250 0.4 1.0 0.4 1.5 340 250 340 420 Directional Control Equipment Symbols Air Purge Pilot pressure N.O. OUT OUT IN Pressure (MPa) Model VXA21 VXA22 0.25 to 0.7 IN How to Order VXA21 VXA22 Bracket Nil –– None B ––– With bracket ∗ Refer to “Table 2” below when only brackets are required. Thread type Nil –– Rc T ––– NPTF F ––– G N ––– NPT Orifice size 2 –– ø3mm 3 –– ø4.5mm 4 –– ø6mm 5 –– ø8mm 6 –– ø10mm ∗ Refer to “Table 1” below for applicability. Type of actuation/Body type 0 –– Normally closed (N.C.)/Single 2 –– Normally open (N.O.)/Single Port size 01 –– 1/8 02 –– 1/4 03 –– 3/8 04 –– 1/2 ∗ Refer to “Table 1” below for applicability. Valve option Nil –– Standard specification V –– Vacuum, non-leak Table 1. Model/Port size/Orifice Model VXA21 VXA22 01 (1 8) 02 (1 4) — — — — — 02 (1 4) 03 (3 8) 04 (1 2) Orifice (symbol) 2 3 4 5 6 (3 mmø) (4.5 mmø) (6 mmø) (8 mmø) (10 mmø) — — — — — — — — — — — — Table 2. Bracket part numbers Model VXA212 VXA213 VXA223 VXA224 VXA225 VXA226 Part no. VX070-020 VX070-022 VX070-029 Ordering example: For series VXA21, orifice of ø4.5 mm, normally open, Rc 1/4 (Model number) VXA2130-02 57 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 58 Rubber Seal Pilot Operated Poppet Type 3 Port Solenoid Valve Air Purge Series VP300/500/700 Large flow capacity: Paint Stirring Models Cv1.0 (VP300), Cv2.3 (VP500), Cv4.0 (VP700) Series Body ported Base mounted Low power consumption: 1.8 W(DC) Model Can be used as a selector valve or divider valve Port size (Rc) Can be changed from N.C. to N.O. Weight kg (Body ported/Base mounted) Note) Series VP300 VP342 VP344 18 Effective area (mm2) (Cv factor) 14 16.2 18 (0.9) (1.0) 0.19/0.25 Series VP500 VP542 VP544 14 38 36 41.4 (2) (2.3) 0.33/0.43 Series VP700 VP742 VP744 38 12 62 72 (3.4) (4) 0.64/0.75 Note) Values for grommet type. Values for body ported type do not include brackets. Vacuum operation is possible. Up to –101.2 kPa (1 Torr) Specifications Air N.C. or N.O. (changeable) Internal pilot type External pilot type Fluid Type of actuation Pilot type Supply pressure –101.2 kPa to 0.8 Operating pressure range MPa 0.2 to 0.8 Ambient and fluid temperature °C Response time ms Note 1) Maximum operating frequency Hz Lubrication Manual override Mounting orientation Impact resistance/Vibration resistance m/s2 Note 2) Series VP300 VP344-G VP342-D VP544-G Rated coil voltage (V) Series VP700 VP744-E Maximum 50 30 or less (at 0.5 MPa) 5 Not required (If lubricated, use turbine oil class 1, ISOVG32) Non-locking push type Slotted locking type∗, Locking type∗ Free 300/50 Vibration resistance: No malfunction resulted in a one sweep test between 8.3 and 2000Hz. Test was performed in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and de-energized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Electrical entry VP742-T Equivalent to supply pressure, Minimum 0.2 Note 1) Based on dynamic performance test JIS B8374-1981 (at coil temperature of 20°C, rated voltage, without surge voltage suppressor) Note 2) Impact resistance: No malfunction resulted from the impact test using a drop impact tester. The test was performed one time each in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and de-energized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Series VP500 VP542-D External pilot pressure Allowable voltage fluctuation Apparent power (VA) Note 2) Power consumption (W) Note 2) Grommet (G), Grommet terminal (E), Conduit terminal (T), DIN terminal (D) AC(50/60Hz) 100, 200, 12∗, 24∗, 48∗, 110 to 120∗, 220∗, 240∗ Note 1) DC 24, 6∗, 12∗, 48∗, 100∗, 110∗ Note 1) –15% to +10% of rated voltage 5.6 (50 Hz), 5.0 (60 Hz) Inrush AC Energized 3.4 (50 Hz), 2.3 (60 Hz) DC 1.8 or 2 (with indicator light) Note 1) Values indicated by an asterisk (∗) are optional. Note 2) At rated voltage JIS symbols Options Description Bracket (screws included) Series VP342 VP542 VP742 Part no. Type VP300-27-1A VP500-27-1A VP700-27-1A N.C. Body ported N.O. External Pilot Type (Optional) Use the external pilot type for the following cases. Standard • Vacuum or low pressure of 0.2 MPa or less Base mounted • Consult with SMC for holding vacuum. • When P port is largely restricted Universal External pilot • When using A port for atmospheric release while blowing, etc. • When using on a manifold, the external pilot piping can be centralized on the manifold base. 58 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 59 Rubber Seal Pilot Operated Poppet Type 3 Port Solenoid Valve Series VP300/500/700 How to Order VP 3 4 2 1 E B 01 A Option VP solenoid valve F Flow passage Body size 3 5 7 14 38 12 With bracket (For VP342, 542, 742 only) A B standard standard standard Normally closed Normally open Port size Type of actuation 4 Symbol N.C./N.O. common (pilot type) Body ported Base mounted VP342 VP344 VP542 VP544 VP742 VP744 Directional Control Equipment Nil∗ Without sub-plate 18 01 14 02 38 03 12 04 Body type 2 4 Port size Rc ∗ For VP344, VP544, VP744 only Manual override Valve option Nil B∗ C∗ Nil Standard (Internal pilot type) R∗ External pilot type ∗ Optional Push type Slotted locking type Locking type ∗ Optional Indicator light/Surge voltage suppressor Rated voltage ∗ Optional Nil Z∗ S∗ None With indicator light/surge voltage suppressor (for “E”, “T”, “D” only) With surge voltage suppressor (for “G” only) ∗ Optional Electrical entry G E T D Grommet Grommet terminal Conduit terminal DIN terminal How to Order Pilot Valve Assemblies Pilot valve assemblies/Electrical entry SF4 1 E Z B 50 Rated voltage Manual override 1 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 2 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 3∗ 110 to 120 VAC, 50/60 Hz 4∗ 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 5 24 VDC 6∗ 12 VDC 7∗ 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz 9∗ Other Nil B∗ C∗ ∗ Optional Electrical entry G E T D Grommet Grommet terminal Conduit terminal DIN terminal G Push type Slotted locking type Locking type ∗ Optional Approx. 300 (Lead wire length) Symbol Electrical entry Symbol Electrical entry Surge voltage suppressor GS Approx. 300 1 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 2 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 3∗ 110 to 120 VAC, 50/60 Hz 4∗ 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 5 24 VDC 6∗ 12 VDC 7∗ 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz 9∗ Other Surge voltage suppressor Indicator light E EZ Indicator light/Surge voltage suppressor Nil Z∗ S∗ None With indicator light/surge voltage suppressor (for “E”, “T”, “D” only) With surge voltage suppressor (for “G” only) ∗ Optional Surge voltage suppressor Indicator light T TZ Surge voltage suppressor Indicator light D DZ 59 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 60 Rubber Seal Pilot Operated Poppet Type 3 Port Solenoid Valve Non-operation Series VG342 Light weight: 1.1kg Valve capacity: Rc 1/Cv13.1 Low power consumption: 4.8W DC (standard) 2W DC (low power consumption type) Specifications N.C., N.O. common Internal pilot type External pilot type Type of actuation Operation Operating pressure range Response time Note 1) Can be used in vacuum or with low pressure Maximum operating frequency Changeable actuation: N.C., N.O., external pilot Can be used as a selector or divider valve (external pilot) 0.2 to 0.9 MPa –101.2 kPa to 0.9 MPa — Equivalent to operating pressure, Minimum 0.2 MPa External pilot pressure No lubrication required External pilot type — Vacuum: up to 101.2 kPa Low pressure: 0 to 0.2 MPa Air Purge 30 ms or less (at 0.5 MPa) 5 cycles/sec (min. operating frequency of 1 cycle/30 days based on JlS B8374-1981) Maximum 50°C Ambient and fluid temperature Not required (If lubricated, use turbine oil class 1, lSO VG32.) Lubrication Push type (non-locking type) Manual override Free Mounting orientation 150/50 Impact resistance/Vibration resistance (m/s2) Note 2) 1.1 kg Note 3) Weight Note 1) Based on dynamic performance test JIS B8374-1981 (at coil temperature of 20°C, rated voltage, without surge voltage suppressor) Note 2) Impact resistance: No malfunction resulted from the impact test using a drop impact tester. The test was performed one time each in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and de-energized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Vibration resistance: No malfunction resulted in a one sweep test between 45 and 1000Hz. Test was performed in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and de-energized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Note 3) For grommet type Effective area/Cv factor Port size P→A A→R P→A A→R Effective area mm2 Cv factor Rc 1 2 140 145 7.8 8.1 Rc 3 4 185 195 10.3 10.8 Rc 1 210 235 11.7 13.1 Pilot valve assembly specifications Electrical entry Lead wire color Enclosure Rated coil voltage (V) AC (50/60 Hz) DC Grommet (G), Grommet terminal (E) Conduit terminal (T), DlN terminal (D) 100 VAC: Blue, 200 VAC: Red, 24 VDC: Red/Black Dust proof 100, 200, 24∗, 48∗, 110∗, 220∗, 240∗ Note 1) 24, 6∗, 12∗, 48∗, 100∗ Note 1) –15% to +10% of rated voltage 12.7 (50), 10.7 (60) 7.6 (50), 5.4 (60) 4.8 W or 5 W (with indicator light) Allowable voltage fluctuation Apparent power (VA) (Hz) Note 2) JIS symbols N.C. Power consumption Note 2) N.O. Inrush AC Energized DC Note 1) Values indicated by an asterisk (∗) are optional. Note 2) At rated voltage Option specification External pilot Low power consumption type: VG342–––Y Consider this specification when an electronic control, etc., requires low power consumption. The following specification is different from the standard. 2W DC or 2.2 W (with indicator light)∗ Power consumption ∗ 100 VDC is 2.4 W, with indicator light 2.6 W. Continuous energization type: VG342–––E Consider this specification when operating valves in a continuously energized state for a long period of time. The following specification is different from the standard. Apparent power (VA) (Hz) Note) Power consumption Note) Note) At rated voltage 60 AC Inrush Energized DC 7.9 (50), 6.2 (60) 5.8 (50), 3.5 (60) 2 W or 2.2 W (with indicator light) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 61 Rubber Seal Pilot Operated Poppet Type 3 Port Solenoid Valve Series VG342 Caution How to Order VG342 Indicator Light/ Surge Voltage Suppressor 04 1 G A 100 VAC/DC or more For indicator light assembly Terminal No. 1 (+) Pilot valve option Valve type Nil R Nil Y∗ E∗ Internal pilot External pilot ∗ Optional Rated voltage 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 110 VAC, 50/60 Hz 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 24 VDC 12 VDC 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz Other Nil A B External pilot N.C. (Normally closed) N.O. (Normally open) 48 VDC or less For indicator light assembly Terminal No. 1 (+) (+) Thread type Nil F∗ N∗ T∗ ∗ Optional (–) Rc G NPT NPTF Terminal No. 2 (–) Electrical Connection ∗ Optional Electrical entry G D E T Terminal No. 2 (–) Flow passage Grommet DIN terminal Grommet terminal Conduit terminal Port size 04 06 10 Rc 1 2 Rc 3 4 Rc 1 The internal connections for DlN terminal and terminal (with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor circuit) are as shown below. Connect each to the power supply side. With DlN terminal block With terminal block Indicator light/Surge voltage suppressor Nil S Z None With surge voltage suppressor (For grommet type only) With indicator light/surge voltage suppressor (Except grommet type) How to Order Pilot Valve Assemblies VO307 X84 1 G Pilot valve assembly for VG342 Valve option Nil ∗ Optional Rated voltage 5 6∗ 7∗ 9∗ ∗ Optional 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 110 VAC, 50/60 Hz 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 24 VDC 12 VDC 240 V, 50/60 Hz Other 1 + + 2 – – Changing the Flow Passage Indicator light/Surge voltage suppressor Nil Standard Y∗ Low power consumption E∗ Continuous energization 1 2 3∗ 4∗ Ground Terminal no. DlN terminal Terminal S None With surge voltage suppressor (For grommet type only) Z With indicator light/surge voltage suppressor (Except grommet type) Electrical entry G D E T Grommet DIN terminal Grommet terminal Conduit terminal N.C. N.O. External pilot When changing the flow passage, confirm that pressure has been removed from the valve. Loosen the hexagon socket head cap screw M4 x 0.7 in the switching plate and match the mark on the adapter plate with a character symbol on the switching plate. Perform piping as shown in the table below. Piping Flow passage NC NO Port P Primary R Exhaust side Secondary (Plug for 2 port valve) A Exhaust side (Plug for Secondary 2 port valve) Primary Universal porting External (Piping of primary side is possible anywhere.) Note 1) When operating with internal pilot, confirm that the X port is plugged. If it is not plugged, use an R 1/8 plug. Note 2) When operating with external pilot, pressurize from the X port. 61 Directional Control Equipment 1 2 3∗ 4∗ 5 6∗ 7∗ 9∗ Standard Low power consumption Continuous energization ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 62 Rubber Seal Large 3 Port Solenoid Valve Non-operation Series VP3145/3165/3185 Large flow capacity, small exhaust resistance Models Port size Rc The switching plate enables conversion to N.C. or N.O. without changing ports. Cv factor Can be used in vacuum or with low pressure Effective area mm2 Weight kg Note) External pilot type — Vacuum: up to 101.2 kPa Low pressure: 0 to 0.2 MPa VP3145 VPA3145 Model (Refer to Cv factor values in “Models” table.) Easy conversion to N.C. or N.O. Air Purge IN, OUT EXT IN → OUT OUT → EXT IN → OUT OUT → EXT 38 12 34 34 5.0 7.2 90 130 5.6 8.9 100 160 1.5 6.1 11.7 110 210 VP3165 VPA3165 34 1 11 4 11 4 12.8 15.6 17.2 15.6 17.2 18.3 230 280 310 280 310 330 2.0 VP3185 VPA3185 2 11 4 11 2 2 31.7 36.1 36.1 36.1 37.2 37.2 570 650 650 650 670 670 2.8 Note) For grommet type. Add 0.2 kg for conduit terminal type. Subtract 0.5kg for air operated type. Unrestricted mounting orientation Specifications Air N.C. or N.O. (changeable) External pilot type Internal pilot type Vacuum/Low pressure General General Fluid Type of actuation Pilot type Main pressure Operating pressure range MPa Pilot pressure Ambient and fluid temperature (°C) Response time (ms) (at 0.5 MPa) JIS symbols Internal pilot type <Standard> External pilot type <For pressurizing> -101.2kPa to 0.2 0.2 to 0.8 0.2 to 0.3 See the graph on next page. 0.2 to 0.8 Note 1) Maximum operating frequency (Hz) Lubrication Note 2) Manual override Mounting orientation Impact resistance/Vibration resistance (m/s2) Note 3) 0 (no freezing) to 60 30 or less AC 30 or less ON OFF 40 or less DC 30 or less 3 Required (equivalent to turbine oil class 1, ISO VG32) Non-locking type Free 150/50 AC DC Note 1) Based on dynamic performance test JIS B8374-1981 (at coil temperature of 20°C, rated voltage, without surge voltage suppressor) Note 2) Since this solenoid valve is a lubricating type, use a lubricant equivalent to turbine oil class 1 (ISO VG32). Note 3) Impact resistance: No malfunction resulted from the impact test using a drop impact tester. The test was performed one time each in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and deenergized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Vibration resistance: No malfunction resulted in a one sweep test between 45 and 1000 Hz. Test was performed in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature for both energized and de-energized states. (The value is for the initial stage.) Solenoid specifications Grommet (G), Conduit terminal (T), DIN terminal (D) Conduit terminal with indicator light (TL), Conduit terminal with surge voltage suppressor (TS), Electrical entry Conduit terminal with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor (TZ), Options DlN terminal with indicator light (DL), DlN terminal with surge voltage suppressor (DS), DlN terminal with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor (DZ) AC (50/60 Hz) 100 V, 200 V, 110 V ∗, 220 V ∗, 240 V ∗ Note 1) Rated coil voltage 12 V ∗, 24 V, 48 V ∗, 100 V ∗ Note 1) DC Allowable voltage fluctuation –15% to +10% of rated voltage Inrush 73 VA (50 Hz), 58 VA (60 Hz) Note 2) Apparent power AC Energized 28 VA (50 Hz), 17 VA (60 Hz) Power consumption Note 2) DC 12 W Standard <For vacuum> Note) In the case of the N.O. specification, it operates as a normally open valve only when the proper pressure is applied to the pilot chamber. 62 Note 1) Values indicated by an asterisk (∗) are optional. Note 2) At rated voltage ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 63 Rubber Seal Large 3 Port Solenoid Valve External Pilot Type Use an external pilot model in the following cases: • Vacuum or low pressure of 0.2 MPa or less: External pilot for vacuum/low pressure • Operation with restricted supply port: External pilot for general purpose • Slow build up of supply port air pressure: External pilot for general purpose • Low resistance in the secondary side as in the case of air blowing or filling an air tank, etc.: External pilot for general purpose Note 1) Use external pilot pressure within the range shown in the graph below. Note 2) Changing from an internal pilot to an external pilot or vice versa is not possible. How to Order VP3 1 4 5 04 1 G A Pilot option VP 3 port solenoid valve Nil 1 Type of actuation No. of solenoids 1 A B Single Body size 12 4 6 8 G Grommet T Conduit terminal D DIN terminal TL∗ Conduit terminal with indicator light Conduit terminal with TS∗ surge voltage suppressor Conduit terminal with indicator light/ TZ∗ surge voltage suppressor DL∗ DIN terminal with indicator light DIN terminal with DS∗ surge voltage suppressor DIN terminal with indicator light/ DZ∗ surge voltage suppressor 112 Body ported Valve option General purpose Nil V General Vacuum/Low pressure Pilot pressure (MPa) Port size (IN/OUT port) Port size Rc Symbol (Nominal size) VP3145 VP3165 VP3185 03 04 06 10 12 14 20 N.C. (Normally closed) N.O. (Normally open) Electrical entry 1 Body type 5 Standard (Internal pilot) External pilot ∗ Optional 38 12 (10 A) (15 A) 3 4 (20 A) 1 (25 A) 1 1 4 (32 A) 1 1 2 (40 A) 2 (50 A) Rated coil voltage 11 22 3∗ 4∗ 55 6∗ 7∗ 9∗ Main pressure (MPa) 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 110 VAC, 50/60 Hz 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 24 VDC 12 VDC 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz Other ∗ Optional How to Order Pilot Valve Assemblies VT3113 00 1 G Rated coil voltage 11 22 3∗ 4∗ 55 6∗ 7∗ 9∗ 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 110 VAC, 50/60 Hz 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 24 VDC 12 VDC 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz Other ∗ Optional Electrical entry TL∗ TS∗ TZ∗ DL∗ DS∗ DZ∗ Grommet Conduit terminal DIN terminal Conduit terminal with indicator light Conduit terminal with surge voltage suppressor Conduit terminal with indicator light/ surge voltage suppressor DIN terminal with indicator light DIN terminal with surge voltage suppressor DIN terminal with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor ∗ Optional 63 Directional Control Equipment Vacuum/ Low pressure VP3145/3165/3185 Series ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 64 3 Port Micro Mechanical Valve Series VM1000 Miniature construction requires minimal mounting space. Easy tubing connection with builtin hose nipple. Port options: Side ported Bottom ported Large over travel after actuation (mechanically operated type) Air Purge Standard specifications Valve type Number of ports Total travel (T.T.) Piping Fluid Operating pressure Ambient and operating air temperature Effective area (Cv factor) Lubrication Fitting Weight (Basic type) N.C. poppet type 3 port 4.8 mm (Basic type) Side ported or Bottom ported Air 5 to 0.8 MPa –5 to 60°C (with no freezing) 1 mm2 (0.055) Not required (If lubricated, use turbine oil class 1, ISO VG32.) With hose nipple 6g Option specifications Total travel (T.T.) 2.5 mm (Basic type) • A commercially available actuator for the V micro switch can be installed. • However, be aware that there are different types of micro switch such as P.T., O.T. or F.O.F. • Total travel of 2.5 mm is only available for the basic type. Models Mechanical operation Actuator Basic type Roller lever One way roller lever Manual operation Toggle lever 64 Push button Port type Side ported Bottom ported Side ported Bottom ported Side ported Bottom ported Side ported Bottom ported Side ported Bottom ported Side ported Bottom ported Side ported Bottom ported No. of ports 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port 3 port Applicable tube T0425 TU0425/T0403 VM1000-4N-00 VM1000-4NU-00 VM1010-4N-00 VM1010-4NU-00 VM1000-4N-01 VM1000-4NU-01 VM1010-4N-01 VM1010-4NU-01 VM1000-4N-02 VM1000-4NU-02 VM1010-4N-02 VM1010-4NU-02 VM1000-4N-08 VM1000-4NU-08 VM1010-4N-08 VM1010-4NU-08 VM1000-4N-32R VM1000-4NU-32R VM1010-4N-32R VM1010-4NU-32R VM1000-4N-32B VM1000-4NU-32B VM1010-4N-32B VM1010-4NU-32B VM1000-4N-32G VM1000-4NU-32G VM1010-4N-32G VM1010-4NU-32G Note Red Red Black Black Green Green ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 65 3 Port Mechanical Valve Series VM100 Air Purge Compact size equivalent to micro Specifications Piping switch Models Piping Actuator No. o f port s Basic type Roller lever One way roller lever Straight plunger Roller plunger Cross roller plunger Toggle lever Push button (Mushroom) Push button (Extended) Push button (Flush) Side ported 3 port VM130-01-00 VM131-01-00 VM130-01-01 VM131-01-01S VM131-01-02 VM131-01-02S VM130-01-05 VM130-01-06 VM130-01-06S VM130-01-07 VM130-01-07S VM130-01-08 VM130-01-30R VM130-01-30B VM130-01-30G VM130-01-30Y VM130-01-32R VM130-01-32B VM130-01-32G VM130-01-32Y Bottom ported 3 port VM132-M5-00 VM133-M5-00 VM133-M5-01 VM133-M5-01S VM133-M5-02 VM133-M5-02S VM132-M5-05 VM132-M5-06 VM132-M5-06S VM132-M5-07 VM132-M5-07S VM132-M5-08 VM132-M5-30R VM132-M5-30B VM132-M5-30G VM132-M5-30Y VM132-M5-32R VM132-M5-32B VM132-M5-32G VM132-M5-32Y — — — — VM-05B VM-06B VM-06BS VM-07B VM-07BS VM-08B VM-30AR VM-30AB VM-30AG VM-30AY VM-32AR VM-32AB VM-32AG VM-32AY VM130-01-33 VM132-M5-33 VM-33A VM132-M5-34R VM132-M5-34B VM132-M5-34G VM132-M5-34Y VM132-M5-36 VM153-M5-35R VM153-M5-35B VM153-M5-35G VM153-M5-35Y (5 port) VM-34AR VM-34AB VM-34AG VM-34AY VM-36A — — — — VM130-01-34R VM130-01-34B Selector (2 position) VM130-01-34G VM130-01-34Y Key selector (2 position) VM130-01-36 VM151-01-35R VM151-01-35B Selector (3 position) VM151-01-35G VM151-01-35Y (5 port) Actuator part no. Application — Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller — Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller Red Black Green Yellow Red Black Green Yellow A set of Red, Black, Green, and Yellow included. Red Black Green Yellow Red Black Green Yellow Note) Actuator replacement is available except for roller lever, one way roller lever, and 3 position selector types. 65 Directional Control Equipment Mechanical operation A variety of actuators available Manual operation Port options: Side ported Bottom ported Side ported Bottom ported Air Fluid Operating pressure –100 kPa to 1.0 MPa –5 to 60°C (with no freezing) Ambient and operating air temperature 2.5 mm2 (0.14) Effective area (Cv factor) Not required (If lubricated, use turbine oil class 1, ISO VG32.) Lubrication Port size (Nominal size) Rc 1/8 (6 A) M5 x 0.8 95 g 110 g Weight (Basic type) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 66 3 Port Mechanical Valve Series VM200 Large flow capacity A variety of actuators available Air Purge Specifications Fluid Air Operating pressure 0 to 1.0MPa Ambient and operating air temperature -5 to 60°C (with no freezing) Effective area (Cv factor) 19 mm2 (1.0) Lubrication Not required (If lubricated, use turbine oil class 1, ISO VG32.) Port size (Nominal size) Rc 1/4 (8 A) Weight (Basic type) 111 g Models No. of ports Mechanical operation Actuator Basic type Roller lever One way roller lever Straight plunger Roller plunger Cross roller plunger Toggle lever Push button (Mushroom) Manual operation Push button (Extended) Push button (Flush) Selector (2 position) Key selector (2 position) Selector (3 position) Foot pedal 3 port Actuator part no. VM230-02-00 VM230-02-01 VM230-02-01S VM230-02-02 VM230-02-02S VM230-02-05 VM230-02-06 VM230-02-06S VM230-02-07 VM230-02-07S VM230-02-08 VM230-02-30R VM230-02-30B VM230-02-30G VM230-02-30Y VM230-02-32R VM230-02-32B VM230-02-32G VM230-02-32Y — VM-01A VM-01AS VM-02A VM-02AS VM-05A VM-06A VM-06AS VM-07A VM-07AS VM-08A VM-30AR VM-30AB VM-30AG VM-30AY VM-32AR VM-32AB VM-32AG VM-32AY VM230-02-33 VM-33A VM230-02-34R VM230-02-34B VM230-02-34G VM230-02-34Y VM230-02-36 VM230-02-35R VM230-02-35B VM230-02-35G VM230-02-35Y VM230-02-40 VM-34AR VM-34AB VM-34AG VM-34AY VM-36A — — — — — Application — Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller — Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller — Red Black Green Yellow Red Black Green Yellow A set of Red, Black, Green, and Yellow included. Red Black Green Yellow — Red Black Green Yellow — Note) Actuator replacement is available except for 3 position selector and foot pedal types. 66 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 67 3 Port Mechanical Valve Series VM400 (Proper countermeasures can be taken for applications in which noise or dirt from exhaust could cause a problem to the environment.) Air Fluid Operating pressure –100 kPa to 1.0 MPa –5 to 60°C (with no freezing) Ambient and operating air temperature 7 mm2 (0.38) Effective area (Cv factor) Not required (If lubricated, use turbine oil class 1, ISO VG32.) Lubrication Rc 1/8 (6 A) Port size (Nominal size) 110 g Weight (Basic type) Models Actuator Basic type Roller lever One way roller lever Straight plunger Roller plunger Cross roller plunger Toggle lever Push button (Mushroom) Push button (Extended) Push button (Flush) Selector (2 position) Key selector (2 position) Model Actuator part no. VM430-01-00 VM430-01-01 VM430-01-01S VM430-01-02 VM430-01-02S VM430-01-05 VM430-01-06 VM430-01-06S VM430-01-07 VM430-01-07S VM430-01-08 VM430-01-30R VM430-01-30B VM430-01-30G VM430-01-30Y VM430-01-32R VM430-01-32B VM430-01-32G VM430-01-32Y — VM-01A VM-01AS VM-02A VM-02AS VM-05A VM-06A VM-06AS VM-07A VM-07AS VM-08A VM-30AR VM-30AB VM-30AG VM-30AY VM-32AR VM-32AB VM-32AG VM-32AY VM430-01-33 VM-33A VM430-01-34R VM430-01-34B VM430-01-34G VM430-01-34Y VM430-01-36 VM-34AR VM-34AB VM-34AG VM-34AY VM-36A Application — Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller — Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller Polyacetal roller Hard steel roller — Red Black Green Yellow Red Black Green Yellow A set of Red, Black, Green, and Yellow included. Red Black Green Yellow — Directional Control Equipment Mechanical operation Piping connection to any port Specifications Manual operation N.C. or N.O. models available Air Purge Note) Actuator replacement is available. 67 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 68 Coolant Valve Solenoid/Air Operated Type Series VNC Coolant Models Piping port Model Symbols Valve type Operation N.C. N.O. 1 VNC VNC 04 P1 02 P2 Air operated VNC1 4 VNC1 4 VNC1 4 VNC2 4 VNC2 4 VNC2 4 VNC2 4 VNC3 4 VNC3 4 VNC4 4 VNC4 4 VNC5 4 VNC5 4 VNC5 4 VNC5 4 VNC6 4 VNC6 4 VNC6 4 VNC6 4 VNC7 4 VNC7 4 VNC7 4 VNC7 4 VNC814 VNC811 VNC914 VNC911 -6A -8A -10A -10A -10A -15A -15A -20A -20A -25A -25A -32A -32A -32F -32F -40A -40A -40F -40F -50A -50A -50F -50F -65F -65F -80F -80F Note) Rc Flange 18 14 — — 38 — 12 — 34 — 1 — 11 4 — — 32 11 2 — — 40 2 — — 50 — 65 — 80 Orifice (ømm) 7 11 15 11 15 14 20 16 25 22 32 22 32 28 40 28 40 33 50 33 50 45 65 56 80 Weight (kg) Flow coefficient Effective area Air operated Solenoid Cv type type (mm2) 0.7 1 1.3 2.5 3.8 3 5 5 8 7 12 11 18 11 18 19 28 19 28 29 43 29 43 49 70 73 100 13 18 23 45 70 55 90 90 140 130 220 210 320 210 320 330 500 330 500 520 770 520 770 880 1260 1400 1800 0.2 0.3 0.5 0.7 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 2.2 2.4 5.0 5.2 3.6 3.8 6.8 7.0 5.5 5.7 10.2 10.4 — 15.7 — 21.2 Note) The flange is equivalent to JIS B 2210 10K (regular type). 014 VNC VNC P1 12 P1 External pilot solenoid type Valve specifications Fluid VNC Fluid temperature VNC Coolant –5 to 60°C∗ –5 to 99°C∗ (air operated type only) –5 to 50°C∗ (60°C for air operated type) A B Ambient temperature Proof pressure Operating VNC 1 2 pressure range VNC 4 Pressure VNC VNC External pilot air Lubrication Temperature 1 4 2 1.5 MPa 0 to 0.5 MPa 0 to 1 MPa 0.25 to 0.7 MPa 0.1 to 0.7 MPa (Refer to Table 1.) Not required (If lubricated, use turbine oil class 1, ISO VG32.) –5 to 50°C∗ (60°C for air operated type) ∗ With no freezing Use pilot pressure that is within range A with respect to the operating pressure. Pilot pressure (MPa) 68 Model Pilot solenoid valve Electrical entry AC (50/60 Hz) DC Allowable pressure fluctuation Coil insulation type Rated coil voltage V Temperature increase Apparent power Table 1 Operating pressure/Pilot Pressure Operating pressure (MPa) Pilot solenoid valve specifications Inrush AC Power DC consumption Manual override Energized VNC1 SF4--23 Grommet Grommet terminal Conduit terminal DIN terminal VNC2 to 9 VO301-00T-X302 Conduit terminal 100 V, 200 V, other (option) 24 V, other (option) –15% to +10% of rated voltage Equivalent to class B (130°C) 35°C or less 70°C or less (at rated voltage) (at rated voltage) 5.6 VA (50 Hz) 5.0 VA (60 Hz) 3.4 VA (50 Hz) 2.3 VA (60 Hz) 12 VA (50 Hz) 10.5 VA (60 Hz) 7.5 VA (50 Hz) 6 VA (60 Hz) 1.8 W 4.8 W Push type, other (option) Non-locking push type ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 69 Coolant Valve Solenoid/Air Operated Type Series VNC How to Order Seal material A B Bracket NBR seal FPM seal Nil B None With bracket For valve sizes 1, 2, 3, and 4 only Air Operated Type VNC 2 0 1 A 15A External Pilot Solenoid Type VNC 2 1 1 A 15A (Except valve sizes 8 and 9) 1 T Nil: Push type Valve size Symbol Orifice size (mm) 1 ø7 2 ø15 (ø11) 3 4 ø20 (ø14) ø25 (ø16) 5 ø32 (ø22) 6 ø40 (ø28) Valve type Port size Symbol Port 1 2 4 Symbol size N.C. N.O. N.C. (Rc) 0.5 MPa 1 MPa 1 MPa 6A 1/8 8A 1/4 10A 3/8 10A 3/8 15A 1/2 20A 3/4 1 25A 32A 1 1/4 1 1/4B 32F Flange 40A 40F 50A 7 ø50 (ø33) 50F 8 ø65 (ø45) 65F 9 ø80 (ø56) 80F Values inside ( ) are for N.C. at 1 MPa. A: Projecting style push type Rated voltage Nil 1 2 3∗ 4∗ 5 6∗ 7∗ 9∗ Air operated type 100 VAC, 50/60 Hz 200 VAC, 50/60 Hz 110 VAC, 50/60 Hz 220 VAC, 50/60 Hz 24 VDC 12 VDC 240 VAC, 50/60 Hz Other B: Slotted locking type Valve size 1 Nil: Push type ∗ Optional Valve sizes 2 to 9 1 1/2 1 1/2B Flange 2 2B Flange 2 1/2B Flange 2B Flange Electrical entry and indicator light/surge voltage suppressor Air operated type Nil Grommet G Grommet with surge voltage suppressor GS Grommet terminal E Grommet terminal with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor EZ Conduit terminal T Conduit terminal with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor TZ DIN terminal D DIN terminal with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor DZ Conduit terminal T Conduit terminal with surge voltage suppressor TS Conduit terminal with indicator light/surge voltage suppressor TZ∗ Conduit terminal with indicator light TL∗ Valve size 1 Valve sizes 2 to 9 69 Directional Control Equipment Manual override ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 70 Flow Switching 2 Port Air Operated Valve Special Order Product Paint Stirring Air operated 2 port valve with compact metering valve Metering valve construction with reproducibility (adjustable between 0 to 300° ) 10.5 (fully closed) 34.5 M5 x 0.8 Pilot port Effective area for single valve can be detected with calibration mark. Needle (M8 x 1.25) VKFA332-1-01-X1 18 25 PA Calibration mark position 11.5 17.5 Direct manual override 2-ø3.5 mounting hole Width across flats 3 mm Rc 1/8 (OUT port) Rc 1/8 (IN port) 57.5 50 5 28.5 100 P 11 2.3 21 A Specifications Valve type Fluid Operating pressure range Pilot pressure OFF Effective area ON 70 Poppet Air, Inert gas 0 to 0.7 MPa 0.15 to 0.7 MPa 4 mm2 (Cv factor: 0.22) Adjustable type: 0 to 4 mm2 (at 5/6 rotation from fully closed state) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 71 Booster Valve Series VBA1110 Specifications Intensified pressure ratio Maximum 2 VBA1111 Maximum 4 Compressed air VBA1110 VBA1111 Proof pressure VBA2 00 VBA4 00 Maximum supply pressure Hydraulic Clamp Models VBA1110 VBA2 00 VBA4 00 Fluid to 4200 Air operated type Handle operated type VBA1110-02 VBA1111-02 VBA2100-03 VBA4100-04 VBA2200-03 VBA4200-04 Model Max. flow rate l/min (ANR) Note) 400 Port size Rc Exhaust port size Rc 3.0 MPa Pilot port size Rc 1.5 MPa Pilot pressure range VBA1110 0.2 to 2.0 MPa VBA1111 VBA2 00 0.2 to 1.0 MPa VBA4 00 Ambient and fluid temperature 2 to 50°C (with no freezing) Set pressure range None Mounting orientation Horizontal 1900 1000 1900 3/8 1/2 1/2 3/8 1/8 0.1 to 0.5 MPa 0.85 0.98 3.8 7.5 3.8 7.5 Note) Flow conditions — IN/OUT: 1.0MPa for VBA1110, IN/OUT: 0.5MPa for VBA1111, VBA22100, 42100 Refer to flow characteristics graphs on page 14-9-3 of “Best Pneumatics Vol. 14” when selecting a model. Accessory (option) part nos. Part no. Model Description Pressure gauge VBA2100 VBA1110-1111 VBA4100 VBA4200 VBA2200 G27-20-R1 … 2 pcs. G27-10-R1-X209 … 2 pcs. G46-10-01 … 2 pcs. G27-10-R1-X209 … 2 pcs. G46-10-01 … 2 pcs. AN200-02 Silencer AN300-03 AN400-04 AN300-03 AN400-04 Pressure adjustment mechanism Relieving type How to Order 1 Pressure 2.0 MPa Intensified pressure ratio 0 1 Pressure adjustment 1 Handle operated type Port size Symbol Port size 02 Rc 1/4 VBA1110-02 VBA1111-02 VBA4100-04 Handle operated type VBA2100-03 Body size 1/4 standard 1 Double Quadruple Series VBA1000 VBA 1 1 1 0 02 GN Series VBA2000/4000 VBA 2 1 0 0 03 GN 2 4 Body size 3/8 standard 1/2 standard Option Pressure gauge Silencer G N Pressure adjustment 1 Handle operated type 2 Air operated type Pressure 0 1.0 MPa VBA4200-04 Port size Symbol Port size 03 Rc 3/8 04 Rc 1/2 Applicable series VBA2100, 2200 VBA4100, 4200 Related products Air operated type VBA2200-03 Description Model Mist separator Exhaust cleaner Symbol Air tank Knob operated type VBA1110/1111 VBA2100/2200 VBA4100/4200 AM250-02 AM450-04, 06 AM550-06, 10 AMC310-03 AMC510-06 AMC610-10 Note 35 dB or more noise reduction VBAT05 VBAT20 (20 l, Directly connected to booster valve) (5 l, Directly connected VBAT38 (38 l, Directly connected to booster valve) to booster valve) VBAT10 (10 l, Directly connected to booster valve) Air operated type 71 Directional Control Equipment Lubrication 1000 3/8 (IN, OUT) 1/2 (IN, OUT) 3/8 (IN, OUT) 1/2 (IN, OUT) 1/4 Weight kg 1.0 MPa 60 1/4 (IN, OUT) ECOPS.qxd 72 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 72 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 73 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Application VMG KN KK TRB TRBU TKS TCU TK AR10 to 60 AR425 to 935 AR20K to 60K AW10 to 40 AW20K to 40K Air blow Air blow, Air tool, Coolant Air blow, Air tool, Air leakage Air leakage Air leakage Air leakage Air blow, Air tool Air leakage Air blow, Air tool Air blow, Air tool Actuator Air blow, Air tool Actuator Air line maintenance GD40-01 Air line maintenance Air line maintenance Page 74 80 83 104 105 106 107 107 108 109 110 111 113 114 115 116 73 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Blow gun Nozzles for blowing/Sensing heads S couplers FR double layer tubing FR double layer polyurethane tubing Double layer tubing stripper Polyurethane coil tubing Tube cutter Regulator Pilot operated regulator Regulator with back flow mechanism Filter regulator Filter regulator with back flow mechanism Air filter element part number list Differential pressure gauge Filter with element service indicator Series ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 74 Blow Gun Series VMG Air Blow Top piping Bottom piping With S coupler plug Piping type Piping direction Body color Nozzle type Bottom Male thread nozzle Rc, NPT, G 1/4, 3/8 White With S coupler plug Top Dark blue High efficiency nozzle Air blow thrust has been increased by 10%. (comparison done the same nozzle diameter) Low noise nozzle 45 High efficiency nozzle 40 Sample Thrust (g) 35 High efficiency nozzle 30 100 mm Male thread nozzle 25 20 15 10 5 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 Internal pressure (MPa) Scale: Accuracy Measurement value ±0.2% or less Temperature: 20°C Distance between a sample and the scale: 100 mm Long copper pipe nozzle ∗ Male thread nozzle ø2.5 Pressure loss (MPa) Large 0.05 Conventional product Blow Gun 0 74 Pressure loss Small Operational force Provides constant operational force irrespective of the supply pressure Supply pressure (MPa) 1.0 0.04 0.03 0.005 MPa pressure loss at 0.5 MPa 0.02 0.01 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 Supply pressure (MPa) 1 1.2 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 75 Example of Improvement Before Improvement In the case of air guns, energy saving measures are not considered. S1 S2 Effective area ratio 2.3 : 1 Pressure loss: Large ø3 Without nozzle ø3 Pressure Loss of Air Gun Only Effective area (mm2) Effective area ratio Nozzle size (mm) Number of nozzles Supply pressure Regulator pressure Outlet pressure Pressure loss Upstream side S1: 15 Nozzle side S2: 6.4 S1 : S2 = 2.3 : 1 ø3 1 0.700 MPa 0.300 MPa 0.260 MPa 0.040 MPa Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment After Improvement Change to fittings, tubing and Blow Gun with large effective areas. S1 S2 Filter regulator S coupler Effective area ratio 10.7 : 1 Coil tube Nozzle ø2 Pressure loss: Small ø2 Pressure Loss of Blow Gun Only Effect of Energy Saving Improvement Air consumption 100% Min. 90% Reduction Before After Effective area (mm2) Effective area ratio Nozzle size (mm) Number of nozzles Supply pressure Regulator pressure Outlet pressure Pressure loss Upstream side S1: 30 Nozzle side S2: 2.8 S1 : S2 = 10.7 : 1 ø2 1 0.700 MPa 0.300 MPa 0.297 MPa 0.003 MPa 75 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 76 VMG How to Order VMG 1 1 W 03 01 Nozzle Blow gun Type Standard type Nil 01 02 03 04 11 12 13 21 22 23 24 31 32 33 34 Series 1 Resin body lever type Piping entry Bottom Top 1 2 Body color White Dark blue W BU High efficiency nozzle Low noise nozzle with male thread Note 1) Copper extension nozzle Length 300 mm Length 600 mm Nozzle size ø1 ø1.5 ø2 ø2.5 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 ø0.75 x 4 ø0.9 x 8 ø1 x 4 ø1.1 x 8 ø1.5 ø2 ø1.5 ø2 Note 1) One piece of H06-02 self-align fitting is attached. When a copper extension nozzle is ordered separately, a self-align fitting will also be required for connection. Order one with the above part number in addition to the nozzle. Piping connection type Nil N F Male thread nozzle Nozzle model Without nozzle KN-R02-100 KN-R02-150 KN-R02-200 KN-R02-250 KNH-R02-100 KNH-R02-150 KNH-R02-200 KNS-R02-075-4 KNS-R02-090-8 KNS-R02-100-4 KNS-R02-110-8 KNL3-06-150 KNL3-06-200 KNL6-06-150 KNL6-06-200 Rc NPT G Connection size Piping connection system 02 03 11 Screw-in type With S coupler plug Size and part no. 1/4 3/8 KK4P-02MS Plug part no. Port size Note1) Note 1) In case of a type with an S coupler plug, specify no symbol (Rc) for the piping connection type. The size is Rc 1/4. Specifications Air Fluid 0 to 1.0 MPa Operating pressure range 1.5 MPa Proof pressure Ambient and fluid temperature Effective area 5 to 60°C (With no condensation) 30 mm2 (without nozzle) Rc, NPT, G, 1/4, 3/8 Port size Piping entry Top Bottom Nozzle port size Rc 1/4 Weight 180 g Operational force (when the valve is fully open) 76 7N ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 77 Blow Gun Series VMG Construction !2 qw !8 e !3 r u i Component Parts o t !4 !6 !1 !0 !7 !9 y @1 @0 !5 No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 Description Body L Body R Main valve Valve guide Nozzle holder Port Elbow Cover Ring Arm L Arm R Spring Main valve seal Guide cover Lever Tube O-ring O-ring Parallel pin Round head Phillips screw Hexagon nut High efficiency nozzle 600 400 KN-R02-250 500 400 Flow rate [l/min (ANR)] Flow rate [l/min (ANR)] ∗ Only for VMG11 Note) Values when the main valve is fully open. Male thread nozzle KN-R02-200 300 KN-R02-150 200 KN-R02-100 100 KNH-R02-200 350 300 250 KNH-R02-150 200 150 KNH-R02-100 100 50 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1 0.1 0.2 Supply pressure [MPa] 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 400 700 600 KNS-R02-090-8 400 KNS-R02-100-4 300 200 KNS-R02-075-4 Flow rate [l/min (ANR)] KNS-R02-110-8 500 0.8 0.9 1 Copper extension nozzle 900 800 0.7 Supply pressure [MPa] Low noise nozzle with male thread Flow rate [l/min (ANR)] Chromated Anodized Anodized KNL3-06-200 KNL6-06-200 350 300 250 KNL3-06-150 KNL6-06-150 200 150 100 50 100 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 Supply pressure [MPa] 0.8 0.9 1 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1 Supply pressure [MPa] 77 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Flow Characteristics Note Material PBT PBT PBT Aluminium alloy Aluminium alloy Aluminium alloy PBT Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel HNBR Stainless steel PBT PBT NBR NBR Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 78 VMG Dimensions VMG11/Piping entry: Bottom Rc 1/4 156 Nozzle Note 1) Width across flats22 30 102 34.2 23 117.5 A Rc, NPT, G 1/4, 3/8 1) S coupler plug mounting .2 No te VMG12/Piping entry: Top 34 Width across flats 22 Rc, NPT, G 1/4, 3/8 Rc 1/4 147 S coupler plug mounting 172.5 Nozzle 23 102 30 A 117.5 (mm) Type Male thread nozzle High efficiency nozzle Nozzle model KN-R02-100 KN-R02-150 KN-R02-200 KN-R02-250 KNH-R02-100 KNH-R02-150 KNH-R02-200 Nozzle size ø1 ø1.5 ø2 ø2.5 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 A Note 1) 23.4 23 22.5 22.1 44 44 44 (mm) Type Low noise nozzle with male thread Copper extension nozzle (with self-align fitting H06-02) Nozzle model KNS-R02-075-4 KNS-R02-090-8 KNS-R02-100-4 KNS-R02-110-8 KNL3-06-150 KNL3-06-200 KNL6-06-150 KNL6-06-200 Note 1) Reference dimensions after installation 78 Nozzle size ø0.75 x 4 ø0.9 x 8 ø1 x 4 ø1.1 x 8 ø1.5 ø2 ø1.5 ø2 A Note 1) 12 12 12 12 305.3 305.3 605.3 605.3 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 79 Blow Gun Series VMG Dimensions: Nozzle/Series KN Male thread nozzle: KN (mm) Model D KN-R02-100 KN-R02-150 KN-R02-200 KN-R02-250 Connection Width across flats thread H1 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 ø2.5 R 1/4 R 1/4 R 1/4 R 1/4 14 14 14 14 L1 A 31.4 31 30.5 30.1 25.4 25 24.5 24.1 Connection thread øD Nozzle size H1 A L1 High efficiency nozzle: KNH (mm) D KNH-R02-100 KNH-R02-150 KNH-R02-200 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 R 1/4 R 1/4 R 1/4 14 14 14 L1 A 52 52 52 46 46 46 Connection thread H1 A L1 The air blow thrust is improved by 10%. Model D KNS-R02-075-4 KNS-R02-090-8 KNS-R02-100-4 KNS-R02-110-8 Connection Width across flats thread H1 ø0.75 x 4 ø0.9 x 8 ø1 x 4 ø1.1 x 8 R 1/4 R 1/4 R 1/4 R 1/4 14 14 14 14 L1 A 20 20 20 20 14 14 14 14 øD (mm) Nozzle size 2 H1 Connection thread A L1 Copper extension nozzle: KNL Outside diameter L1 KNL3-06-150 KNL3-06-200 KNL6-06-150 KNL6-06-200 ø1.5 ø6 300 ø2 ø6 300 ø1.5 ø6 600 ø2 ø6 600 Note) When a copper extension nozzle is ordered separately, a self-align fitting will also be required for connection with the blow gun. Order one with the following part number in addition to the nozzle. Outside diameter D øD Model (mm) Nozzle size L1 Self-align fittings (For copper extension nozzle connection) Half union H06-02 79 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Low noise nozzle with male thread: KNS øD Nozzle size Model Connection Width across flats thread H1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 80 Air Blow Nozzles for Blowing Air Tool Series KN Coolant Nozzle with self-align fitting/KN KN-04-100 KN-04-150 KN-06-100 KN-06-150 KN-06-200 KN-08-150 KN-08-200 KN-10-250 KN-10-300 KN-10-350 KN-10-400 KN-10-600 KN-12-350 KN-12-400 KN-12-600 KN-16-400 KN-16-600 KN-20-400 KN-20-600 ø1 ø1.5 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 ø1.5 ø2 ø2.5 ø3 ø3.5 ø4 ø6 ø3.5 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø4 ø6 ø6 ø6 ø8 ø8 ø10 ø10 ø10 ø10 ø10 ø12 ø12 ø12 ø16 ø16 ø20 ø20 Width across flats H1 H2 10 10 12 12 12 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 17 17 17 22 22 26 26 10 10 12 12 12 14 14 17 17 17 17 17 19 19 19 24 24 27 27 L1 L2 27 27.7 30.1 30.8 31.5 33.8 34.6 35.6 36.3 37.1 29.5 27.7 40.4 41.3 31.2 40.1 38.4 45.6 43.9 15 15 16 16 16 16 16 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 øD Model (mm) Nozzle size Connection D size H1 H2 L2 L1 Nozzle with male thread/KN (mm) Connection size Width across flats H1 KN-R01-100 KN-R01-150 KN-R02-100 KN-R02-150 KN-R02-200 KN-R02-250 KN-R02-600 KN-R03-400 KN-R03-600 KN-R04-400 KN-R04-600 KN-R06-600 KN-R06-800 KN-R10-800 ø1 ø1.5 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 ø2.5 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø6 ø8 ø8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 R3/8 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2 R3/4 R3/4 R1 10 10 14 14 14 14 14 17 17 22 22 27 27 36 L1 A Connection thread 17.4 17 25.4 25 24.5 24.1 21.1 25.4 23.7 33.6 31.8 40.1 38 52.4 21.4 21 31.4 31 30.5 30.1 27.1 31.8 30.1 41.8 40.1 49.6 47.8 62.8 øD Model Nozzle size D H1 L1 Copper extension nozzle/KNL 80 A Outside diameter L1 KNL3-06-150 KNL3-06-200 KNL3-08-200 KNL3-08-250 KNL3-10-250 KNL3-10-300 KNL6-06-150 KNL6-06-200 KNL6-08-200 KNL6-08-250 KNL6-10-250 KNL6-10-300 ø1.5 ø2 ø2 ø2.5 ø2.5 ø3 ø1.5 ø2 ø2 ø2.5 ø2.5 ø3 ø6 ø6 ø8 ø8 ø10 ø10 ø6 ø6 ø8 ø8 ø10 ø10 300 300 300 300 300 300 600 600 600 600 600 600 øD Model O.D. (mm) Nozzle size D L1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Page 81 Series Nozzles for Blowing KN Nozzle for One-touch fitting/KN Note) Not applicable to the connection threads (M5, M6) of the KJ and the KQ series. Model Connection size L1 A KN-Q06-100 KN-Q06-150 KN-Q06-200 KN-Q08-150 KN-Q08-200 KN-Q10-200 KN-Q10-250 KN-Q12-250 KN-Q12-300 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 ø1.5 ø2 ø2 ø2.5 ø2.5 ø3 ø6 ø6 ø6 ø8 ø8 ø10 ø10 ø12 ø12 35 35 35 39 39 43 43 45.5 45.5 18 18 18 20.5 20.5 22 22 24 24 øD (mm) Nozzle size D 10 A L1 Pivoting nozzle with self-align fitting/KNK KNK-10-400 KNK-10-600 KNK-12-400 KNK-12-600 KNK-16-400 KNK-16-600 KNK-20-400 KNK-20-600 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø10 ø10 ø12 ø12 ø16 ø16 ø20 ø20 Width across flats H1 H2 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 19 19 24 24 27 27 L1 L2 41.7 41.7 41.2 41.2 41.8 41.8 43.8 43.8 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 35° øD Model (mm) Nozzle size Connection D size H2 L2 8.5 L1 Pivoting nozzle with male thread/KNK ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 ø4 ø6 R1/4 R1/4 R3/8 R3/8 R1/2 R1/2 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 17 22 22 L1 A 38 38 39 39 42.2 42.2 31.9 31.9 32.4 32.4 34.1 34.1 Connection thread 35° øD H2 H1 8.5 A L1 High efficiency nozzle/KNH (mm) Model Nozzle size D KNH-R02-100 KNH-R02-150 KNH-R02-200 ø1 ø1.5 ø2 Connection Width across flats size H1 14 14 14 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 L1 A 52 52 52 46 46 46 Connection thread A The air blow thrust is improved by 10%. øD KNK-R02-400 KNK-R02-600 KNK-R03-400 KNK-R03-600 KNK-R04-400 KNK-R04-600 Width across flats H1 H2 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Model (mm) Nozzle size Connection D size H1 L1 Low noise nozzle with self-align fitting/KNS Width across flats H2 H1 L2 24.3 24.3 24 24 24 16 16 17 17 17 ø8 ø8 ø10 ø10 ø10 12 12 14 14 14 Model Nozzle size D Connection size Width across flats H1 L1 A KNS-R01-075-4 KNS-R01-100-4 KNS-R01-090-8 KNS-R02-075-4 KNS-R02-090-8 KNS-R02-100-4 KNS-R02-110-8 ø0.75 x 4 ø1 x 4 ø0.9 x 8 ø0.75 x 4 ø0.9 x 8 ø1 x 4 ø1.1 x 8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/8 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 R1/4 12 12 12 14 14 14 14 18 18 18 20 20 20 20 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 KNS-08-075-4 KNS-08-100-4 KNS-10-075-4 KNS-10-090-8 KNS-10-100-4 ø0.75 x 4 ø1 x 4 ø0.75 x 4 ø0.9 x 8 ø1 x 4 14 14 17 17 17 L1 L2 øD Model (mm) Nozzle size Connection D size H1 H2 2 L1 Low noise nozzle with male thread/KNS øD (mm) 2 H1 A L1 Connection thread 81 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:27 AM Series Page 82 KN Sensing Heads Standard sensing head (mm) KNP-1 ø2.5 Connection Width across flats H1 H2 size ø4 5 8 L1 L2 63.7 1000 L1 L2 øD Model Nozzle size D ∗ A 1 m polyurethane tube is included. H1 H2 Polyurethane tubing Needle sensing head (mm) ø0.7 ø4 5 A L1 L2 L3 12.7 41 1000 23 A L2 ∗ A 1 m polyurethane tube is included. L3 L1 Polyurethane tubing Cassette size KNP-2 Connection Cassette size H1 size øD Model Nozzle size D Use to measure workpiece collision pressure. Standard sensing head Needle sensing head Specifications Nozzle (KN, KNK, KNH, KNS, KNL) Applicable tubing material Nylon, Soft nylon, Flexible copper pipe (C1220T-O), OST pipe Applicable piping O.D. mm ø4, ø6, ø8, ø10, ø12, ø16, ø20 Fluid Air, Coolant Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa (0.3 MPa with SGP pipe) Ambient and fluid temperature –5 to 60°C (with no freezing) Threads Mounting Nut Seal for R threads JISB0203 (taper threads for piping) JISB0211, class 2 (taper threads for piping) None Sensing head (KNP) Applicable fitting size Fluid 82 ø4 Air Maximum operating pressure (at 20°C) 0.8 MPa Ambient and fluid temperature –5 to 60°C (with no freezing) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 83 Air Blow S Couplers Air Tool Series KK Air Leakage Variations Series KK KK Male thread type Series Connection thread size R M5 R 1/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/2 R 3/4 KK2 KK3 KK4 KK6 Female thread type Series Connection thread size Rc M5 Rc 1/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/2 KK2 KK3 KK4 KK6 Nut fitting type (for fiber reinforced urethane hose) Series Applicable hose I.D./O.D. mm 5/8 6/9 6.5/10 8/12 8.5/12.5 11/16 Series KK3, 4, 6 KK3 KK4 KK6 One-touch fitting type (Straight, Elbow, Bulkhead) Series Applicable tubing O.D. mm ø3.2 ø4 ø6 ø8 ø10 ø12 ø16 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment KK2 KK3 KK4 KK6 Series KK2 Series KKH Male thread type Series Connection thread size R R 1/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/2 KKH3 KKH4 Female thread type Series Connection thread size Rc Rc 1/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 KKH3 KKH4 Nut fitting type (for fiber reinforced urethane hose) Series Applicable hose I.D./O.D. mm 5/8 6/9 6.5/10 8/12 8.5/12.5 KKH3 KKH4 Series KKA Stainless type Male/Female thread type Series Connection thread size R, Rc 1/8 R, Rc 1/4 R, Rc 3/8 R, Rc 1/2 R, Rc 3/4 R, Rc 1 R, Rc 1 1/4 R, Rc 1 1/2 KKA3 KKA4 KKA6 KKA7 KKA8 KKA9 83 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 84 KK The pulling strength for the plugs and sockets has been improved. Twice as strong as the conventional models We standardized the product with a sleeve cover. Changing the lock ring material to a shock absorbent PBT further improved the shock absorbent performance. Lock ring Shock absorbent PBT Employs a unique connection method No spring located in the flow path Loss of effective area is minimized because there is no valve spring to block the flow path. Check valve end configuration facilitates rectifying effect A slim body design and large effective area are achieved with a construction that does not use steel balls and therefore does not restrict the flow path. Allows smooth flow of fluids. Low leakage seal construction Sleeve cover (Except for Series KK2) Reliable sealing is achieved by surface contact. Lightweight Together with a reduction of the body size, pressing parts and resin parts are used to achieve an overall weight reduction. Series Series KK2 Series KK3 Series KK4 Series KK6 Plug no. KK2P-M5M KK3P-01MS KK4P-02MS KK6P-04MS Socket no. Effective area mm2 Note 1) Body O.D. mm Weight g Note 2) KK2S-M5M 3.8 ø10.0 6.1 KK3S-01MS 20 ø20.2 20.1 KK4S-02MS 39 ø28.0 44.1 KK6S-04MS 82 ø31.6 90.1 Note 1) Values when plug and socket are connected. Note 2) Values for socket only. One-touch fitting type now standard Three types from ø4 to ø16 added to series. Flow is possible from the plug side or socket side. Fluids: Air and Water One-touch connection Elbow type Simple connection with one hand simplifies work. Bulkhead type q w Click Straight type Sleeve lock mechanism Prevents accidents caused by unexpected separation. Lock 84 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 85 S Couplers Series KK Socket (S) Plug (P) Male thread type Male thread type Body size M5 1/8 1/4 1/2 Port size M5 x 0.8 R 1/8 R 1/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/2 R 3/8 R 1/2 R 3/4 Body size Part no. KK2P-M5M -01MS KK3P-01MS -02MS -03MS KK4P-01MS -02MS -03MS -04MS KK6P-03MS -04MS -06MS Female thread type M5 1/8 1/4 1/2 Port size M5 x 0.8 R 1/8 R 1/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/2 R 3/8 R 1/2 R 3/4 KK2S-M5M -01MS KK3S-01MS -02MS -03MS KK4S-01MS -02MS -03MS -04MS KK6S-03MS -04MS -06MS Part no. Port size M5 x 0.8 Rc 1/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/2 KK2S-M5F KK3S-01F -02F -03F KK4S-02F -03F KK6S-03F -04F Female thread type Body size M5 1/8 1/4 1/2 Port size M5 x 0.8 Rc 1/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/2 KK2P-M5F KK3P-01F -02F -03F KK4P-02F -03F KK6P-03F -04F Part no. KK3P-50N -60N -65N KK4P-50N -60N -65N -80N -85N KK6P-80N -85N -110N Part no. KK2P-23H -04H -06H KK3P-04H -06H -08H -10H KK4P-06H -08H -10H -12H KK6P-12H -16H Part no. KK2P-23L -04L -06L KK3P-04L -06L -08L -10L KK4P-06L -08L -10L -12L KK6P-12L -16L Part no. KK2P-23E -04E -06E KK3P-04E -06E -08E -10E KK4P-06E -08E -10E -12E KK6P-12E -16E Body size M5 1/8 1/4 1/2 Nut fitting type (for fiber reinforced urethane hose) Applicable hose I.D./O.D. mm Body size 5/8 6/9 1/8 6.5/10 5/8 6/9 6.5/10 1/4 8/12 8.5/12.5 8/12 8.5/12.5 1/2 11/16 Straight type with One-touch fitting Applicable tubing O.D. mm Body size 3.2 M5 4 6 4 6 1/8 8 10 6 8 1/4 10 12 12 1/2 16 Elbow type with One-touch fitting Applicable tubing O.D. mm Body size 3.2 M5 4 6 4 6 1/8 8 10 6 8 1/4 10 12 12 1/2 16 Bulkhead type with One-touch fitting Applicable tubing O.D. mm Body size 3.2 4 M5 6 4 6 1/8 8 10 6 8 1/4 10 12 12 1/2 16 Part no. Part no. KK3S-50N -60N -65N KK4S-50N -60N -65N -80N -85N KK6S-80N -85N -110N Part no. KK2S-23H -04H -06H KK3S-04H -06H -08H -10H KK4S-06H -08H -10H -12H KK6S-12H -16H Part no. KK2S-23L -04L -06L KK3S-04L -06L -08L -10L KK4S-06L -08L -10L -12L KK6S-12L -16L Part no. KK2S-23E -04E -06E KK3S-04E -06E -08E -10E KK4S-06E -08E -10E -12E KK6S-12E -16E 85 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Nut fitting type (for fiber reinforced urethane hose) Applicable hose Body size I.D./O.D. mm 5/8 6/9 1/8 6.5/10 5/8 6/9 6.5/10 1/4 8/12 8.5/12.5 8/12 8.5/12.5 1/2 11/16 Straight type with One-touch fitting Applicable tubing O.D. mm Body size 3.2 M5 4 6 4 6 1/8 8 10 6 8 1/4 10 12 12 1/2 16 Elbow type with One-touch fitting Applicable Body size tubing O.D. mm 3.2 M5 4 6 4 6 1/8 8 10 6 8 1/4 10 12 12 1/2 16 Bulkhead type with One-touch fitting Applicable Body size tubing O.D. mm 3.2 4 M5 6 4 6 1/8 8 10 6 8 1/4 10 12 12 1/2 16 Part no. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 86 KK Specifications Fluid Air, Water (standard industrial water) KK2: –100 kPa to 1.0 MPa KK3: –90 kPa to 1.0 MPa KK4, 6: 0 to 1.0 MPa Note) Operating pressure range Proof pressure Series KK2 1.5 MPa Air: –5 to 60°C Water: 5 to 40°C (with no freezing) Electroless nickel plated (copper-free application), With male thread sealant Ambient and fluid temperature Plating, Sealant Note) Do not use the S couplers with a leakage tester or for vacuum retention because they are not guaranteed for zero leakage. Performance Plug and socket connection One-touch connection and release Check valve Series KK3, 4, 6 Socket: Built-in check valve (standard) Sleeve lock mechanism Note) Manual locking type (standard) Note) Series KK2 is not provided with lock mechanism. JIS symbols Single plug Effective Area Single socket Body size Connected plug and socket Plug Socket Effective area mm2 M5 KK2P-M5M KK2S-M5M 3.8 1/8 KK3P-01MS KK3S-01MS 20 1/4 KK4P-02MS KK4S-02MS 39 1/2 KK6P-04MS KK6S-04MS 82 How to Order KK 4 S 02 M S Body size 2 3 4 6 M5 1/8 1/4 1/2 Connection type Symbol Socket/Plug designation S P With sealant (male thread) Socket Plug Type Male thread M Female thread F With nut fitting N H Straight with One-touch fitting Elbow with One-touch fitting L E Bulkhead with One-touch fitting Piping port size variation Male/Female thread type Thread size Symbol M5 x 0.8 M5 R,Rc 1/8 01 R,Rc 1/4 02 R,Rc 3/8 03 R,Rc 1/2 04 R,Rc 3/4 06 86 One-touch fitting type Symbol Tubing O.D. mm ø3.2 23 ø4 04 ø6 06 ø8 08 ø10 10 ø12 12 ø16 16 Nut fitting type Symbol Hose O.D./I.D. mm 5/8 50 6/9 60 6.5/10 65 8/12 80 8.5/12.5 85 11/16 110 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 87 S Couplers Series KK Flow Characteristics Air (0 to 1 MPa) Water (0 to 0.4MPa) KK2 KK2 0.007 0.50 Series KK2 (KK2S-M5M + KK2P-M5M) 0.45 Series KK2 (KK2S-M5M + KK2P-M5M) 0.006 0.40 0.005 Flow rate (l /min [ANR]) Flow rate (l /min [ANR]) 0.35 0.30 0.25 0.20 0.15 0.004 0.003 0.002 0.10 0.001 0.05 0.00 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 0.000 1 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Pressure (MPa) Pressure (MPa) KK3, 4, 6 KK3, 4, 6 0.14 11 0.13 10 Series KK6 (KK6S-04MS + KK6P-04MS) 9 Series KK6 (KK6S-04MS + KK6P-04MS) 0.12 0.11 0.10 Flow rate (l /min [ANR]) Flow rate (l /min [ANR]) 8 7 6 5 Series KK4 (KK4S-02MS + KK4P-02MS) 4 0.09 0.08 Series KK4 (KK4S-02MS + KK4P-02MS) 0.07 0.06 0.05 0.04 3 0.03 2 0.02 1 0 Series KK3 (KK3S-01MS + KK3P-01MS) 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 Pressure (MPa) 0.7 0.8 0.9 Series KK3 (KK3S-01MS + KK3P-01MS) 0.01 1 0.00 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 Pressure (MPa) 87 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 88 KK Construction KK2 q w q w e r t y u i o !0 !1 !3 !2 Plug Socket Plug No. 1 2 Socket Description Plug body Gasket Material Brass Stainless steel, NBR Note Electroless nickel plated KK3, 4, 6 No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Description Spacer Chuck Sleeve Collar Sleeve spring Plug O-ring Valve seat Valve spring Valve seat O-ring Valve O-ring Valve Socket body Gasket Material PBT PBT Brass Brass Stainless steel NBR PBT Stainless steel NBR FKM PBT Brass Stainless steel, NBR <With One-touch fitting> q i u !7 !3 r !6 !1 t y !2 e !0 o w q Plug Plug 88 Electroless nickel plated Electroless nickel plated Electroless nickel plated <With One-touch fitting> !4 !5 No. 1 14 15 Note !5 !4 Socket Socket Description Plug body Cassette Seal Material Brass — NBR Note Electroless nickel plated No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 Description Socket body Valve Valve seat Collar Spacer Lock ring Sleeve Chuck Valve O-ring Valve seat O-ring Plug O-ring Valve spring Sleeve spring Cassette Seal Collar 2 Sleeve cover Material Brass PBT PBT PBT PBT Shock absorbent PBT Cold rolled carbon steel sheet Stainless steel FKM NBR NBR Stainless steel Stainless steel — NBR Stainless steel Weather resistant NBR Note Electroless nickel plated Electroless nickel plated ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 89 S Couplers Series KK Dimensions/Plug (P) Male thread type (mm) Body size KK2 M5 1/8 T H Model Connection L1 Width male thread across flats M5 x 0.8 7 KK2P-M5M 18.8 R 1/8 -01MS 23.2 10 R 1/8 KK3P-01MS 30.4 R 1/4 14 -02MS 33.4 12.3 R 3/8 19.9 -03MS KK3·4·6 1/4 1/2 17 36.9 KK4P-01MS R 1/8 -02MS R 1/4 -03MS R 3/8 17 42.2 -04MS R 1/2 22 46.2 KK6P-03MS R 3/8 19 48.0 -04MS R 1/2 22 52.0 -06MS R 3/4 27 55.0 14 L2 18.4 Minimum Effective Weight area A∗ bore (g) (mm2) 15.8 2.5 4.4 2.6 19.2 8.1 8.4 27.4 14.2 6.0 30.4 33.0 40.2 34.2 22.6 44.0 45.5 L2 L1 20.2 35.7 41.5 H 28.1 17.0 9.0 50.9 38.2 31.0 A T 3.0 26.4 37.0 25.2 3.4 KK2 32.5 57.4 11.0 76.0 13.0 106.2 KK3·4·6 A T 44.7 53.7 94.4 ∗ Reference dimension for R threads after installation. L2 H L1 Female thread type (mm) Model M5 KK2P-M5F M5 x 0.8 KK3P-01F Rc 1/8 -02F Rc 1/4 17 35.0 -03F Rc 3/8 19 36.8 KK4P-02F Rc 1/4 17 37.2 Rc 3/8 19 Rc 1/2 24 1/8 1/4 1/2 -03F KK6P-03F -04F L1 L2 8 17.6 12.3 14 28.3 18.4 39.8 43.3 50.2 Minimum Effective Weight area bore (g) (mm2) 8.1 3.4 2.6 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment T H Connection Width male thread across flats Body size T 10.4 22.6 6.0 19.0 20.8 23.2 50.9 9.0 25.2 106.2 13.0 31.0 23.9 24.6 L2 H L1 28.6 43.9 Nut fitting type (for urethane hose with fiber reinforcement) Body size Model KK3P-50N 1/8 1/4 1/2 Applicable H1 H2 hose Width Width I.D./O.D. (mm) across flats across flats 5/8 -60N 6/9 -65N 6.5/10 KK4P-50N 5/8 -60N 6/9 -65N 6.5/10 -80N 8/12 -85N 8.5/12.5 KK6P-80N 8/12 -85N 8.5/12.5 -110N 11/16 14 17 (mm) L1 14 36.1 17 39.9 14 43.9 17 46.7 L2 M 13.7 18.4 16.5 13.7 25.2 16.5 47.6 19 19 17.4 53.4 24 24 57.2 31.0 20.1 Weight Minimum Effective area bore (g) (mm2) 4.5 12.7 21.4 5.4 18.3 38.8 5.9 21.9 35.9 4.5 12.7 34.7 5.4 18.3 48.4 5.9 21.9 45.1 7.4 34.4 53.2 7.8 38.2 55.6 7.4 34.4 60.5 7.8 38.2 62.8 10.2 65.4 96.5 Applicable hose H1 H2 M L2 L1 89 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 90 KK Dimensions/Plug (P) Straight type with One-touch fitting Applicable tubing O.D. (mm) KK2P-23H ø3.2 øD1 øD2 L1 M L2 tubing M5 -04H 10.0 20.5 8.0 -06H ø6 ø4 12.0 10.0 -06H ø6 14.0 12.0 -08H ø8 16.0 14.0 38.6 -10H ø10 19.0 17.0 39.7 KK4P-06H ø6 14.0 12.0 -08H ø8 16.0 14.0 -10H ø10 19.0 17.0 1/4 -12H KK6P-12H -16H 10.0 ø12 21.0 19.0 ø16 26.0 25.7 3.7 4.4 3.4 8.1 8.1 16.0 3.2 3.9 5.6 17.0 4.7 10.1 12.8 13.5 35.4 18.4 18.5 25.2 47.5 31.0 22.6 22.6 3.3 3.4 9.1 13.2 17.6 10.1 12.8 22.3 18.5 6.2 19.8 22.6 23.0 21.0 7.7 27.6 35.3 27.1 9.0 40.2 9.2 41.2 13.0 — 25.0 106.2 M 7.9 4.7 50.9 Applicable tubing 4.0 17.0 22.0 56.1 15.7 6.0 21.0 46.2 tubing 2.5 12.7 12.3 23.5 KK3P-04H 1/8 1/2 ø4 7.0 øD1 Model øD2 Body size (mm) Effective area (mm2) Minimum Weight bore Urethane Nylon (g) L2 L1 30.0 44.4 50.7 Elbow type with One-touch fitting 1/8 Applicable tubing O.D. (mm) KK2P-23L ø3.2 -04L ø4 -06L ø6 ø4 -06L ø6 -08L ø8 -10L ø10 17.0 ø6 14.0 ø8 -08L -10L -12L 1/2 KK6P-12L -16L øD2 L1 10.0 12.0 ø10 17.0 ø12 19.0 ø16 21.0 L3 L2 M tubing tubing 16.5 12.7 2.5 3.6 4.3 5.8 16.6 13.5 18.0 16.0 3.4 7.8 7.8 6.4 3.0 3.7 5.3 7.2 20.0 17.0 12.8 32.8 18.4 23.0 18.5 15.2 34.0 26.5 21.0 18.5 36.0 4.5 10.1 11.4 8.0 15.0 16.8 9.7 20.0 17.0 12.8 40.2 15.2 41.4 25.2 23.0 18.5 26.5 21.0 18.5 42.8 4.5 10.1 11.4 19.6 6.0 17.5 19.8 21.3 7.5 24.7 27.5 25.7 9.3 24.0 KK3P-04L KK4P-06L 1/4 øD1 12.3 11.6 25.1 10.4 31.6 44.0 28.5 22.0 49.9 31.0 34.0 25.0 26.5 53.5 20.9 6.0 9.0 13.0 øD2 Applicable tubing øD1 M5 Model L3 M Body size (mm) Effective area (mm2) Minimum Weight bore Urethane Nylon (g) 18.0 18.5 23.0 L2 L1 29.0 29.6 28.0 38.1 39.7 40.3 — 58.7 48.7 Bulkhead type with One-touch fitting Body size Model KK2P-23E M5 1/8 1/4 90 Applicable tubing O.D. (mm) ø3.2 M8 x 0.75 ø4 M9 x 0.75 -06E ø6 M11 x 0.75 KK3P-04E ø4 M12 x 1 -06E ø6 M14 x 1 -08E ø8 M16 x 1 -10E ø10 M20 x 1 KK4P-06E ø6 M14 x 1 -08E ø8 M16 x 1 -10E ø10 M20 x 1 KK6P-12E -16E H1 H2 flats flats T Width Width Thread across across -04E -12E 1/2 (mm) 10 14 17 22 17 22 10 11 14 L1 28.3 43.4 24 46.4 17 47.0 19 50.2 24 53.2 ø16 M28 x 1.5 30 32 M 18.4 25.2 54.2 60.1 62.6 12.5 12.7 3.7 4.4 6.0 8.1 3.2 3.9 5.6 16.6 16.8 17.0 20.0 18.5 4.7 10.1 12.8 22.3 15.7 30.2 22.0 21.0 16.8 17.0 22.6 20.0 18.5 22.0 21.0 6.0 22.6 9.7 54.7 4.7 10.1 12.8 6.2 19.8 22.6 7.7 27.6 35.3 30.6 9.0 40.2 50.9 9.2 41.2 75.2 24.5 25.0 13.0 — Applicable tubing 6.6 8.1 23.0 22.0 31.0 2.5 3.4 12.7 13.5 16.9 16.0 39.3 40.2 27 12.3 28.6 19 24 L3 tubing tubing 17 ø12 M22 x 1 L2 Effective area (mm2) Minimum Weight bore Urethane Nylon (g) 38.2 61.4 86.1 106.2 125.0 H2 T Mounting plate thickness 7mm or less H1 M L3 L2 L1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 91 S Couplers Series KK Dimensions/Socket (S) Male thread type M5 1/8 KK3·4·6 1/4 1/2 Model KK2S-M5M M5 x 0.8 8 10 -01MS R 1/8 KK3S-01MS R 1/8 -02MS R 1/4 -03MS R 3/8 KK4S-01MS R 1/8 -02MS R 1/4 -03MS R 3/8 -04MS R 1/2 KK6S-03MS R 3/8 -04MS R 1/2 -06MS R 3/4 14 17 19 22 24 27 10.0 20.2 2.5 24.7 26.2 23.7 21.7 25.3 26.8 22.8 37.5 40.0 3.8 KK2 A2 A1 T 6.1 4.7 5.8 9.1 6.0 20.4 20.1 33.5 36.0 31.5 34.0 38.7 41.2 32.2 34.5 50.4 54.1 46.4 50.1 51.0 54.7 45.0 48.7 9.0 21.1 øD Body size L2 19.2 29.0 6.0 22.9 47.5 9.0 38.9 44.1 28.0 50.0 53.7 43.5 47.2 11.0 40.4 50.9 49.7 53.4 41.7 45.4 13.0 42.7 61.2 53.7 59.0 11.0 71.7 87.9 31.6 60.2 65.5 52.2 57.5 13.0 82.3 90.1 50.7 56.0 15.0 83.8 113.3 ∗ Reference dimension for R threads after installation. L1 L2 H KK3·4·6 A2 A1 T øD KK2 (mm) Effective A2∗ L1 When A1 ∗ When Minimum area Weight bore (mm2) (g) connected connected H T Width øD Connection across male thread flats L1 L2 H M5 1/8 KK3·4·6 1/4 1/2 Model øD L1 10.0 25.3 26.8 36.0 38.5 40.1 42.6 41.9 44.4 50.4 54.1 51.1 54.8 58.6 63.9 61.0 66.3 KK2S-M5F M5 x 0.8 8 KK3S-01F Rc 1/8 14 -02F Rc 1/4 17 -03F Rc 3/8 KK4S-02F Rc 1/4 -03F KK6S-03F -04F 20.2 19 28.0 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/2 24 31.6 L2 Effective Weight When Minimum area (g) bore connected (mm2) 4.2 8.2 10.9 14.4 18.0 5.4 6.4 20.6 23.6 21.1 34.4 L1 L2 38.8 39.6 56.9 42.7 46.2 83.1 93.6 83.8 87.4 T KK2 øD Body size H Width across flats H T KK3·4·6 øD KK2 T Connection male thread L1 L2 H Nut fitting type (for urethane hose with fiber reinforcement) 1/8 1/4 1/2 Model KK3S-50N 5/8 -60N 6/9 -65N 6.5/10 KK4S-50N 5/8 -60N 6/9 -65N 6.5/10 -80N 8/12 -85N 8.5/12.5 KK6S-80N 8/12 -85N 8.5/12.5 -110N 11/16 14 17 øD 14 17 20.2 14 19 17 28.0 (mm) L1 L2 When connected M 42.6 45.1 13.7 44.4 46.9 16.5 54.1 57.8 13.7 56.8 60.5 55.4 59.1 66.0 71.3 64.4 69.7 19 17.4 31.6 24 24 16.5 20.1 Minimum Effective Weight area bore (mm2) (g) 4.5 12.2 32.1 5.4 18.3 48.7 5.9 19.2 46.4 4.5 12.2 55.8 5.4 20.4 69.3 5.9 24.1 66.8 7.4 35.1 68.5 7.8 7.4 36.6 71.1 107.5 7.8 41.2 110.2 10.2 68.4 119.8 Applicable hose H1 H2 øD Body size H1 H2 Applicable Width Width hose across across I.D./O.D. (mm) flats flats M L1 L2 91 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment (mm) Female thread type ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 92 KK Dimensions/Socket (S) Straight type with One-touch fitting ø3.2 2 When connected 7.0 33.8 35.3 8.0 33.6 35.1 2.5 3.8 4.6 6.4 3.4 4.0 4.8 6.5 13.5 4.7 5.8 5.8 7.9 49.1 16.0 3.2 3.8 5.8 22.5 47.1 49.6 17.0 4.7 10.4 13.4 24.4 48.9 51.4 18.5 6.2 16.8 18.9 27.3 17.0 49.9 52.4 21.0 7.7 19.1 19.1 37.1 ø6 12.0 58.2 61.9 17.0 4.7 10.4 13.4 51.4 -08H ø8 14.0 60.1 63.8 18.5 6.2 18.3 21.8 51.3 -10H ø10 17.0 61.5 65.2 21.0 7.7 27.0 29.4 54.8 62.5 66.2 30.5 32.0 59.4 70.1 75.4 42.7 48.8 84.1 72.3 77.6 53.4 62.5 99.9 10.0 ø4 -06H ø6 10.0 33.9 35.4 KK3S-04H ø4 10.0 46.6 -06H ø6 12.0 -08H ø8 14.0 -10H ø10 KK4S-06H KK3·4·6 1/4 (mm ) Minimum Weight (g) bore Urethane Nylon tubing tubing M -12H KK6S-12H -16H 20.2 28.0 ø12 ø16 19.0 31.6 25.7 12.7 22.0 25.0 9.2 13.2 KK2 Applicable tubing M L1 L2 KK3·4·6 Applicable tubing M L1 L2 Elbow type with One-touch fitting (mm) 1/8 KK3·4·6 1/4 1/2 ø4 -06L ø6 KK3S-04L ø4 -06L ø6 -08L ø8 -10L ø10 KK4S-06L ø6 -08L ø8 -10L ø10 KK6S-12L -16L 28.0 ø12 ø16 31.6 When connected 2 L3 M (mm ) Minimum Weight bore Urethane Nylon (g) tubing tubing 9.3 26.0 27.5 16.5 12.7 2.5 3.7 4.4 11.6 27.2 28.3 16.6 13.5 10.4 41.7 44.2 18.0 16.0 12.8 42.9 45.4 20.0 17.0 4.5 5.6 5.6 7.2 3.0 3.7 5.3 23.2 4.5 10.1 11.4 24.0 15.2 43.1 45.6 23.0 18.5 18.5 42.9 45.4 26.5 21.0 12.8 54.3 58.0 20.0 17.0 6.0 15.0 16.8 25.0 7.5 18.0 18.5 34.4 4.5 10.1 11.4 53.5 15.2 55.5 59.2 23.0 18.5 18.5 54.2 57.9 26.5 21.0 6.0 17.5 19.8 53.1 7.5 24.7 27.5 54.7 55.4 59.1 28.5 22.0 20.9 66.3 71.6 26.5 66.9 72.2 34.0 25.0 9.0 29.0 29.6 57.0 38.1 39.7 91.4 50.3 58.7 93.5 10.0 20.2 L1 13.0 øD2 KK2 Applicable tubing M L3 ø3.2 -04L -12L L2 øD2 6.7 L1 L2 KK3·4·6 øD2 Applicable tubing M L3 KK2S-23L M5 Applicable tubing øD1 O.D. (mm) øD1 Model Effective area øD1 KK2 Body size L1 L2 (mm) Bulkhead type with One-touch fitting M5 1/8 KK3·4·6 KK2S-23E ø3.2 M8 x 0.75 -04E ø4 M9 x 0.75 -06E ø6 M11 x 0.75 KK3S-04E ø4 M12 x 1 -06E ø6 M14 x 1 -08E ø8 M16 x 1 -10E ø10 M20 x 1 ø6 M14 x 1 KK4S-06E 1/4 -08E -10E -12E 1/2 H1 Applicable T Width tubing Thread across O.D. (mm) flats KK6S-12E -16E ø8 M16 x 1 ø10 M20 x 1 10 14 17 22 19 H2 Width across øD flats L2 L1 When connected 10 33.8 35.3 11 10.0 33.5 35.0 L3 M 13.0 12.7 2.5 3.8 4.6 3.4 4.0 4.8 9.1 33.9 35.4 13.1 13.5 4.7 5.8 5.8 12.6 14 46.6 49.1 16.9 16.0 3.2 3.8 5.8 29.0 17 47.1 49.6 16.8 17.0 4.7 10.4 13.4 39.4 49.0 51.5 20.0 18.5 6.2 16.8 18.9 43.4 24 49.9 52.4 22.0 21.0 7.7 19.1 19.1 68.3 17 58.2 61.9 16.8 17.0 4.7 10.4 13.4 57.2 60.1 63.8 20.0 18.5 6.2 18.3 21.8 60.6 61.7 65.4 22.0 21.0 7.7 27.0 29.4 86.8 19 19 22 24 ø12 M22 x 1 24 27 ø16 M28 x 1.5 30 32 20.2 28.0 62.7 66.4 23.0 22.0 31.6 70.1 75.4 72.5 77.8 24.5 25.0 9.2 Mounting plate thickness 7mm or less 9.6 14 42.7 48.8 116.0 H2 T H1 M L3 L1 L2 KK3·4·6 Applicable tubing H2 T Mounting plate thickness 7 mm or less H1 30.5 32.0 105.7 13.2 53.4 62.5 183.2 Applicable tubing KK2 (mm2) Minimum Weight bore Urethane Nylon (g) tubing tubing øD KK2 Model Effective area øD Body size M L3 92 øD2 L1 -04H 1/8 1/2 L2 øD2 øD2 KK2S-23H M5 Applicable tubing øD1 O.D. (mm) øD1 KK2 Model øD1 Body size (mm) Effective area L1 L2 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 93 S Couplers Series KKH Able to absorb drop impact (equivalent to impact energy of 0.5 J). The pulling strength for the plugs and sockets has been improved. Twice as strong as the conventional models. Spacer (High impact PBT) Cover ring (Super high impact PBT) (Rubber) Plug (P) Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Same effective sectional area as that of Series KK. Sleeve cover Socket (S) Male thread type Male thread type Body size 1/8 1/4 Connection port size Part no. R 1/8 KK3P-01MS R 1/4 -02MS R 3/8 -03MS R 3/8 -03MS R 1/8 KK4P-01MS R 1/8 KKH4S-01MS R 1/4 -02MS R 1/4 -02MS R 3/8 -03MS R 3/8 -03MS R 1/2 -04MS R 1/2 -04MS Female thread type Body size 1/8 1/4 1/8 1/4 1/8 1/4 Connection port size Part no. R 1/8 KKH3S-01MS R 1/4 -02MS Female thread type Connection port size Part no. Body size Connection port size Part no. Rc 1/8 KKH3S-01F Rc 1/4 -02F Rc 1/8 KK3P-01F Rc 1/4 -02F Rc 3/8 -03F Rc 3/8 -03F Rc 1/4 KK4P-02F Rc 1/4 KKH4S-02F Rc 3/8 -03F Rc 3/8 -03F Nut fitting type (for fiber reinforced urethane hose) Body size Body size Applicable hose I.D./O.D. mm Part no. 5/8 KK3P-50N 6/9 -60N 6.5/10 -65N 5/8 KK4P-50N 1/8 1/4 Nut fitting type (for fiber reinforced urethane hose) Body size 1/8 Applicable hose I.D./O.D. mm Part no. 5/8 KKH3S-50N 6/9 -60N 6.5/10 -65N 5/8 KKH4S-50N 6/9 -60N 6.5/10 -65N -80N 8/12 -80N -85N 8.5/12.5 -85N 6/9 -60N 6.5/10 -65N 8/12 8.5/12.5 1/4 Series KKH are only available as sockets. Series KK should be used as plugs. 93 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 94 KKH Specifications Fluid Air/Water (Standard industrial water) Note) Operating pressure range KKH3: –90 kPa to 1.0 MPa KKH4: 0 to 1.0 MPa Proof pressure 1.5 MPa Air: –5 to 60°C Water: 5 to 40°C (with no freezing) Ambient and fluid temperature Electroless nickel plated (Copper-free application), With male thread sealant Plating, Seal Connection plug Series KK plug Note) Do not use the S couplers with a leak tester or for vacuum retention because they are not guaranteed for zero leakage. Performance JIS symbol Single plug Single socket Plug and socket connection One-touch connection and release Check valve Connected plug and socket Socket: Built-in check valve (Standard) Sleeve lock mechanism ——— Effective Area Body size Plug Socket Effective area (mm2) 1/8 KK3P-01MS KK4P-02MS KKH3S-01MS KKH4S-02MS 20 1/4 The flow characteristics are the same as those of Series KK. Please refer to page 87. How to Order KKH 4 S 02 M S Body size 3 4 With seal (male thread) 1/8 1/4 Connection type Symbol Socket/Plug designation S Socket M F N Type Male thread Female thread With nut fitting Piping port size variations 94 Male/Female thread type Nut fitting type Symbol Connection port size R, Rc 1/8 01 R, Rc 1/4 02 R, Rc 3/8 03 R, Rc 1/2 04 Symbol Hose I.D./O.D. (mm) 5/8 50 6/9 60 6.5/10 65 8/12 80 8.5/12.5 85 39 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 95 S Couplers KKH Series Dimensions: Socket (S) Male thread type (mm) 1/8 1/4 H Connection Width port size across flats Model KKH3S-01MS R 1/8 -02MS R 1/4 -03MS R 3/8 KKH4S-01MS R 1/8 -02MS R 1/4 -03MS R 3/8 -04MS R 1/2 14 D 20.2 17 19 28.0 22 L1 L2 When connected A2∗ When connected Min. bore size 33.5 36.0 6.0 A1∗ Effective Weight area (g) (mm2) 20.4 T 20.3 37.5 40.0 31.5 34.0 9.0 38.7 41.2 32.2 34.5 9.0 50.4 54.1 46.4 50.1 6.0 22.9 48.7 51.0 54.7 45.0 48.7 9.0 38.9 45.3 50.0 53.7 43.5 47.2 11.0 40.4 52.1 49.7 53.4 41.7 45.4 13.0 42.7 62.4 21.1 A2 A1 øD Body size T 19.4 27.7 L1 L2 H ∗ Reference dimension for R threads after installation. Female thread type 1/4 H Connection Width port size across flats D L1 L2 When connected Min. bore size Effective Weight area (g) (mm2) KKH3S-01F Rc 1/8 14 36.0 38.5 -02F Rc 1/4 17 20.2 40.1 42.4 -03F Rc 3/8 19 41.9 44.3 KKH4S-02F Rc 1/4 50.4 54.1 10.9 39.6 58.1 -03F Rc 3/8 51.1 54.8 14.4 42.7 47.4 19 28.0 20.6 8.2 21.1 T 23.8 øD 1/8 T Model 33.1 37.1 L1 L2 Body size 1/8 1/4 Model Applicable H1 H2 hose Width Width I.D./O.D. mm across flats across flats KKH3S-50N 5/8 -60N 6/9 -65N 6.5/10 KKH4S-50N 5/8 -60N 6/9 -65N 6.5/10 -80N 8/12 -85N 8.5/12.5 14 17 (mm) D 14 17 20.2 14 19 17 19 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Nut fitting type (for fiber reinforced urethane hose) H 28.0 L2 L1 When connected M Min. bore size 42.6 45.1 13.7 4.5 12.2 32.3 5.4 18.3 48.9 5.9 19.2 46.6 4.5 12.2 57.0 5.4 20.4 70.5 L1 5.9 24.1 68.0 L2 7.4 35.1 69.7 7.8 36.6 72.3 44.4 46.9 16.5 54.1 57.8 13.7 56.8 60.5 16.5 55.4 59.1 17.4 Effective Weight area (g) (mm2) Applicable hose H1 H2 øD Body size (mm) M Series KKH are only available as sockets. Series KK should be used as plugs. For dimensions, please refer to page 89. 95 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 96 KKA Stainless steel type NEW Port sizes 1 to 1 1/2 are added. Body material: Stainless steel 304 Seal material: Fluoro rubber (FKM) Both plug and socket have an integral check valve. Available with and without check valves depending on the operating conditions. Series KKA7, 8, 9 Reduces liquid dripping when the plug and socket are uncoupled. Liquid dripping: 0.02 to 0.77 cm3 at each removal Aeration: 0.1 to 2.7 cm3 at each removal Plug valve Socket valve Non-greased specifications (standard) Allows smooth installation and removal even without grease. • O-ring: Fluorine coated • Sliding parts of plug and socket: Plated with fluorine-contained material Fluid: Water, Air Operating temperature range: –5 to 100°C Note) Do not use S couplers with steam. 96 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 97 S Couplers Male thread type Body size 1/8 1/4 With check valve 1/2 3/4 Without check valve 1 1 1/4 Part no. Port size With check valve Without check valve R 1/8 KKA3P-01M KKA3P-01M-1 R 1/4 -02M -02M-1 R 3/8 -03M -03M-1 R 1/4 KKA4P-02M KKA4P-02M-1 R 3/8 -03M -03M-1 R 1/2 -04M -04M-1 R 3/8 KKA6P-03M KKA6P-03M-1 R 1/2 -04M -04M-1 R 3/4 -06M -06M-1 R 1/2 KKA7P-04M — R 3/4 -06M — R1 -10M — R 3/4 KKA8P-06M — R1 -10M — R1 1/4 -12M — R1 KKA9P-10M — R1 1/4 -12M — R1 1/2 -14M — Female thread type 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 Without check valve 1 1/4 Body size 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 Port size R 1/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/4 R 3/8 R 1/2 R 3/8 R 1/2 R 3/4 R 1/2 R 3/4 R1 R 3/4 R1 R 1 1/4 R1 R 1 1/4 R 1 1/2 Part no. With check valve Without check valve KKA3S-01M -02M -03M KKA4S-02M -03M -04M KKA6S-03M -04M -06M KKA7S-04M -06M -10M KKA8S-06M -10M -12M KKA9S-10M -12M -14M KKA3S-01M-1 -02M-1 -03M-1 KKA4S-02M-1 -03M-1 -04M-1 KKA6S-03M-1 -04M-1 -06M-1 — — — — — — — — — Female thread type Part no. Port size With check valve Without check valve Rc 1/8 KKA3P-01F KKA3P-01F-1 -02F -02F-1 Rc 1/4 -03F -03F-1 Rc 3/8 KKA4P-02F KKA4P-02F-1 Rc 1/4 -03F -03F-1 Rc 3/8 -04F -04F-1 Rc 1/2 KKA6P-03F KKA6P-03F-1 Rc 3/8 -04F -04F-1 Rc 1/2 -06F -06F-1 Rc 3/4 — KKA7P-04F Rc 1/2 — -06F Rc 3/4 — -10F Rc 1 — KKA8P-06F Rc 3/4 — Rc 1 -10F — Rc 1 1/4 -12F — Rc 1 KKA9P-10F — Rc 1 1/4 -12F — Rc 1 1/2 -14F Body size 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 Port size Rc 1/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/2 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/2 Rc 3/4 Rc 1/2 Rc 3/4 Rc 1 Rc 3/4 Rc 1 Rc 1 1/4 Rc 1 Rc 1 1/4 Rc 1 1/2 Part no. With check valve Without check valve KKA3S-01F -02F -03F KKA4S-02F -03F -04F KKA6S-03F -04F -06F KKA7S-04F -06F -10F KKA8S-06F -10F -12F KKA9S-10F -12F -14F KKA3S-01F-1 -02F-1 -03F-1 KKA4S-02F-1 -03F-1 -04F-1 KKA6S-03F-1 -04F-1 -06F-1 — — — — — — — — — 97 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Body size With check valve KKA Socket (S) Plug (P) Male thread type Series ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 98 KKA Series Stainless Steel Type Specifications Fluid Water/Air Operating Note) pressure range KKA3: –100 kPa to 1.0 MPa KKA4, 6, 7, 8, 9: 0 to 1.0 MPa Proof pressure 10 MPa Ambient and fluid temperature Non-greased specification JIS symbol Single plug Single socket Material With check valve –5 to 150°C (No freezing) Note) Do not use with steam. No grease is used. Rubber: Fluorine coated, Metal sliding parts: Plated with fluorine-contained material Metal part: Stainless steel 304, Rubber material: Fluoro rubber (FKM) With male thread seal Seal Note) Do not use the S couplers with a leak tester or for vacuum retention because they are not guaranteed for zero leakage. Without check valve Performance Connected plug and socket One-touch connection and release Plug and socket connection Check valve on both sides: Plug and socket are available with and without check valves. Check valve Note) Series KKA cannot be connected with Series KK or Series KKH. Check valve on single side: Effective Area No check valve on either side: Built-in check valve Characteristics with Check Valve on Both Sides Body size Liquid dripping Aeration cm3 at each removal cm3 at each removal KKA3 0.02 Plug: With check valve Socket: With check valve 0.1 Effective area (mm2) Plug Socket KKA3P-01F KKA3S-01F 17.4 KKA4P-02F KKA4S-02F 26.4 KKA6P-04F KKA6S-04F 54.2 KKA7P-06F KKA7S-06F 99.6 KKA8S-10F 168.3 KKA4 0.04 0.1 KKA8P-10F KKA6 0.06 0.2 KKA9P-12F KKA9S-12F 332.1 KKA7 0.14 0.5 KKA3P-01M-1 KKA3S-01M 18.5 KKA8 0.27 0.9 KKA4P-02M-1 KKA4S-02M 31.8 KKA9 0.77 2.7 KKA6P-04M-1 KKA6S-04M 55.3 KKA3P-01M-1 KKA3S-01M-1 22.6 KKA4P-02M-1 KKA4S-02M-1 40.2 KKA6P-04M-1 KKA6S-04M-1 76.0 Without check valve Plug: Socket: With check valve Liquid dripping: Without check valve Plug: Socket: Without check valve Volume of water leakage at the time when the plug and socket are uncoupled. Aeration: Volume of external air entrained when the plug and socket are connected. How to Order KKA 4 P 02 M -1 Body size 3 4 6 7 8 9 Built-in check valve Built-in check valve Socket/Plug designation 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 P S Port size Symbol Plug Yes No No Yes Socket Yes Yes No No Availability With check valve -1 Without check valve Note) Plug Socket Note) A plug with check valve should be used in combination with a socket with check valve. If a socket without check valve is used, the check valve of the plug will not open. 98 Nil 01 02 03 04 06 10 12 14 Thread size R, Rc 1/8 R, Rc 1/4 R, Rc 3/8 R, Rc 1/2 R, Rc 3/4 R, Rc 1 R, Rc 1 1/4 R, Rc 1 1/2 Note) KKA7/8/9 is not available without a check valve. Contact us when such a type is needed. Connection type Symbol M F Type Mail thread (with seal) Female thread ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 99 S Couplers KKA Series Flow Characteristics Air Plug: With check valve Socket: With check valve Plug: With check valve Socket: With check valve 50 10 Series KKA6 (KKA6P-04F+KKA6S-04F) 40 7 6 5 Series KKA4 (KKA4P-02F+KKA4S-02F) 4 3 Flow rate m3/min (ANR) 8 Flow rate m3/min (ANR) Series KKA9 (KKA9P-12F+KKA9S-12F) 45 9 35 30 Series KKA8 (KKA8P-10F+KKA8S-10F) 25 20 15 10 2 1 5 Series KKA3 (KKA3P-01F+KKA3S-01F) Series KKA7 (KKA7P-06F+KKA7S-06F) 0 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 0 1.0 0.1 0.2 0.3 Pressure (MPa) 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 Plug: Without check valve Socket: Without check valve 10 9 9 8 Series KKA6 (KKA6P-04M-1+KKA6S-04M-1) 6 Series KKA4 (KKA4P-02M-1+KKA4S-02M) 5 4 3 Flow rate m3/min (ANR) 8 Series KKA6 (KKA6P-04M-1+KKA6S-04M) 2 7 Series KKA4 (KKA4P-02M-1+KKA4S-02M-1) 6 5 4 3 2 1 1 Series KKA3 (KKA3P-01M-1+KKA3S-01M) 0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 Series KKA3 (KKA3P-01M-1+KKA3S-01M-1) 0 1.0 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 Pressure (MPa) 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0 Pressure (MPa) Pressure Loss Water Plug: With check valve Socket: With check valve Plug: With check valve Socket: With check valve 0.2 0.2 Series KKA3 0.175 (KKA3P-01F+KKA3S-01F) 0.15 Series KKA4 (KKA4P-02F+KKA4S-02F) 0.125 0.1 0.075 0.05 Pressure loss (MPa) 0.15 Pressure loss (MPa) Series KKA8 (KKA8P-10F+KKA8S-10F) 0.175 Series KKA7 (KKA7P-06F+KKA7S-06F) 0.125 0.1 0.075 Series KKA9 (KKA9P-12F+KKA9S-12F) 0.05 Series KKA6 (KKA6P-04F+KKA6S-04F) 0.025 0 0.025 0 0 0.01 0.02 0.03 3 Flow rate (m /min) 0.04 0.05 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 3 Flow rate (m /min) 99 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment 10 Flow rate m3/min (ANR) 0.5 Pressure (MPa) Plug: Without check valve Socket: With check valve 7 0.4 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 100 KKA Construction t w q y e r u !3 !2 y r !0 !1 t o q Plug 1 2 3 4 5 6 100 e w Socket Plug No. i Socket Description Stem Rear stem Plug valve Valve O-ring Stem O-ring Plug valve spring Material Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel FKM FKM Stainless steel Note Plated with fluorine-contained material Fluorine coated Fluorine coated No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Description Body Rear body Socket valve Collar Sleeve Valve O-ring Plug O-ring Body O-ring Collar seal Collar spring Sleeve spring Steel ball Stopper ring Material Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel FKM FKM FKM FKM Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel Stainless steel Note Plated with fluorine-contained material Plated with fluorine-contained material Plated with fluorine-contained material Fluorine coated Fluorine coated Fluorine coated Fluorine coated ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 101 S Couplers Series KKA Dimensions: Plug (P) With check valve Male thread type (mm) Body size Model KKA3P-01M 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 -02M R 1/4 -03M R 3/8 KKA4P-02M R 1/4 -03M R 3/8 -04M R 1/2 KKA6P-03M R 3/8 -04M R 1/2 -06M R 3/4 KKA7P-04M R 1/2 -06M R 3/4 -10M R1 KKA8P-06M 1 R 3/4 -10M R1 -12M R 1 1/4 KKA9P-10M 1 1/4 T Connection port size R 1/8 H Width across flats 14 17 22 24 30 32 36 41 46 R 1 1/4 -14M R 1 1/2 55 A L2 31.4 35.4 38.4 16.0 32.9 42.2 36.2 18.9 20.4 27.6 59.9 54.2 35.6 75.0 85.4 72.7 109.5 99.1 49.1 96.3 96.3 109.0 A 69.2 119.0 173.9 13.5 99.6 209.6 L2 H 275.0 73.4 82.9 T 60.3 10.0 59.5 69.9 36.6 65.9 58.1 66.3 109.0 26.4 40.4 49.9 85.4 28.3 6.9 36.7 39.9 19.8 32.9 40.6 47.1 69.4 17.4 38.2 46.2 47.9 15.4 5.6 32.4 39.4 43.2 R1 -12M L1 Min. Effective bore area Weight (g) size (mm2) L1 362.8 17.5 168.3 22.0 264.9 24.6 332.1 403.9 538.6 824.1 861.4 936.3 (mm) Body size Model KKA3P-01F 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 -02F 39.6 19 40.4 KKA4P-02F Rc 1/4 17 43.4 -03F Rc 3/8 19 44.4 -04F Rc 1/2 KKA6P-03F Rc 3/8 -04F Rc 1/2 -06F Rc 3/4 KKA7P-04F Rc 1/2 -06F Rc 3/4 -10F Rc 1 Rc 3/4 -10F Rc 1 -12F Rc 1 1/4 24 32 Rc 1 1/4 -14F Rc 1 1/2 5.6 20.2 17.4 41 36.1 18.9 6.9 26.4 69.7 84.1 20.4 10.0 54.2 54.6 67.7 69.4 13.5 99.6 196.8 325.9 L2 H L1 420.5 35.6 17.5 168.3 87.3 110.1 79.7 217.1 27.6 82.0 110.1 T 123.8 391.3 552.8 107.8 55 40.2 48.7 85.0 50 31.8 35.8 72.4 Rc 1 -12F 16.0 Effective Weight area (g) (mm2) 48.6 52.9 30 L2 Min. bore size 36.0 Rc 3/8 KKA9P-10F 1 1/4 L1 -03F KKA8P-06F 1 H T Connection Width port size across flats Rc 1/8 14 Rc 1/4 17 986.9 49.1 24.6 332.1 925.6 848.2 101 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Female thread type ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 102 KKA Dimensions: Socket (S) With check valve Male thread type (mm) Model KKA3S-01M 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 A 38.1 34.1 41.1 35.1 R 1/4 -03M R 3/8 42.1 35.6 KKA4S-02M R 1/4 46.0 40.0 -03M R 3/8 47.0 40.5 -04M R 1/2 50.0 42.0 KKA6S-03M R 3/8 51.4 44.9 -04M R 1/2 54.4 46.4 -06M R 3/4 56.4 46.9 KKA7S-04M R 1/2 76.3 68.1 -06M R 3/4 79.3 69.8 -10M 17 22 30 36 18.5 24.2 30.7 42.5 R1 82.8 72.4 R 3/4 94.9 85.4 98.4 88.0 100.4 87.7 125.5 115.1 127.5 114.8 127.5 114.8 -10M R1 -12M R 1 1/4 KKA9S-10M 1 1/4 L -02M KKA8S-06M 1 øD Min. Effective Weight bore area (g) size (mm2) 46 55 R1 -12M R 1 1/4 -14M R 1 1/2 63 69 38.5 5.9 18.5 41.8 46.3 76.8 7.7 31.8 A 78.5 T 86.6 149.1 10.2 55.3 160.4 øD Body size T H Connection Width port size across flats R 1/8 184.8 426.1 13.6 101.5 H 457.8 L 514.0 873.5 17.6 169.9 931.1 1012.9 22.0 264.9 25.1 344.9 1680.7 1758.1 1819.4 Female thread type (mm) Model KKA3S-01F 1/8 1/4 1/2 3/4 -02F 102 41.2 KKA4S-02F Rc 1/4 -03F Rc 3/8 -04F Rc 1/2 KKA6S-03F Rc 3/8 -04F Rc 1/2 -06F Rc 3/4 57.9 KKA7S-04F Rc 1/2 75.1 -06F Rc 3/4 -10F Rc 1 Rc 3/4 -10F Rc 1 -12F Rc 1 1/4 Rc 1 1/4 -14F Rc 1 1/2 18.5 24.2 46.9 97.1 7.7 31.8 52.3 24 36 30.7 42.5 76.5 189.6 10.2 55.3 93.9 101.5 935.2 17.6 169.9 69 121.8 121.8 914.7 1002.1 121.8 63 1919.1 25.1 344.9 H 457.4 550.9 99.2 50 202.0 477.2 13.6 90.9 55 T 180.6 82.3 41 46 56.2 91.1 104.3 50.5 30 47.2 52.3 46.1 Rc 1 -12F 46.9 5.9 43.1 19 22 Effective Weight area (g) (mm2) 37.6 18.5 Rc 3/8 KKA9S-10F 1 1/4 L -03F KKA8S-06F 1 øD Min. bore size øD Body size T H Connection Width port size across flats Rc 1/8 17 Rc 1/4 1810.0 1732.6 L ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 103 S Couplers Series KKA Dimensions: Plug (P) Without check valve Male thread type (mm) Body size Model H T Connection Width port size across flats L1 KKA3P-01M-1 R 1/8 12 28.5 -02M-1 R 1/4 14 31.5 1/8 Min. Effective bore area Weight (g) size (mm2) A L2 24.5 16.0 9.8 6.0 25.5 22.6 -03M-1 R 3/8 KKA4P-02M-1 R 1/4 -03M-1 R 3/8 35.4 -04M-1 R 1/2 39.4 31.4 50.2 KKA6P-03M-1 R 3/8 37.9 31.4 41.9 -04M-1 R 1/2 -06M-1 R 3/4 30 Model T Connection port size H Width across flats L1 KKA3P-01F-1 Rc 1/8 14 23.2 -02F-1 Rc 1/4 17 30.3 -03F-1 Rc 3/8 19 32.0 KKA4P-02F-1 Rc 1/4 17 29.7 -03F-1 Rc 3/8 19 34.0 -04F-1 Rc 1/2 24 39.4 46.1 KKA6P-03F-1 Rc 3/8 22 30.9 34.3 1/4 1/2 17 22 32.5 26.0 34.4 28.4 40.9 18.9 20.4 A 23.6 21.0 8.0 28.9 40.2 11.0 32.9 42.9 T 14.6 76.0 33.4 27.9 H L2 L1 56.0 98.7 Female thread type (mm) Body size 1/8 1/4 -04F-1 Rc 1/2 24 39.6 -06F-1 Rc 3/4 30 42.8 16.0 6.0 Effective Weight area (g) (mm2) 9.6 22.6 T 20.2 26.2 20.0 8.0 18.9 40.2 11.0 20.4 76.0 25.8 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment 1/2 L2 Min. bore size L2 H L1 50.0 78.6 Dimensions: Socket (S) Without check valve Male thread type (mm) 1/8 1/4 1/2 Model øD L A 38.1 34.1 Min. Effective bore area Weight (g) size (mm2) KKA3S-01M-1 R 1/8 -02M-1 R 1/4 41.1 35.1 -03M-1 R 3/8 42.1 35.6 KKA4S-02M-1 R 1/4 46.0 40.0 -03M-1 R 3/8 47.0 40.5 -04M-1 R 1/2 50.0 42.0 81.7 KKA6S-03M-1 R 3/8 51.4 44.9 138.3 -04M-1 R 1/2 54.4 46.4 -06M-1 R 3/4 56.4 46.9 17 22 30 18.5 24.2 30.7 A T 36.1 6.1 23.4 39.4 43.9 øD Body size H T Connection Width port size across flats 71.9 8.1 11.4 41.2 81.6 73.6 H L 149.6 174.0 Female thread type (mm) 1/8 1/4 1/2 Model H T Connection Width port size across flats KKA3S-01F-1 Rc 1/8 -02F-1 Rc 1/4 -03F-1 Rc 3/8 KKA4S-02F-1 Rc 1/4 -03F-1 Rc 3/8 -04F-1 Rc 1/2 KKA6S-03F-1 Rc 3/8 -04F-1 Rc 1/2 -06F-1 Rc 3/4 17 øD 41.2 44.5 6.1 23.4 43.1 24.2 30.7 46.9 92.2 8.1 41.2 86.2 52.3 99.4 50.5 178.8 56.2 57.9 T 44.8 49.9 46.1 24 30 Effective Weight area (g) (mm2) 37.6 18.5 19 22 L Min. bore size øD Body size 11.4 81.6 H L 191.2 169.8 103 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 104 Flame Resistant (Equivalent to UL-94 Standard V-0) FR Double Layer Tubing Series TRB Air Leakage How to Order For general air pressure and water piping in environments with sparks from spot welding, etc. TRB 10 75 B 100 Roll length Inner tube O.D. Double layer construction using flame resistant resin for the outer layer. Symbol 20 100 Inner tube I.D. (equivalent to UL-94 Standard V-0) Length 20 m roll 100 m reel Color Symbol B W R BU Y G Color Black White Red Blue Yellow Green Inner tube Soft nylon Series - 20m roll - 100m reel Outer layer Tube size Metric size Burst pressure (MPa) Burst Pressure Characteristics Curve and Operating Pressure Bu rst pr es su re Bu (T rst RB pre 06 ssu 04 re ) (ex cep tT RB 06 04 ) Maximum operating pressure (TRB0604) Maximum operating pressure (except TRB0604) Operating temperature (°C) Outer layer color Note 1) Sectional view of FR double layer tube Model Inner tube O.D. (mm) Inner tube I.D. (mm) Outer layer thickness (mm) TRBU0604 6 4 1 TRBU0805 8 5 1 TRBU1065 10 6.5 1 TRBU1208 12 8 1 Black (B) White (W) Red (R) Blue (BU) Yellow (Y) Green (G) Specifications Fluid Maximum operating Note 3) pressure (at 20°C) Burst pressure Minimum bending Note 4) radius (mm) Operating Temperature Inner tube Materials Outer layer Air, Water Note 2) 1.0MPa Refer to burst pressure characteristics curve. 15 28 35 45 –20 to 60°C, For water: 0 to 60°C (with no freezing) Nylon 12 PVC (equivalent to UL-94 standard V-0) Note 1) The color of all inner tubes is black. Note 2) Can be used with general industrial water. Contact SMC if used with other fluids. Also keep surge pressure at or below the maximum operating pressure. Note 3) In the case of other temperatures, refer to the burst pressure characteristics curve. In addition, operate so that abnormal temperature increase due to adiabatic compression does not occur. Note 4) Indicates the bending value when the outside diameter rate of change is 10% or less at a temperature of 20°C. 104 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 105 Flame Resistant (Equivalent to UL-94 Standard V-0) FR Double Layer Tubing Series TRBU Air Leakage How to Order For general air pressure and water piping in environments with sparks from spot welding, etc. TRBU 10 75 B 100 Double layer construction using flame resistant resin for the outer layer. Roll length Inner tube O.D. Symbol 20 100 Inner tube I.D. (equivalent to UL-94 Standard V-0) Length 20 m roll 100 m reel Color Symbol B W R BU Y G Color Black White Red Blue Yellow Green Inner tube Polyurethane Outer layer Series - 20m roll - 100m reel Tube size Outer layer color Note 1) Burst Pressure Characteristics Curve and Operating Pressure Burst pressure (MPa) 5.0 4.0 Bu rst 3.0 Model Inner tube O.D. (mm) Inner tube I.D. (mm) Outer layer thickness (mm) pre ssu re TRBU0604 6 4 1 TRBU0805 8 5 1 TRBU1065 10 6.5 1 TRBU1208 12 8 1 Black (B) White (W) Red (R) Blue (BU) Yellow (Y) Green (G) 2.0 Burst pre ssure 1.0 0 -20 0 20 40 Specifications 60 Operating temperature (°C) Fluid Maximum operating Note 3) pressure (at 20°C) Burst pressure Minimum bending Note 4) radius (mm) Operating Temperature Inner tube Materials Outer layer Air, Water Note 2) 0.8 MPa Refer to burst pressure characteristics curve. 15 20 27 35 –20 to 60°C, For water: 0 to 40°C (with no freezing) Polyurethane PVC (equivalent to UL-94 standard V-0) Note 1) The color of all inner tubes is black. Note 2) Can be used with general industrial water. Contact SMC if used with other fluids. Also keep surge pressure at or below the maximum operating pressure. Note 3) In the case of other temperatures, refer to the burst pressure characteristics curve. In addition, operate so that abnormal temperature increase due to adiabatic compression does not occur. Note 4) Indicates the bending value when the outside diameter rate of change is 10% or less at a temperature of 20°C. 105 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Metric size Sectional view of FR double layer tube ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 106 Double Layer Tubing Stripper Series TKS Air Leakage Allows easy stripping of the outer layer from double layer tubing. Able to strip without damaging the inner tube The outer layer can be stripped without damaging the inner tube because a pawl is inserted between the inner tube and outer layer. Tubing guide Caution Do not use to strip covering materials from electrical wires, etc. Adjustment of cutter and stripping length is unnecessary Cutter Outer layer Inner tube A constant stripping length is always possible due to the fixed cutter with angle that cuts until the tubing reaches the end surface inside the stripper. Pawl Removal of stripped tubing is unnecessary Can be attached to tools Stripping work can be automated by attaching to an air driver, etc. Since the stripped tubing is discharged to the outside, no additional labor is required to remove it. Window Socket adapter • Even double layer polyurethane tubing (series TRBU) which is highly adhesive to the outer layer can be stripped easily. Tip color Applicable tubing∗ TKS-06 Orange TRB0604, TRBU0604 TKS-08 Yellow TRB0806, TRBU0805 TKS-10 Blue TRB1075, TRBU1065 TKS-12 Green TRB1209, TRBU1208 Dimensions mm D1 D2 16 35 18 20 22 L Weight g 58 45 62 50 ∗ Inner tube material: TRB for Nylon, TRBU for Polyurethane 9.7 (3/8") 106 øD1 Model øD2 Variations L ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 107 Polyurethane Coil Tubing Air Blow Series TCU Compact piping possible Air Tool Specifications TCU TCU TCU TCU TCU TCU TCU 0425B-1 0425B-2 0425B-3 0604B-1 0604B-2 0604B-3 0805B-1 Model Number of tubes 1 tube 2 tubes 3 tubes 1 tube 8 Tube I.D. mm 2.5 4 5 Air 0.8 MPa Burst pressure Burst pressure (MPa) rst 1 tube 6 Max. operating pressure (at 20°C) Note 2) Bu 3 tubes 4 Fluid Burst Pressure Characteristics Curve and Operating Pressure 2 tubes Tube O.D. mm Refer to the burst pressure characteristics curve. Operating temperature –20 to 60°C Material Polyurethane Color Black Note 1) Consult SMC if used with other than air fluids. Note 2) For other temperatures, refer to the burst pressure characteristics curve. In addition, operate so that abnormal temperature increase due to adiabatic compression does not occur. Coil Tubing pre ssu re O.D. 4 Max. ope rating pre I.D. 2.5 ssure 4 8 5 No. of tubes Max. operating length m 1 2 3 1.5 1 1 2 2 1.5 3 1 1 2 Model TCU0425B-1 TCU0425B-2 TCU0425B-3 TCU0604B-1 TCU0604B-2 TCU0604B-3 TCU0805B-1 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Operating temperature (°C) 6 Color Black (B) Black (B) Black (B) Black (B) Black (B) Black (B) Black (B) Tube Cutter Series TK TK-1 Applicable tube O.D.: 13 mm or less TK-2 Applicable tube O.D.: 18 mm or less Air Leakage TK-3 (Simplified type) Applicable tube O.D.: 12 mm or less Note) Do not use the cutter to cut metal such as electrical wires. 107 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 108 Regulator Air Blow Series AR10 to 60 Air Tool How to Order AR 30 F 03 BE 1N Option Regulator Symbol 10 20 25 30 40 50 60 Thread type AR20 Nil N F Metric thread (M5) Rc NPT G Port Symbol size M5 01 02 03 04 06 10 AR40 M5 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 ∗ When more than one specification is required, indicate in ascending alphanumeric order. Note 2) The only difference from the standard specifications is the adjusting spring for the regulator. It does not restrict the setting of 0.2 MPa or more. Note 3) For M5 and NPT thread types.Note2) This product is for overseas use only according to the new Measurement Law. (The SI unit type is provided for use in Japan.) Port size Body size 10 20 25 30 40 50 60 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — Accessory Note 1) Symbol Nil B E G H Combination Symbol Optional specifications Accessory Accessory/Optional specifications With bracket (With set nut) Standard Specifications Applicable model — AR10 to 60 With bracket With square embedded type pressure gauge (With limit indicator) AR20 to 60 AR10 With round pressure gauge (Without limit indicator) AR20 to 60 With round pressure gauge (With limit indicator) AR10 to 40 With set nut (For panel mount) Description — Note 1) Optional parts are not assembled and are supplied loose at the time of shipment (except option E). Accessory/Optional Specifications Combinations JIS symbol Description Applicable model 0.02 to 0.2 MPa setting AR10 to 60 Non-relieving AR10 to 60 Flow direction: Right Left AR10 to 60 Upward handle AR10 to 60 Name plate and pressure gauge in imperial units (PSI, °F) AR10 to 60 1 (2) N R Y Z (3) Body size : Combination available : Varies depending on the model Accessory B E G : Combination not available : Available only with NPT thread Optional specifications H 1 N R Y Applicable regulator Z AR10 AR20~40 AR50~60 B Square embedded type pressure gauge E Round pressure gauge G With set nut (For panel mount) H 0.02 to 0.2 MPa setting -1 -N Non-relieving type -R Flow direction: Right Left -Y Upward handle Name plate and pressure gauge -Z in imperial units (PSI, °F) Model AR10 Port size M5 x 0.8 Fluid Proof pressure Maximum operating pressure 0.05 to 0.7 MPa Set pressure range Pressure gauge port size (1) 1/16 (2) Relief pressure Ambient and fluid temperature Construction Weight (kg) 0.06 AR20 AR50 AR60 3/4 1/4, 3/8 1/4, 3/8, 1/2 Air 1.5 MPa 1.0 MPa 0.05 to 0.85 MPa 1/8 1/8 1/8 1/4 1/4 Set pressure + 0.05 MPa (3) (at relief flow rate of 0.1 l/min (ANR)) –5 to 60°C (With no freezing) Relieving type 3/4, 1 1 1/4 1/4 0.26 1.17 1.22 1/8, 1/4 AR25 AR30 AR40 AR40-06 1/4, 3/8 0.21 0.29 0.44 0.47 Note 1) Pressure gauge connection threads are not required for regulator with a square embedded type pressure gauge (AR20 to AR60). Note 2) Use a bushing (part no: 131368) when connecting the R 1/8 pressure gauge to the R 1/16 gauge port. Note 3) Except AR10. Accessory Part No. Applicable model AR10 Accessory Bracket assembly (1) Set nut Pressure (2) gauge 1 MPa 0.2 MPa 108 AR20 AR25 AR30 AR40 AR40-06 AR50 AR60 AR10P-270AS AR20P-270AS AR25P-270AS AR30P-270AS AR40P-270AS AR40P-270AS AR50P-270AS (5) AR50P-270AS(5) AR10P-260S AR20P-260S AR25P-260S AR30P-260S AR40P-260S AR40P-260S (6) — — (6) Round type G27-10-R1 (4) Square embedded type — GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS Round type G27-10-R1 G36-2-01 G36-2-01 G36-2-01 G46-2-02 G46-2-02 G46-2-02 G46-2-02 Square (4) embedded type — GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS (3) G36-10-01 G36-10-01 G36-10-01 G46-10-02 G46-10-02 G46-10-02 G46-10-02 Note 1) Assembly includes a bracket and set nuts. Note 2) in part numbers for a round pressure gauge indicates a type of connection thread. No indication is necessary for R; however, indicate N for NPT. Please contact SMC regarding the connection thread NPT and pressure gauge supply for PSI unit specifications. Note 3) For 1.0 MPa. Note 5) Assembly includes a bracket and 2 mounting screws. Note 4) Includes one O-ring and 2 mounting screws. Note 6) Please contact SMC regarding the set nuts for AR50 and AR60. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 109 Pilot Operated Regulator Air Blow Series AR425 to 935 Air Tool Standard Specifications AR425 Model AR435 AR625 1/4, 3/8, 1/2 Port size AR635 AR825 3/4, 1 AR835 AR925 AR935 11 4, 11 2 Fluid 2 Air Proof pressure 1.5 MPa Max. operating pressure 1.0 MPa Set pressure range (MPa) (1) Air consumption (for bleed hole) (2) 0.05 to 0.83 0.02 to 0.2 0.05 to 0.83 0.02 to 0.2 0.05 to 0.83 0.02 to 0.2 0.05 to 0.83 0.02 to 0.2 5 l/min (ANR) (at maximum pressure) 1 4 Pressure gauge port size Ambient and fluid temperature –5 to 60°C (No freezing) Construction Internal pilot relieving type (Pilot air is always bleeding.) Weight (kg) 0.7 1.1 2.5 4.5 Note 1) Outlet pressure range: P2 is 90% of P1 or less. Note 2) Air consumption differs depending on the set pressure. Accessory (Option)/Part No. Part no. Description Model Bracket Pressure gauge with limit indicator (1) AR45 AR65 AR85 AR95 B24P B25P — — G46-10-02 (Max. 1.0 MPa), G46-2-02 (Max. 0.2 MPa) Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment Note 1) • In the gauge part no. (e.g. G46-10-02), l indicate kind of the connecting thread. Put nothing for Rc and “N” for NPT thread. • Please consult with SMC for NPT pressure gauge. How to Order Internal pilot operated relieving type regulator AR 4 25 02 BG R Option Nil Regulator R Body size 4 12 6 1 8 11 2 9 2 Accessory 0.05 to 0.83 MPa 25 35 Note) 0.02 to 0.2 MPa Note) Compared with AR25 type, its adjusting spring will only be different. AR65 1 4 3 8 Symbol Description Applicable model Nil With bracket AR45 to 65 B G Gauge Port size 02 03 04 06 10 12 14 20 Regulating pressure range AR85 None Flow direction: Right Left G46-10-02 G46-2-02 AR25 AR35 1 2 3 4 1 11 4 11 2 2 Thread type Nil JIS symbol AR65-BG N F Rc NPT G AR425-BG 109 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 110 Regulator with Back Flow Mechanism Series AR20K to 60K Actuator How to Order Regulator with a built-in mechanism that ensures a quick release of the outlet air pressure (built-in check valve with back flow mechanism). AR 30 K F 03 BE 1N Regulator Option Symbol Body size 1 (2) N R Y 20 25 30 40 50 60 With back flow mechanism Note) AR10 comes with a back flow mechanism as a standard feature. If the set pressure is below 0.15 MPa, back flow may not occur. When a backflow mechanism is required with a set pressure of less than 0.15 MPa, please ccontact SMC. AR20K Z Port size Nil Rc Example 1) N NPT When the pressure in the rear and the F G front of the cylinder differs: Example 2) Circuit diagram When the air supply is cut off and releasing the inlet pressure to the atmosphere, the residual pressure release of the outlet side can be ensured for a safety purpose. Body size 25 30 40 50 60 Port Symbol size 20 01 1/8 02 1/4 03 3/8 — 04 1/2 — 06 3/4 — 1 — 10 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — Name plate and pressure AR20K to 60K gauge in imperial units (PSI) (3) Accessory (1) Symbol Nil Description Applicable model — B With bracket With square embedded type pressure gauge (With limit indicator) With round pressure gauge (With limit indicator) With set nut (For panel mount) — AR20K to 60K E Circuit diagram Applicable model AR20K to 60K AR20K to 60K AR20K to 60K AR20K to 60K ∗ When more than one specification is required, indicate in alphanumeric order. Note 2) The only difference from the standard specifications is the adjusting spring for the regulator. It does not restrict the setting of 0.2 MPa or more. Note 3) For NPT thread type. This product is for overseas use only according to the new Measurement Law. (The SI unit type is provided for use in Japan.) Thread type AR40K Description 0.02 to 0.2 MPa setting Non-relieving Flow direction: Right Left Upward handle JIS symbol G H AR20K to 60K AR20K to 60K AR20K to 40K Note 1) Optional parts are not assembled and are supplied loose at the time of shipment (except option E). Standard Specifications Model Port size AR20K AR25K AR30K AR40K AR40K-06 AR50K AR60K 1/8, 1/4 1/4, 3/8 1/4, 3/8 1/4, 3/8, 1/2 Air 3/4 3/4, 1 1 1/4 1/4 1/4 Fluid 1.5 MPa Proof pressure 1.0 MPa Maximum operating pressure 0.05 to 0.85 MPa Set pressure range (1) Pressure gauge port size (2) 1/8 1/8 1/8 1/4 Set pressure + 0.05 MPa (at relief flow rate of 0.1 l/min (ANR)) Relief pressure –5° to 60°C (With no freezing) Ambient and fluid temperature Relieving type Construction Weight (kg) 0.26 ∗ AR10 comes with a back flow mechanism as a standard feature. 0.21 0.30 0.45 0.48 1.17 1.22 Note 1) Set the inlet pressure 0.05 MPa or higher than the set pressure. Note 2) Pressure gauge connection threads are not required for regulators with a square embedded type pressure gauge (AR20K to AR60K). Accessory Part No. Applicable model Accessory Bracket assembly Set nut Pressure gauge (2) 1 MPa 0.2 MPa AR20K AR25K AR30K AR40K AR40K-06 AR50K AR60K AR20P-270AS AR25P-270AS AR30P-270AS AR40P-270AS AR40P-270AS AR50P-270AS (3) AR20P-260S AR25P-260S AR30P-260S AR40P-260S AR40P-260S — (5) Round type G36-10-01 G36-10-01 G36-10-01 G46-10-02 G46-10-02 G46-10-02 G46-10-02 (4) Square embedded type GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS GC3-10AS Round type G36-2-01 G36-2-01 G36-2-01 G46-2-02 G46-2-02 G46-2-02 G46-2-02 Square (4) embedded type GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS GC3-2AS (1) Note 1) Assembly includes a bracket and set nuts. Note 2) in part numbers for a round pressure gauge indicates a type of connection thread. No indication is necessary for R; however, indicate N for NPT. Please contact SMC regarding the connection thread NPT and pressure gauge supply for PSI unit specifications. Note 3) Assembly includes a bracket and 2 mounting screws. Note 4) Includes one O-ring and 2 mounting screws. Note 5) Please contact SMC regarding the set nut for AR50K and 60K. 110 (3) AR50P-270AS — (5) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 111 Filter Regulator Air Blow Series AW10 to 40 Air Tool Integrated filter and regulator units save space and require less piping. JIS symbol AW20 AW40 How to Order AW 30 F 03 BE 1N Option Filter regulator 10 20 30 40 Thread type (1) N F (2) Metric thread (M5) Rc NPT G Applicable model AW10 to 40 AW10 to 40 AW10 to 40 AW30/40 AW20 AW30/40 AW10 to 40 AW10 to 40 AW30/40 AW10 to 40 ∗ When more than one specification is required, indicate in alphanumeric order. Note 5) The only difference from the standard specifications is the adjusting spring for the regulator. It does not restrict the setting of 0.2 MPa or more. Note 6) Without a valve function. Note 7) For M5 and NPT thread types. This product is for overseas use only according to the new Measurement Law. (The SI unit type is provided for use in Japan.) Note 1) Drain guide is NPT 1/4 (applicable to AW30 and 40), and the exhaust port for auto-drain comes with ø3/8" One-touch fitting (applicable to AW30 and AW40). Note 2) Drain guide is G 1/4 (applicable to AW30 and AW40). Accessory (3) Symbol Nil Port size Symbol Port size M5 01 02 03 04 06 M5 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 Body size 10 — — — — — 20 — — — — 30 — — — — B C D E 40 — — G H Applicable model — AW10 to 40 With bracket AW10 to 40 Float type auto-drain (N.C.) AW30/40 Float type auto-drain (N.O.) AW20 to 40 With square embedded type pressure gauge (With limit indicator) AW10 With round pressure gauge (Without limit indicator) AW20 to 40 With round pressure gauge (With limit indicator) AW10 to 40 With set nut (For panel mount) Description — Note 3) Optional parts are not assembled and are supplied loose at the time of shipment (except options C, D and E). : Combination available : Varies depending on the model Combination Optional specifications Accessory Accessory/Optional specifications Symbol Accessory/Optional Specifications Combinations Accessory B C D E G H Optional specifications 1 2 6 8 C J N R W Z : Combination not available : Available only with NPT thread Applicable filter regulator AW10 AW20 AW30 to 40 B With bracket (With set nut) C Float type auto-drain (N.C.) D Float type auto-drain (N.O.) E Square embedded type pressure gauge G Round pressure gauge H With set nut (For panel mount) –1 0.02 to 0.2 MPa setting –2 Metal bowl –6 Nylon bowl –8 Metal bowl with level gauge –C With bowl guard –J Drain guide 1/4 –N Non-relieving type –R Flow direction: Right Left Drain cock with barb fitting: ø6 x ø4 nylon tubing –W Name plate, caution plate for bowl, and pressure gauge in imperial units (PSI, °F) –Z 111 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment 0.02 to 0.2 MPa setting 1 (5) Metal bowl 2 Nylon bowl 6 Metal bowl with level gauge 8 With bowl guard C Drain guide 1/4 J (6) Non-relieving N Flow direction: Right Left R Drain cock with barb fitting: ø6 x ø4 nylon tubing W Z (7) Name plate, caution plate for bowl, and pressure gauge in imperial units (PSI, °F) Body size Nil Description Symbol ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 112 AW10 to 40 Standard Specifications Model Port sizes Fluid Proof pressure Maximum operating pressure Set pressure range Pressure gauge port size (1) Relief pressure Ambient and fluid temperature Nominal filtration rating Drain capacity (cm3) Bowl material Bowl guard Construction Weight (kg) AW10 M5 x 0.8 AW20 1/8, 1/4 AW30 AW40 1/4, 3/8 1/4, 3/8, 1/2 Air 1.5 MPa 1.0 MPa 0.05 to 0.7 MPa 0.05 to 0.85 MPa 1/8 1/8 1/4 1/16 (2) Set pressure + 0.05 MPa (3) (at relief flow rate of 0.1 l/min (ANR)) –5 to 60°C (With no freezing) 5 µm 8 45 2.5 25 Polycarbonate Standard — Option Relieving type 0.40 0.72 0.09 0.32 AW40-06 3/4 1/4 45 0.75 Note 1) Pressure gauge connection threads are not required for regulators with a square embedded type pressure gauge (AW20 to AW40). Note 2) Use a bushing (part no: 131368) when connecting R 1/8 pressure gauge to R 1/16 gauge port. Note 3) Not applicable to AW10. Accessory Part No. Applicable model Accessory Bracket assembly (1) Set nut (2) 1.0 MPa Pressure gauge Round Type Square embedded type 0.2 MPa Round Type Square embedded type Float type auto-drain (5) (4) N.O. N.C. (4) AW10 AW20 AW30 AW40 AW40-06 AR10P-270AS AR10P-260S G27-10-R1 — G27-10-R1 (3) — — AD17 AW20P-270AS AR20P-260S G36-10-01 GC3-10AS G36-2-01 GC3-2AS — AD27 AR30P-270AS AR30P-260S G36-10-01 GC3-10AS G36-2-01 GC3-2AS AD38 AD37 AR40P-270AS AR40P-260S G46-10-02 GC3-10AS G46-2-02 GC3-2AS AD48 AD47 AR40P-270AS AR40P-260S G46-10-02 GC3-10AS G46-2-02 GC3-2AS AD48 AD47 Note 1) Assembly includes a bracket and set nuts. Note 2) in part numbers for a round pressure gauge indicates a type of connection thread. No indication is necessary for R; however, indicate N for NPT. Please contact SMC regarding the connection thread NPT and supply of the pressure gauge for PSI unit specifications. Note 3) For 1 MPa. Note 4) Includes one O-ring and 2 mounting screws. Note 5) Minimum operating pressure: N.O. type–0.1 MPa; N.C. type–0.1 MPa (AD17/27) and 0.15 MPa (AD37/47). Please contact SMC regarding the specifications for PSI unit and °F. 112 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 113 Filter Regulator with Back Flow Mechanism Air Blow Series AW20K/30K/40K Air Tool How to Order AW 30 K F 03 BE 1N Option Filter regulator Symbol 1 (4) 2 6 8 C J (5) N R W Z (6) Body size 20 30 40 With back flow mechanism Note) AW10 comes with a back flow mechanism as a standard feature. If the set pressure is not exceeding 0.15 MPa, back flow may not occur. When a back flow mechanism is required with a set pressure of less than 0.15 MPa, please contact SMC. AW40K N (1) F (2) Rc NPT G Note 1) Drain guide is NPT 1/4 (applicable to AW30K and 40K), and the exhaust port for auto-drain comes with ø3/8" One-touch fitting (applicable to AW30K and AW40K). Note 2) Drain guide is G 1/4 (applicable to AW30K and AW40K). Accessory (3) Symbol Nil Port size Symbol Standard Specifications JIS symbol 01 02 03 04 06 20 — — — 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 30 — — — Model Port sizes Fluid Proof pressure Maximum operating pressure Set pressure range (1) Pressure gauge port size (2) Relief pressure Ambient and fluid temperature Nominal filtration rating Drain capacity (cm3) Bowl material Bowl guard Construction Weight (kg) 40 — Description Applicable model — With bracket AW20K to 40K Float type auto-drain (N.C.) AW20K to 40K Float type auto-drain (N.O.) AW30K/40K With square embedded type pressure gauge (With limit indicator) AW20K to 40K With round pressure gauge (With limit indicator) AW20K to 40K With set nut (For panel mount) AW20K to 40K — Note 3) Optional parts are not assembled and are supplied loose at the time of shipment (except options C, D and E). AW20K AW30K AW40K AW40K-06 1/8, 1/4 1/4, 3/8 1/4, 3/8, 1/2 3/4 Air 1.5 MPa 1.0 MPa 0.05 to 0.85 MPa 1/8 1/8 1/4 1/4 Set pressure + 0.05 MPa (at relief flow rate of 0.1 l/min (ANR)) –5 to 60°C (With no freezing) 5 µm 8 25 45 45 Polycarbonate Option Standard Relieving type 0.40 0.32 0.72 0.75 Note 1) Set the inlet pressure 0.05 MPa or higher than the set pressure. Note 2) Pressure gauge connection threads are not required for regulators with a square embedded type pressure gauge (AW20K to AW40K). Accessory Part No. Circuit Diagram When the air supply is cut off and releasing the inlet pressure to the atmosphere, the residual pressure release of the outlet side can be ensured for a safety purpose. JIS symbol With back flow mechanism Filter regulator Applicable model Accessory (1) AW20K Bracket assembly AW20P-270AS AR20P-260S Set nut Round type G36-10-01 (2) 1.0 MPa Square (3) Pressure GC3-10AS embedded type gauge Round type G36-2-01 0.2 MPa Square (3) GC3-2AS embedded type — N.O. Float type auto-drain AD27 N.C. AW30K AW40K AW40K-06 AR30P-270AS AR30P-260S G36-10-01 GC3-10AS G36-2-01 GC3-2AS AD38 AD37 AR40P-270AS AR40P-260S G46-10-02 GC3-10AS G46-2-02 GC3-2AS AD48 AD47 AR40P-270AS AR40P-260S G46-10-02 GC3-10AS G46-2-02 GC3-2AS AD48 AD47 Note 1) Assembly includes a bracket and set nuts. Note 2) in part numbers for a round pressure gauge indicates a type of connection thread. No indication is necessary for R; however, indicate N for NPT. Please contact SMC regarding the connection thread NPT and pressure gauge supply for PSI unit specifications. Note 3) Includes one O-ring and 2 mounting screws. Note 4) Minimum operating pressure: N.O. type–0.1 MPa; N.C. type–0.1 MPa (AD27) and 0.15 MPa (AD37/47). Please contact SMC regarding the specifications for PSI unit and °F. 113 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment AW20K B C D E G H Body size Port size Applicable model AW20K to 40K AW20K to 40K AW20K to 40K AW30K/40K AW20K AW30K/40K AW20K to 40K AW20K to 40K AW30K/40K Name plate, caution plate for bowl, and pressure gauge in imperial units (PSI, °F) AW20K to 40K ∗ When more than one specification is required, indicate in alphanumeric order. Note 4) The only difference from the standard specifications is the adjusting spring for the regulator. It does not restrict the setting of 0.2 MPa or more. Note 5) Without a valve function. Note 6) For NPT thread type. This product is for overseas use only according to the new Measurement Law. (The SI unit type is provided for use in Japan.) Thread type Nil Description 0.02 to 0.2 MPa setting Metal bowl Nylon bowl Metal bowl with level gauge With bowl guard Drain guide 1/4 Non-relieving type Flow direction: Right Left Drain cock with barb fitting: ø6 x ø4 nylon tubing ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 114 Air Filter Element Part Number List Air Line Maintenance Air filter Filter regulator Air filter (large capacity) Mist separator Series AF Series AW Series AF Series AFM Mist separator regulator Series AWM Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. AF10 AF10P-060S AW10 AF10P-060S AF20 AF20P-060S AW20 AF20P-060S AF30 AF30P-060S AW30 AF30P-060S AF40 AF40P-060S AW40 AF40P-060S AF40-06 AF40P-060S AW40-06 AF40P-060S AF50 AF50P-060S AF60 AF60P-060S Micro mist separator Series AFD Micro mist separator regulator Filter model Element part no. AFM20 AFM20P-060AS AWM20 AFM20P-060AS AF800 11345-5B AFM30 AFM30P-060AS AWM30 AFM30P-060AS AF900 11352-5B AFM40 AFM40P-060AS AWM40 AFM40P-060AS Main line filter Series AFF Series AWD Free standing main line filter Mist separator Series AM Series AFF Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. Element part no. Filter model Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. AFF2B AFF-EL2B AFF75A EC700-003N AM150 AM-EL150 AFF4B AFF-EL4B AFF125A EC700-003N AM250 AM-EL250 AFF8B AFF-EL8B AFF150A EC800-003N AM350 AM-EL350 Filter model Element part no. AFF11B AFF-EL11B AFF220A EC900-003N AM450 AM-EL450 AFD20 AFD20P-060AS AWD20 AFD20P-060AS AFF22B AFF-EL22B AM550 AM-EL550 AFD30 AFD30P-060AS AWD30 AFD30P-060AS AFF37B AFF-EL37B AM650 AM-EL650 AFD40 AFD40P-060AS AWD40 AFD40P-060AS AFF75B AFF-EL75B AM850 AM-EL850 Micro mist separator Micro mist separator with prefilter Series AMD Super mist separator Series AME Series AMH Micro mist separator (Free standing type, In-line type) Series AMD Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. AMD150 AMD-EL150 AMD800 63174 AMH150 AMH-EL150 AME150 AME-EL150 AMD250 AMD-EL250 AMD801 63174 AMH250 AMH-EL250 AME250 AME-EL250 AMD350 AMD-EL350 AMD900 63174 (3 pcs.) AMH350 AMH-EL350 AME350 AME-EL350 AMD450 AMD-EL450 AMD901 63174 (3 pcs.) AMH450 AMH-EL450 AME450 AME-EL450 AMD550 AMD-EL550 AMD1000 63174 (5 pcs.) AMH550 AMH-EL550 AME550 AME-EL550 AMD650 AMD-EL650 AMH650 AMH-EL650 AME650 AME-EL650 AMD850 AMD-EL850 AMH850 AMH-EL850 AME850 AMH-EL850 Odor removal filter Series AMF Odor removal filter (Free standing type, In-line type) Series AMF Filter model Element part no. Filter model Element part no. AMF150 AMF-EL150 AMF800 AMF250 AMF-EL250 AMF801 63271 AMF350 AMF-EL350 AMF900 63271 (3 pcs.) AMF450 AMF-EL450 AMF901 63271 (3 pcs.) AMF550 AMF-EL550 AMF1000 63271 (5 pcs.) AMF650 AMF-EL650 AMF850 AMF-EL850 114 63271 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 115 GD40-2-01 Differential Pressure Gauge The difference between the inlet and Models/Specifications Model outlet pressures can be viewed at a Fluid glance on a differential pressure Maximum operating pressure gauge. It is ideal for filter Proof pressure maintenance. Ambient and fluid temperature • Compact and light weight • Easily installed by merely providing a bypass circuit Air Line Maintenance GD40-2-01 Compressed air 1 MPa 1.5 MPa 5 to 60°C 1/8 0 to 0.2 MPa ±0.006 MPa ø40 300 Port size (Rc) Gauge range Accuracy Dial size Weight (g) • With protective cover for hazard prevention Main part materials Case Internal parts Window Gauge plate Standard accessories Die-cast zinc Brass, Phosphor bronze Chloroethylene Stainless steel Design Precautions Caution T0425 (0.5 m) H04-01 (1 pc.) DL04-01 (1pc.) Nylon tubing Male connector Male elbow Mounting Caution A differential pressure gauge cannot be used in a location with frequent pulsation. 1) The HIGH and LOW marks on the back of the differential pressure gauge indicate high pressure and low pressure sides, respectively. Connect the HIGH side to the primary side and the LOW side to the secondary side of filters and other equipment. Do not use a stop valve, as damage to the differential pressure gauge may occur if the valve is inadvertently left open or closed. 2) Install the differential pressure gauge vertically. 3) Securely connect the piping of the differential pressure gauge, because it will be damaged if the piping becomes detached. Piping example Dimensions Bracket mounting thread Differential pressure gauge Primary side Secondary side ø62 Low pressure side High pressure side Thread depth 7 115 Auxiliary Pneumatic Equipment Air Preparation Equipment JIS symbol Mounting ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 116 Filter with Element Service Indicator Air Line Maintenance This unit indicates the clogging (service life) of elements. The element service indicator indicates the clogging of elements in a mist separator, etc., which can be used as a guide for the time to replace the element. Clogging Indication Replace an element when the element service indicator's red indicator reaches to the top. The top of the indicator window indicates differential pressure of approximately 0.1 MPa. Replace an element every 2 years even if the red indicator does not reach the top. Differential pressure: 0.05 MPa or less (The indicator's tip is visible.) Applicable series Main line filter: AFF2B to AFF75B Mist separator: AM150 to AM850 Micro mist separator: AMD150 to AMD850 Micro mist separator with prefilter: AMH150 to AMH850 How to Order 2B 4B 8B 11B 22B 37B 75B AM AMD AMH Size 1/8 1/4 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/2 An element service indicator is already mounted on each series at the factory. It cannot be mounted at a later time or used as a separate unit. Size Size AFF Differential pressure: 0.1 MPa or more (The indicator reaches to the top.) 2B, 150 4B, 250 8B, 350 11B, 450 22B, 550 37B, 650 75B, 850 150 250 350 450 550 650 850 Thread type Bore size Nil N F Bore size 1/8 01 1/4 02 3/8 03 1/2 04 3/4 06 1 10 1 1/2 14 2 20 Thread type Rc Nil NPT N G F Bore size 01 02 03 Size 2B, 150 4B, 250 8B, 350 11B, 450 22B, 550 37B, 650 75B, 850 04 06 10 14 20 Refer to the “Air Preparation Equipment” portion of Best Pneumatics Vol. 14 for selecting the model number and size of a mist separator, etc. 01 02 03 04 06 10 14 20 Accessory Option Nil B C D BC BD Nil J M R T JR MR JT MT RT JRT MRT Accessory Without accessory With bracket With N.C. auto drain With N.O. auto drain Option Accessory Nil 2B, B 150 C to D 22B, BC 550 BD Nil B 37B, 650 D BD Nil 75B, B 850 D BD Size Option Drain guide with 1/4B female thread Nil Drain cock with M5 thread J Flow direction: Right to left M With element service indicator R T Nil B C D J M R T JR MR JT MT RT JRT MRT : Applicable (Combinations other than those indicated are not possible.) 116 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 117 Sensors/Measuring Instruments SMC PRESSURE SWITCH RESET SET Digital flow switch Application PF2A/PF2W Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air tool, Air leakage, Cooling water 118 ZSE30/ISE30 Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air tool, Vacuum 154 ZSE40/ISE40 ZSE3/ISE3 Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air tool, Vacuum Air line maintenance 162 171 ZSE50F/ISE50 Air line maintenance, Liquid removal, Coolant 173 ISE70/75/75H Air line maintenance, Liquid removal, Coolant 182 ZSE5B/ISE5B PPA (Made to Order) ISA2 ISA (Special order product) Air line maintenance, Liquid removal, Coolant 189 197 203 205 222 224 Air blow, Air tool Air line maintenance, Air blow, Air leakage Air purge Air purge Liquid removal Page 117 Sensors Measuring Instruments High precision 2-color display digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch LCD display type digital pressure switch High precision digital pressure switch for general fluids 2-color display digital pressure switch Digital pressure switch with backlight Compact manometer Air leakage tester Air catch sensor Air catch sensor Negative pressure detection valve Series ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 118 Air Line Maintenance Digital Flow Switches Series PF2A/PF2W Air Blow Air Leakage Air Tool Cooling Water For Air Flow rate measurement range l/min 1 to 10 5 to 50 10 to 100 20 to 200 50 to 500 150 to 3000 300 to 6000 600 to 12000 Remote Type Integrated Type Display unit Sensor unit PF2A710 PF2A750 PF2A711 PF2A721 PF2A751 PF2A703H PF2A706H PF2A712H PF2A510 PF2A550 PF2A511 PF2A521 PF2A551 Display unit (4 ch) PF2A30 PF2A20 PF2A31 — — — For Water Flow rate measurement range l/min 0.5 to 4 2 to 16 5 to 40 10 to 100 Remote Type Integrated Type Sensor unit PF2W504(T) PF2W520(T) PF2W540(T) PF2W511 PF2W704(T) PF2W720(T) PF2W740(T) PF2W711 Display unit (4 ch) Display unit PF2W30 PF2W20 PF2W33 Application examples Flow control of N2 gas to prevent detection Clean gas filter camera shimmering and lead frame oxidation Flow control of cooling water for wafer temperature regulation and high frequency electric power supply Flow control of pressurized cooling water for welding gun Set the clean gas filter on the outlet side piping of the flow switch. The accumulated pulse output function enables remote monitoring of accumulated flow. Main line flow control M/C Make possible the monitoring of air flow from the main line to each branch line. A COUNT B COM DC12V GND F.G. R.S. HOLD COM BANK1 BANK2 PRESET FUNC. UP RIGHT LEFT DOWN MODE SEL. AC100~240VCOM OUT1OUT2OUT3OUT4OUT5S.STOP RD M/C Flow control for each branch line 118 COM MULTI COUNTER:CEU5 M/C SET SD SG RS-232C Pulse counter ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 119 Digital Flow Switch For Air Series PF2A For details about certified products conforming to international standards, visit us at www.smcworld.com. How to Order Integrated display type PF2A7 10 01 27 M Flow rate range 10 50 11 21 51 1 to 10 l/min 5 to 50 l/min 10 to 100 l/min 20 to 200 l/min 50 to 500 l/min Unit specification Thread type Nil N F Wiring specification (Refer to page 152.) Rc NPT G M12 3 m lead wire with connector Without lead wire Nil N Port size Flow rate (l/min) Port Symbol size 10 50 100 200 500 1/8 01 1/4 02 3/8 03 1/2 04 Applicable model PF2A710, PF2A750 PF2A711, PF2A721 PF2A751 Output specification Symbol Output specification 27 NPN open collector 2 outputs 67 PNP open collector 2 outputs Nil M With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l Specifications Output Note 5) specification Switch output Resistance Accumulated pulse output Indicator light Response time Hysteresis Power supply voltage Enclosure Operating temperature range Withstand voltage Insulation resistance Vibration resistance Impact resistance Noise resistance PF2A710 PF2A750 0.5 to 10.5 l/min 2.5 to 52.5 l/min 0.5 to 10.5l /min 2.5 to 52.5 l/min 1 to 10 l/min 5 to 50 l/min 0.1 l/min 0.5 l/min 0.1 l/pulse 0.5 l/pulse l/min, CFM x 10–2 PF2A711 Air, Nitrogen 5 to 105 l/min 5 to 105 l/min 10 to 100 l/min 1 l/min 1 l/pulse PF2A721 10 to 210 l/min 10 to 210 l/min 20 to 200 l/min 2 l/min 2 l/pulse l/min, CFM x 10–1 PF2A751 25 to 525 l/min 25 to 525 l/min 50 to 500 l/min 5 l/min 5 l/pulse l, ft3 x 10–1 0 to 50°C ±5% F.S. or less ±1% F.S. or less ±2% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less (15 to 35°C, based on 25°C), ±5% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, based on 25°C) 150 mA or less 160 mA or less 170 mA or less 250 g 290 g 1/8, 1/4 3/8 1/2 Heater type 3-digit, 7-segment LED –50 kPa to 0.75 MPa –50 kPa to 0.5 MPa 1.0 MPa 0 to 999999 l Maximum load current: 80 mA; Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) NPN open collector Maximum applied voltage: 30 V; Two outputs Maximum load current: 80 mA NPN open collector Internal voltage drop: 1.5 V or less (With load current of 80 mA); Two outputs NPN or PNP open collector (same as switch output) Illuminates when output is ON. OUT1: Green; OUT2: Red 1sec. or less Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0), Window comparator mode: 3-digit fixed Note 6) 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) IP65 Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each (De-energized) 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Note 1) For digital flow switch with unit switching function. (Fixed SI unit [(l/min, or l, m3 or m3 x 103)] will be set for switch type without the unit switching function.) Note 2) Flow rate display can be switched between the basic condition of 0°C, 101.3 kPa and the standard condition (ANR) of 20°C, 101.3 kPa, and 65% RH. Note 3) Without lead wire. Note 4) Accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. Note 5) Switch output and accumulated pulse output can be selected during initial setting. Note 6) Window comparator mode — Since hysteresis will reach 3 digits, keep P_1 and P_2 or n_1 and n_2 apart by 7 digits or more. (In case of output OUT2, n_1, 2 to be n_3, 4 and P_1, 2 to be P_3, 4.) Note 7) The flow switch is comformed to CE mark. 119 Sensors Measuring Instruments Model Measured fluid Flow rate measurement range Set flow rate range Flow rate measuring range Minimum set unit Accumulated pulse flow rate exchange value (Pulse width: 50 ms) Note 1, 2) Real-time flow rate Display unit Accumulated flow Operating fluid temperature Linearity Repeatability Temperature characteristics Current consumption (No load) Weight Note 3) Port size (Rc, NPT, G) Detection type Display Operating pressure range Proof pressure Accumulated flow range Note 4) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 120 PF2A How to Order Remote type Display unit PF2A5 10 01 C Flow rate range 10 50 11 21 51 1 to 10 l/min 5 to 50 l/min 10 to 100 l/min 20 to 200 l/min 50 to 500 l/min Thread type Option (Refer to page 152.) Rc NPT G Nil N F Nil C None e-con connector x 1 pc. The cable and connector are shipped unassembled. Port size Flow rate (l/min) Port Symbol size 10 50 100 200 500 01 1/8 02 1/4 03 3/8 04 1/2 Applicable model Wiring specification (Refer to page 152.) Nil PF2A510, 550 N M12 3 m lead wire with connector Without lead wire PF2A511, 521 PF2A551 Output specification Symbol Nil 1 2 Applicable display unit (monitor) model Specification Output for display unit Series PF2A300 Output for display unit + analog output (1 to 5 V) Series PF2A200/300 Output for display unit + analog output (4 to 20 mA) Series PF2A300 Specifications Model PF2A510 PF2A550 Measured fluid Detection type Flow rate measuring range Operating pressure range PF2A511 5 to 50 l/min 10 to 100 l/min –50 kPa to 0.5 MPa 1.0 MPa 0 to 50°C ±1% F.S. or less (Connected to PF2A3), ±3% F.S. or less (Connected to PF2A2) ±2% F.S. or less (15 to 35°C, based on 25°C) ±3% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, based on 25°C) Temperature characteristics Output Note 2) specification 50 to 500 l/min ±5% F.S. or less Linearity Note 1) Analog voltage output (Non-linear) output impedance 1 kΩ output for display unit PF2A3 Voltage output 1 to 5 V within the flow rate range Linearity: ±5% F.S. or less; allowable load resistance: 100 kΩ or more. Analog output Current output 4 to 20 mA within the flow rate range Linearity: ±5% F.S. or less; allowable load resistance: 300 Ω or less with 12 VDC, 600 Ω or less with 24 VDC 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) Power supply voltage Current consumption (No load) Operating temperature range 110 mA or less 100 mA or less IP65 Enclosure Resistance 20 to 200 l/min –50 kPa to 0.75 MPa Operating fluid temperature Output for display unit PF2A551 Heater type 1 to 10 l/min Withstand pressure Repeatability Note 1) PF2A521 Air, Nitrogen Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case Withstand voltage Insulation resistance 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each Impact resistance 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Noise resistance Weight Note 3) Port size (Rc, NPT, G) 200 g 1/8, 1/4 240 g 3/8 Note 1) The system accuracy when combined with PF2A2/PF2A3. Note 2) Output system can be selected during initial setting. Note 3) Without lead wire. (Add 20 g for the types of analog output whether voltage or current output selected.) Note 4) Flow rate unit measured under the following conditions: 0°C and 101.3 kPa. Note 5) The sensor unit is comformed to CE mark. 120 1/2 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 121 For Air Digital Flow Switch Series PF2A How to Order Remote type Display unit PF2A3 0 0 A M Unit specification Nil M Flow rate range Mounting Symbol Flow rate range Type for sensor unit 0 1 1 to 10 l/min 5 to 50 l/min 10 to 100 l/min 20 to 200 l/min 50 to 500 l/min Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l Panel mounting A PF2A510 PF2A550 PF2A511 PF2A521 PF2A551 With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) Output specification Symbol Output specification NPN open collector 2 outputs PNP open collector 2 outputs 0 1 Applicable model PF2A300/310 PF2A301/311 Specifications Model PF2A300/301 PF2A310/311 Flow rate measurement range Note 1) 0.5 to 10.5 l/min 2.5 to 52.5 l/min 5 to 105 l/min 10 to 210 l/min 25 to 525 l/min Set flow rate range Note 1) 0.5 to 10.5 l/min 2.5 to 52.5 l/min 5 to 105 l/min 10 to 210 l/min 25 to 525 l/min 0.1 l/min 0.5 l/min 1 l/min 2 l/min 5 l/min 0.1 l/pulse 0.5 l/pulse 1 l/pulse 2 l/pulse 5 l/pulse Minimum set unit Note 1) Accumulated pulse flow rate exchange value (Pluse width: 50 ms) Note 1) Note 2, 3) Display unit Real-time flow rate l/min, CFM x 10–2 l/min, CFM x 10–1 3 Accumulated flow l, ft x 10 Accumulated flow range Note 4) 0 to 999999 l ±5% F.S. or less Linearity Note 4) Repeatability ±1% F.S. or less Note 5) ±1% F.S. or less (15 to 35°C based on 25°C) ±2% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C based on 25°C) Temperature characteristics 50 mA or less 60 mA or less Output Note 6) specification Weight 45 g NPN open collector (PF2A300, PF2A310) Maximum load current: 80 mA Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) Maximum applied voltage: 30 V 2 outputs PNP open collector (PF2A301, PF2A311) Maximum load current: 80 mA Internal voltage drop: 1.5 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) 2 outputs Switch output Accumulated pulse output Display Indicator light Power supply voltage Response time Hysteresis Enclosure Operating temperature range Withstand voltage NPN or PNP open collector (same as switch output) 3-digit, 7-segment LED Illuminates when output is ON. OUT1: Green; OUT2: Red 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) 1 sec. or less Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0), Window comparator mode: Fixed (3 digits) Note 6) IP40 Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case Insulation resistance 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each Impact resistance 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each Noise resistance 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Note 1) The flow rate measurement range can be modified depending on the setting. Note 2) For digital flow switch with unit switching function. (Fixed SI unit [l/min or l] will be set for switch types without the unit switching function.) Note 3) Flow rate display can be switched between the basic condition of 0°C, 101.3 kPa and the standard condition (ANR) of 20°C, 101.3 kPa, and 65% RH. Note 4) Accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. Note 5) The system accuracy when combined with PF2A5. Note 6) Switch output and accumulated pulse output can be selected during initial setting. Note 7) Window comparator mode — Since hysteresis will reach 3 digits, keep P_1 and P_2 or n_1 and n_2 apart by 7 digits or more. (In case of output OUT2, n_1, 2 to be n_3, 4 and P_1, 2 to be P_3, 4.) Note 8) The display unit is comformed to CE mark. 121 Sensors Measuring Instruments Current consumption Resistance –1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 122 PF2A How to Order 4-channel Flow Monitor Remote type Display unit PF2A20 0 M Output specification Accessory / Power supply output cable (2 m) 0 1 Option 2 (Refer to page 152.) NPN 4 outputs PNP 4 outputs None Sensor connector (4 pc.) Nil 4C Unit specification Nil M Option 1 (Refer to page 152.) With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) Nil A B Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l None Panel mounting Front protective cover + Panel mounting Connectable remote type sensor part is PF2W5--1 (with analog output 1 to 5 V). Specifications Model Applicable flow rate sensor PF2A200/201 PF2A550--1 PF2A511--1 PF2A521--1 PF2A551--1 Flow rate measurement range Note 1) 0.5 to 10.5 l/min 2.5 to 52.5 l/min 5 to 105 l/min 10 to 210 l/min 25 to 525 l/min Set flow rate range Note 1) Minimum set unit Note 1) Accumulated pulse flow rate exchange value (Pluse width: 50 ms) Note 1) Note 2, 3) Real-time flow rate Display unit Accumulated flow Accumulated flow range Note 4) Power supply voltage Current consumption Power supply voltage for sensor Power supply current for sensor Note 3) Sensor input No. of inputs Input protection 0.5 to 10.5 l/min 2.5 to 52.5 l/min 5 to 105 l/min 10 to 210 l/min 25 to 525 l/min 0.1 l/min 0.5 l/min 1 l/min 2 l/min 5 l/min 0.1 l/pulse 0.5 l/pulse 1 l/pulse 2 l/pulse Output Note 6) specification PF2A510--1 Switch output (Real-time switch output, Accumulated switch output) Accumulated pulse output No. of outputs Output protection Hysteresis Response time Note 5) Linearity Note 5) Repeatability Note 5) Temperature characteristics Display method Resistance Indicator light Enclosure Operating temperature range Operating humidity range Vibration resistance Impact resistance Noise resistance Connection Material Weight –2 5 l/pulse –1 l/min, CFM x 10 l, ft3 x 10–2 0 to 999999 l, 0 to 999999 ft3 x 10–2 l/min, CFM x 10 l, ft3 x 10–1 0 to 999999 l, 0 to 999999 ft3 x 10–1 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) 50 mA or less (Not including the current consumption of the sensor) Same as [Power supply voltage] Max. 110 mA (However, the total current for the 4 inputs is 440 mA maximum or less.) 1 to 5 VDC (Input impedance: Approx. 800K Ω) 4 inputs Excess voltage protection Maximum load current: 80 mA NPN open collector (PF2A200) Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) Maximum applied voltage: 30 V Maximum load current: 80 mA PNP open collector (PF2A201) Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) NPN or PNP open collector (same as switch output) 4 outputs (1 output per 1 sensor input) With short circuit protection Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0), Window comparator mode: Fixed (3 digits) Note 6) 1 sec. or less ±5% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less ±2% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, 25°C) For measured value display: 4-digits, 7-segment LED (Orange) For channel display: 1-digit, 7-segment LED (Red) Illuminates when output is ON. OUT1: Green; OUT2: Red IP65 for the front face only, and IP40 for the remaining parts Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –10 to 60°C (No condensation or freezing) Operating or Stored: 35 to 85% RH (No condensation) 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each (de-energized) 980 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each (de-energized) 500 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Power supply / Output connection: 8P connector, Sensor connection: 4P connector (e-con) Housing: PBT, Display: PET, Backside rubber: CR 60 g (Except for any accessories that are shipped together) Note 1) Fixed SI unit [l/min or l] will be set for switch types without the unit switching function. (“-M” is suffixed at the end of part number.) Accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. Note 2) Flow rate display can be switched between the basic condition of 0°C, 101.3 kPa and the standard condition (ANR) of 20°C, 101.3 kPa, and 65% RH. Note 3) If Vcc side on sensor input connector part is short-circuited with the 0 V side, the flow monitor inside will be damaged. Note 4) Switch output and accumulated pulse output can be selected during initial setting. Note 5) The system accuracy when combined with an applicable flow sensor. Note 6) The display unit is comformed to CE mark. 122 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 123 For Air Digital Flow Switch Series PF2A Flow Characteristics (Pressure Loss) PF2A710/510 PF2A750/550 3.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 10 Pressure loss (kPa) Pressure loss (kPa) Pressure loss (kPa) 1.0 0 1 PF2A711/511 2.5 2.0 1.5 1.0 5 7.5 Flow rate (l/min) 0 10 PF2A721/521 6 4 2 0.5 2.5 8 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 Flow rate (l/min) 0 10 25 50 75 Flow rate (l/min) 100 PF2A751/551 50 Pressure loss (kPa) Pressure loss (kPa) 20 15 10 5 0 20 40 30 20 10 50 100 150 Flow rate (l/min) 200 0 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 Flow rate (l/min) Sensors Measuring Instruments Sensor Unit Construction PF2A710/750 PF2A510/550 q w e r w t w e Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 5 Description Attachment Seal Mesh Body Sensor Material ADC NBR Stainless steel PBT PBT Flow direction PF2A711/721/751 PF2A511/521/551 q w e r t y Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Attachment Seal Spacer Mesh Body Sensor Material ADC NBR PBT Stainless steel PBT PBT Flow direction 123 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 124 PF2A Dimensions: Integrated Display Type for Air Internal circuit and wiring example PF2A710/750 1 2 to 8 are terminal numbers. 98 82 60 67 58 6 17 1.6 Main circuit FLOW SWITCH 54 44 UP Brown 1 OUT1 OUT2 Load 4 Black Load 2 White SET OUT1 3 OUT2 Blue DOWN FOR AIR PF2A7--27(-M) 2-Port size 4-ø4.5 + 12 to – 24 VDC 24 40 50 Main circuit 1 (42.2) 4 Brown OUT1 Black Load White OUT2 2 + 12 to Load – 24 VDC 3 Blue 4 42 PF2A7--67(-M) 2-ø3.4 43 Flow direction PF2A711/721/751 64 23 116 88 1.6 Connector pin numbers 4 UP SET OUT1 OUT2 DOWN 1 FOR AIR 4– ø4.5 2-Port size 40 50 73 (42.2) Flow direction 124 3 34 54 44 FLOW SWITCH 30 2 Pin no. Pin description 1 DC (+) 2 OUT2 3 DC (–) 4 OUT1 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 125 For Air Series Digital Flow Switch PF2A Dimensions: Remote Type Sensor Unit for Air Internal circuit and wiring example 98 82 60 48.2 1 2 to 8 are terminal numbers. B 23 Sensor unit 1.6 Brown Display unit (PF2A30/31) 54 44 34 Main circuit 1 NC 2 White 2 4 Black 4 3 6 Main circuit PF2A510/550 8 Switch output + 12 to – 24 VDC Switch output + 12 to – 24 VDC 7 Blue 3 1 5 PF2A5- 2-Port size 40 50 24 Display unit (PF2A30/31) Sensor unit Brown 2 4 Load 2 White 4 (44.2) Main circuit 1 Analog output 3 Black 3 6 Main circuit 4-ø4.5 1 8 7 5 Blue Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter. PF2A5--1 (With voltage output type) Output specifications A B Pulse output only 42 62 52 Brown 72 Main circuit 2-ø3.4 Display unit (PF2A30/31) 1 4 Pulse output + Analog output Sensor unit 43 Analog output 2 White Flow direction 4 2 4 Load 3 Black 3 1 6 Main circuit A (mm) 8 Switch output 7 + 12 to – 24 VDC 5 Blue B 116 Wiring 23 1.6 Main circuit Brown (1) DC (+) 34 54 44 76.2 Black (4) OUT (Output for display unit) White (2) NC/Analog output Blue (3) DC (–) ∗ Use this sensor by connecting to SMC remote type display unit Series PF2A2/3. 4-ø4.5 40 50 2-Port size 30 Connector pin numbers 1 3 4 (44.2) 2 A (mm) Output specifications A B Pin no. Pulse output only 48 62 1 DC (+) Pulse output + Analog output 58 72 2 NC/Analog output 3 DC (–) 4 OUT Pin description Flow direction 125 Sensors Measuring Instruments Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter. PF2A5--2 (With voltage output type) PF2A511/521/551 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 126 PF2A Dimensions: Remote Type Display Unit for Air PF2A3-A Internal circuit and wiring example 1 2 to 8 are terminal numbers. Panel mounting type OUT2 40.3 40 Sensor 4.3 NC 4 Black 3 Brown 2 SMC FLOW SWITCH 8 Load OUT1 Main circuit 41.8 7 Load 6 + – Blue 5 40 35.8 1 A UNIT RESET 12 to 24 VDC Series PF2A5 PF2A30-A SET OUT2 Panel fitting dimensions 3 x 7.2 (= 21.6) 8-M3 6.4 36 Black 3 +0.5 0 Brown 2 8 Load OUT1 Main circuit Sensor NC 4 7 Load 6 + – Blue 5 1 2 3 12 to 24 VDC 4 Series PF2A5 5 6 7 PF2A31-A ∗ Do not connect the white wire of the sensor to 3 . 36 19.4 +0.5 0 1 Terminal block number 8 1 View A 5 Analog output 1 to 5 VDC 4 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 6 7 8 4 to 20 mADC Analog output [V] 20 Analog output [V] 5 1 4 Min. measured flow rate value Max. measured flow rate value Basic condition Part no. PF2A510--1 PF2A550--1 PF2A511--1 PF2A521--1 PF2A551--1 126 2 ∗ The applicable panel thickness is 1 to 3.2 mm. Real-time [l/min] flow rate Standard condition Minimum Maximum Minimum Maximum measured measured measured measured flow rate value flow rate value flow rate value flow rate value 1 5 10 20 50 10 50 100 200 500 Min. measured flow rate value 1.1 5.4 11 21 54 10.7 53.5 107 214 535 Max. measured flow rate value Basic condition Part no. PF2A510--2 PF2A550--2 PF2A511--2 PF2A521--2 PF2A551--2 Real-time [l/min] flow rate Standard condition Minimum Maximum Minimum Maximum measured measured measured measured flow rate value flow rate value flow rate value flow rate value 1 5 10 20 50 10 50 100 200 500 1.1 5.4 11 21 54 10.7 53.5 107 214 535 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 127 For Air Digital Flow Switch Series PF2A Dimensions: Remote Type Display Unit for Air (4 Channel Flow Monitor) PF2A200/201 40.1 40 (7.5) 2.5 6 36.8 L/min L OUT1 CH FLOW SMC SET Sensor connector (option) Front Protection Cover + Panel Mount 53 9.4 47 (2) 46.4 42.4 Sensors Measuring Instruments Panel mounting adapter Front protection cover Waterproof seal Panel 55 or more +0.1 55 or more 37.5 -0.2 Panel fitting dimensions Applicable panel thickness: 0.5 to 8 mm 127 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 128 PF2A Dimensions: Remote Type Display Unit for Air (4-channel Flow Monitor) Sensor connector (4P x 4) Connector (option) Sensor connector port r e w q Power supply / Output connector port Pin no. Terminal Connector no. q DC+ 1 Cable wire color Brown w N.C. 2 Not used e DC– 3 Blue r IN: 1 to 5 V 4 White Power supply / Output connector (8P) Power supply / Output connector (accessory) q w e r t y u i Pin no. Terminal q DC (+) w DC (–) e CH1_OUT1 r N.C. t CH2_OUT1 y CH3_OUT1 u CH4_OUT1 i N.C. Pin no. 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Yellow Green Red Gray White Black Blue Brown N.C. CH4_OUT1 CH3_OUT1 CH2_OUT1 N.C. CH1_OUT1 DC(–) DC(+) 2000 Internal circuit and wiring example 128 + CH1_OUT1 (Black) – Load 24 VDC Load CH2_OUT1 (Gray) CH3_OUT1 (Red) CH4_OUT1 (Green) DC (–) (Blue) Load 4 3 NC 2 1 DC (+) (Brown) Load 4 3 NC 2 1 Main circuit Sensor Load Load Sensor DC (–) (Blue) 4 3 NC 2 1 Sensor CH4_OUT1 (Green) – 4 3 NC 2 1 Sensor CH3_OUT1 (Red) 24 VDC Load 4 3 NC 2 1 CH2_OUT1 (Gray) + Load Sensor 4 3 NC 2 1 CH1_OUT1 (Black) Main circuit Sensor 4 3 NC 2 1 PF2A201 DC (+) (Brown) 4 3 NC 2 1 Sensor Sensor PF2A200 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 129 Digital Flow Switch/Large Flow Type For Air Series PF2A For details about certified products conforming to international standards, visit us at www.smcworld.com. How to Order Integrated display type PF2A7 Flow rate range 03 06 12 150 to 3000 l/min 300 to 6000 l/min 600 to 12000 l/min H M Unit specification High flow type Port specification Wiring specification (Refer to page 152.) Nil M12 3 m lead wire with connector Without lead wire N Rc NPT G Nil N F Port size Symbol Port size 10 14 20 1 11/2 2 Flow rate (l/min) 3000 6000 12000 Applicable model PF2A703H PF2A706H PF2A712H Nil M With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l, m3, m3 x 103 Output specification 28 29 68 69 NPN open collector 1 output + Analog output (1 to 5 V) NPN open collector 1 output + Analog output (4 to 20 mA) PNP open collector 1 output + Analog output (1 to 5 V) PNP open collector 1 output + Analog output (4 to 20 mA) Switching of switch output and accumulated pulse output is possible with NPN or PNP open collector outputs. Specifications Switch output Note 4) Output specification Accumulated Note 4) pulse output Analog output Note 5) Resistance Response time Hysteresis Power supply voltage Current consumption Enclosure Operating temperature range Withstand voltage Insulation resistance Vibration resistance Impact resistance Noise resistance Weight Port size (Rc, NPT, G) PF2A703H 150 to 3000 l/min 5 l/min PF2A706H PF2A712H Dry air, Nitrogen Heater type 300 to 6000 l/min 600 to 12000 l/min 10 l/min l/min, CFM l, m3, m3 x 103, ft3, ft3 x 103, ft3 x 106 0.1 to 1.5 MPa 2.25 MPa 20 kPa (at maximum flow rate) 0 to 9,999,999,999 l ±1.5% F.S. or less (0.7 MPa, at 20°C) ±1.0% F.S. or less (0.7 MPa, at 20°C), ±3.0% of F.S. or less in case of analog output ±1.5% F.S. or less (0.1 to 1.5 MPa, based on 0.7 MPa) ±2.0% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, based on 25°C) NPN open collector Max. load current: 80 mA; Max. applied voltage: 30 V; Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) PNP open collector Max. load current: 80 mA; Internal voltage drop: 1.5 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) NPN or PNP open collector Flow rate per pulse: 100 l/pulse, 10.0 ft3/pulse Pulse width: 50 msec Output voltage: 1 to 5 V; Load impedance: 100 kΩ or more Output current: 4 to 20 mA; Load impedance: 250 Ω or less 1 sec. or less Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0); Window comparator mode: (can be set from 0 to 3% F.S.) 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) 150 mA or less IP65 0 to 50°C (No condensation) 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case 50 MΩ (500 VDC) between external terminal and case 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns 1.1 kg (Without lead wire) 2.0 kg (Without lead wire) 1.3 kg (Without lead wire) 1 11/2 2 Note 1) Flow rate display can be switched between the basic condition of 0°C, 101.3 kPa and the standard condition (ANR) of 20°C, 101.3 kPa, and 65% RH. Note 2) For digital flow switch with unit switching function. (Fixed SI unit [(l/min, or l, m3 or m3 x 103)] will be set for switch type without the unit switching function.) Note 3) The high flow rate type is CE marked; however, the linearity with applied noise is ±5% F.S. or less. Note 4) Switch output and accumulated pulse output selections are made using the button controls. Note 5) The analog output operates only for real-time flow rate, and does not operate for accumulated flow. 129 Sensors Measuring Instruments Model Measured fluid Detection type Flow rate measuring range Note 1) Minimum setting unit Note 1) Note 2) Real-time flow rate Display unit Accumulated flow Operating pressure range Proof pressure Pressure loss Accumulated flow range Linearity Note 3) Repeatability Pressure characteristics Temperature characteristics ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 130 PF2A Flow Characteristics (Pressure Loss) PF2A703H PF2A706H 20 10 600 1200 1800 2400 Flow rate (l/min) 3000 20 Pressure loss (kPa) Pressure loss (kPa) Pressure loss (kPa) 20 0 150 PF2A712H 10 0 300 1200 2400 3600 4800 Flow rate (l/min) 6000 10 0 600 2400 4800 7200 9600 12000 Flow rate (l/min) Construction q w e y r t Component Parts Flow direction 130 No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Attachment Seal Mesh Body Sensor Spacer Material Aluminum alloy HNBR Stainless steel Aluminum alloy PPS PBT Note Anodized — — Anodized — — ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 131 For Air Digital Flow Switch Series PF2A Dimensions PFA703H/706H/712H D Internal circuit and wiring example E B 1 to 4 are terminal numbers. F 1 A Main circuit Load 4 2 U P SET MODE DOWN 3 C 60 2-G ON OFF OUT1 Black Analog output White 50 msec + – 24 VDC Load Blue Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter, ammeter. 28 PF2A7H-- 29 (-M) (42.2) 4 3 1 Main circuit 1 2 Connector pin numbers 4-I thread with depth J Accumulated pulse output Brown 4 OUT1 Black 2 Analog output White Load 3 Pin no. 40 Accumulated pulse output Brown ON OFF Load 50 msec + – 24 VDC Blue Pin description Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter, ammeter. 1 DC (+) 2 Analog output 68 PF2A7H-- 69 (-M) 3 DC (–) 4 OUT1 Accumulated pulse output wiring examples Max. 30 V 80 mA or less H OUT1 Load Black 0V Blue or 50 msec 50 msec A Model PF2A703H PF2A706H PF2A712H B C E F G 92 67 55 Rc 1, NPT 1, G 1 65 180 45 104 79 65 75 220 55 114 89 75 55 160 40 D H I J 36 M5 x 0.8 8 Brown Rc 11/2, NPT 11/2, G 11/2 46 M6 x 1 9 Rc 2, NPT 2, G 2 56 M6 x 1 9 OUT1 Load Black 80 mA 0V or 50 msec 50 msec PF2A7H-- 68 69 (-M) Analog output 1 to 5 VDC 4 to 20 mADC 20 Analog output [V] Analog output [V] 5 1 4 Min. measured flow rate value Part no. PF2A703H--28 PF2A703H--68 PF2A706H--28 PF2A706H--68 PF2A712H--28 PF2A712H--68 Max. measured flow rate value Real-time [l/min] flow rate Minimum measured flow rate value [l/min] Maximum measured flow rate value [l/min] 150 3000 300 6000 600 12000 Min. measured flow rate value Part no. PF2A703H--29 PF2A703H--69 PF2A706H--29 PF2A706H--69 PF2A712H--29 PF2A712H--69 Max. measured flow rate value Real-time [l/min] flow rate Minimum measured flow rate value [l/min] Maximum measured flow rate value [l/min] 150 3000 300 6000 600 12000 131 Sensors Measuring Instruments 28 PF2A7H-- 29 (-M) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 132 Digital Flow Switch For Water Series PF2W For details about certified products conforming to international standards, visit us at www.smcworld.com. How to Order Integrated display type PF2W7 20 Flow rate range 04 0.5 to 4 l/min 20 2 to 16 l/min 40 5 to 40 l/min 11 10 to 100 l/min Symbol Port size 03 04 06 10 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 03 27 M Thread type Nil N F Flow rate (l/min) 4 16 40 100 Unit specification Rc NPT G Wiring specification (Refer to page 152.) Port size Nil N Applicable model PF2W704, PF2W720 PF2W720, PF2W740 PF2W740, PF2W711 PF2W711 M12 3 m lead wire with connector Without lead wire Nil M With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l Output specification 27 NPN open collector 2 outputs 67 PNP open collector 2 outputs Specifications Model Measured fluid Flow rate measurement range Set flow rate range Flow rate measuring range Minimum set unit Accumulated pulse flow rate exchange value (Pulse width: 50 ms) Note 5) Output specification Switch output Resistance Accumulated pulse output Indicator light Response time Hysteresis Power supply voltage Enclosure Operating temperature range Withstand voltage Insulation resistance Vibration resistance Impact resistance Noise resistance PF2W720 PF2W740 PF2W711 Water 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45 l/min 7 to 110 l/min 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45 l/min 7 to 110 l/min 2 to 16 l/min 5 to 40 l/min 10 to 100 l/min 0.1 l/min 0.5 l/min 1 l/min 0.1 l/pulse 0.5 l/pulse 1 l/pulse 0 to 50°C ±5% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less ±2% F.S. or less ±5% F.S. or less (0° to 50°C, based on 25°C) 70 mA or less 80 mA or less 520 g 460 g 700 g 1150 g 3/8, 1/2 3/8 1/2, 3/4 3/4, 1 Karman vortex 3-digit, 7-segment LED l/min, gal (US)/min l, gal (US) 0 to 1 MPa 1.5 MPa 0 to 999999 l Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) 0.35 to 4.5 l/min 0.35 to 4.5 l/min 0.5 to 4 l/min 0.05 l/min 0.05 l/pulse Maximum load current: 80 mA; Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) NPN open collector Maximum applied voltage: 30 V; 2 outputs Maximum load current: 80 mA Internal voltage drop: 1.5 V or less (With load current of 80 mA); 2 outputs NPN or PNP open collector (same as switch output) Illuminates when output is ON. OUT1: Green; OUT2: Red 1 sec. or less Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0), Window comparator mode: 3-digit fixed Note 6) 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) IP65 0 to 50°C 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns PNP open collector Note 1) In the case of PF2W711, ±3% of F.S. or less (15°C to 35°C, based on 25°C). Note 2) Without lead wire. Note 3) For digital flow switch with unit switching function. (Fixed SI unit [l/min or l] will be set for switch type without the unit switching function.) Note 4) Accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. Note 5) Switch output and accumulated pulse output can be selected during initial setting. Note 6) Window comparator mode — Since hysteresis will reach 3 digits, keep P_1 and P_2 or n_1 and n_2 apart by 7 digits or more. (In case of output OUT2, n_1, 2 to be n_3, 4 and P_1, 2 to be P_3, 4.) Note 7) The flow switch is comformed to CE mark. 132 Sensors Measuring Instruments Operating fluid temperature Linearity Repeatability Temperature characteristics Note 1) Current consumption (No load) Weight Note 2) Port size (Rc, NPT, G) Detection type Display Note 3) Real-time flow rate Display unit Accumulated flow Operating pressure range Proof pressure Accumulated flow range Note 4) Ambient temperature range PF2W704 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 133 For Water Digital Flow Switch PF2W Series How to Order Remote type Sensor unit PF2W5 20 C 03 Flow rate range 04 0.5 to 4 l/min 20 2 to 16 l/min 40 5 to 40 l/min 11 10 to 100 l/min Option (Refer to page 152.) Nil C Thread type The cable and connector are shipped unassembled. Rc NPT G Nil N F None e-con connector x 1 pc. Wiring specification (Refer to page 152.) Port size Port Symbol size 03 04 06 10 3/8 1/2 3/4 1 Flow rate (l/min) 4 16 40 100 Nil N Applicable model PF2W504, PF2W520 PF2W520, PF2W540 PF2W540, PF2W511 PF2W511 M12 3 m lead wire with connector Without lead wire Output specification Symbol Nil 1 2 Applicable display unit (monitor) model Specification Output for display unit (sensor output) only Series PF2W300 Output for display unit + Analog output (1 to 5V) Series PF2W200/300 Output for display unit + Analog output (4 to 20 mA) Series PF2W300 Specifications Model PF2W504 PF2W520 Measured fluid Detection type 5 to 40 l/min 10 to 100 l/min Karman vortex 0.5 to 4 l/min 2 to 16 l/min Operating pressure range Withstand pressure 0 to 1 MPa 1.5 MPa Operating fluid temperature 0 to 50°C Linearity Note 1) Repeatability PF2W511 Note 1) 0 to 50°C ±5% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less ±1% F.S. or less (connected with PF2W33) ±3% F.S. or less (connected with PF2W2) ±2% F.S. or less (15 to 35°C based on 25°C), ±3% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C based on 25°C) Output for display unit Pulse output, N channel, open drain, output for display unit PF2W3. (Specifications: Maximum load current of 10mA; Maximum applied voltage of 30 V) Output Note 2) specification Temperature characteristics Voltage output 1 to 5 V within the flow rate range Linearity: ±5% F.S. or less; allowable load resistance: 100 kΩ or more. Analog output Current output 4 to 20 mA within the flow rate range Linearity: ±5% F.S. or less; allowable load resistance: 300 Ω or less with 12 VDC, 600 Ω or less with 24 VDC 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) Power supply voltage 20 mA or less Current consumption (No load) Resistance Enclosure IP65 Operating temperature range Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) Withstand voltage 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case Insulation resistance Vibration resistance 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each Impact resistance 490 m/s in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each Noise resistance 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Weight Note 3) Port size (Rc, NPT, G) 4.9 m/s2 2 410 g 470 g 650 g 1,100 g 3/8 3/8, 1/2 1/2, 3/4 3/4, 1 Note 1) The system accuracy when combined with PF2W2/3. Note 2) Output system can be selected during initial setting. Note 3) Without lead wire. (Add 20 g for the types of analog output whether voltage or current output selected.) Note 4) The sensor unitis comformed to CE mark. 133 Sensors Measuring Instruments Flow rate measuring range PF2W540 Water ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 134 PF2W Series How to Order Remote type Display unit PF2W3 0 0 A M Unit specification Flow rate range Symbol Flow rate range Type for sensor unit 0.5 to 4 l/min 2 to 16 l/min 5 to 40 l/min 10 to 100 l/mim 0 3 PF2W504 PF2W520 PF2W540 PF2W511 Panel mounting A With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l Panel mount adapter part no. Output specification 0 1 Nil M Mounting NPN open collector 2 outputs PNP open collector 2 outputs Panel adapter B ZS-22-02 Description Part no. Specifications PF2W300/301 Model PF2W330/331 Flow rate measurement range Note 1) 0.35 to 4.5 l/min 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45 l/min 7 to 110 l/min Set flow rate range Note 1) 0.35 to 4.5 l/min 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45 l/min 7 to 110 l/min 0.05 l/min 0.1 l/min 0.5 l/min 1 l/min 0.05 l/pulse 0.1 l/pulse 0.5 l/pulse 1 l/pulse Minimum setting unit Note 1) Accumulated pulse flow rate exchange value (Pulse width: 50 ms) Note 1) Note 2) Display unit Real-time flow rate l/min, gal (US)/min Accumulated flow l, gal (US) Accumulated flow range Note 3) 0 to 999999 l Linearity Note 4) ±5% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less Repeatability Note 4) ±3% F.S. or less ±1% F.S. or less Temperature characteristics Current consumption (No load) ±2% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, based on 25°C), ±1% F.S. or less (15 to 35°C, based on 25°C) Output Note 5) specification Accumulated pulse output Operating temperature range Resistance 45 g NPN open collector (PF2W300, PF2W330) Maximum load current: 80 mA Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) Maximum applied voltage: 30 V 2 outputs PNP open collector (PF2W301, PF2W331) Maximum load current: 80 mA Internal voltage drop: 1.5 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) 2 outputs Switch output Enclosure Withstand voltage 60 mA or less 50 mA or less Weight NPN or PNP open collector (Same as switch output) IP40 Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case Insulation resistance 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each Impact resistance 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each Noise resistance 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Display Indicator light Power supply voltage Response time Hysteresis 3-digit, 7-segment LED Illuminates when output is ON. OUT1: Green; OUT2: Red 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) 1 sec. or less Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0) Window comparator mode: 3-digit fixed Note 6) Note 1) Values vary depending on each set flow rate range. Note 2) For digital flow switch with unit switching function. (Fixed SI unit [l/min or l] will be set for switch types without the unit switching function.) Note 3) Accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. Note 4) The system accuracy when combined with PF2W5. Note 5) Switch output and accumulated pulse output can be selected during initial setting. Note 6) Window comparator mode — Since hysteresis (H) will reach 3 digits, keep P_1 and P_2 or n_1 and n_2 apart by 7 digits or more. (In case of output OUT2, n_1, 2 to be n_3, 4 and P_1, 2 to be P_3, 4.) Note 7) The display unit is comformed to CE mark. 134 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 135 For Water Digital Flow Switch Series PF2W How to Order 4-channel Flow Monitor Remote type Display unit PF2W20 M Output specification Accessory / Power supply output cable (2 m) 0 1 Option 2 (Refer to page 152.) NPN 4 outputs PNP 4 outputs None Sensor connector (4 pc.) Nil 4C Unit specification Nil M Option 1 (Refer to page 152.) With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) None Panel mounting Front protective cover + Panel mounting Nil A B Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l Connectable remote type sensor part is PF2W5--1 (with analog output 1 to 5 V). Specifications Model Applicable flow rate sensor PF2W200/201 PF2W520/520T--1 PF2W540/540T--1 PF2W511--1 Flow rate measurement range Note 1) 0.35 to 4.50 l/min 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45.0 l/min 7 to 110 l/min Set flow rate range Note 1) Minimum set unit Note 1) Accumulated pulse flow rate exchange value (Pluse width: 50 ms) Note 1) Note 1) Real-time flow rate Display unit Accumulated flow Accumulated flow range Note 1) Power supply voltage Current consumption Power supply voltage for sensor Power supply current for sensor Note 3) Sensor input No. of inputs Input protection 0.35 to 4.50 l/min 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45.0 l/min 7 to 110 l/min 0.05 l/min 0.1 l/min 0.5 l/min 1 l/min 0.05 l/pulse 0.1 l/pulse 0.5 l/pulse 1 l/pulse Switch output (Real-time switch output, Accumulated switch output) Accumulated pulse output No. of outputs Output protection Hysteresis Response time Note 4) Linearity Note 4) Repeatability Note 4) Temperature characteristics Display method Resistance Indicator light Enclosure Operating temperature range Operating humidity range Vibration resistance Impact resistance Noise resistance Connection Material Weight l/min, gal (US)/min l, gal (US) 0 to 999999 l, 0 to 999999 gal (US) 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) 55 mA or less (Not including the current consumption of the sensor) Same as [Power supply voltage] Max. 110 mA (However, the total current for the 4 inputs is 440 mA maximum or less.) Sensors Measuring Instruments Output Note 3) specification PF2W504/504T--1 1 to 5 VDC (Input impedance: Approx: 800 kΩ) 4 inputs NPN open collector (PF2W200) PNP open collector (PF2W201) Excess voltage protection Maximum load current: 80 mA Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) Maximum applied voltage: 30 V Maximum load current: 80 mA Internal voltage drop: 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) NPN or PNP open collector (same as switch output) 4 outputs (1 output per 1 sensor input) With short circuit protection Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0), Window comparator mode: Fixed (3 digits) 1 sec. or less ±5% F.S. or less ±3% F.S. or less ±2% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, 25°C) For measured value display: 4-digits, 7-segment LED (Orange) For channel display: 1-digit, 7-segment LED (Red) Illuminates when output is ON. OUT1: Green IP65 for the front face only, and IP40 for the remaining parts Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –10 to 60°C (No condensation or freezing) Operating or Stored: 35 to 85% RH (No condensation) 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each (de-energized) 980 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each (de-energized) 500 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Power supply / Output connection: 8P connector, Sensor connection: 4P connector (e-con) Housing: PBT, Display: PET, Backside rubber: CR 60 g (Except for any accessories that are shipped together) Note 1) Fixed SI unit [l/min or l] will be set for switch types without the unit switching function. (“-M” is suffixed at the end of part number.) Accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. Note 2) If Vcc side on sensor input connector part is short-circuited with 0 V side, the flow monitor inside will be damaged. Note 3) Switch output and accumulated pulse output can be selected during initial setting. Note 4)The system accuracy when combined with applicable flow sensor. Note 5) The display unit is comformed to CE mark. 135 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 136 PF2W Flow Characteristics (Pressure Loss) PF2W704/504 PF2W720/520 0.030 0.05 0.020 0.015 0.010 0.07 0.04 Pressure loss (MPa) Pressure loss (MPa) Pressure loss (MPa) 0.025 0.03 0.02 0.06 0.05 0.04 0.03 0.02 0.01 0.005 0 PF2W740/540 0.01 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 Flow rate (l/min) 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 Flow rate (l/min) 14 16 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 Flow rate (l/min) 35 PF2W711/511 0.035 Pressure loss (MPa) 0.030 0.025 0.020 0.015 0.010 0.005 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100110 Flow rate (l/min) Sensor Unit Construction q w e w r Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 Flow direction 136 Description Attachment Seal Body Sensor Material Stainless steel NBR PPS PPS 40 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 137 For Water Digital Flow Switch Series PF2W Dimensions: Integrated Display Type for Water PF2W704/720 67 58 L Internal circuit and wiring example 6 1.6 17 60 1 to 4 are terminal numbers. Main circuit 1 FLOW SWITCH 34 54 44 UP SET OUT1 OUT1 Brown Load 4 Black OUT2 2 OUT2 DOWN 3 FOR WATER Load White Blue + – 12 to 24 VDC PF2W7--27(-M): NPN type 4-ø4.5 2-Port size 40 50 1 (42.2) Brown Main circuit OUT1 4 Black Load White OUT2 + 2 Load 3 73 Blue – 12 to 24 VDC 4 42 PF2W7--67(-M): PNP type Connector pin numbers 2-ø3.4 4 3 1 2 43 Flow direction Model L dimension PF2W704 100 PF2W720 106 120 60 67 6 17 1.6 Pin description 1 DC (+) 2 OUT2 3 DC (–) 4 OUT1 Sensors Measuring Instruments PF2W740 Pin no. FLOW SWITCH OUT1 34 34 55 60 50 UP SET OUT2 DOWN FOR WATER 4-ø4.5 2-Port size 40 50 34 34 73 (42.2) Flow direction 137 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 138 PF2W Dimensions: Integrated Display Type for Water PF2W711 148 80 77 79 32 UP SET OUT1 OUT2 4-ø5.5 DOWN 2-Port size 36 60 88 46 Flow direction 138 45 46 58 70 FLOW SWITCH (42.2) 45 9 2 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 139 For Water Digital Flow Switch Series PF2W Dimensions: Remote Type Sensor Unit for Water PF2W504/520-(N)- Internal circuit and wiring example B L 1 2 to 8 are terminal numbers. 60 48.2 23 1.6 Sensor unit Brown NC Display unit (PF2W30/31) 2 White 2 4 Black 4 3 6 Main circuit 54 44 34 Main circuit 1 8 12 to 24 VDC Switch output 7 + – Blue 3 4-ø4.5 40 50 2-Port size 1 5 PF2W5- 6 Display unit (PF2W30/31) Sensor unit Brown 2 Analog output Load 2 White 4 Black 3 4 3 6 Main circuit (44.2) Main circuit 1 1 8 12 to 24 VDC Switch output 7 + – 5 A Blue Output specification A B Output for display unit only 42 62 Output for display unit + Analog output 52 72 Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter. PF2W5--1 (With voltage output type) 4 43 Sensor unit Brown 1 Model L dimension PF2W504 100 PF2W520 106 2 Analog output Load 2 White 4 Black 3 4 3 6 1 8 12 to 24 VDC Switch output 7 + – 5 Blue Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter. PF2W5--2 (With voltage output type) PF2W540-(N)- B 120 60 48.2 23 1.6 Wiring Main circuit 34 55 60 50 Brown (1) DC (+) Black (4) OUT (Output for display unit) White (2) NC/Analog output Blue (3) DC (–) 4-ø4.5 40 50 2-Port size 6 ∗ Use this sensor by connecting to SMC remote type display unit Series PF2W2/3. (44.2) Connector pin numbers Flow direction Output specification A B Output for display unit only 42 62 Output for display unit + Analog output 52 72 2 1 3 4 Pin no. Pin description 1 DC (+) 2 NC/Analog output 3 DC (–) 4 OUT 139 Sensors Measuring Instruments Main circuit Flow direction Display unit (PF2W30/31) Main circuit 2-ø3.4 A ECOPS.qxd ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 140 PF2W Dimensions: Remote Type Sensor Unit for Water PF2W511-(N)- B 148 80 45 70 58 46 32 36 2-Port size 2 45 (44.2) 4-ø5.5 A B Output for display unit only 63 77 Output for display unit + Analog output 73 87 A Output specification Flow direction Analog output 1 to 5 VDC 4 to 20 mADC Analog output [V] 20 Analog output [V] 5 1 4 0 0 Min. measured flow rate value Part no. PF2W504--1 PF2W520--1 PF2W540--1 PF2W511--1 140 Max. measured flow rate value Real-time [l/min] flow rate Minimum measured Maximum measured flow rate value [l/min] flow rate value [l/min] 0.5 2 4 16 5 40 10 100 Min. measured flow rate value Part no. PF2W504--2 PF2W520--2 PF2W540--2 PF2W511--2 Max. measured flow rate value Real-time [l/min] flow rate Minimum measured Maximum measured flow rate value [l/min] flow rate value [l/min] 0.5 2 4 16 5 40 10 100 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 141 For Water Series Digital Flow Switch PF2W Dimensions: Remote Type Display Unit for Water PF2W3-A Internal circuit and wiring example Panel mounting type 1 2 to 8 are terminal numbers. OUT2 Sensor 40.3 4.3 Black 3 Brown 2 SMC FLOW SWITCH 8 7 35.8 40 UNIT 6 12 to 24 VDC Series PF2W5 SET PF2W30-A Panel fitting dimensions 8-M3 36 +0.5 0 OUT2 Sensor 3 4 NC 4 Black 2 36 19.4 +0.5 0 3 Brown 8 7 6 Blue 5 1 5 6 7 Load + – 12 to 24 VDC 8 Series PF2W5 View A Load OUT1 Main circuit 6.4 2 + – 5 A RESET 1 Load Blue 1 3 x 7.2 (= 21.6) Load OUT1 Main circuit 41.8 40 NC 4 ∗ The applicable panel thickness is 1 to 3.2 mm. PF2W31-A ∗ Do not connect the white wire of the sensor to 3 . Sensors Measuring Instruments Terminal block number 1 5 2 4 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 6 7 8 141 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 142 PF2W Dimensions: Remote Type Display Unit for Water (4-channel Flow Monitor) PF2W200/201 40.1 40 (7.5) 2.5 6 36.8 L/min L OUT1 CH FLOW SMC SET Sensor connector (option) Front Protection Cover + Panel Mount 53 9.4 47 (2) 46.4 42.4 Panel mounting adapter Front protection cover Waterproof seal 55 or more +0.1 55 or more 37.5 -0.2 Panel fitting dimensions Applicable panel thickness: 0.5 to 8 mm 142 Panel ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 143 For Water Digital Flow Switch Series PF2W Dimensions: Remote Type Display Unit for Water (4-channel Flow Monitor) Sensor connector (4P x 4) Connector (option) Sensor connector port r e w q Power supply / Output connector port Pin no. Terminal Connector no. q DC+ 1 Cable wire color Brown w N.C. 2 Not used e DC– 3 Blue r IN: 1 to 5 V 4 White Power supply / Output connector (8P) Power supply / Output connector (accessory) q w e r t y u i Pin no. Terminal q DC (+) w DC (–) e CH1_OUT1 r N.C. t CH2_OUT1 y CH3_OUT1 u CH4_OUT1 i N.C. Pin no. 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Yellow Green Red Gray White Black Blue Brown N.C. CH4_OUT1 CH3_OUT1 CH2_OUT1 N.C. CH1_OUT1 DC(–) DC(+) 2000 Sensors Measuring Instruments Internal circuits and wiring example DC (–) (Blue) 4 3 NC 2 1 CH1_OUT1 (Black) – Load 24 VDC CH2_OUT1 (Gray) Load 4 3 NC 2 1 + CH3_OUT1 (Red) CH4_OUT1 (Green) DC (–) (Blue) Load Load Load 4 3 NC 2 1 DC (+) (Brown) Load CH4_OUT1 (Green) – 4 3 NC 2 1 Main circuit CH3_OUT1 (Red) 24 VDC Load 4 3 NC 2 1 CH2_OUT1 (Gray) + Load Sensor 4 3 NC 2 1 CH1_OUT1 (Black) Main circuit Sensor 4 3 NC 2 1 PF2W201 DC (+) (Brown) 4 3 NC 2 1 Sensor Sensor PF2W200 143 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 144 Digital Flow Switch/High Temperature Fluid Type For Water Series PF2A For details about certified products conforming to international standards, visit us at www.smcworld.com. How to Order Integrated display type PF2W7 20 T 03 27 Flow rate range 04 0.5 to 4 l/min 20 2 to 16 l/min 40 5 to 40 l/min Temperature range T Wiring specification (Refer to page 152.) Thread type Nil N F Rc NPT G Unit specification 0 to 90°C Port size Flow rate (l/min) Symbol Port Applicable model size 4 16 40 03 3/8 PF2W704T, PF2W720T 04 1/2 PF2W720T, PF2W740T 06 3/4 PF2W740T Nil N M12 3 m lead wire with connector Without lead wire Output specification Nil M With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note 2) Note) Fixed unit: Real-time flow rate: l/min Accumulated flow: l 27 PNP open collector 2 outputs 67 NPN open collector 2 outputs Specifications Model Measured fluid Flow rate measurement range Set flow rate range Flow rate measuring range Minimum setting unit PF2W704T PF2W720T PF2W740T Output Note 5) specification Water, Mixture of water (50%) and ethylene glycol (50%) 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45 l/min 0.35 to 4.5 l/min 1.7 to 17.0 l/min 3.5 to 45 l/min 0.35 to 4.5 l/min 2 to 16 l/min 5 to 40 l/min 0.5 to 4 l/min 0.1 l/min 0.5 l/min 0.05 l/min Accumulated pulse flow rate exchange value (Pulse width: 50 ms) 0.1 l/pulse 0.5 l/pulse 0.05 l/pulse Operating fluid temperature 0 to 90°C (With no cavitation) Linearity ±5% F.S. or less Repeatability ±3% F.S. or less Temperature characteristics Note 1) ±5% F.S. or less (0 to 90°C, based on 25°C) Current consumption (No load) 70 mA or less Weight Note 2) 710 g Port size (Rc, NPT, G) 3/8 1/2, 3/4 3/8, 1/2 Detection type Karman vortex Display 3-digit, 7-segment LED Note 3) Real-time flow rate l/min, gal (US)/min Display unit l, gal (US) Accumulated flow Operating pressure range 0 to 1 MPa Withstand pressure 1.5 MPa Accumulated flow range Note 4) 0 to 999999 l Maximum load current: 80 mA; Internal voltage drop: NPN open collector 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) Maximum applied voltage: 30 V; 2 outputs Switch output Resistance Accumulated pulse output Indicator light Response time Hysteresis Power supply voltage Enclosure Operating temperature range Withstand voltage Insulation resistance Vibration resistance Impact resistance Noise resistance PNP open collector Maximum load current: 80 mA; Internal voltage drop: 1.5 V or less (With load current of 80 mA); 2 outputs NPN or PNP open collector (Same as switch output) Illuminates when output is ON. OUT1: Green; OUT2: Red 1 sec. or less Hysteresis mode: Variable (can be set from 0); Window comparator mode: 3-digit fixed Note 6) 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) IP65 Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Note 1) ±5% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, based on 25°C), ±3% F.S. or less (15 to 35°C, based on 25°C) Note 2) Without lead wire. Note 3) For digital flow switch with unit switching function. (Fixed SI unit [l/min or l] will be set for switch type without the unit switching function.) Note 4) Accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. Note 5) Switch output and accumulated pulse output can be selected during initial setting. Note 6) Window comparator mode — Since hysteresis will reach 3 digits, keep P_1 and P_2 or n_1 and n_2 apart by 7 digits or more. (In case of output OUT2, n_1, 2 to be n_3, 4 and P_1, 2 to be P_3, 4.) Note 7) The flow switch is comformed to CE mark. 144 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 145 For Water Digital Flow Switch Series PF2W How to Order Remote type Display unit PF2W5 20 T C 03 Flow rate range 04 0.5 to 4 l/min 20 2 to 16 l/min Temperature range 40 5 to 40 l/min 0 to 90°C T Option (Refer to page 152.) Nil Thread type C Rc NPT G Nil N F The cable and connector are shipped unassembled. Wiring specification (Refer to page 152.) Port size Symbol 03 04 06 Port Flow rate (l/min) Applicable model size 4 16 40 3/8 PF2W504T/520T 1/2 PF2W520T/540T 3/4 PF2W540T Model Nil N Specification Applicable display unit (monitor) model Series PF2W300 Output for display unit Series PF2W200/300 Output for display unit + Analog output (1 to 5 V) Series PF2W300 Output for display unit + Analog output (4 to 20 mA) PF2W520T PF2W504T Measured fluid Karman vortex 0.5 to 4 l/min 2 to 16 l/min Operating pressure range Withstand pressure 1.5 MPa 0 to 90°C (With no cavitation) ±2% F.S. or less Repeatability Note 1) Output Note 2) specification ±2% F.S. or less (15 to 35°C based on 25°C), ±3% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C based on 25°C) Pulse output, N channel, open drain, output for display unit PF2W3. (Specifications: Maximum load current of 10 mA; Maximum applied voltage of 30 V) Voltage output 1 to 5 V within the flow rate range Linearity: ±5% F.S. or less; allowable load resistance: 100 kΩ or more. Analog output Current output 4 to 20 mA within the flow rate range Linearity: ±5% F.S. or less; allowable load resistance: 300 Ω or less with 12 VDC, 600 Ω or less with 24 VDC 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) Power supply voltage 20 mA or less Current consumption (No load) Enclosure Resistance Sensors Measuring Instruments ±5% F.S. or less Linearity Note 1) Output for display unit 5 to 40 l/min 0 to 1 MPa Operating fluid temperature Temperature characteristics PF2W540T Water, Mixture of water (50%) and ethylene glycol (50%) Detection type Flow rate measuring range M12 3 m lead wire with connector Without lead wire Output specification Symbol Nil 1 2 Specifications None e-con connector x 1 pc. IP65 Operating temperature range Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –25 to 85°C (No condensation or freezing) Withstand voltage 1000 VAC for 1 min. between external terminal and case Insulation resistance 50 MΩ or more (500 VDC Mega) between external terminal and case Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller: 1.5 mm amplitude or 98 m/s2 acceleration in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each Impact resistance 490 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each Noise resistance 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µs, Rise time 1 ns Weight Note 3) Port size (Rc, NPT, G) 660 g 3/8 3/8, 1/2 1/2, 3/4 Note 1) The system accuracy when combined with PF2W3/3. Note 2) Output system can be selected during initial setting. Note 3) Without lead wire. (Add 20 g for the types of analog output whether voltage or current output selected.) Note 4) The sensor unitis comformed to CE mark. Display units are the same as those of remote type digital flow switch for water (series PF2W3/ PF2W20). Refer to page 134, 135 for details. 145 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 146 PF2W Flow Characteristics (Pressure Loss) PF2W704T/504T PF2W720T/520T 0.05 0.020 0.015 0.010 0.04 0.03 0.02 0.06 0.05 0.04 0.03 0.02 0.01 0.005 0 0.07 Pressure loss (MPa) 0.025 Pressure loss (MPa) Pressure loss (MPa) 0.030 PF2W740T/540T 0.01 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 Flow rate (l/min) 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 Flow rate (l/min) 14 16 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 Flow rate (l/min) 35 Sensor Unit Construction q w e w r Component Parts No. 1 2 3 4 Flow direction 146 Description Attachment Seal Body Sensor Material Stainless steel FKM PPS PPS 40 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 147 For Water Digital Flow Switch Series PF2W Dimensions: Integrated Display Type for Water PF2W704T/720T/740T Internal circuit and wiring example 1 to 4 are terminal numbers. 74 120 23 1.6 FLOW SWITCH UP OUT1 Load 4 2 Load White 3 + 12 to – 24 VDC Blue DOWN PF2W7T--27(-M) FOR WATER 1 2-Port size 40 50 (42.2) 34 Brown OUT1 4 Black Load White OUT2 2 + 12 to Load – 24 VDC 3 Blue Main circuit 4-ø4.5 Brown Black OUT2 34 60 50 SET OUT1 OUT2 1 Main circuit 60 PF2W7T--67-M) Connector pin numbers 3 1 2 34 77 4 Flow direction Pin no. Pin description 1 DC (+) OUT2 3 DC (–) 4 OUT1 Sensors Measuring Instruments 2 147 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 148 PF2W Dimensions: Remote Type Sensor Unit for Water B Internal circuit and wiring example 23 1.6 120 60 1 2 to 8 are terminal numbers. Sensor unit Brown Display unit (PF2W30/31) Main circuit 34 60 50 1 2 NC 2 White 4 Black 4 3 6 Main circuit PF2W504T/520T/540T-(N) 8 12 to 24 VDC Switch output 7 + – Blue 3 1 5 PF2W5T- 4-ø4.5 34 2-Port size 40 50 Display unit (PF2W30/31) Sensor unit Brown Analog output 2 White 4 2 4 Load 3 Black 3 6 Main circuit (44.2) Main circuit 1 1 8 12 to 24 VDC Switch output 7 + – 5 Blue A B Output for display unit only 52 72 Output for display unit + Analog output 62 Sensor unit Brown 82 Display unit (PF2W30/31) 1 Flow direction Analog output 2 White 4 2 Load Black 3 4 3 6 Main circuit Output specification Main circuit A Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter. PF2W5T--1 (With voltage output type) 1 8 7 12 to 24 VDC Switch output + – 5 Blue Analog output 1 to 5 VDC 4 to 20 mADC Load is an analog input equipment such as a voltmeter. PF2W5T--2 (With voltage output type) Wiring 20 Analog output [V] Analog output [V] 5 Main circuit Brown (1) DC (+) 1 4 0 0 Black (4) OUT (Output for display unit) White (2) NC/Analog output Blue (3) DC (–) Min. measured flow rate value Part no. PF2W504T--1 PF2W520T--1 PF2W540T--1 Max. measured flow rate value Real-time [l/min] Min. measured flow rate flow rate value Minimum measured Maximum measured flow rate value [l/min] flow rate value [l/min] 0.5 4 2 16 5 40 Part no. PF2W504T--2 PF2W520T--2 PF2W540T--2 Max. measured flow rate value Real-time [l/min] flow rate Minimum measured Maximum measured flow rate value [l/min] flow rate value [l/min] 0.5 4 2 16 5 40 ∗ Use this sensor by connecting to SMC remote type display unit Series PF2W3. Connector pin numbers 4 3 1 2 Pin no. 148 Pin description 1 DC (+) 2 NC/Analog output 3 DC (–) 4 OUT ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 149 For Air/Water Digital Flow Switch Series PF2A/PF2W Operating Unit Description Integrated Display Type Remote Type Display Unit PF2A710/750/711/721/751 PF2W704(T)/720(T)/740(T)/711 PF2A300/301/310/311 PF2W300/301/330/331 q q w t w SMC FLOW SWITCH r UP e SET e OUT1 y OUT2 SET DOWN u t u r UNIT RESET y RESET button ( + button) If the UP and DOWN buttons are pressed simultaneously, the RESET function will activate. In case of an emergency, please clear the display. The display of the accumulated flow will be reset to zero. q LED display/Red Displays the measured flow rate, each setting condition, and error code. Indicator w (PF2A7, PF2A3 for air only) Illuminates when the normal condition (nor) is selected. e r t y u Output (OUT1) display/Green Displays the output condition of OUT1. Illuminates when turned ON. Output (OUT2) display/Red Displays the output condition of OUT2. Illuminates when turned ON. UP button ( button) Use to change the mode or to increase the set value. SET button ( button) Use this button to set the valve or the set mode. DOWN button ( button) Use to change the mode or decrease the set value. Integrated Display Type q r e i w Displays the measured flow rate, each setting condition, and error code. q LCD display/Orange w Output (OUT1) display/Orange Displays the output condition of OUT1. Illuminates when turned ON. e Unit display/Orange t u UP S E T MODE DOWN y Flow rate confirmation Displays the selected unit. Type without unit switching function is fixed SI units (l/min, or l, m3, m3 x 103). r display/Orange The blinking intervals change depending on the flow rate value. t y u i UP button ( button) Use to change the mode or to increase the set value. SET button ( button) Use to select the function. DOWN button ( button) Use to change the mode or decrease the set value. MODE button ( button) Use for changing the function. 4-channel Flow Monitor (Remote Type Display Unit) PF2A200/201 PF2W200/201 q w e r q LCD display/Orange w Switch output display/Red L/min L t OUT1 CH y SET u i Displays the measured flow rate, each setting condition, and error code. Displays the output condition of OUT1 (CH1 to 4). Illuminates when turned ON. Unit display of flow rate for air/ CH1 to 4 will illuminate when the normal condition (nor) is e Red (PF2A200, 201 for air only) selected. r Unit display/Orange t y u i Illuminates the selected unit. Use after putting the unit label other than l/min, l. Channel display/Red Displays the selected channel. UP button ( button) Use to change the mode or to increase the set value. SET button Use this button to set the value or the set mode. DOWN button ( button) Use to change the mode or decrease the set value. 149 Sensors Measuring Instruments RESET button ( + button) If the UP and DOWN buttons are pressed simultaneously, the RESET function will activate. In case of an emergency, please clear the display. The display of the accumulated flow will be reset to zero. PF2A703H/706H/712H ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 150 PF2A/PF2W Series Functions Refer to the operation manual how to set and to operate. Flow rate measurement selection Real-time flow rate and accumulated flow rate can be selected. Up to 999999 of flow rate value can be accumulated. The accumulated flow rate is reset when the power supply turns OFF. (PF2A7H maintains the values.) Output type Real-time switch output, accumulated switch output, or accumulated pulse output can be selected as an output type. Real-time switch output • Hysteresis mode Unit switching ON YES For Air Display OFF Real-time flow rate P-2 P-1 High flow rate → Accumulated flow l/min l CFM x 10–2, CFM x 10–1 ft3 x 10–1 “P” • Window comparator mode H: Hysteresis H H ON CFM = ft3/min High Flow Rate Type (For Air) Display Real-time flow rate NO l/min l CFM gal (US) OUT1 Output mode ON YES High Temperature Fluid Type (For Water) Real-time flow rate Accumulated flow l/min l GPM P-1 P-2 High flow rate → • Hysteresis mode ∗ OUT2 is the same. Display OFF Accumulated flow OFF n-2 n-1 High flow rate → • Window comparator mode H: Hysteresis H H ON “n” gal (US) Note 2) Output mode is set to inverted output at the factory before shipment. GPM = gal (US)/min Note) Fixed SI unit [l/min or l, m3 or m3 x 10] will be set for the type without the unit switching function. NO OFF n-1 n-2 High flow rate → Flow rate conversion Basic state: 0°C, 101.3 kPa Standard state: 20°C, 101.3 kPa, 65%RH (ANR) Switchable between these states. Accumulated switch output ON “P” Flow rate measuring unit confirmation OFF This function allows to confirm the accumulated flow rate when real-time flow rate is selected and to confirm the real-time flow rate when accumulated flow rate is selected. OUT1 P-3 High flow rate → Output mode Key lock This function prevents incorrect operations such as changing the set value accidentally. ON “n” Accumulation clearance This is to clear the accumulated value. OFF Note 2) n-3 High flow rate → Note 2) Output mode is set to inverted output at the factory before shipment. Initialization of setting (Only for series PF2A7H) This is to restore the setting to the initial state when dispatched from the factory. Accumulated pulse output “P” ON OFF OUT1 Output mode 50 msec ON “n” OFF Note 2) Note 1) For digital flow switch with unit switching function. (Fixed SI unit [l/min or l, m3 or m3 x 103] will be set for switch types without unit switching function.) Refer to the specifications of display unit for the flow rate value per pulse. 150 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 151 For Air/Water Digital Flow Switch Functions Series PF2A/PF2W Refer to the operation manual how to set and to operate. Copy function (PF2200, 201 only) Channel select function (PF2200, 201 only) Information to be copied is: q Flow rate range w Display mode e Display unit (Only available when the unit specification is nil.) r Output method t Output mode y Flow rate display unit (available with PF2A20 only) u Flow rate value Every pushing the button, channel selection “12341...” is available. The flow rate measurement of each selected channel is shown in the display unit. Channel scan function (PF2200, 201 only) Changes displaying the channel shown every about 2 seconds and its detected flow rate. Peak hold, Bottom hold display function (PF2200, 201 only) The maximum or minimum value can be held in the case where the real-time flow rate display mode is selected during the initial setting. Error correction LED display Contents Solution Note 1) A current of more than 80 mA is flowing to OUT1. Check the load and the wiring for OUT1. Note 2) Check the load and the wiring for OUT2. The set data has changed for some Note 1) reason. Perform the RESET operation, and reset all the data again. The flow rate is over the flow rate measurement Note 2) range. Use an adjustment valve, etc. to reduce the flow rate until it is within the flow rate range. A current of more than Note 2) Note 1) Sensors Measuring Instruments Note 1) 80 mA is flowing to OUT2. Note 1) Applicable to display integrated type and remote type except PF2A7H series. Note 2) Applicable to PF2A7H series only. For PF2A/W200, 201 LED display Contents Solution Over current is flowing to the load of a switch output. Shut off the power supply. After eliminating the output factor that caused the excess current, turn the power supply back on. Internal data error. Internal data error. Contact SMC. Internal data error. Internal data error. Shut off the power supply and then reset the switch. Internal data error. The flow rate is over the flow rate measurement range. Use an adjustment valve, etc. to reduce the flow rate until it is within the flow rate range. 151 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 152 PF2A/PF2W Option When only optional parts are required, order with the part numbers listed below. M12 lead wire with connector e-con connector Part no. Qty. Lead wire length Part no. Qty. ZS-29-A 1 3m ZS-28-CA-4 1 T1 OU T2 OU U P T SE DO WN e-con connector M12 lead wire with connector PF2A7 (H) PF2W7 (T) PF2A20 PF2W20 M12 lead wire with connector PF2A5 PF2W5 (T) In addition to the lead wire assembly shown above, those listed below (female contact) can be connected. However, they cannot be connected with an e-con connector because the diameter of the core wire and its coverage diameter are different. For details, contact each manufacturer. Connector size M12 Pin no. 4 In addition to the connectors shown above, those listed below (e-con) can be connected. Manufacturer Model Manufacturer Applicable series Sumitomo 3M Limited 37104-3122-000FL Correns Corp. VA-4D Tyco Electronics AMP K.K. 2-1473562-4 OMRON Corp. XS2 OMRON Corp. XN2A-1430 Yamatake Co.,Ltd. PA5-4I Hirose Electric Co., Ltd. HR24 DKK Ltd. CM01-8DP4S Panel mounting Pin no. Description Note Part no. Description Note ZS-22-E Panel mounting adapter A, B With mounting bracket ZS-26-B ZS-26-C Panel mounting adapter With waterproof seal, mounting screw Panel PF2A3 PF2W3 Front protective cover + Panel mounting adapter With waterproof seal, mounting screw Front protective cover Mounting screw (M3 x 8 L) (accessory) Panel mounting adapter A Panel mounting adapter B Mounting bracket (accessory) Panel mounting adapter PF2A20 PF2W20 152 Waterproof seal (accessory) Panel ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 153 Related Product: Multi Counter Series CEU5 How to Order CEU5 Power supply voltage Nil Output transistor mode Nil NPN open collector output P PNP open collector output A B COM DC12V GND F.G. R.S. HOLD COM BANK1 BANK2 MULTI COUNTER:CEU5 100 to 240 VAC D COM COUNT PRESET FUNC. UP RIGHT LEFT 24 VDC DOWN MODE SEL. AC100~240VCOM OUT1OUT2OUT3OUT4OUT5S.STOP RD External output Nil RS-232C B RS-232C + BCD SET SD SG RS-232C Connection Method Connection with the Digital Flow Switch (Series PF2) COM B COM DC12V GND F.G. R.S. HOLD COM BANK1 BANK2 MULTI COUNTER:CEU5 COUNT Sensors Measuring Instruments A PRESET FUNC. UP RIGHT LEFT BCD DOWN MODE SEL. AC100~240VCOM OUT1OUT2OUT3OUT4OUT5S.STOP RD SET SD SG RS-232C RS-232C • OUT1 to OUT 5 • OUT1 to OUT20 (Bank switching) • Binary output (31 points) • Possible to measure accumulated pulse output of a Digital Flow Switch by an unit of 100 l (litter) and 10 ft3 (cube foot) using the pre-scaling function* of the multi counter (When inputting to the multi counter, Up or Down is selected as input method.) • Possible to take advantage of all CEU5 functions using preset mode and function mode. * The set value is calculated by selecting manual mode. By multiplication by 4, then, per pulse value is set. <Connection with other manufacturers’ encoders> • Possible to switch multi counter side input method to 2-phase or Up/Down. • Possible to connect to an encoder if the output method is Open Collector. • When selecting UP or DOWN, phase A to COM input is counted toward addition direction, phase B to COM input is counted toward subtraction direction. Caution When connecting the CEU5 with an encoder from another manufacturer, please thoroughly confirm the specification beforehand. Please note that the CEU5 may not count normally depending on the output method, output frequency and connecting cable length, etc. of the encoders. Regarding connection with scale cylinder, refer to “Stroke reading cylinders & Counters CE series” in the Best Pneumatics Vol. 10. 153 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 154 High Precision 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE30/ISE30 Air tool Maintenance Vacuum Air blow 2-color digital display allows you to choose the setting according to your application requirements. 4 different display settings are available. Red Green Green Red ® Red Red Green Green ∗ The picture shown is an image, which differs from the actual display. Abnormal conditions can be detected at a glance! PRESSURE OUT PRESSURE kPa OUT SET PRESSURE kPa OUT SET PRESSURE kPa OUT SET PRESSURE kPa kPa OUT SET SET With one-touch fittings (ø4, ø6, ø5/32", ø1/4") Reduced dimensions in piping direction 17.8 mm reduction∗ 12.4 mm reduction∗ Straight type Elbow type 14.4 22.4 17.8 mm 32.2 12.4 mm 34.8 KQ2H06-M5 KQ2L06-M5 ∗ Comparison when One-touch fittings (KQ2H06-M5 / KQ2L06-M5) are connected to the piping ports (M5 x 0.8) 154 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 155 High Precision 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE30/ISE30 Space saving improvement Space saving improvement Before Display calibration ZSE4E ISE4E its own pa Before nel openin g. 40 Each displa y required 126 After After Just one p anel openin g is required fo r st displays, w ackable hic mounted e h can be ithe or vertically r horizontally . This function allows uniformity in the numbers displayed. More user-friendly controls 103.5 Compact p rofile Plug-type connectors take the burden out of wiring work and maintenance. With analog output Applicable panel thickness is up to 6 mm (Panel mounting) In addition to the conventional voltage output type (1 to 5 V) Current output type (4 to 20 mA) is now available. • Convenient when longer wiring is required • Excellent noise resistance Switches for vacuum and positive pressure can be easily distinguished. The different display panel frame colors easily tell them apart. Vacuum/Low pressure (ZSE30) Blue Positive pressure (ISE30) Gray High precision resolution: 1/1000 Variations Vacuum/Low pressure Positive pressure ZSE30 ISE30 Rated pressure range 100 kPa 1 MPa 0 0 –100 kPa Setting/Display resolution Switch output Output 0.2 kPa 0.001 MPa NPN/PNP open collector (1 output) Analog output Voltage output: 1 to 5 V; Current output: 4 to 20 mA Current consumption 45 mA or less (70 mA or less for current output) Option Panel mount/Bracket 155 Sensors Measuring Instruments Raised rubber button controls are clearly set apart, simple to operate, soft to the touch. 34.5 ZSE30 ISE30 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 156 ZSE30/ISE30 ® How to Order Option 1 Without lead wire Nil Lead wire with connector (Lead wire length: 2 m) L For positive pressure ISE30 01 25 M For vacuum/low pressure ZSE30 01 25 M Piping specification 01 R 1/8 (With M5 female thread) T1 NPT 1/8 (With M5 female thread) C4H ø4 One-touch fitting ø5/32" One-touch fiting C6H ø6 One-touch fitting N7H ø1/4" One-touch fitting C4L ø4 One-touch fitting ø5/32" One-touch fitting C6L ø6 One-touch fitting N7L ø1/4" One-touch fitting Option 2 Nil None Bracket A Straight type Panel mount Output specification 25 NPN output 65 PNP output 26 1 to 5 V output 28 4 to 20 mA output B Elbow type Panel mount adapter + Front protective cover D Option Part No. When optional parts are required separately, use the following part numbers to place an order. Option Lead wire with connector Part no. Note ZS-27-A Bracket ZS-27-B Lead wire length: 2 m With mounting screws (M3 x 5 L: 2 pcs.) With M3 x 8 L (2 pcs.) Panel mount adapter ZS-27-C Panel mount adater + Front protective cover ZS-27-D 156 With M3 x 8 L (2 pcs.) Unit specification Nil M With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) (International System of Units) Note) Fixed unit: For vacuum/Low pressure: kPA For positive pressure: MPa ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 157 High Precision 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE30/ISE30 Specifications ZSE30 (Vacuum/Low pressure) ISE30 (Positive pressure) Rated pressure range –100.0 to 100.0 kPa 0.000 to 1.000 MPa Set pressure range –101.0 to 101.0 kPa –0.100 to 1.000 MPa Withstand pressure 500 kPa 1.5 MPa Min. regulating unit 0.2 kPa 0.001 MPa Fluid Air, Inert gas, Non-flammable gas Power supply voltage 12 to 24 VDC, Ripple (p-p) 10% or less (With power supply polarity protection) Current consumption 45 mA or less (at no load) Switch output Note 1) NPN or PNP open collector output: 1 output Max. load current 80 mA Max. applied voltage 30 V (With NPN output) Residual voltage 1 V or less (With load current of 80 mA) Response time 2.5 ms or less (Response time selections with anti-chattering function: 20, 160, 640, 1280 ms) Short circuit protection Yes Repeatability ±0.2% F.S. ±2 digit or less ±0.2% F.S. ±1 digit or less Output voltage: 1 to 5 V ±2.5% F.S. or less (With rated pressure range) Linearity: ±1% F.S. or less, Output impedance: Approx. 1 kΩ Output current: 4 to 20 mA ±2.5% F.S. or less (With rated pressure range) Linearity: ±1% F.S. or less Maximum load impedance: 300 Ω with power supply voltage of 12 V; 600 Ω with power supply voltage of 24 V Minimum load impedance: 50 Ω Note 2) Voltage output Analog output Hysteresis Note 3) Current output Hysteresis mode Window comparator mode Adjustable (can be set from 0) 3 1/2 digit, 7-segment indicator, 2-color display (Red and green) Sampling cycle: 5 times/s Display ±2% F.S. ±2 digit ±2% F.S. ±1 digit (at 25°C ambient temperature) (at 25°C ambient temperature) Illuminates when output is ON. (Green) Indicator light ±2% F.S. or less (based on 25°C) Temperature characteristics IP40 Enclosure Operating temperature range Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –10 to 60°C (No freezing or condensation) Operating and stored: 35 to 85% RH (No condensation) Operating humidity range 1000 VAC for 1 min. between live parts and enclosure Withstand voltage 50 MΩ or more between live parts and enclosure (at 500 VDC) Insulation resistance 10 to 150 Hz, 1.5 mm or 20 m/s2 amplitude in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hours each Vibration resistance 100 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each Impact resistance Compliant with CE Marking and UL (CSA) standards Standard Note 1) When switch output is selected, analog output is not available. Note 2) When voltage output is selected, a simultaneous selection of switch output and current output is not available. Note 3) When current output is selected, a simultaneous selection of switch output and voltage output is not available. Piping Specifications Part Port size 01 T1 C4H C6H N7H C4L C6L N7L R1/8 M5 x 0.8 NPT1/8 M5 x 0.8 — — — — — — One-touch fitting Straight type — — ø4 mm ø5/32 inch ø6 mm ø1/4 inch — — — One-touch fitting Elbow type — — — — — ø4 mm ø5/32 inch ø6 mm ø1/4 inch Wetted part material Weight With lead wire with connector (2 m) Without lead wire with connector Sensor pressure receiving area: Silicon, Piping port: C3602 (Electroless nickel plated), O-ring: HNBR O-ring: NBR O-ring: NBR, fitting: PBT 81 g 76 g 78 g 43 g 38 g 40 g Function Various additional functions are available for easy measurement, switch operation and check of measured values suitable for the conditions of the measured fluid. Anti-chattering function Key lock function Peak hold function Bottom hold function Zero out function Unit conversion (for overseas use) Note 2) Prevents malfunction due to sudden fluctuations in the primary pressure by adjusting the response time. The key board operation can be locked to prevent incorrect operation on the operation switch. Can retain the maximum pressure value displayed during measurement. Can retain the minimum pressure value displayed during measurement. The pressure display can be set at zero when the pressure is open to the atmosphere. Can convert the display value (for overseas use only). 157 Sensors Measuring Instruments Environmental resistance Display accuracy ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 158 ZSE30/ISE30 Unit Descriptions Indication light (Green) LCD display Displays the switch operation status. MPa UP button OUT SET Use this button to change the mode or increase the ON/OFF set value. It also allows you to switch to the peak value display mode. SET button Example of Internal Circuit and Wiring Residual pressure error Contents Solution Shut off the power supply. After eliminating Load current of switch the output factor that output is more than 80 mA. caused the excess current, turn the power supply back on. Pressure is applied during the zero out operation as follows: When the switch for positive pressure is used: ±0.071 MPa or more. When the switch positive pressure is used: ±7.1 kPa or more. After displaying for 3 seconds, it will return to the measuring mode. Due to the individual product difference, the setting range varies ±10% F.S. Bring the pressure back to atmospheric pressure and try using the zero out function. -25 NPN open collector output Maximum 30 V, 80 mA Residual voltage: 1 V or less Brown DC(+) Main circuit Take the following corrective solutions when errors occur. -26 Analog output type 1 to 5 V (±2.5% F.S.) Output impedance: 1 kΩ Load + Black OUT – 12 to 24 VDC Brown DC(+) Main circuit Error Correction overcurrent error DOWN button Use this button to change the mode or decrease the ON/OFF set value. It also allows you to switch to the bottom value display mode. Use this button to switch the mode and set the set value. Error LCD description display Displays the current pressure condition, setting mode conditions, selected display unit, and error codes. A display color type can be selected from either a single color display with red or green, or 2-color display in which green and red are switched according to the output. Black OUT (Analog output) Load + – 12 to 24 VDC Blue DC(–) Supply pressure is below the minimum regulating pressure. Reduce/Increase supply pressure to within the regulating pressure range. -28 Analog output type 4 to 20 mA (±2.5% F.S.) Maximum load impedance: Power supply voltage 12 V: 300 Ω Power supply voltage 24 V: 600 Ω Minimum load impedance: 50 Ω Internal data error Brown DC(+) Main circuit Applied pressure error Supply pressure exceeds the maximum regulating pressure. Black OUT (Analog output) Load 12 to – 24 VDC + Blue DC(–) System error Internal data error Internal data error -65 PNP open collector Maximum 80 mA Brown DC(+) Main circuit Internal data error Shut off the power supply. Turn the power supply back on. If the power should not come back on, please contact SMC for an inspection. Load Blue DC(–) 158 12 to – 24 VDC + Black OUT ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 159 High Precision 2-color Display Series Digital Pressure Switch ZSE30/ISE30 Dimensions 30 25 8 9.5 Lead wire with connector 3.6 20 ± 0.1 SMC OUT SET Wi dth 2-M3 x 0.5 Thread depth 4 M5 x 0.8 MPa 10 PRESSURE 20 ± 0.1 1.5 01: R1/8 T1: NPT1/8 ac ros sf lat s1 2 A øB C A øB Straight One-touch fitting size ø4, ø5/32" ø6 ø1/4" Straight A B 14.4 11.2 (mm) Elbow C B A 10.4 18 20 22.4 12.8 20 22.8 13.2 20.5 Elbow With One-touch fitting Sensors Measuring Instruments 15 4.2 10 42.5 With bracket 3 22 30 20 1.8 30 45 SMC 20 25 35 35 159 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 160 ZSE30/ISE30 Dimensions Panel mount 7.2 17.8 8 9.5 34.5 R4 .5 MPa .5 R4 21 PRESSURE 47.8 OUT SET MADE IN JAPAN 8.75 Panel thickness 0.5 to 6 Panel mount adapter + Front protective cover 42.4 11 17.8 8 9.5 34.5 Panel thickness 0.5 to 6 160 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 161 High Precision 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE30/ISE30 Dimensions Panel fitting dimension Multiple (2 pcs. or more) horizontal mounting PRESSURE OUT SET PRESSURE MPa MPa OUT SET OUT PRESSURE MPa SET 1-pc. mounting 31 x n pcs. + 3.5 x (n pcs. – 1) 24 and up 0 31 – 0.4 0 31 –0.4 MADE IN JAPAN MADE IN JAPAN MADE IN JAPAN Sensors Measuring Instruments Multiple (2 pcs. or more) vertical mounting 0 31–0.4 PRESSURE 24 and up MPa SET PRESSURE MPa OUT SET PRESSURE 31 x n pcs. + 3.5 x (n pcs. – 1) OUT MADE IN JAPAN MADE IN JAPAN MPa OUT SET MADE IN JAPAN 161 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 162 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE40/ISE40 Air Tool Air Line Maintenance Vacuum Air Blow High precision and high resolution Vacuum pressure Compound pressure Positive pressure → High speed response: 2.5 ms or less Pressure Momentary change With anti-chattering function P1 Set value P2 Stable switch output is possible even with sudden changes in the primary pressure (when operating large bore cylinders, etc.). Time → Anti-chattering function Devices such as large bore cylinders and high-flow vacuum ejectors consume a large volume of air when they operate, and this may cause a momentary drop in the primary pressure. This function prevents such momentary pressure drops from being detected as abnormal pressures by allowing the response time selection to be changed. t (ms) t (ms) (Averaging) (Averaging) Switch output ON operation when normal OFF Time → [Selectable response times: t] 2.5 ms (normal), 24 ms, 192 ms or 768 ms The normal setting is selected when shipped from the factory. Switch output ON operation when anti-chattering OFF function is used (Operating principle) The pressure values measured within the user-selected response time are averaged, and switch output (ON/OFF) is determined by comparing this averaged pressure value with the set pressure. Time → Without using auto shift When the primary pressure fluctuates, a correct determination becomes impossible. Allows switch output unaffected by variations in primary pressure. → With auto shift function 1/1000 (0.1 kPa) 11/2000 (0.1 kPa) 1/1000 (0.001 MPa) Pressure Auto shift function Erroneous operation may occur if there is fluctuation in the primary pressure. The auto shift function compensates for pressure changes to ensure proper ON/OFF switch response during such fluctuations. (Operating principle) At the point when the primary pressure fluctuates, the set pressure value is compensated by setting the auto shift input (external input) to low (no-voltage) input, using the pressure measured at that point as a standard. Set value Primary pressure normal Able to detect suction pressure (vacuum pressure) and elease pressure (positive pressure) with a single pressure switch. 3 types of piping Different piping methods are possible to accommodate the installation location. Primary pressure ncrease P1 P2 Time → Switch output ON 1, 2 OFF Does not turn OFF Does not turn ON Time → → When using auto shift Compound pressure (ZSE40F) Primary pressure drop Pressure Set value Set value compensation Primary pressure normal Set value compensation Primary pressure drop Primary pressure ncrease P1 P2 Time → Switch output ON 1, 2 OFF Time → 5 ms or more 10 ms or less output response time [Switch when auto shift is input. ] Hi Auto shift input Lo Time → Repeatability IP65 compatible ±0.2% F.S. ±1 digit or less Dusttight/Splash proof type 162 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 163 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE40/ISE40 How to Order Set pressure range Nil –0.100 to 1.000 MPa For positive pressure For positive pressure ISE40 01 22 M For vacuum/compound pressure ZSE40 01 22 M Option Set pressure range Nil F Nil 10.0 to –101.3 kPa For vacuum pressure –100.0 to 100.0 kPa For compound pressure Piping specification None Bracket A (ZS-24-A) Bracket B (ZS-24-B) Bracket D (ZS-24-D) A W1 : Rc 1/8 ∗ WF1: G 1/8 01: R 1/8 (With M5 female threads) T1: NPT 1/8 (With M5 female threads) Reverse pressure two directions R 1/8, NPT 1/8 Rc 1/8, G 1/8 M5 x 0.8 female threads B Rc 1/8, G 1/8 ∗ M5: M5 x 0.8 (Female threads) ∗ C4: With ø4 One-touch fitting ∗ C6: With ø6 One-touch fitting Wall mount D Refer to the dimensions. Wall mount E M5 x 0.8 ø4, ø6 One-touch fitting ∗ Option Panel mount (ZS-24-C) + Front protective cover Piping specification/Options Description Symbol 01 Bracket A A Bracket B B Bracket D D Panel mount E Panel mount + Front protective cover F Piping specifications T1 W1 WF1 C4 C6 M5 F : Available ∗ When optional parts only are required, order with the part numbers inside ( ). : Not available Unit specification Input/Output specification 22 30 62∗ 70∗ (ZS-22-A) NPN open collector 2 outputs + analog output NPN open collector 2 outputs + auto shift input PNP open collector 2 outputs + analog output PNP open collector 2 outputs + auto shift input Nil M With unit switching function SI unit only Note) Note) Fixed unit For vacuum/compound pressure: kPa For positive pressure: MPa ∗ Option Note When equipped with auto shift function, the following ranges can be set. Set pressure range –100.0 to 100.0 kPa 10.0 to –101.3 kPa –0.1 to 1.000 MPa Setting range –100.0 to 100.0 kPa –101.3 to 101.3 kPa –1.000 to 1.000 MPa Lead wire length Nil L 0.6 m 3m 163 Sensors Measuring Instruments Panel mount ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 164 ZSE40/ISE40 Specifications ZSE40F (Compound pressure) –100.0 to 100.0 kPa –100.0 to 100.0 kPa Rated pressure range Set pressure range Withstand pressure Set pressure resolution Analog output ISE40 (Positive pressure) 0.000 to 1.000 MPa –0.100 to 1.000 MPa 1.5 MPa — 0.001 500 kPa 0.1 — Air, Non-corrosive/Non-flammable gas 12 to 24 VDC ±10%, Ripple (p-p) 10% or less (With power supply polarity protection) 55 mA or less NPN or PNP open collector output: 2 outputs 80 mA 30 V (With NPN output) 1 V or less (With 80 mA load current) 2.5 ms or less (With anti-chattering function: 24 ms, 192 ms and 768 ms selections) Yes ±0.2% F.S. ±1 digit or less Variable (can be set from 0) Fixed (3 digits) 3 1/2 digit LED display (Sampling cycle: 5 times/sec.) ±2% F.S. ±1 digit or less (at ambient temperature of 25°C) Green LED (OUT1: Illuminates when ON), Red LED (OUT2: Illuminates when ON) kPa MPa Applicable fluid Power supply voltage Current consumption Switch output Max. load current Max. applied voltage Residual voltage Response time Short circuit protection Repeatability Hysteresis mode Hysteresis Window comparator mode Display Display accuracy Indicator light Note 2) ZSE40 (Vacuum pressure) –101.3 to 0.0 kPa –101.3 to 10.0 kPa Output voltage: 1 to 5 V Output voltage: 1 to 5 V ±2.5% F.S. or less (in rated pressure range) ±5% F.S. or less (in rated pressure range) Linearity: ±1% F.S. or less Linearity: ±1% F.S. or less Output impedance: Approx. 1 kΩ Output impedance: Approx. 1 kΩ Auto shift input Note 3) Enclosure No-voltage input (Reed or solid state), input 5 ms or more IP65 Operating: 0 to 50˚C, Stored: –10 to 60°C (No condensation or freezing) Ambient temperature range Operating/Stored: 35 to 85% RH (No condensation) Ambient humidity range Environmental 1000 VAC for 1 min. between lead wires and body Withstand voltage resistance Insulation resistance 50 MΩ or more (at 500 VDC) between lead wires and body 10 to 500 Hz at the smaller of amplitude 1.5 mm or acceleration 98 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each (De-energized) Vibration resistance 980 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each (De-energized) Impact resistance ±2% F.S. or less of pressure measured at 25°C Temperature characteristics 01: R 1/8, M5 x 0.8, T1: NPT1/8, M5 x 0.8, W1: Rc 1/8 Port size C4: With ø4 One-touch fitting, C6: With ø6 One-touch fitting, M5: M5 female threads 5-wire oilproof heavy-duty vinyl cord (0.15 mm2) Lead wire 01/T1 types approx. 60 g, W1 type approx. 80 g, C4/C6/M5 types approx. 92 g (Each including 0.6 m lead wires) Weight Note 1) For ZSE40F/ZSE40/ISE40--22 62 Note 2) ZSE40F/ZSE40/ISE40--30 70 Note) When equipped with auto shift function, the following ranges can be set. Model ZSE40F-- 30 70 ZSE40-- 30 70 ISE40-- 30 70 Set pressure range –100.0 to 100 kPa –101.3 to 101.3 kPa –1.0000 to 1.000 MPa Functions Various additional functions are available for easy measurement, switch operation and check of measured values suitable for the conditions of the measured fluid. Auto shift function Note 1) Anti-chattering function Key lock function Peak hold function Bottom hold function Zero out function Unit conversion (for overseas use) Note 2) Can correct the pressure set point value of switch output according to fluctuations in the primary pressure. Prevents malfunction due to sudden fluctuations in the primary pressure by adjusting the response time. The key board operation can be locked to prevent incorrect operation on the operation switch. Can retain the maximum pressure value displayed during measurement. Can retain the minimum pressure value displayed during measurement. The pressure display can be set at zero when the pressure is open to the atmosphere. Can convert the display value (for overseas use only). Note 1) Select and order by specifying the types and models. 164 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 165 High Precision Series Digital Pressure Switch ZSE40/ISE40 Setting Calibration procedure Initial setting Manual pressure setting Zero out Key lock mode Enter the set value of the pressure to perform switch output. Adjusts the zero point of the atmospheric pressure. Mode is not switched, even if the button is pressed during operation. Auto preset Manual pressure setting Normal operation Automatically sets the pressure for the adsorption confirmation or supply pressure confirmation. Allows fine-tuning of the data set automatically by auto preset. Measured pressure is displayed and the switch operation begins. Set “Output mode”, “Response time” and “Auto or Manual mode.” Calibration Procedure 3 1/2-digit LED kPa LED (Red) LED (Green) Displays OUT1 output condition. When it is ON, the LED is illuminated. UP button Sensors Measuring Instruments Displays present pressure. Displays each mode. Displays error mode. OUT2 OUT1 SET Displays OUT2 output condition. When it is ON, the LED is illuminated. DOWN button Switches the mode and set value. Switching of the mode and set value SET button Switches to each mode and fixes the set value. 165 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 166 ZSE40/ISE40 Output Method ON YES OFF P-2 • Hysteresis mode P-1 High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) High vacuum (for vacuum pressure) [P] H H (Fix hysteresis) = 3 digits H ON NO • Window comparator mode OFF P-1 P-2 High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) High vacuum (for vacuum pressure) Output mode OUT1 ON ∗ Same with OUT2. YES OFF n-2 • Hysteresis mode n-1 High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) High vacuum (for vacuum pressure) [n] H H (Fix hysteresis) = 3 digits H ON NO OFF n-1 n-2 • Window comparator mode High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) High vacuum (for vacuum pressure) 1.2 kΩ 6.8 kΩ DC (–) (Blue) DC (+) (Brown) Auto shift input (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) 166 6.8 kΩ DC (–) (Blue) Load Main circuit 12 VDC to 24 VDC 1.2 kΩ DC (+) (Brown) Auto shift input (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) Load DC (–) (Blue) Load With auto shift input Load With analog output Main circuit ZSE40(F)/ISE40- -70(L)-(M) 1 kΩ 12 VDC to 24 VDC DC (–) (Blue) ZSE40(F)/ISE40- -62(L)-(M) DC (+) (Brown) Analog output (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) Load 12 VDC to 24 VDC Main circuit 1 kΩ DC (+) (Brown) Analog output (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) Load With auto shift input Load ZSE40(F)/ISE40- -30(L)-(M) With analog output Main circuit ZSE40(F)/ISE40- -22(L)-(M) Load Example of Internal Circuit and Wiring 12 VDC to 24 VDC ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 167 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE40/ISE40 Dimensions ZSE40(F)/ISE40– 01 T1 20 30 M5 x 0.8 thread depth 5 20 30 MPa OUT2 OUT1 Lead wire ength Wi dth ac ro 12 ss fl ats 6.4 2-M3 x 0.5 thread depth 4 1.5 01: R 1/8 T1: NPT 1/8 30 2.5 14 4.5 15.2 2.6 10.7 7.8 7 ø3.5 12 .4 600 (3000) Atmospheric release port 18.35 SET Bracket A Sensors Measuring Instruments A View A 2-M3 x 5L 15 1.6 11.5 40 4.5 55 45 30 4.5 20 6.5 (26.7) Bracket D A View A 2-M3 x 5L 4.2 1.6 15 40 11.5 55 45 30 22 35 (26.7) 7.2 167 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 168 ZSE40/ISE40 Dimensions ZSE40(F)/ISE40– W1 WF1 2-M4 x 0.7 thread depth 4 30 20 W1: Rc 1/8 WF1: G 1/8 30 20 7 MPa OUT2 OUT1 600 (3000) Lead wire length Atmospheric release port 5 R 6.4 18.35 19 SET 6. 2.5 7 6 4 10.7 15.2 30 2.6 42 7.8 12 .4 ø3.5 W1: Rc 1/8 WF1: G 1/8 12 Bracket A A 30 View A 4.5 (30.7) 20 6.5 Bracket B A 30 v 6.5 168 4.5 5 4. 4.5 1.6 12.1 30 45 46.1 2-M4 x 5L 15 4.5 1.6 11.5 40 55 49 2-M4 x 5L ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 169 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch Series ZSE40/ISE40 Dimensions Bracket D A 30 View A 4.2 1.6 15 11.5 40 55 49 2-M4 x 5L 22 (30.7) 35 7.2 C4 ZSE40(F)/ISE40– C6 M5 32.3 30 20 4. 2- 5 12.8 Lead wire length Atmospheric release port 6.4 18.35 19 SET 25.4 OUT2 OUT1 600 (3000) Sensors Measuring Instruments 30 MPa 44.3 22.15 28.15 8 ø3.5 For –M5 7 8.5 43 10.7 15.2 30 2.6 2.5 7 12 .4 7.8 12 One-touch fitting ø4, ø6 M5 x 0.8 thread depth 5 169 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 170 ZSE40/ISE40 Dimensions Panel mount Cutting dimensions for panel mounting 42 40 36 25.4 +0.5 0 43 or more 36 +0.5 0 4.3 OUT2 OUT1 70 or more SET The thickness of the panel is 1 to 3.2 mm. Panel mount + Front protection cover 42.4 40 SET 47.4 OUT2 OUT1 170 25.4 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 171 LCD Display Digital Pressure Switch (For vacuum) (For positive pressure) Series ZSE3/ISE3 The digital display allows easy pressure setting. Air Line Maintenance Built-in failure detection output function This feature senses an overall decrease in vacuum pressure due to clogged filter elements, worn vacuum pads or system leakage and and sends a warning output signal before a failure occurs. For General Pneumatics Two independent pressure settings This feature is ideal when a change of vacuum suction pad size requires two different set pressures, or switching of positive pressure lines requires confirmation of two pressures. Data storage function Since a dedicated IC (EEPROM) is used, set data will be stored for 100,000 hours (approximately 11 years) even without power. Vacuum unit: Can be used as a modular unit with series ZX. With suction filter Self-diagnostic function Overcurrent detection LCD display: Error indication on LCD SMC Excess pressure detection Data error mmHg Indicator light: Red light blinks for error. RESET SET Specifications Vacuum ZSE3 Model Set pressure range Maximum pressure Minimum display unit Positive pressure 100 kPa Positive pressure 1 MPa ISE3L ISE3 0 to 0.98 MPa 1MPa — 1 1 0.01 — — Illuminates when ON. (OUT1: Green, OUT2: Red) 200 Hz Variable (3 digits or more) Fixed (3 digits) Air, Non-corrosive gas ±3% F.S. or less ±1% F.S. or less 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) NPN open collector 30 V, 80 mA or less 25 mA or less Indicator light: Red light blinks, Error code displayed on LCD 3 1/2 digit LCD (5mm-size numerals) Overcurrent , Excess pressure, Data error, Pressure at zero clear 0 to 60°C (with no condensation) 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µS, Rise time 1 nS 1000 VAC 50/60 Hz for 1 min between external terminals and case 2 MΩ (500 VDC) between external terminals and case 0 to –101 kPa 0 to 98 kPa 200 kPa Note 1) kPa MPa Port size Enclosure R 1/8, M5 x 0.8, NPTF 1/8, M5 x 0.8 ZX ejector mounted type: M5 x 0.8 R 1/8, M5 x 0.8, NPTF 1/8, M5 x 0.8 IP40 Note 1) For vacuum operation, a momentary pressure of 0.5 MPa will not be a problem. Note 2) For ZSE3-- 23 24 , the red light will be ON for failure detection output. Note 3) Hysteresis mode: When the value of P1 and P2 are the same, or when P1 > P2 is within 3 digits, the hysteresis will automatically be 3 digits for the set value of P1. Window comparator mode: Since the hysteresis is 3 digits, separate P1 and P2 by 7 digits or more when setting. 1 digit is the minimum pressure display unit. (See the table above.) 171 Sensors Measuring Instruments Indicator light Note 2) Response frequency Note 3) Hysteresis mode Hysteresis Window comparator mode Fluid Temperature characteristics Repeatability Operating voltage Output specification Current consumption Error display Pressure display Self-diagnostic function Operating temperature range Noise resistance Withstand voltage Insulation resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller, amplitude 1.5 mm or acceleration 98 m/s2, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each Vibration resistance Shock resistance 980 m/s2 in X,Y,Z directions 3 times each Connector type Heat resistant vinyl cord ø1.55, 0.31 mm2, 4-wire Lead wire Grommet type Oilproof heavy-duty vinyl cord -21, –23: ø3.5, 0.14 mm2, 4 cores –22, –24: ø3.5, 0.15 mm2, 5 cores 40 g (with 0.6 m lead wire) Weight ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 172 ZSE3/ISE3 How to Order Set pressure range Nil L 0 to 0.98 MPa 0 to 98 kPa Piping specification 01 T1 Single mounting R 1/8 Single mounting NPTF 1/8 Note) M5 x 0.8 female thread provided inside piping Output specification Positive Pressure ISE3 Vacuum ZSE3 21 NPN open collector 2 outputs Without analog output 22 NPN open collector 2 outputs With analog output (1 to 5 V) Wiring specification Nil Grommet type lead wire length 0.6 m L Grommet type lead wire length 3 m C Connector type lead wire length 0.6 m CL Connector type lead wire length 3 m CN Without connector Only grommet type available for analog output. Piping specification 01 Single mounting R 1/8 T1 Single mounting NPTF 1/8 0X With suction filter M5 x 0.8 0XY With suction filter M6 x 1 (optional) Note) M5 x 0.8 female thread provided inside piping for single mounting type 172 Output specification 21 NPN open collector 2 outputs Without analog output 22 NPN open collector 2 outputs With analog output (1 to 5 V) 23 NPN open collector 1 output Failure detection function, Without analog output 24 NPN open collector 1 output Failure detection function, With analog output (1 to 5 V) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 173 Air Line Maintenance High Precision Digital Pressure Switch For General Fluids Fluid Series ZSE50F/ISE50 Coolant Pressure detection for a wide range of fluids Argon Air containing drain Ammonia Freon Hydraulic fluid ( JIS-K2213 ) Carbon dioxide Nitrogen Silicon oil ( JIS-K2213 ) To measure low-quality air, containing drain Leakage test with nitrogen Lubricating oil (JIS-K6301) Fluoro carbon To confirm absorption of workpiece with water on the surface, e.g. wet LCD glass plate To measure hydraulic pressure Using of stainless steel diaphragm The stainless steel diaphragm prevents direct contact between sensor and measured fluid. Pressure sensor Fitting Liquid and gas contact areas Stainless steel 630 Fittings Stainless steel 304 Extremely low leakage ZSE50F / ISE50 ZSE60F / ISE60 Enclosure Stainless steel diaphragm Sensors Measuring Instruments Sensor and fittings are electron-beam welded. Leakage is kept at the lowest level by using VCR® and Swedgelok® fittings. 1 x 10-5 Pa⋅m3/s 1 x 10-10 Pa⋅m3/s IP65 Panel mount With bracket Option Panel mount + Front side protection cover Application examples To confirm adsorption of workpieces containing water To confirm primary pressure of cleaning line To confirm working pressure of hydraulic cylinder 173 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 174 ZSE50/ISE50 High precision and high resolution Compound pressure 1/2000 ( 0.1 kPa ) Positive pressure 1/1000 ( 0.001MPa ) Repeatability 0.2% F.S. 1 digit or less Variety of functions Anti-chattering function Auto preset function Prevents erroneous operation due to sudden fluctuations in primary pressure, by allowing the response time to be changed. Automatic pressure setting is possible. Saves time for setting operation. Selectable response times: 2.5 ms, 24 ms, 192 ms, 768 ms or less Auto shift function Pressure detection is not affected by fluctuations in primary pressure. Series ZSE60F/ISE60 • Key lock function • Peak and bottom display function • Zero out function Confirmation of atmospheric pressure of load lock Special fitting types are used in semiconductor production equipment (Metal gasket seal fittings) Leak rate: 1 x 10 –10 Pa.m3/s ZSE 60F/ISE60-A2 ZSE60F/ISE60-B2 URJ 1/ 4 TSJ 1 / 4 ZSE50F Model Variations Port size Leak rate Rated pressure range 174 ZSE60F ISE60 Special fittings for the semiconductor industry (Metal gasket seal fittings) Threaded type URJ 1/4, TSJ 1/4 R 1/ 4, NPT 1/4, G 1/ 4 (With M5 male thread) –5 1 x 1 0 Pa. m 3 / s –1 0 1 x 10 Pa⋅ m3 / s 100 kPa 1 MPa 100 kPa 1 MPa 0 0 0 0 –100 kPa Output ISE50 –100 kPa Switch output 2 outputs NPN or PNP Analog output Output voltage 1 to 5 V ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 175 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch for General Fluids Series ZSE50F/ISE50 How to Order ISE50 For positive pressure ZSE50 F For compound pressure 02 22 L M 02 22 L M Piping specification 02 T2 G2 ∗ Option R 1/4 (M5 with female screw), Piping in backward direction Nil NPT 1/4 (M5 with female screw), Piping in backward direction None Bracket A G 1/4 (M5 with female screw), Piping in backward direction ∗ Option A Input/Output specification 22 30 62 ∗ 70 ∗ NPN open collector 2 output + Analog output Bracket D NPN open collector 2 output + Auto shift input D PNP open collector 2 output + Analog output PNP open collector 2 output + Auto shift input ∗ Option Note) Auto shift input is used for the auto shift function. For more information, please refer to “Auto Shift Function” on page 178. Refer to the dimensions for the difference between brackets A and D. Panel mount E Lead wire length L 3m Sensors Measuring Instruments Panel mount + Front protection cover Analog Output Series ISE50 Series ZSE50F Analog output value (V) Analog output value (V) Suitable model: ZSE50F/ISE50- -22/62(L)-(M) 5 1 0 1.0 MPa F 5 1 –100 kPa Pressure 100 kPa Pressure Unit specification Nil With unit switching function M Fixed SI unit Note) Note) Fixed units: For compound pressure : KPa For positive pressure: MPa Option When option parts are required separately, use the following part numbers to place an order. Option Part no. Qty. Note Bracket A ZS-24-A 1 With 2 pcs. of mounting screws Bracket D ZS-24-D 1 With 2 pcs. of mounting screws Panel mount ZS-24-E 1 Panel mount + Front protection cover ZS-24-F 1 175 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 176 ZSE50F/ISE50 Specifications ZSE50F (Compound pressure) ISE50 (Positive pressure) Rated pressure range 100 to 100 kPa 0.000 to 1.000 MPa Set pressure range 100 to 100 kPa 0.100 to 1.000 MPa 500 kPa 1.5 MPa Withstand pressure kPa MPa Setting/Display resolution Fluid 0.1 — — 0.001 Fluid that will not corrode stainless steel 630 and 304 Power supply voltage 12 to 24 VDC, Ripple (p-p) 10% or less Current consumption 55 mA or less (With no load) Switch output NPN or PNP open collector: 2 outputs Max. load current 80 mA Max. applied voltage 30 V (With NPN output) Residual voltage 1 V or less (With 80 mA load current) Response time 2.5 ms or less (With anti-chattering function: 24 ms, 192 ms and 768 ms selections) Short circuit protection Yes 0.2% F.S. 1 digit or less Repeatability Hysteresis Fix (3 digits) Window comparator mode 3 1/2 digit LED display (Sampling frequency: 5 times/sec) Display 2% F.S. 1 digit or less (With ambient temperature of 25°C) Display accuracy Green LED (OUT1: Illuminates when ON.), Red LED (OUT2: Illuminates when ON.) Indicator light Output voltage: 1 to 5 V ±5% F.S. or less (in rated pressure range) Linearity: ±1% F.S. or less Output impedance: Approx. 1 kΩ Analog output Note 1) Auto shift input Note 2) IP65 Operating: 0 to 50C, Stored: 10 to 60C (No condensation or freezing) Ambient temperature range Operating and stored: 35 to 85% RH (No condensation) Ambient humidity range 250 VAC for 1 min, between all lead wires and enclosure Withstand voltage Insulation resistance 2 MΩ or more (at 50 VDC) between all lead wires and enclosure Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz at the smaller of amplitude 1.5 mm or acceleration 98 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each (De-energized) 980 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each (Not energized) 3% F.S. or less of measured pressure at 25C in temperature Shock resistance Temperature characteristics 02: R 1/4, M5 x 0.8 Port size T2: NPT 1/4, M5 x 0.8 Pressure receiving area: Stainless steel 630, Fittings: Stainless steel 304 Wetted material 5-wire oilproof heavy-duty vinyl cable (0.15 mm2) Lead wire Approx. 120 g (Each including 3 m lead wire) Weight Note 1) Note 2) Output voltage: 1 to 5 V ±2.5% F.S. or less (in rated pressure range) Linearity: ±1% F.S. or less Output impedance: Approx. 1 kΩ No-voltage input (Solid state switch or reed switch), input 5 ms or more Enclosure Environmental resistance 0.3% F.S. 1 digit or less Variable (0 or above) Hysteresis mode For ZSE50F/ISE50--22 62 ZSE50F/ISE50--30 70 Note) The possible set ranges for types with auto shift function are as follows: Model Possible set range ZSE50F-- 30 70 –100.0 to 100.0 kPa ISE50-- 30 70 –1.000 to 1.000 MPa Function Various additional functions are available for easy measurement, switch operation and check of measured values suitable for the conditions of the measured fluid. Auto shift function Note 1) Anti-chattering function Key lock function Peak hold function Bottom hold function Zero out function Unit conversion (for overseas use) Note 1) Can correct the pressure set point value of switch output according to fluctuations in the primary pressure. Prevents malfunction due to sudden fluctuations in the primary pressure by adjusting the response time. The key board operation can be locked to prevent incorrect operation on the operation switch. Can retain the maximum pressure value displayed during measurement. Can retain the minimum pressure value displayed during measurement. The pressure display can be set at zero when the pressure is open to the atmosphere. Can convert the display value (for overseas use only). Note 1) Select and order by specifying the types and models. 176 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 177 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch for General Fluids Series ZSE50F/ISE50 Output Method ON YES • Hysteresis mode OFF P-2 P-1 High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) [P] H H (Fix hysteresis) = 3 digits H ON • Window comparator mode NO OFF P-1 P-2 High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) Output mode OUT1 ON ∗ Same with OUT2. YES • Hysteresis mode OFF n-2 n-1 High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) [n] H H (Fix hysteresis) = 3 digits H ON NO • Window comparator mode OFF n-1 n-2 High pressure (for positive pressure/ compound pressure) Sensors Measuring Instruments Example of Internal Circuit and Wiring 50 ZSE 50 60 F/ISE 60 - -22(L)-(M) 50 ZSE 50 60 F/ISE 60 - -30(L)-(M) 6.8 kΩ DC (–) (Blue) 50 ZSE 50 60 F/ISE 60 - -70(L)-(M) 6.8 kΩ DC (–) (Blue) Load 1.2 kΩ DC (+) (Brown) Auto shift input (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) Load DC (–) (Blue) 12 VDC to 24 VDC Main circuit DC (+) (Brown) Analog output (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) Load With auto shift input Load With analog output Main circuit 12 VDC to 24 VDC DC (–) (Blue) 50 ZSE 50 60 F/ISE 60 - -62(L)-(M) 1 kΩ Load 1.2 kΩ DC (+) (Brown) Auto shift input (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) Load 12 VDC to 24 VDC Main circuit DC (+) (Brown) Analog output (Gray) OUT1 (Black) OUT2 (White) Load 1 kΩ With auto shift input Load Main circuit With analog output 12 VDC to 24 VDC 177 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 178 ZSE50F/ISE50 Auto Shift Function This function uses the measured pressure at the time of auto shift input as the reference pressure value and corrects the set point values “ ” and “ ” of switch output 1 and “ ” and “ ” of switch output 2. “ ” to “ ” correspond to “ ” to “ ” in case of normally closed circuit. Pressure When auto shift is not used: Fluctuations in the primary pressure interrupt correct judgement. Normal primary pressure Drop of primary pressure Increase of primary pressure P1 P2 Time ON Switch output 1, 2 OFF Pressure When auto shift is used: When the primary pressure changes, set the auto shift function to Lo. The pressure value at this point will be saved as the reference value to correct the pressure set point values in order to make correct judgments. Normal primary pressure Drop of primary pressure Auto shift function conditions and explanation • Keep the pressure constant at least for 5 ms after the last transition signal of auto shift input. ” for • At the time of auto shift input, the display unit displays “ about 1 second. The pressure value at this time is saved as the ”. correction value “ • The set point values “ ” to “ ” or “ ” to “ ” are corrected based on the saved correction values. • The time between the auto shift input and start of switch output is 10 ms or less. • If the set point value corrected by auto shift input falls out of the possible set range, the correction value is not saved. The dis” if the set point value is above the upper limplay will show “ ” if it is below the lower limit. it and “ • The correction value “ ” set by auto shift input disappears when the power is turned off. ” for the auto shift function is reset to • The correction value “ zero (the initial value) when the power is turned on again. ∗ The correction value is not stored on the EEPROM. Note The possible set range for types with auto shift function is as follows: Model Set pressure range ZSE50F-- 30 70 Increase of primary pressure –100.0 to 100 kPa ZSE60F-- 30 70 ISE50-- 30 70 ISE60-- 30 70 P1 P2 –1.0000 to 1.000 MPa Time ON Switch output 1, 2 OFF 5 ms or more Auto shift input 10 ms or less time [ Switchwhenoutputauto response shift inputs. ] Hi Lo Anti-chattering Function A large bore cylinder or ejector consumes a large amount of air in operation and may experience a temporary drop in the primary pressure. This function prevents detection of such temporary drops in primary pressure as abnormal pressure. <Principle> This function averages pressure values measured during the response time set by the user and then compares the average pressure value with the pressure set point value to output the result on the switch. Pressure Temporary fluctuation P1 Set point value P2 Switch output operation in normal conditions Time t (ms) t (ms) <Averaging process> <Averaging process> ON OFF Time Switch output ON operation when chattering prevention OFF function is on Time 178 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 179 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch for General Fluids Series ZSE50F/ISE50 Error Correction Take the following measures when an error occurs. Error description LCD display Contents Solution Load current of switch output is more than 80 mA. Shut off the power supply. After eliminating the output factor that caused the excess current, turn the power supply back on. Pressure is applied during the zero out operation as follows: 0.071 MPa or more with ISE50/60 7.1 kPa or more with ZSE50F/60F ∗ After displaying for 3 seconds, it will return to the measuring mode. Bring the pressure back to atmospheric pressure and try using the zero out function. OUT1 Over current error OUT2 Residual pressure error Supply pressure exceeds the maximum regulating pressure. Applied pressure error Supply pressure is below the minimum regulating pressure. The value is above the upper limit of the set pressure ∗ After displaying this message for about 1 seconds, the switch returns to the measurement mode. Auto shift error The value is below the lower limit of the set pressure ∗ After displaying this message for about 1 seconds, the switch returns to the measurement mode. Reduce/Increase supply pressure to within the regulating pressure range. Set the pressure again so that the sum of the applied pressure and pressure set point value at the time of auto shift input will not fall out of the set pressure range. Internal data error Internal data error System error Internal data error Shut off the power supply. Turn the power supply back on. If the power should not come back on, please contact SMC for an inspection. Sensors Measuring Instruments Internal data error ∗ The upper limits and lower limits are shown in the table below. Compound pressure Positive pressure Upper limit Set pressure range Lower limit 100.0 to 100.0 kPa –100.0 kPa 100.0 kPa –0.100 to 1.000 MPa –0.100 MPa 1.000 MPa With auto shift function Compound pressure 3Positive pressure Upper limit Set pressure range Lower limit –100.0 to 100.0 kPa –100.0 kPa 100.0 kPa –1.000 to 1.000 MPa –1.000 MPa 1.000 MPa 179 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 180 ZSE50F/ISE50 Dimensions 02 ZSE50F/ISE50- T2 G2 30 30 23.4 (In case of NPT 23.9) 20 2-M3 x 0.5 depth 4 18.35 6.4 20 8.45 Piping port M5 x 0.8 depth 5 Piping port R, NPT 1/4 7 30 2.5 25.1 8.45 12.4 10.1 ø22 ø14.5 15.2 2.6 10.7 12 7.8 .4 ø3.5 Piping port G 1/4 Piping port G 180 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 181 High Precision Digital Pressure Switch for General Fluids Series ZSE50F/ISE50 Dimensions Bracket A A 4.5 ø4 .5 15 11.5 40 55 45 20 30 20 1.6 6.5 20 41.5 Bracket A ZS-24-A View A Bracket D A 1.6 4.5 15 11.5 4.2 40 55 45 Sensors Measuring Instruments 20 30 20 7.2 41.5 35 7.5 22 Bracket D ZS-24-D View A Cutting dimensions for panel mounting Panel mount + Front protection cover 25.4 43 or more 47.4 70 or more 36 7.8 +0.5 0 +0.5 0 42.4 40 36 Front protection cover The thickness of the panel is from 1 to 3.2 mm. 181 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 182 Air Line Maintenance 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch Liquid Removal Series ISE70/75/75H ® Coolant Metal Body Type (Die-cast aluminum) For General Fluids For Air 10 MPa • 15 MPa 1 MPa 2-color (ISE75) (ISE75H) (ISE70) IP67 digital 2-color Display (green and red) • Selectable from four patterns ON q w e r OFF red green green red red red green green Easily identifiable abnormal readings 10 mm character height M12 Connector • Lead wire with M12 connector (5 m) • Straight and right-angled connectors With Bracket • User-selectable mounting orientation Functions • Anti-chattering • Display calibration • Zero out • Key lock • Unit display switching (Fixed SI unit in Japan) For Air • Withstand pressure: Rated pressure x 3 displa settings of PSI • Model with initial display is also available as standard. • Port size • Rc1/4, NPT1/4, G1/4 (ISO1179) ISE75 (10 MPa) MPa MPa OUT1 UP ISE75H (15 MPa) MPa OUT1 DOWN OUT1 UP SET DOWN UP SET Plain PRESSURE SWITCH 182 For General Fluids ISE70 (1 MPa) DOWN SET Gray PRESSURE SWITCH Orange PRESSURE SWITCH ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 183 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch/For Air Series ISE70 ® How to Order 02 ISE70 1 MPa 43 M Piping 02 N02 F02 Rc 1/4 Option 2 NPT 1/4 G1/4 (ISO1179) None Nil With bracket Output 2 3 Color 1 43 Fixed setting: NPN open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) + PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 2) 65 PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) Display unit 4 Connector Pin Assignments Nil With unit display switching function M Fixed SI unit Note) P Pressure unit: PSI (Initial value) With unit display switching function Output -43 (Color: Grey) DC (+) 2 White OUT1 (PNP) Blue 4 Black Note) Mounting screws are not included. Option 1 Note) Fixed unit: MPa DC (–) OUT1 (NPN) Nil None S Lead wire with M12 connector (5 m), straight L Lead wire with M12 connector (5 m), right-angled Output -65 (Color: Black) 1 Brown 2 White 3 Blue 4 Black DC (+) Sensors Measuring Instruments 1 Brown 3 A NC DC (–) OUT1 (PNP) Optional Part No. When option parts are required separately, use the following part numbers to place an order. Option Part no. Note OUT1 UP Bracket DO SE T ZS-31-A WN Bracket B and the bracket assembly make up one set. Note: Mounting screws are not included. Bracket B Bracket assembly Lead wire with M12 connector, straight ZS-31-B Lead wire length: 5 m Lead wire with M12 connector, right-angled ZS-31-C Lead wire length: 5 m 183 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 184 ISE70 Specifications ISE70 Model 0 to 1 MPa Rated pressure range –0.1 to 1 MPa Set pressure range Withstand pressure 1.5 MPa Set pressure resolution 0.01 MPa Air, lnert gas, Non-flammable gas Fluid 12 to 24 VDC, Ripple (p-p) 10% or less (with power supply polarity protection) Power supply voltage 55 mA or less (at no load) Current consumption Output -43: Fixed setting; NPN open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) + PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 2) Note 1) Output -65: PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) Switch output 80 mA Max. load current 30 V (with NPN output) Max. applied voltage 1 V or less (with load current of 80 mA) Residual voltage 2.5 ms (Response time selections with anti-chattering function: 20 ms, 160 ms, 640 ms, 1000 ms, 2000 ms) Response time With short circuit protection Short circuit protection ±0.5% F.S. Repeatability Hysteresis Hysteresis mode Adjustable (can be set from 0) Window comparator mode 3 digit, 7-segment indicator, 2-color display (red and green) can be interlocked with the switch output, Sampling cycle: 5 times/s Display ±2% F.S. ± 1 digit or less (at 25°C ± 3°C) Display accuracy Illuminates when output is ON. (Green) Indication light Anti-chattering function, Unit display switching function, Zero out function, Key lock function Functions IP67 Note 2) Enclosure Environmental resistance Fluid temperature range 0 to 50°C (with no freezing or condensation) Operating temperature range Operating: 0 to 50°C, Stored: –10 to 60°C (with no freezing or condensation) Operating humidity range Operating and stored: 35 to 85% RH (with no condensation) 1000 VAC for 1 min. between live parts and enclosure Withstand voltage Insulation resistance 50 MΩ or more between live parts and enclosure (at 500 VDC Mega) Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz, 1.5 mm or 98 m/s2 amplitude in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hours each 980 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each (Non energized) Impact resistance Temperature characteristics (Based on 25°C: Operating temperature range) Standard Wetted material ±2% F.S. or less Compliant with CE Marking and UL/CSA (UL508) standards Fitting: C3602 (electroless nickel plated), Sensor port: PBT, Sensor pressure receiving area: silicon, O-ring: NBR 02: Rc1/4, N02: NPT1/4, F02: G1/4 (ISO1179) Note 3) Port size Lead wire Lead wire with M12 4-pin pre-wired connector (5 m) Mass (Weight) 190 g (excluding the lead wire with M12 4-pin pre-wired connector) Note 1) The NPN and PNP outputs function for a single set point. Note 2) A FKM gasket is used for sealing the housing. Note 3) G1/4: Applicable to ISO1179-1 Example of Internal Circuit and Wiring Fixed setting: NPN open collector output + PNP open collector output See the operation manual for information on how to set and on handling precautions. (the pressure set point for switching the output signal is common to both outputs.) Maximum 30 V (NPN only), 80 mA, Residual voltage 1 V or less Output -43 Output -65 DC (+) (Brown) OUT1 (NPN) Load (Black) OUT1 (PNP) + – Load 12 to 24 VDC Main circuit Main circuit DC (+) (Brown) N.C. (White) OUT1 (PNP) (Black) Load (White) DC (–) (Blue) 184 DC (–) (Blue) + – 12 to 24 VDC ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 185 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch/For General Fluids Series ISE75/75H ® How to Order 10 MPa ISE75 02 43 M 15 MPa ISE75H 02 43 M Piping 02 N02 F02 Option 2 Rc 1/4 NPT 1/4 Nil G1/4 (ISO1179) None With bracket Output 2 3 Color 1 43 Fixed setting: NPN open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) + PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 2) 65 PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) Display unit 4 With unit display switching function Connector Pin Assignments M Fixed SI unit Note) Output -43 (Color: Grey) P Pressure unit: PSI (Initial value) With unit display switching function 1 Brown DC (+) 2 White OUT1 (PNP) Blue 4 Black Sensors Measuring Instruments Nil 3 A Option 1 Note) Fixed unit: MPa Nil None S Lead wire with M12 connector (5 m), straight L Lead wire with M12 connector (5 m), right-angled DC (–) OUT1 (NPN) Output -65 (Color: Black) 1 Brown 2 White 3 Blue 4 Black DC (+) NC DC (–) OUT1 (PNP) Optional Part No. When option parts are required separately, use the following part numbers to place an order. Option Part No. Note OUT1 UP Bracket DO SE T WN Bracket B and the bracket assembly make up one set. ZS-31-A Bracket B Bracket assembly Lead wire with M12 connector, straight ZS-31-B Lead wire length: 5 m Lead wire with M12 connector, right-angled ZS-31-C Lead wire length: 5 m 185 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 186 ISE75/75H Specifications ISE75 ISE75H 0 to 10 MPa 0 to 15 MPa Set pressure range 0.4 to 10 MPa 0.5 to 15 MPa Withstand pressure 30 MPa Model Rated pressure range 45 MPa 0.1 MPa Set pressure resolution Fluid that will not corrode stainless steel 430 and stainless steel 630 Fluid Power supply voltage 12 to 24 VDC, Ripple (p-p) 10% or less (with power supply polarity protection) Current consumption 55 mA or less (at no load) Output -43: Fixed setting; NPN open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) + PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 2) Note 1) Output -65: PNP open collector 1 output (Pin no. 4) Switch output 80 mA Max. load current 30 V (with NPN output) Max. applied voltage 1 V or less (with load current of 80 mA) Residual voltage 2.5 ms (Response time selections with anti-chattering function: 20 ms, 160 ms, 640 ms, 1000 ms, 2000 ms) Response time With short circuit protection Short circuit protection ±0.5% F.S. Repeatability Hysteresis Hysteresis mode Adjustable (can be set from 0) Window comparator mode 3 ditit, 7-segment indicator, 2-color display (red and green) can be interlocked with the switch output, Sampling cycle: 5 times/s Display ±2% F.S. ± 1 digit or less (at 25°C ± 3°C) Display accuracy Illuminates when output is ON. (Green) Indication light Anti-chattering function, Unit display switching function, Zero out function, Key lock function Functions IP67 Note 2) Enclosure Environmental resistance Fluid temperature range –5 to 80°C (with no freezing or condensation) Operating temperature range Operating: –5 to 50°C, Stored: –10 to 60°C (with no freezing or condensation) Operating humidity range Operating and stored: 35 to 85% RH (with no condensation) 250 VAC for 1 min. between live parts and enclosure Withstand voltage Insulation resistance 50 MΩ or more between live parts and enclosure (at 50 VDC Mega) Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz, 1.5 mm or 98 m/s2 amplitude in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hours each 980 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions 3 times each (Non energized) Impact resistance Temperature characteristics (Based on 25°C: Operating temperature range) Standard ±3% F.S. or less Compliant with CE Marking and UL/CSA (UL508) standards Wetted material Pressure receiving area: Stainless steel 630, Fittings: Stainless steel 430 02: Rc1/4, N02: NPT1/4, F02: G1/4 (ISO1179) Note 3) Port size Lead wire Lead wire with M12 4-pin pre-wired connector (5 m) Mass (Weight) 210 g (excluding the lead wire with M12 4-pin pre-wired connector) Note 1) The NPN and PNP outputs function for a single set point. Note 2) A FKM gasket is used for sealing the housing. Note 3) G1/4: Applicable to ISO1179-1 Example of Internal Circuit and Wiring Fixed setting: NPN open collector output + PNP open collector output See the operation manual for information on how to set and on handling precautions. (the pressure set point for switching the output signal is common to both outputs.) Maximum 30 V (NPN only), 80 mA, Residual voltage 1 V or less Output -43 Output -65 DC (+) (Brown) OUT1 (NPN) Load (Black) OUT1 (PNP) + – Load 12 to 24 VDC Main circuit Main circuit DC (+) (Brown) N.C. (White) OUT1 (PNP) (Black) Load (White) DC (–) (Blue) 186 DC (–) (Blue) + – 12 to 24 VDC ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 187 2-color Display Digital Pressure Switch For General Fluids ISE70/75/75H Series Unit Description LCD display Indication light (Green) MPa Displays the switch operation status. SET button OUT1 UP Use this button to switch the mode and set the set value. DOWN SET UP button Use this button to change the mode or increase the ON/OFF set value. It also allows you to switch to the peak value display mode. PRESSURE SWITCH Displays the current pressure condition, set mode and error code. The display mode can be selected from four options: fixed green single-color reading, fixed red single-color reading, green reading interlocked with output for switching to red reading, and red reading interlocked with output for switching to green reading. DOWN button Use this button to change the mode or decrease the ON/OFF set value. It also allows you to switch to the bottom value display mode. Functions Error correction This function eliminates slight differences in the output values and allows uniformity in the numbers displayed. Displayed values of the pressure sensor can be calibrated to within ±5% of their readings. Take the following corrective solutions when error occurs. ±5% R.D. 0 Error description LCD display Contents Solution Overcurrent error A load current greater than 80 mA is turned on through either or both of the switch outputs. Shut off the power supply. After eliminating the output factor that caused the excess current, turn the power supply back on. Residual pressure error A pressure level greater than ±7% F.S. has been applied during zero adjustment. The switch will automatically return to measuring mode in three seconds, however. Note that the range of zero adjustment differs by ±1 digit due to switchto-switch variations. Bring the pressure back to atmospheric pressure and try using the zero out function. + Applied pressure : Factory setting display value set prior to shipment : Display calibration range Note) When the display calibration function is used, the set pressure value may change ±1 digit. Peak/Bottom hold function This function constantly detects and updates the maximum and minimum pressure values and allows to hold the display value. Key lock function This function prevents incorrect operations such as changing the set value accidentally. Zero out (Zero ADJ) function Applied pressure error The measured pressure reading can be adjusted to zero. More specifically, the factory-set reading can be corrected to within ±7% F.S. Unit display switching function Supply pressure exceeds the maximum set pressure. Supply pressure is below the minimum set pressure. Reduce/Increase supply pressure to within the set pressure range. Internal data error The reading unit can be selected. Unit/Reading resolution ISE70 ISE75/75H Pa 0.01 MPa 0.1 MPa kgf/cm2 0.1 1 bar 0.1 1 psi 1 1 (x 10) Anti-chattering function A large bore cylinder or ejector consumes a large amount of air in operation and may experience a temporary drop in the primary pressure. This function prevents detection of such temporary drops in primary pressure as abnormal pressure. Internal data error System error Internal data error Shut off the power supply. Turn the power supply back on. Internal data error Note) If the switch will not recover to normal even after all of the above mentioned solutions have been applied, consult SMC for investigation. Response time selections: 20 ms, 160 ms, 640 ms, 1000 ms, 2000 ms 187 Sensors Measuring Instruments Displayed pressure value Display calibration function ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 188 ISE70/75/75H Dimensions ISE70/ 75/ 75H 34 9 39 MPa OUT1 70 UP DOWN Lead wire with M12 connector (5 m) straight 20 14.5 SET 15.7 (28.7) 24 (38.2) Lead wire with M12 connector (5 m) right-angled Note) The connector faces down (toward the piping). Do not attempt to rotate the connector, as it is not rotatable. Piping port 02: Rc 1/4 N02: NPT 1/4 F02: G1/4 (ISO1179) Note) Compatible to ISO1179-1. Color 1 2 With bracket 3 34 9 44.5 MPa DOWN 1 Brown DC (+) 2 White OUT1 (PNP) 3 SET Blue 4 Black 14.5 90 Connector Pin Assignments Output -43 (Color: Grey) OUT1 UP 4 DC (–) OUT1 (NPN) Output -65 (Color: Black) .5 2-6 1 Brown 18.3 2 White 3 Blue 4 Black (28.7) 46 60 (38.2) 24 6 Piping port 02: Rc 1/4 N02: NPT 1/4 F02: G1/4 (ISO1179) Note) Compatible to ISO1179-1. 188 35 DC (+) NC DC (–) OUT1 (PNP) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 189 Air Line Maintenance Digital Pressure Switch with Backlight (For vacuum) (For positive pressure) Liquid Removal Series ZSE5B/ISE5B Coolant For use in various fluid applications Stainless steel diaphragms • Hydraulic fluid • Silicon oil • Lubricating oil • Dry air • Carbon dioxide • Argon • Drainage-containing air • Ammonia • Nitrogen gas • Freon Stainless steel 630 is used for the sensor unit and stainless steel 304 is used for the fitting. For General Purpose Fluids Leakage rate: 1 x 10-4 atm cc/s The use of an electron beam to weld the sensor unit and fitting enables pressure calibration of various fluids, which were not previously applicable, such as air containing moisture, and oil. Two independent pressure settings This feature is ideal when a change of vacuum suction pad size requires two different set pressures, or switching of positive pressure lines requires confirmation of two pressures. Multiple units available with unit switching function Display units can be easily selected. Vacuum mmHg ↔ kPa ↔ PSI ↔ kgf/cm2 ↔ bar Positive Pressure MPa ↔ PSI ↔ kgf/cm2 ↔ bar Variety of switch output modes ON ON OFF OFF P2 P1 n2 (Standard) Window comparator mode ON Sensors Measuring Instruments Hysteresis mode n1 (Inverted) ON OFF OFF P1 P2 (Standard) n1 n2 (Inverted) Exact detection of atmospheric pressure (for vacuum) Detects restored atmospheric pressure after vacuum release pressure is applied. Data storage function Since a dedicated IC (EEPROM) is used, set data will be stored for 100,000 hours (approximately 11 years) even without power. Panel mounting available A special adaptor permits panel mounting. 189 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 190 ZSE5B/ISE5B How to Order Positive Pressure ISE5B L Vacuum ZSE5B L Piping specification Unit specification 02 R 1/4 Nil With unit switching function T2 NPTF 1/4 M Fixed SI units Note) Note) Fixed units ISE5B: MPa ZSE5B: kPa Note) M5 x 0.8 female thread provided inside piping Lead wire length L 3m Output specification 26 27 67 Analog output (1 to 5 V) NPN open collector 2 outputs PNP open collector 2 outputs Panel mount adaptor part no. (Panel adaptor A + Panel adaptor B + Mounting bracket) ZS-22-E Panel adaptor A ………… ZS-22-03 Panel adaptor B ………… ZS-22-02 Mounting bracket ……….. ZS-22-04 ZS-22-D (With 4 pcs. of M3 tapping screws) Optional bracket Panel adaptor A Panel adaptor B Mounting bracket 190 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 191 Digital Pressure Switch with Backlight Series ZSE5B/ISE5B Specifications Vacuum ZSE5B Model Positive pressure Note 1) Equipped with unit switching function [The type without the unit switching function will have a fixed SI unit (kPa or MPa).] Note 2) Hysteresis mode ZSE: When the value of P1 and P2 are the same, or when P1 > P2 is within 2 digits, the hysteresis will automatically be 2 digits for the set value of P1. ISE: When the value of P1 and P2 are the same, or when P1 > P2 is within 3 digits, the hysteresis will automatically be 3 digits for the set value of P1. Window comparator mode ZSE: Since the hysteresis is 2 digits, separate P1 and P2 by 5 digits or more when setting. ISE: Since the hysteresis is 3 digits, separate P1 and P2 by 7 digits or more when setting. ∗ 1 digit is the minimum pressure display unit. (See the table above.) Note 3) The analog output type has no overcurrent detection function. Operating Unit Descriptions LCD UP Button PRESSURE SWITCH Increases ON/OFF setting value. Changes to the peak display mode. DOWN Button MPa RESET SET LED LED () (Green) Displays OUT1 operation status. Displays present pressure. Displays ON/OFF setting value. Displays error code. Displays unit. Decreases ON/OFF setting value. Use for changing to the bottom display mode, unit switching or output mode. LED (Red) Displays OUT2 operation status. Flashes when an error occurs. RESET Button Reset the switch by pressing the UP and Down buttons simultaneously. Clears when an abnormality occurs. Clears the display to zero. SET Button Changes to the setting mode. Press and hold for one second or longer to change to the unit switching or output mode. 191 Sensors Measuring Instruments ISE5B Set pressure range –100 to 100 kPa –0.1 to 1 MPa Maximum operating pressure 1.5 MPa 200 kPa — 2 kPa 0.01 MPa — Note 1) mmHg — 10 Minimum display unit kgf/cm2 0.1 0.02 PSI 1 0.2 bar 0.1 0.02 Indicator light Illuminates when ON. (OUT1: Green, OUT2: Red) Response frequency 200 Hz (5 ms) Note 2) Hysteresis mode Variable (2 digits or more) Variable (3 digits or more) Hysteresis Window comparator mode Fixed (2 digits) Fixed (3 digits) Non-corrosive fluid for stainless steel 304, stainless steel 630 Fluid ±3% F.S. or less Temperature characteristics Repeatability ±1% F.S. or less Supply voltage 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) Output specification NPN open collector 30 V, 80 mA or less PNP open collector 80 mA or less 45 mA or less Current consumption Indicator light: Red light blinks, Error code displayed on LCD Error display 3 1/2 digit LCD (character height 10 mm) Pressure display (Overcurrent Note 3)), Excess pressure, Data error, Pressure at zero clear Self diagnostic function 0 to 50°C (with no condensation) Operating temperature range 500 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µS, Rise time 1 nS Noise resistance Withstand voltage 250 VAC 50/60 Hz for 1 min. between external terminals and case 2 MΩ (50 VDC) between external terminals and case Insulation resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller, amplitude 1.5 mm or acceleration 98 m/s2, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each Vibration resistance 980 m/s2 in X, Y, Z directions, 3 times each Impact resistance Grommet oil resistant heavy duty cord –26: ø3.4, 0.2 mm2, 3 cores, 3 m –27, –67: ø3.5, 0.14 mm2, 4 cores, 3 m Lead wire 126 g (with 3 m lead wire) Weight 02: R 1/4, M5 x 0.8 T2: NPTF 1/4, M5 x 0.8 Port size IP40 Enclosure ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 192 ZSE5B/ISE5B Series Pressure Setting Setting procedure Initial setting Normal operation Pressure setting Select a display unit and output mode. Display the pressure operation and perform the switch operation. Set the pressure for switch output. Initial setting 1. Set Mode SMC 2. Display Units SMC PRESSURE SWITCH Note) 3. Select OUT1 Output Mode SMC PRESSURE SWITCH 4. Select OUT2 Output Mode SMC PRESSURE SWITCH PRESSURE SWITCH Note) SET RESET RESET SET SET Press the SET button and hold for one second or longer. “1.3” is displayed as shown above and the unit flasher. Note) “1.3” indicates the micro computer's program version. SET Press the SET button. Select a display unit by pressing the button. For high pressure: MPa → PSI → kgf/cm2 → bar For low pressure: mmHg → kPa → PSI → kgf/cm2 → bar SET RESET RESET Press the SET button. SET SET Setting is completed when the SET button is pressed. Out1 changes between and by pressing the button. : Normal output : Inverted output Out2 changes between and by pressing the button. : Normal output : Inverted output (Refer to Table 1 .) (Refer to Table 1 .) Unit display changes for the type with the unit switching function only. The type without the unit switching function will have a fixed SI unit (kPa or MPa). Table 1 Output mode ON YES • OFF [P] ≥ H H (fixed hysteresis) = 2 digits (ZSE5B) or 3 digits (ISE5B) H ON NO OUT1 OFF Hysteresis mode P-2 P-1 Pressure → P-1 • Window comparator mode • Hysteresis mode P-2 Pressure → Output mode ON YES ∗ OUT2 is the same. OFF [n] n-2 n-1 Pressure → ≥ H H (fixed hysteresis) = 2 digits (ZSE5B) or 3 digits (ISE5B) H ON NO 192 • OFF n-1 Pressure → n-2 Window comparator mode ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 193 Digital Pressure Switch with Backlight Series ZSE5B/ISE5B Pressure Setting Setting procedure 1. Setting Value Input Mode 2. OUT1 Setting Value (1) Input PRESSURE SWITCH 3. OUT1 Setting Value (2) Input PRESSURE SWITCH PRESSURE SWITCH SET mmHg RESET RESET SET SET RESET Press the SET button. button: Increases the setting value button: Decreases the setting value Press the SET button. SET button: Increases the setting value button: Decreases the setting value (Refer to Table 2 when using in vacuum. 4. OUT2 Setting Value (1) Input 5. OUT2 Setting Value (2) Input PRESSURE SWITCH SET PRESSURE SWITCH SET RESET Press the SET button. SET SET RESET Press the SET button. button: Increases the setting value button: Decreases the setting value Setting is completed when the SET button is pressed. SET button: Increases the setting value button: Decreases the setting value Table 2 For use as a vacuum switch The setting range for the ZSE5 pressure switch is –100 kPa to 100 kPa. Note that the setting method is different from the conventional digital pressure switch. <Example> When switched at –50 kPa or higher and the hysteresis is 10 kPa • Set P1 at –40 kPa and P2 at –50 kPa. Sensors Measuring Instruments 1. Hysteresis mode P2: P1: –50 kPa –40 kPa Negative pressure 0 Positive pressure Note) Pressure must be P1 > P2, which is the opposite of conventional switches. Note) Set the hysteresis at more than 2 digits. ∗ “Digit” is the minimum setting unit for pressure. 1 digit 2 kPa ON Standard output OFF ON Inverted output OFF Relationship between pressure and switch output 2. Window comparator mode <Example> When switched at –30 kPa or higher and –70 kPa or lower • Set P1 at –70 kPa and P2 at –30 kPa. Note) Hysteresis is automatically set at 2 digits in case of the window comparator mode. P1: –70 kPa P2: –30 kPa Negative pressure ON -66kPa –66 kPa 0 Positive pressure –34 -34kPa kPa Standard output OFF ON OFF Inverted output Relationship between pressure and switch output 193 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 194 ZSE5B/ISE5B Error Correction Other Functions • Peak Display Mode Take the following corrective actions when errors occur. Displays the peak pressure value (highest degree of vacuum) when the UP button is pressed during pressure display. The LCD displays “H”. Press the UP button again to return to the previous display. PRESSURE SWITCH RESET Display SET • Bottom Display Mode RESET SET Solution Set data was changed by accident for an unknown reason. Push the UP and Down buttons to reset all data. Out1 load current is exceeding 80 mA. Turn off the power and replace the load connected to OUT1. During output ON, OUT1 without load may have shorted or is currently shorting the power supply, etc. Confirm that OUT1 is not shorted, and then reset the switch. OUT2 load current is exceeding 80 mA. Turn off the power and replace the load connected to OUT2. During output ON, OUT2 without load may have shorted or is currently shorting the power supply, etc. Confirm that OUT2 is not shorted, and then reset the switch. Max. operating pressure has been exceeded for more than 2 seconds: 1.5 times the max. operating pressure for positive pressure, or 0.5 MPa for vacuum. Reduce the supply pressure to below the maximum pressure rating, and then reset the switch. Note) Displays the bottom pressure value (lowest degree of vacuum) when the DOWN button is pressed during pressure display. The LCD displays “L”. Press the DOWN button again to return to the previous display. PRESSURE SWITCH Contents Note) • Reset Function Simultaneously pressing the UP and DOWN buttons will reset the switch. 1) Reset will cause the following during normal operation. • Clears peak or bottom pressure display, or resets to zero clear. 2) Reset will cause the following when an error has occurred. • Display changes to the condition at the time of power supply input while retaining the data set in the setting mode. (The system resets.) • In case of a data error, the setting mode is displayed. When the setting is completed, the display changes to the condition at the time of power supply input. (The system resets.) Note) The reset function does not work in the setting mode. PRESSURE SWITCH RESET SET Example of Internal Circuits and Wiring When compared with the Apply atmospheric atmospheric pressure, a pressure, and then pressure of ±0.07 MPa for reset the switch. 1MPa type, or ±7 kPa for vacuum and 100 kPa types is applied at zero clear. Note) Not available for analog output type. Construction Lead wire colors inside [ ] are those prior to conformity with IEC standards. Brown DC (+) [Red] 1 to 5 V (±5% F.S.) Load impedance: 1 kΩ or more Main circuit -26 Analog Output Type LED Green – LED Red Main circuit Black OUT1 [White] Load Max. 80 mA↓ LED Red White OUT2 [Yellow] + 12 to 24 VDC – Load Blue DC (–) [Black] Brown DC (+) [Red Main circuit Black OUT1 Max. 80 mA [White] → Load LED Green White OUT2 Max. 80 mA [Yellow] → Load LED Red 194 Load Max. 80mA↓ LED Green -67 PNP Open Collector Max. 80 mA Blue DC (–) [Black] 12 to 24 VDC Brown DC (+) [Red] -27 NPN Open Collector Max. 30 V, 80 mA Residual voltage: 1 V or less Black OUT(Analog output) [White] + Blue DC (–) [Black] Parts list No. + – 12 to 24 VDC 1 2 3 4 5 6 Description Indicator panel Body Seal Lead wire Pressure sensor Fitting Material Denatured PPO PBT NBR Vinyl chloride (Vinyl sheath) Stainless steel 630 Stainless steel 304 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 195 Digital Pressure Switch with Backlight Series ZSE5B/ISE5B Specific Product Precautions Be sure to read before handling. Wiring Warning Others Caution 1. Withstand voltage Withstand voltage between the metal fitting and lead wire of the switch is 250 V. Do not apply voltage in excess of 250 V. 1. Panel mounting Insert the panel adaptor A from the front side of the panel. ↓ Firmly secure the panel adaptor A with the panel adaptors B from the back side of the panel. Caution 1. When there is a danger of induction noise being generated in the piping, ground the piping. ↓ Insert a pressure switch in to the panel adaptor A from the back side of the panel. ↓ Pressure Source Secure the switch with a mounting bracket. Panel adaptor A Warning 1. Operating fluid Sections in contact with fluid are made of stainless steel 630 (pressure sensor) and stainless steel 304 (fitting). Use a fluid that will not corrode these materials. The corrosion resistance of stainless steel 630 and that of stainless steel 304 are almost the same. For reference, non-corrosive fluids and gases for stainless steel 304 are shown below. Drainage-containing air Hydraulic fluid (JIS-K2213) Silicon oil (JIS-K2213) Lubrication oil (JIS-K6301) Fluoro carbon Carbon dioxide Ammonia Argon Gaseous nitrogen Pressure switch Mounting bracket 195 Sensors Measuring Instruments Dry air Panel adaptor B ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 196 ZSE5B/ISE5B Dimensions Standard type 30 39 4-ø2.7 Depth 6.5 20 Sensor Welded parts Fitting 20 30 SMC PRESSURE SWITCH 53.5 RESET 02: R 1/4 T2: NPTF 1/4 5 3000 Lead wire length 8.5 SET M5 x 0.8 depth 5 12.3 17 28 With bracket 50 40 30 (44) 4-ø4.5 39 30 20 SMC PRESSURE SWITCH 53.5 RESET Bracket ZS-22-D 3000 Lead wire length 8.5 SET 12.3 17 28 Panel mounting Panel adaptor A ZS-22-03 41.8 40 4.3 36 +0.5 0 36 +0.5 0 40 58.5 36 Mounting bracket ZS-22-04 SMC PRESSURE SWITCH RESET SET Panel adaptor B ZS-22-02 196 Panel fitting dimensions (41.6) Panel thickness: 1 to 3.2 mm ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 197 Compact Manometer Air Blow Series PPA Air Tool Measures the collision pressure received by an air blown workpiece. Standard sensing head Pin point sensing head Refer to page 58 regarding sensing heads. Confirmation of air line supply pressure Confirmation of regulator set pressure Compact and lightweight Portable type weighing only about 100 g (unit 50 g, battery 50 g) can also be held in the palm of the hand. Measurement unit switching for global use Freely selectable display units and easy unit conversions also make it ideal for the SI unit transition period. Backlight for easy viewing in dark locations Continuous one year operation is possible with two AA batteries (3 V). The digital display of line pressure eliminates human reading errors. It is also possible to check pulsation in the supply pressure using the peak/bottom display function. Regulator settings can be performed more precisely than with a dial gauge by viewing the digital display. Furthermore, since the unit is battery operated, power lines are not necessary. Related products for line pressure measurement Convenient for easy line pressure measurement without removing piping or stopping supply pressure, etc. Convenient hand strap for carrying Keeping practical use in mind, the hand strap is a standard feature. Zero/span calibration is possible Offset adjustment with the zero clear function, and span calibration with the trimmer can be performed. Peak/Bottom hold function With pressure being displayed, variations in supply pressure can be grasped instantly with one-touch switching of the display from peak value to bottom value. Tube coupler Pressure can be supplied or stopped by inserting or removing the tube. MPa POWER LIGHT MPa POWER LIGHT Finger valve Peak display Pressure can be easily applied or released by switching the control knob. Bottom display Auto power off function to save battery life Power turns off automatically if not operated for more than 5 minutes. Case holder is available The case holder is provided as an option to allow for situations where portability is not required. 197 Sensors Measuring Instruments Long service life of 12 months continuous operation ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 198 PPA How to Order PPA10 0 Pressure specification 0 1 2 Option/Case holder –0.1 to 1 MPa (for high pressure) –101 to 10 kPa (for vacuum) –10 to 100 kPa (for low pressure) Without case With PPA-B Nil B Unit specification Nil B With unit switching function Fixed SI unit Note) Note) Fixed units For vacuum/low pressure: kPa For high pressure: MPa One-touch fitting type Symbol Applicable tube size N/A Nil One-touch fitting N/A 04 ø4 (mm) KJH04-M5 06 ø6 (mm) KJH06-M5 Applicable tube material N/A Nylon Soft nylon Polyurethane Specifications Model Rated pressure range PPA100 for high pressure PPA101 for vacuum PPA102 for low pressure –0.1 to 1 MPa –101 to 10 kPa –10 to 100 kPa 3-digit LCD with backlight Pressure display 1/100 Pressure display resolution Note 1) Minimum display units kPa —— 1 1 MPa 0.01 —— —— mmHg —— 5 —— kgf/cm2 0.1 0.01 0.01 inHg —— 0.2 —— PSI 1 0.1 0.1 bar 0.1 0.01 0.01 Error display Functions Withstand pressure Fluid Power supply Battery life Excess pressure, Memory data error, Change battery signal Peak/Bottom display, Backlight, Auto power OFF Zero clear, Unit display switching 1.5 MPa 200 kPa 200 kPa Air, Non-corrosive gas 3 V(DC), Type AA dry cell battery x 2 pcs. Note 2) 12 months continuous operation (without back lighting) Response speed 250 ms Display accuracy ±2% F.S. or less (Temperature conditions: at 25°C) Repeatability ±1% F.S. or less (Temperature conditions: at 25°C) Temperature characteristics Piping port Ambient temperature ±3% F.S. or less (0 to 50°C, based on 25°C) M5 x 0.8 0 to 50°C (with no condensation) Ambient humidity 35 to 85% RH (with no condensation) Impact resistance 100 G in X, Y, Z directions, 3 times each Enclosure Weight IP40 (IEC standard) Approx. 100 g (Unit 50 g, Batteries 50 g) Note 1) Equipped with unit switching function [The type without the unit switching function will have a fixed SI unit (kPa or MPa).] Note 2) Two pieces of type AA dry cell batteries (manganese R6 or alkaline LR6) are not included. 198 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 199 Compact Manometer Operating Unit Descriptions Series PPA Operation and Functions (PPA100 shown. Unit: MPa) Initial Setting Be sure to initialize the operating unit set when using for the first time and after changing batteries, as the unit will indicate memory data error. 1. Press and hold the POWER button for 3 seconds or more. “P” for peak display “b” for bottom display 1. The display will show “Err”. Turn the power OFF. 2. Press and hold down for 6 seconds or longer. The unit will be zero cleared. When this happens, “CAL” will appear on the LCD. LCD • Present pressure display • Peak/Bottom value display • Unit display MPa POWER 3. When zero clear is completed, the unit is ready for operation. LIGHT MPa In lock mode POWER 2. Press and hold the POWER button for 6 seconds or more. LIGHT POWER button LIGHT button • Power ON/OFF • Peak mode switching • Turns on back light MPa POWER LIGHT 3. Release the POWER button. MPa POWER LIGHT Press the POWER button. • The power comes ON as it is pressed. • When pressed and held for 6 seconds or more, the unit is zero cleared. MPa POWER LIGHT Power OFF Press and hold the POWER button for 3 seconds or more. • When pressed and held for 3 seconds or more, the power turns OFF. • When there is no button operation for more than 5 minutes, the power turns OFF. (automatic power OFF function) POWER LIGHT 199 Sensors Measuring Instruments Power ON ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 200 PPA Operation and Functions (PPA100 shown. Unit: MPa) Peak/Bottom Display Unit Display Switching 1. Press and hold the POWER and LIGHT buttons for 3 seconds or more. 1. When pressed continuously for 3 seconds or more, the unit on the LCD will flash. Note) Since this is combined with power OFF operation, the button should be released at the point when “P” or “b” is displayed. Press the POWER button. Do this when pressure is 2. The unit will change. (See the table below.) POWER Peak Display Displays the maximum pressure value and “P” appears on the LCD. The display will change if pressure increases beyond the pressure value that is being held. 3. The unit is set, and switching is finished. kgf MPa being displayed. LIGHT MPa POWER LIGHT 2. Press the LIGHT button. Unit display changes for the type with the unit switching function only. The type without the unit switching function will have a fixed SI unit (kPa or MPa). kgf MPa POWER LIGHT Press the POWER button. Bottom Display Displays the minimum pressure value and “b” appears on the LCD. The display will change if pressure falls below the pressure value that is being held. MPa POWER LIGHT (These modes are convenient for confirming Press the POWER button. pressure fluctuations.) 3. Press the POWER button. MPa bar POWER MPa LIGHT POWER High pressure (PPA100) MPa → bar → PSI → kgf Vacuum (PPA101) kPa → bar → PSI → inHg → mmHg LIGHT Low pressure (PPA102) kPa → bar → PSI → kgf Note) The “inHg” unit cannot be displayed. Turning On the Backlight Press the LIGHT button. Auto Power OFF Function When the power is turned ON and there is no button operation for more than 5 minutes, the power will turn OFF. POWER LIGHT Note) For canceling this function, refer to the functions and operation of the lock mode (below). MPa POWER LIGHT Zero Clear Press and hold the POWER button for 6 seconds or more. Lock Mode (Auto Power OFF Cancel) Press and hold the POWER and LIGHT buttons for 6 seconds or more. MPa POWER 200 LIGHT The auto power OFF function is canceled by activating the lock mode (auto power OFF cancel). When continuously pressed for 6 seconds or more, “L” is displayed on the LCD. Moreover, when the power is turned OFF, the lock mode is released. It normally lights up while the button is being pressed. In the lock mode, it lights up when pressed and turns off when pressed again. However, the maximum lighting time is approximately one minute. The zero point displayed at atmospheric pressure can be automatically adjusted. By this means it is possible to eliminate a display discrepancy at atmospheric pressure. • Turn the power OFF. MPa POWER LIGHT • Release the supply pressure to the atmosphere. • When continuously pressed for 6 seconds or longer, zero clear is performed and “CAL” is displayed on the LCD. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 201 Compact Manometer Series PPA Dimensions Scale: 70% Connecting tube port 40 20 One-touch fitting (included) PPA100 LOCK MODE(AUTO POWER OFF CANCEL) POWER LIGHT BATTERY 1.5Vx2 LR6,R6P AX LIGHT 180 110 POWER X Refer to Note) MADE IN JAPAN Body Span calibration + – – + Type AA dry cell batteries (2 pcs.) Note) Dimension X includes the One-touch fitting. ø4 ø6 ø1/4" 123 124 126 (Front) (Back) Option/Case holder Fitting port size M5 x 0.8 44 Thread depth 5 6.8 9.2 4.5 2 ø4.5 120 ) (R 2- 25 15 SMC 18 5 Sensors Measuring Instruments 20 29 201 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 202 PPA Error Correction Maintenance Take the following corrective actions when errors occur. • Span calibration method Caution Display Contents Entire display flashes Solution Pressure being applied is above the rating. Operate within the rated pressure range. Memory data has probably been corrupted in some way. Perform auto zero adjustment. Battery voltage is low. Replace the batteries. Do not touch the span calibration trimmer except when performing span calibration. 1. Perform zero clear at atmospheric pressure. 2. Apply the maximum rated pressure, and calibrate the span while comparing with a standard pressure gauge. 3. If the display value of the compact manometer is “0” after returning to atmospheric pressure, then calibration is complete. If the display value is not "0," calibrate again by repeating step 2. Compact manometer Standard pressure gauge Trimmer Compressor • Replacing the batteries When battery voltage becomes low the entire LCD will flash. When the LCD flashes replace the batteries. Use two AA dry cell batteries. Caution To replace the batteries, turn the power OFF and replace them within approximately 30 seconds. When not completed within 30 seconds, “Err” will be displayed. In that case, perform zero clear once again. In the event that the display runs out of control, remove the batteries for one minute or longer, and then perform zero clear again after inserting the batteries and turning on the power. Related products useful for line pressure measurement These products are convenient for measuring line pressure easily without the need to remove piping or stop supply pressure, etc. Switching between pressurization and atmospheric release can be easily performed by switching the control knob. Pressure can be supplied or stopped by inserting or removing a tube. Finger Valve Tube Coupler Series VHK Series KC Specifications Applicable tubing Valve type 2 port valve, 3 port valve Tubing material Fluid Air Tubing outside diameter Proof pressure 1.5 MPa Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa Operating vacuum pressure Note 1) –100 kPa (10 Torr) Ambient and fluid temperature 0 to 60°C Applicable tubing material Note 2) Nylon, Soft nylon, Polyurethane Accessory (option) Bracket Note 1) For a vacuum application use a VHK2 (2 way valve). Note 2) Use caution with soft nylon and polyurethane at the maximum operating pressure. (For further details, refer to catalog CAT.E501-(B), “Fittings & Tubing for Pneumatic Piping.”) Nylon, Soft nylon, Polyurethane ø4, ø6, ø8, ø10, ø12 Specifications Fluid Air Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa Proof pressure 3.0 MPa Ambient and fluid temperature 0 to 60°C Thread Mounting JIS B0203 (taper threads for piping) Nut JIS B0211 class 2 (metric fine screw thread) Thread sealant With sealant (standard) Copper-free application Part C3604BD (electroless nickel plated) JIS symbols 2 port valve I A P 202 3 port valve I A P R Main part materials Body C3604BD, PBT Stud C3604BD (thread) Chuck spring SUS304 Guide C3604BD, POM Collet release bushing POM Valve retainer POM Stopper C3604BD, POM Seal O-ring NBR ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 203 Air Line Maintenance Air Blow Air Leakage Tester Made to Order Air Leakage World's first external connection type measuring instrument for air flow rate IN502-07-A Measuring air leakage for each line and equipment Equipment Equipment Measuring air flow Sensors Measuring Instruments Easy piping installation at an extra port (3/8 B). Measuring can be performed for each line or equipment. Simple operation with measuring time of 5 to 10 minutes. Wide measuring range from 300 to 3000 l/min (ANR). Portable: Battery operated and does not require any other power supply preparation. The energy saving automatic power shut off function turns power OFF when not operated for more than 10 minutes. Other measuring items 1. Ejector 2. Purge air 3. Cooling blow of dies, etc. Fixed discharge air flow rate measurement (Cannot be measured while in operation.) Standard specifications IN502-07-A Model Flow rate display range 0 to 9999 l/min (ANR) l/min (ANR), CFM x 10 -1 Flow rate display unit Flow rate display resolution l/min (ANR) Operating pressure range 0.1 to 1.0 MPa Maximum operating pressure 1.0 MPa Pressure display unit MPa ±15% of reading [300 to 3000 l/min (ANR) ∗] Flow measuring accuracy Air Fluid Leakage 10 cc/min or less (based on 0°C, 1 atm) Power supply voltage 3 VDC, Type AA dry cell battery x 2 Approx. 720 measurements Battery life Rc 3/8 Port size Weight 1.7 kg (without batteries) ∗ The measuring error may be greater than ±15% outside the flow range. 203 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 204 Air Leakage Tester Unit Descriptions Pressure supply BATTERY Rc 3/8 SET button Enter and set a pressure level SET SELECT RESET Type AA dry cell battery x 2 POWER Display LIGHT CLOSE Nozzle holder SUPPLY OPEN SELECT button Holders for unused nozzles Select nozzle size, flow rate display unit, and measuring method EXHAUST AIR LEAK TESTER Switch valve HOLDER HOLDER Pressure exhaust Dimensions 17 220 ( 24 ) (15) 120 140 SET SELECT POWER LIGHT CLOSE OPEN 5.5 AIR LEAK TESTER Nozzle Operation Connect the extra port downstream from the stop valve to the pressure supply port of the air leakage tester. <Initial setting> <Measuring> 1. Select a nozzle size. Press the SELECT button and hold for 2 seconds or longer. When the display indicates as shown below, select the size of the nozzle which is attached to the EXHAUST outlet on the back side, and press the SET button. P1 n_1.0 SELECT SEL n_1.5 SELECT SEL n_2.0 (Nozzle sizes) Press the SET button. ø1.0 SELECT Press the SET button. Complete F_1 U_2 P2 ø1.5 1000 to 2000 l/min ø2.0 2000 to 3000 l/min (Flow rate display unit) U_1 l/min U_2 1) Press the SELECT button to confirm the P2 set pressure range. 2) Gradually close the stop valve to reduce the pressure until it is below the confirmed set range. 3) Press the SET button when the pressure level is below the set range. 300 to 1000 l/min 2. Select a flow rate display unit. Select a flow rate display unit, and then press the SET button. U_1 ∗∗∗∗ 2. Enter the P2 pressure value. Select a flow display unit, and then press the SET button. SELECT F_1 P1 Press the SET button. ∗∗∗∗ Press the SELECT button and hold for 2 seconds or longer. SEL 1. Enter the P1 pressure value. Fully open the stop valve and press the SET button. CFM ∗∗∗∗ SELECT P2 ∗∗∗∗ The set pressure is displayed while the SELECT button is pressed. Press the SET button. 3. Turn the knob to OPEN. The P3 pressure will decrease. When the pressure is stabilized, press the SET button. P3 ∗∗∗∗ Press the SET button. 4. Calculate the flow. Based on the entered pressure values, the flow rate is automatically calculated and displayed. CAL U1 ∗∗∗∗ Flow display 204 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 205 Non-contact Type Sensor for Detection of Workpiece Presence Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 Air Purge Stable detection of 0.01 to 0.5 mm clearance Due to the pneumatic bridge circuit and semiconductor pressure sensor, the non-contact type sensor is hardly affected by fluctuations in the supply pressure. Plug connectors (Centralized wiring) Requires less man hours to wire. Easy to add and remove manifold stations. Terminal block box Sensors Measuring Instruments Modular construction Requires less man hours to wire. With regulator + 2 port solenoid valve With 2 port solenoid valve 205 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 206 ISA2 Optimum position is known at a glance. LED level meter Above set position Red Extraneous material Easy-to-operate W large dial Set position Green W Scale provides guidelines for set position. Below set position Green W Minimum operating pressure 30 kPa (ISA2-G) Energy consumption can be reduced compared with the conventional models (Conventional models: 50 kPa) Position of supply port: Either right side or left side is available. 2 wiring methods Variations Model Operating pressure range Individual wiring Output type Mounting Number of manifold stations Port size Enclosure 206 ISA2-H 30 to 200 kPa 50 to 200 kPa Detection distance 0.01 to 0.25 mm Electrical entry Centralized wiring ISA2-G 0.03 to 0.5 mm NPN open connector, PNP open collector Lead wire with connector (Individual wiring) Terminal block box (Centralized wiring) DIN rail, Bracket 1 to 6 stations Rc, NPT, G 1/8 IP66 (IP65 for solenoid valve. Regulator and pressure gauge are open type.) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 207 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 How to Order Manifold Without control unit IISA2 N PL 3 B With control unit IISA2 C SL 3 B 1 D E2 Pressure gauge of regulator Note 1) Without pressure gauge Note 2) A∗ embedded E2 MPa single notation 0.2 Square pressure gauge Z2∗ PSI single notation MPa E4 MPa single notation 0.4 Z4∗ PSI single notation MPa pressure G2 MPa single notation 0.2 Round gauge P2∗ MPa-PSI double notation MPa G4 MPa single notation 0.4 P4∗ MPa-PSI double notation MPa Control unit C V With regulator + 2 port solenoid valve With 2 port solenoid valve Electrical entry and supply port position SR SL PR PL Note 1) Due to new Japanese weight and measurement legislation, PSI notation type cannot be sold or used in Japan. Note 2) The pressure gauge port is Rc 1/8. ∗ Manufactured upon receipt of order. Centralized wiring with supply port on the right Centralized wiring with supply port on the left Individual wiring with supply port on the right Individual wiring with supply port on the left Note) The supply port position is the one when the switch is viewed from the front. Throttle/Manual lock of 2 port solenoid valve Stations 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 station 2 stations 3 stations 4 stations 5 stations 6 stations Nil C W M Without throttle, without manual lock With throttle, without manual lock Without throttle, with manual lock With throttle, with manual lock Throttle B D Manual lock Without bracket With bracket With mounting bracket for DIN rail Note) DIN rail must be ordered separately. (Refer to the page 221.) Electrical entry of 2 port solenoid valve D : DIN connector D0: DIN connector T : Conduit terminal DL: DIN connector (Without connector) TL: Conduit terminal (With indicator light) (With indicator light) Voltage of 2 port solenoid valve 1 2 3 4 5 6 36 100 VAC 200 VAC 110 VAC 220 VAC 24 VDC 12 VDC 230 VAC 207 Sensors Sensors Measuring Measuring Instruments Instruments Option Nil ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 208 ISA2 How to Order For single and double notation type and additional stations ISA2 Air Catch Sensor E2 1 G Detection distance Electrical entry Piping specification 0.01 to 0.25 mm 0.03 to 0.5 mm Nil Straight Output specification Rc 1/8 NPT 1/8 G 1/8 N F∗ 1 5 Nil NPN output PNP output Individual wiring G H ∗ Made to order Pressure gauge Note 1) A∗ Right angle L∗ Centralized wiring Without pressure gauge Note 2) embedded E2 MPa single notation 0.2 Square pressure gauge Z2∗ PSI single notation MPa E4 MPa single notation 0.4 Z4∗ PSI single notation MPa pressure G2 MPa single notation 0.2 Round gauge P2∗ MPa-PSI double notation MPa G4 MPa single notation 0.4 P4∗ MPa-PSI double notation MPa Note 1) Due to new Japanese weight and measurement legislation, PSI notation type cannot be sold or used in Japan. Note 2) The pressure gauge port is Rc 1/8. ∗ Manufactured upon receipt of order. N Without lead wire P Terminal block box ∗ Manufactured upon receipt of order. Ordering Examples Without control unit Centralized wiring Individual wiring Centralized wiring air catch sensor Terminal block box Centralized wiring/Supply port right Individual wiring air catch sensor Centralized wiring air catch sensor Terminal block box ISA2-HE41P ISA2-GE41N ISA2-GE41P 3 0 3 PU L L SET 6 Supply port Supply port IN IN 9 0.2 0.1 0 6 0.3 MPa 0 Right 0.2 MPa Left 3 0 9 0.1 0.4 0 0.2 6 0.4 0 0.1 0 0.2 6 9 0.3 MPa 0.4 Supply port PU L L SET 9 0.3 MPa 3 PU L L SET 0.1 0 0.2 0.3 MPa IN 0.4 Right DIN rail mounting bracket Stations 1 6 0.3 Bracket Stations 0 PU L L SET 9 0.1 0.4 3 0 PU L L SET DIN rail mounting bracket Stations 1 1 2 3 IISA2NSR-1B1 set (1 station manifold part number) ∗ISA2-GE41P1 set (Air catch sensor part number) IISA2NPL-1D1 set (1 station manifold part number) ∗ISA2-GE41N 1 set (Air catch sensor part number) IISA2NSR-3D1 set (3 stations manifold part number) ∗ISA2-HE41P 3 sets (Air catch sensor part number) Prefix the part number of the air catch sensor with an asterisk (∗). Prefix the part number of the air catch sensor with an asterisk (∗). Prefix the part number of the air catch sensor with an asterisk (∗). With control unit Centralized wiring/Supply port left Individual wiring/Supply port right Centralized wiring air catch sensor ISA2-HE41P 2 port solenoid valve Terminal block box Individual wiring air catch sensor 2 port solenoid valve ISA2-GE41 Regulator 3 0 3 0 PU L L SET Supply port 6 IN 9 0.1 0.1 0.15 0.05 0 MPa 0 0.2 6 MPa 0.1 0 0.2 6 MPa 0 PU LL 0.1 0 0.2 MPa 0.1 0.4 0 0.2 0 PU LL 9 0.3 3 S ET 6 9 0.3 0.4 3 0 PU L L SET 9 0.3 0.4 3 PU L L SET 6 MPa 0.4 0.1 0 0.2 0 PU LL 9 0.3 3 S ET 6 MPa Supply port 9 0.3 0.4 S ET 0.1 0 0.2 0.3 MPa IN 0.4 0.2 Left Right Bracket Stations 3 2 1 IISA2CSL-3B5DLCE21 set (3 stations manifold part number) ∗ISA2-HE41P 3 sets (Air catch sensor part number) Prefix the part number of the air catch sensor with an asterisk (∗). 208 Bracket Stations 1 2 3 IISA2VPR-3B5DLC1 set (3 stations manifold part number) ∗ISA2-GE41 3 sets (Air catch sensor part number) Prefix the part number of the air catch sensor with an asterisk (∗). ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 209 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 Specifications ISA2-G1 ISA2-G5 ISA2-H1 0.01 to 0.25 mm ISA2-H5 0.03 to 0.50 mm Dry air (filtered to 5 µm) 30 to 200 kPa 50 to 200 kPa ø1.5 ø2.0 5 or less 10 or less 8 or less 15 or less 12 or less 22 or less 12 to 24 VDC, Ripple (p-p) 10% or less (With power polarity protection) 15 mA or less Supply pressure Model Detection distance Fluid Operating pressure range Recommended detection nozzle 50 kPa Consumption flow rate 100 kPa l/min (ANR) 200 kPa Power supply voltage Current consumption Switch Output NPN PNP NPN PNP open collector: one output open collector: one output open collector: one output open collector: one output 80 mA 30 VDC (at NPN output) 1.5 V or less (at 80 mA) Yes Maximum load current Maximum load voltage Residual voltage Output protection Repeatability 0.01 mm or less (Detection distance range 0.01 to 0.15 mm, 0.01 mm or less (Detection distance range 0.03 to 0.15 mm, (Including temperature characteristics) supply pressure 100 to 200 kPa) supply pressure 100 to 200 kPa) Hysteresis Note 1) 0.01 mm or less (Detection distance range 0.01 to 0.15 mm) 0.01 mm or less (Detection distance range 0.03 to 0.15 mm) LED level meter Note 2) with 1 red, 2 green (Set value < detection distance: red, Set value = detection distance: green 1, Set value > detection distance: green 1 + green 2) IP66 Enclosure Operating: 0 to 60C, Stored: –20 to 70C (No condensation or no freezing) Operating temperature range Operating/Stored: 35 to 85%RH (No condensation) Operating humidity range 1000 VAC or more in 50/60 Hz for 1 minute between external terminal and case Withstand voltage 2 MΩ or more between external terminal and case (measured with 500 VDC megaohm meter) Insulation voltage Environmental Resistance Indicator light 1.5 mm amplitude in 10 to 500Hz or acceleration of 98 m/s2 without control unit and bracket mounted, Others 30 m/s2, whichever is smaller for 2 hours in X, Y, Z direction each (De-energized) Vibration resistance Individual wiring type (body only): 253 g, common wiring type (body only): 250 g, Terminal box: 205 g, lead wire: 278 g, connecting bracket with sealing for additional station: 4 g Weight Note 1) Refer to “Relation between Nozzle Diameter and Detection Distance” for hysteresis. Note 2) Refer to “Setting Procedure” for LED level meter. Working Principle P1 S1 Sensor S3 S2 S4 P2 S1, S2: Fix orifice S3: Variable orifice (adjusted by setting dial) S4: Detection nozzle In a bridge circuit as in the left figure, a detection gap is applied to the detection nozzle (S4) while the setting dial S3 is adjusted to balance the pressure applied to the pressure sensor (P1 = P2). The pressure sensor detects the differential pressure generated when the detection nozzle (S4) is released. When the work piece comes close to the detection nozzle, the back pressure P2 increases until it is larger than P1 (P2 > P1). Then the switch output turns on to notify that the pressure is below the detection gap. 209 Sensors Measuring Instruments Without control unit and bracket mounted: 980 m/s2, Others: 150 m/s2 in X, Y and Z direction, 3 times each (De-energized) Impact resistance Port size Nil: Rc 1/8, N type: NPT 1/8, F type: G 1/8 Lead wire (Individual wiring type) 4-core, oil resistant, cable (0.64 mm2) with M12, 4-pin pre-wired connector Terminal block box (Centralized wiring type) Front wiring (Electrical entry ø21) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 210 ISA2 Example of Internal Circuit and Wiring NPN open collector output Circuit and Wiring for 2 Port Solenoid Valve Main circuit of switch DC (+) OUT Without indicator light DC circuit Load MAX 80 mA Without display light AC Circuit 1 DC (+) 1 ( ) Rectifying device 12 to 24 VDC ZNR DC () ZNR 12 to 24 VDC SOL. 100 to 200 VAC SOL. 2 DC () PNP open collector output Main circuit of switch DC (+) Conduit terminal With indicator light DC circuit 1 DC (+) MAX 80 mA OUT Load 2 ( ) 12 to 24 VDC Conduit terminal DIN type connector With indicator light AC Circuit 1 ( ) Rectifying device ZNR ZNR 12 to 24 VDC SOL. 100 to 200 VAC SOL. DC () LED indicator 2 ( ) light 2 DC () DIN type connector With indicator light DC circuit 1 DC (+) ZNR 12 to 24 VDC SOL. LED Refer to catalog and instruction manual of Series VCA for wiring. Pay attention to the power supply voltage. Use of incorrect power supply will cause damage to equipment. 2 DC () Wiring Individual wiring 2: NC Centralized wiring Terminal block box 1: Brown 3: Blue 4: Black 1 2 3 4 Brown DC (+) NC Blue DC () Black OUT 1. Insert the connector of the lead wire with its key groove at the proper position. 2. Hold the knurl with 2 fingers and rotate it clockwise until finger tight. Lead wire with connector Knurl 3 0 6 9 OUT OUT OUT OUT OUT 1 2 3 4 5 DC () NC OUT 6 1. Mount the seal conduit on the terminal block box. For mounting procedure, refer to the catalog and instruction manual provided by the manufacturer of the seal conduit. 2. Thread the cable through the seal conduit and arrange wiring according to the polarity of the terminal block illustrated above. 3. Fasten the seal conduit with a tightening torque not greater than 5 N⋅m. Do not hold the terminal block box or the switch. 3. Connect the colored wires coming from the cable terminal. Refer to the circuit diagram and table above to avoid mistakes. Seal conduit entry (ø21) 210 DC (+) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 211 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 Relation between Nozzle Diameter and Detection Distance The data in the following charts are characteristics of hysteresis at the detection distance. In case accuracy is required by the settings, the design should be made so that the hysteresis will stay within the optimum adjustment range not larger than 0.01 mm. The smaller the hysteresis, the better the sensitivity. In cases where the hysteresis exceeds 0.01 mm, the air catch sensor should be used to check the presence of the work piece. ISA2-G ISA2-H Detection nozzle: ø1.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.1 0.09 0.1 0.09 Supply pressure 30 kPa 0.07 0.06 0.05 100 kPa 0.04 0.03 Supply pressure 50 kPa 0.08 200 kPa Hysteresis (mm) 0.08 Hysteresis (mm) Detection nozzle: ø1.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.07 0.06 100 kPa 0.05 0.04 0.03 200 kPa 0.02 0.02 0.01 0 0.01 0 Optimum adjustment range 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 Optimum adjustment range 0 Detection distance (mm) Detection distance (mm) Detection nozzle: ø1.5 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.1 0.09 Detection nozzle: ø1.5 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.1 0.09 Supply pressure 30 kPa 50 kPa 0.06 0.05 100 kPa 0.04 0.03 Hysteresis (mm) 0.07 200 kPa 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.05 0.04 200 kPa 0.03 0.01 0 Optimum adjustment range 0 0.06 0.02 0.02 0.01 0 100 kPa 0.07 0.25 Optimum adjustment range 0 Detection distance (mm) Detection distance (mm) Detection nozzle: ø2.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.1 0.09 Detection nozzle: ø2.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.1 0.09 Supply pressure 30 kPa Supply pressure 50 kPa 0.08 0.07 0.06 100 kPa 0.04 0.03 200 kPa 0.02 0.01 0 Optimum adjustment range 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 Detection distance (mm) 0.2 0.25 Hysteresis (mm) 0.08 0.05 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35 0.4 0.45 0.5 100 kPa 0.07 0.06 0.05 0.04 200 kPa 0.03 0.02 0.01 0 Optimum adjustment range 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35 0.4 0.45 0.5 Detection distance (mm) 211 Sensors Measuring Instruments Hysteresis (mm) Supply pressure 0.08 0.08 Hysteresis (mm) 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0.35 0.4 0.45 0.5 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 212 ISA2 Response Time Response time changes with detection distance and piping length. It is hardly influenced by the supply pressure and nozzle diameter (ø1.0 to ø2.0). While all graphs assume a fixed set distance with changes in the detection distance, the upper charts show responses at various set values and the lower charts show responses at various piping lengths. If the set distance is equal to the set value, the response becomes quicker as the set value becomes smaller or the piping length becomes shorter. ISA2-G ISA2-H Detection nozzle: ø1.5 Supply pressure: 100 kPa Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 2.5 2 Set value 2 0.05 mm 1.5 Response time (sec) Response time (sec) Supply pressure: 100 kPa Detection nozzle: ø2.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.1 mm 1 0.5 0.15 mm Set value 1.5 0.1 mm 1 0.05 mm 0.15 mm 0.3 mm 0.5 0.5 mm 0.25 mm 0 0 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 0.3 0 0.1 Detection distance (mm) Detection distanceResponse time characteristics Supply pressure: 100 kPa Set distance: 0.15 mm Detection nozzle: ø2.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 3 Piping tubing length 1.5 2.5 10 m 1.2 2 8m 1.5 5m 1 3m 0.5 0.5 Supply pressure: 100 kPa Set distance: 0.3 mm Piping tubing length 10 m 8m 0.9 5m 0.6 3m 0.3 1m 0 0 0.02 0.04 0.06 0.08 0.1 0.6 Detection distanceResponse time characteristics Response time (sec) Response time (sec) Detection nozzle: ø1.5 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 0.2 0.3 0.4 Detection distance (mm) 0.12 0.14 0.16 1m 0 0 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.2 0.25 Detection distance (mm) Detection distance (mm) Piping tubing lengthResponse time 0.3 0.35 Piping tubing lengthResponse time Nozzle Shape Figure (1) Please keep the nozzle shape as illustrated below. Take every caution against chamfer on the detection surface and/or nozzle hole, which could affect the characteristics as illustrated in Figure (1). ø1 ø1.5 Chamfer is not allowed. ø2 ø3 or more 212 ø3 or more 2 or more 2 or more 2 or more Detection surface ø3 or more ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 213 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 Supply Pressure Dependence The charts illustrate changes in the detection distance with fluctuations in the supply pressure. ISA2-G ISA2-H Detection nozzle: ø1.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m Detection nozzle: ø1.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.6 0.25 mm 0.3 0.2 0.15 mm 0.1 Detection distance (mm) Detection distance (mm) 0.4 0.5 mm 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.15 mm 0.1 0.03 mm 0.01 mm 0 0 0 50 100 150 200 250 0 50 Supply pressure (kPa) Detection nozzle: ø1.5 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 150 0.6 0.3 0.15 mm 0.1 0.5 mm 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.15 mm 0.1 0.03 mm 0.01 mm 0 0 50 100 150 200 0 250 50 Detection nozzle: ø2.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 150 200 250 Detection nozzle: ø2.0 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.6 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.15 mm 0.1 Detection distance (mm) 0.25 mm Detection distance (mm) 100 Supply pressure (kPa) Supply pressure (kPa) 0.5 mm 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.15 mm 0.1 0.03 mm 0.01 mm 0 250 0 0 50 100 150 Supply pressure (kPa) 200 250 0 50 100 150 200 250 Supply pressure (kPa) 213 Sensors Measuring Instruments 0.2 Detection distance (mm) 0.25 mm 0 200 Detection nozzle: ø1.5 Detection side piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing 5 m 0.4 Detection distance (mm) 100 Supply pressure (kPa) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 214 ISA2 Setting Procedure The detection distance is set with the LED level meter and setting dial. Keep the setting dial pulled out while in use. If released, it will return to its original position and become unable to rotate. 1. For accuracy in setting, apply a clearance gauge to the detection nozzle to replicate the set condition in advance. 2. Confirm that the set pressure is applied. If the setting dial is fully closed, the LED level meter appears as . 3. Pull the setting dial and rotate it in the positive direction. The lights will turn on in the order shown below. Rotate in the positive direction. Red Pull out Before pulling out Green 1 Green 2 4. The sensor output comes on when the lights on the LED level meter turn on as . Complete the setting when this condition is observed. 5. Apply the clearance gauge again to confirm that the lights turn on as . Pulled out Handling and setting of 2 port solenoid valve Throttle setting for blowing to prevent water and cutting oil from entering the nozzle. (Clockwise: Close throttle; Counterclockwise: Open throttle) ∗ The setting is not applicable to valves without throttle. 1. Power off the valve. 2. Rotate the throttle clockwise for adjustment so that the detection nozzle will not suck up water or cutting oil. Handling and setting of limit gauge indicator OPEN arrow 1. Removal of cover Hook the finger on the front cover ridge and rotate it in the direction of the OPEN arrow until it stops (15). Then pull out and remove the cover. 2. Setting the installation needle The installation needle should be moved by the fingertip. Set the 2 green installation needles at the maximum and minimum limits of pressure. Example Rotate clockwise IN Maximum 0.24 MPa Minimum 0.16 MPa 3. Installation of cover Throttle Solenoid 3. Power on the valve, then off again. Confirm that the detection nozzle does not suck up water or cutting oil. Note) Do not rotate the throttle more than 4 turns or it will fall out. 214 After setting the installation needles, locate the OPEN arrow at the top right position and insert the claws on the cover into the grooves on the case (indicated by in the expanded view of A part). Rotate the cover clockwise until it stops. Confirm that the cover is firmly secured. Expanded view of A part A Finger ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 215 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 Relation between Dial Scale and Detection Distance Test procedure and conditions Dial scales when the detection nozzle is under the following conditions; Supplied pressure: 100 kPa Piping: ø6 x ø4 tubing, 5 m in length. Results of measurement Note 1) Relation between the detection distance and set dial scales Note 2) (Scale numbers) ISA2-G ISA2-H Detection distance Detection nozzle diameter Detection distance ø1.0 ø1.5 ø2.0 0.05 mm 0.3 to 0.7 0.9 to 1.4 0.3 to 0.7 0.10 mm 1.1 to 1.5 2.3 to 2.8 0.15 mm 1.9 to 2.3 3.4 to 4.1 0.20 mm 2.5 to 3.0 0.25 mm 3.0 to 3.5 Detection nozzle diameter ø1.0 ø1.5 ø2.0 0.1 mm 1.1 to 1.5 2.4 to 2.8 2.6 to 3.4 2.0 to 2.5 0.2 mm 2.4 to 2.9 4.5 to 5.1 5.4 to 6.4 3.7 to 4.6 0.3 mm 3.0 to 3.5 5.5 to 6.3 7.0 to 8.3 4.4 to 5.5 5.3 to 7.0 0.4 mm 3.3 to 3.8 6.0 to 7.0 7.9 to 9.6 5.2 to 7.0 6.6 to 10.7 0.5 mm 3.5 to 4.0 6.5 to 7.5 8.6 to 10.7 Average variation per scale (Detection distance [mm]) ISA2-G ISA2-H Detection distance Detection nozzle diameter ø1.0 ø1.5 ø2.0 0.05 mm 0.010 0.005 0.006 0.10 mm 0.007 0.004 0.15 mm 0.010 0.005 0.20 mm 0.010 0.25 mm 0.010 Detection distance Detection nozzle diameter ø1.0 ø1.5 ø2.0 0.1 mm 0.008 0.004 0.003 0.003 0.2 mm 0.008 0.005 0.004 0.004 0.3 mm 0.025 0.011 0.007 0.005 0.003 0.4 mm 0.046 0.019 0.011 0.007 0.003 0.5 mm 0.050 0.021 0.012 Sensors Measuring Instruments Note 1) This data provides reference values as a guide only, this should not be viewed as a guarantee of our products performance. Note 2) Set dial scales are as follows; 0.2 Sca le 3 Between each major scales, it is sub divided into ten smaller settings (for example, between 2.0 to 3.0—2.1, 2.2, 2.3 etc.), settings are possible at each increment. A scale 3 0 6 9 215 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 216 ISA2 ∗ When the SUP port is on the left, the stations are sequentially numbered from the side of the terminal block box. Dimensions: Centralized Wiring Type With bracket L1 3 Terminal block box 60 38 L2 38 5 LED level meter End plate L End plate R 3 0 3 9 6 81 PU LL SET 6 0.1 0 0.2 3 9 6 0 PU LL SET 0.3 MPa 0 0.1 0.4 0 0.2 PU LL SET 9 0.3 MPa 0.2 0.1 0.4 0 Setting dial 0.3 MPa 0.4 12 ECOPS.qxd Bracket 5.5 21 12 Pressure gauge 24 L3 6.5 36 24 OUT 3 OUT 2 SUP port Rc, NPT, G1/8 36 OUT 4 OUT 1 Stations 1∗ n Stations 1 2 3 4 5 6 L1 106 144 182 220 258 296 L2 — — 38 76 114 152 L3 — 38 76 114 152 190 17 OUT 6 34 63(Max. 65) DC () Right Left OUT 5 DC (+) 5 39 19 Terminal block box wiring diagram Detection port Rc, NPT, G1/8 M4 x 8 (With HW, SW) L2 5 For the bracket attachment position, refer to page 219. Seal conduit entry (ø21) With DIN rail L1 3 Terminal block box 60 38 38 LED level meter End plate L End plate R 0 3 9 6 81 PU LL SET 6 0.1 MPa 3 9 6 0 PU LL SET 0.3 0.4 0.1 0 0.2 PU LL SET 9 0.3 MPa 0.4 0.2 0.1 0 0.3 MPa 0.4 20.5 12 0 0.2 0 Pressure gauge DIN rail mounting bracket 5.25 11.2 SUP port Rc, NPT, G1/8 DIN rail center L3 L4 OUT 2 OUT 4 Left OUT 5 Stations L1 L2 L3 L4 L5 17 34 OUT 6 Right Stations 1∗ n 63(Max. 65) DC () 24 L5 OUT 3 OUT 1 39 Terminal block box wiring diagram 9.8 DC (+) 216 18 3 19 Seal conduit entry (ø21) Detection port Rc, NPT, G1/8 1 2 3 4 5 6 106 — — 120 135.5 144 — 38 162.5 173 182 38 76 200 210.5 220 76 114 237.5 248 258 114 152 275 285.5 296 152 190 312.5 323 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 217 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 Dimensions: Individual Wiring Type With bracket L1 LED level meter L2 38 3 38 5 Lead wire connector End plate L End plate R 0 3 9 6 PU L L SE T 81 92 3 6 0.1 0 0.2 3 9 6 0 PU L L SE T 0.3 0.1 0.4 0 0.2 PU L L SE T 9 0.3 MPa 0.1 0.4 0 0.2 Setting dial 0.3 MPa 0.4 SUP port Rc, NPT, G 1/8 Bracket 5.5 24 12 21 12 MPa 0 6.5 Pressure gauge L3 Plug 24 36 36 Left Right Stations 1························· n 63(Max. 65) 34 5 17 Stations 1 L1 46 L2 L3 Detection port Rc, NPT, G 1/8 19 M4 x 8 (With HW, SW) 2 3 4 5 6 84 122 160 198 236 38 76 114 152 38 76 114 152 190 For the bracket attachment position, refer to page 219. Sensors Measuring Instruments With DIN rail L1 LED level meter 38 3 38 L2 5 Lead wire connector End plate L End plate R 3 92 81 DIN rail center 3 9 6 PU L L SET 6 0.1 0 0.2 0.4 3 9 6 0 PU L L SET 0.3 MPa 0 0.1 0 0.2 PU L L SET 9 0.3 MPa 0.4 0.1 0 0.2 Setting dial 0.3 MPa 0.4 SUP port Rc, NPT, G 1/8 20.5 12 18 0 Pressure gauge 5.25 Plug DIN rail mounting bracket L3 24 11.2 L4 L5 Electriacal entry dimensions Left Right angle 9.8 The direction of a right angle connector cannot be changed. Right Stations 1························· n Stations 1 2 L1 46 84 L2 38 L3 62.5 120 L4 73 135.5 L5 63(Max. 65) 34 17 32.2 41 Straight union 19 3 122 38 76 162.5 173 4 160 76 114 200 210.5 5 6 198 114 152 237.5 248 236 152 190 275 285.5 Detection port Rc, NPT, G1/8 217 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 218 ISA2 Dimensions: With Control Unit SUP port on the left 3 3 Throttle needle SUP port Rc, NPT, G 1/4 118 143 PU LL 6 0.1 0.05 0.1 0.15 0.1 0 0 0 MPa 0.2 178 144 SUP port Rc, NPT, G 1/8 PU LL 6 64.4 DIN connector Manual lock DIN connector 25 82 Conduit terminal 97 Conduit terminal 40 10 42 With regulator + 2 port solenoid valve With 2 port solenoid valve SUP port on the right 97 Conduit terminal Conduit terminal 82 DIN connector DIN connector 0 0 SET SET 9 162 9 0.1 0.15 128 0.05 0.4 0.3 133 0.3 0.4 64.4 103 0 MPa0.2 42 10 40 SUP port Rc, NPT, G 1/8 Throttle needle 25 With regulator + 2 port solenoid valve 218 SUP port Rc, NPT, G 1/8 With 2 port solenoid valve ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 219 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 Bracket Mounting Position With 2 stations, the bracket is mounted on the second sensor from the left. Left 1 2 MPa MPa Right 1 2 MPa MPa 1 2 MPa MPa With n stations, the bracket is mounted on the first and “n” th sensor from the left. 1 2 n MPa MPa MPa Addition of Manifold Stations 1. Loosen the screws and remove the 2 mounting brackets on the front and back side. 2. Disassemble the switch carefully so that the O-ring on the SUP port will not be detached. 1. Disassembly Slot for removal Existing joint brackets 2. Insertion Recess Existing joint brackets Protrusion Joint brackets (ISA-3-A) The switch for adding stations Hook the fingers on the top and bottom removal grooves to pull out the plate. It can be removed by pulling horizontally. 1. Fit seal for additional station (ISA-7-B) to the recess of the SUP port of the additional switch. 2. Fit the protrusion of the additional switch into the existing switch. 3. Mount joint brackets (ISA-3-A) at 2 positions. Note) Perform temporary tightening of screws. 4. Confirm that the recess of the SUP port of the existing switch has seal for additional station attached. 5. Fit the protrusion of the existing switch into the recess of the additional switch. 6. Mount the existing joint bracket. Note) Perform temporary tightening of screws. 3. Assembly 1. Tighten the joint brackets with the prescribed tightening torque of 1.2 N⋅m. 2. Arrange pneumatic piping and confirm that there is no air leakage from new joints. 219 Sensors Measuring Instruments End plate removal ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Series Page 220 ISA2 Parts List End plate R ISA-6-B Terminal block box ISA-11-L h ig ISA-3-A R End plate L ISA-6-A t Combination bracket Seal for additional station ISA-7-B Throttle 2 port solenoid valve Spacer Regulator Y20 Terminal block box ISA-11-L (Centralized wiring/Supply port left) ISA-11-R (Centralized wiring/Supply port right) L ef t IN Spacer Seal for additional station End plate L End plate R Y20 ISA-7-B ISA-6-A ISA-6-B ISA-7-A When 2 air catch sen- When a 2 port solenoid sors are connected or valve is connected to when a 2 port solenoid the right: valve is connected to the left: Joint bracket Lead wire with connector (Individual wiring type) Bracket ISA-3-A ISA-8-A ISA-8-B A pair consists 1 set. Straight, 5 m Right angle, 5 m ISA-4-A With mounting screw 2 pcs. 220 DIN rail mounting bracket ISA-9-A ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 221 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA2 DIN Rail ISA-5- L 4.5 7.5 35 8 35 5.5 1.25 Part no. L ISA-5-1 ISA-5-2 ISA-5-3 ISA-5-4 ISA-5-5 ISA-5-6 ISA-5-7 73.0 135.5 173.0 210.5 248.0 285.5 323.0 Applicable model Individual wiring type Centralized wiring type IISA2P-1 IISA2S-1 IISA2S-2 IISA2S-3 IISA2S-4 IISA2S-5 IISA2S-6 IISA2P-2 IISA2P-3 IISA2P-4 IISA2P-5 IISA2P-6 Pressure Gauge for Air Catch Sensor Square embedded pressure gauge GC3 Round pressure gauge 4 AS Notation specifications Nil MPa single notation P PSI single notation G36 01 4 Maximum pressure indication Notation specifications Maximum pressure indication Nil MPa single notation 2 4 MPa-PSI P Note) double notation 0.2 MPa 0.4 MPa 2 4 02 E 1 0.2 MPa 0.4 MPa VCA27A 5 DL S Thread type Nil N F Rc NPT G None Square embedded pressure gauge (With limit indicator) Round pressure gauge (With limit indicator) Standard Specifications Model Port size Fluid Proof pressure Maximum operating pressure Set pressure range Gauge port size Note 1) Relief pressure Ambient and fluid temperature Construction Weight (kg) Round Note 2) Pressure 0.2 MPa Square embedded Note 3) gauge AR20 14 Air 1.5 MPa 1.0 MPa 0.02 to 0.2 MPa 18 Set pressure + 0.05 MPa {at relief flow of 0.1 l/min(ANR)} 5 to 60C (No condensation) Relieving type 0.29 G36-2-01 GC3-2AS Note 1) The type with square embedded pressure gauge does not have connection. Note 2) The “” in the part number of the round pressure gauge indicates the type of connection threads, no symbol for R and N for NPT. Contact SMC for supply of the connection thread type NPT and the pressure gauge of PSI unit representation. Note 3) With an O-ring (1 pc.) and mounting screws (2 pcs.). Standard Specifications Valve specifications When specifying more than one option, enter symbols first in numerical, then in alphabetical orders. Note 1) Compatible with thread type NPT. Under the New Measurement Law, this type is only sold outside Japan. (The SI unit is used inside Japan.) In all cases, with the exception of NPT, add “-X2025” at the end of the order number. Example) AR20-02E-1-X2025 Throttle Nil Without throttle and manual lock With throttle S With manual lock B K With manual lock and throttle Electrical entry Coil specifications N R Z Note 1) CE marked DIN connector D DIN connector (With light) DL D0 DIN connector (Without connector) Conduit terminal T Conduit terminal (With light) TL Option specification None Non-relieving Flow direction: Right to left Unit representations on the label and pressure gauge are PSI and F 02 Rc 1/4 02N NPT 1/4 02F G 1/4 100 VAC 200 VAC 110 VAC 220 VAC 24 VDC 12 VDC 230 VAC Note 1) The pressure gauge port is Rc 1/8. The pressure gauge is included in the package (not assembled). Note 2) Order individually when 0.4 MPa gauge is required. 02 Q Direct operation poppet Air, Inert gas 2.0 Al HNBR 20 to 60 10 to 60 (No freezing) Dustproof and jetproof (Equivalent to IP65) Environment with no corrosive or explosive gas 0.2 or less Free 30/150 or less Vibration resistance/Impact resistance m/s2 Note 2) 24/12 VDC, 100/110/200/220 VAC (50/60 Hz) Rated voltage 10% rated voltage Allowable voltage fluctuation B type Type of coil insulation VCA2: 6.5 W Power consumption DC Note 1) 50 Hz Apparent VCA2: 7.5 VA AC power 60 Hz Valve type Fluid Withstand pressure (MPa) Body material Seal material Ambient temperature (°C) Fluid temperature (°C) Enclosure Atmosphere Valve leakage cm3/min (ANR) Mounting orientation Note 1) Since the AC specifications include a rectifying device, there is no difference between the apparent power required for starting and holding. Note 2) Vibration resistance: No malfunction resulted in a one-sweep test in a 10 to 300 Hz range in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature, for both energized and de-energized states. Shock resistance: No malfunction resulted in an impact test using a drop impact tester. The test was performed in the axial and right angle directions of the main valve and armature, for both energized and de-energized states. 221 Sensors Measuring Instruments 1 2 3 4 5 6 36 4 Port size Voltage Option (The shape of pressure gauge) Note 2) Nil R 1/8 NPT 1/8 2 Port Solenoid Valve AR 20 E G Note 1) Nil P Note) For double notation of MPa and PSI, add “-X30” at the end of part number. Example) G36-P4-01-X30a Regulator Nil Connection thread ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 222 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA Air Purge Due to the construction of the sensor, fluctuations in the supply pressure do not influence operation. This is a non-contact type sensor for applications requiring confirmation of workpiece presence for machining operations. For Detection of Workpiece Presence LED level meter for easy calibration The LED level meter in conjunction with the adjustment knob allows for easy and correct calibrations. Reliable detection of a 10 µm gap Above the setting position (Red) Adjustment knob Due to the internal air bridge circuit and solid state pressure sensor, the air catch sensor is not influenced by supply pressure fluctuations. Can be mounted on manifolds with up to six stations Centralized wiring and piping are possible. Versatile mounting orientation Due to the use of a pressure sensor, stable detection is guaranteed regardless of mounting orientation. Proper setting position (Green) Below the setting position (Green) Wide detection range Applicable range: 10 to 300 µm IP66 enclosure Dust proof and splash proof How to Order Individual/Centralized Wiring ISA 01 Option Output specification 11 NPN open collector 1 output 15 PNP open collector 1 output Nil ∗ For DIN rail B With bracket With gauge G ∗ Order DIN rail separately. Station 1 to 6 Wiring specification Nil Example 1) NPN output, 4 stations, centralized wiring with terminal block box on left side, with bracket and gauge ISA11-4L-01BG Example 2) PNP output, single unit individual wiring, with gauge ISA15-1-01G 222 L R Individual wiring (without terminal block box) Centralized wiring (with terminal block box on left side) Centralized wiring (with terminal block box on right side) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 223 Air Catch Sensor Series ISA Specifications Dry air (filtered through a 5 µm filter) Fluid Operating pressure range 0.05 to 0.2 MPa Recommended pressure range 0.1 to 0.2 MPa 10 to 300 µm Detection distance range Repeatability including temperature characteristics ±10 µm (0 to 60°C, based on 25°C) 10 µm or less (detection distance 10 to 150 µm) Hysteresis Detection nozzle size ø1.0 standard Indicator functions Operation indicator light (illuminates when ON.), Deflection level indicator light 12 to 24 VDC (Ripple ±10% or less) Power supply voltage Current consumption Output 30 mA or less (Output ON, All LED’s ON) ISA11 NPN open collector 30 V, 80 mA or less ISA15 PNP open collector 80 mA or less Operating temperature range Operating humidity range 0 to 60°C (with no condensation) 35 to 85% RH 1000 Vp-p, Pulse width 1 µS, Rize time 1 ns pulse Noise resistance Withstand voltage 1000 VAC 50/60 Hz for one minute between external terminals and case Insulation resistance 2 MΩ or more (at 500 VDC Mega) between external terminals and case Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller, amplitude 1.5 mm or acceleration 98 m/s2, in X, Y, Z directions, for 2 hours each 980 m/s2 X, Y, Z direction, 3 times for each direction Impact resistance Oil resistant chloroethylene cable (ø3.4, 0.2 mm2, 5 m) Lead wire 250 g (with gauge, 5 m lead wire) Weight Rc 1/8 Port size IP66 (dust proof and splash proof) Enclosure 16 l/min at 0.10 MPa Supply pressure Sensors Measuring Instruments Flow consumption 21 l/min at 0.15 MPa 25 l/min at 0.2 MPa 223 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 224 Negative Pressure Detection Valve Special Order Product Liquid Removal XT-92-65 ø50 Knob for negative pressure detection setting 36 Specifications Operating pressure range 0.15 to 0.8 MPa Ambient and fluid temperature 5 to 60°C Effective area (Cv factor) 2.7 mm2 (0.15) Negative pressure detection –400 mmHg to–130 mmHg setting range (at 0.4 MPa) 30 Weight 102 Min. 105 Bracket hole dimension Max. 115 8 2 2-M5 x 0.8 4-Rc 1/8 224 0.4 kg ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:28 AM Page 225 Vacuum Equipment Vacuum ejector In-line vacuum ejector Multistage ejector Vacuum ejector with check valve Pad with check valve Vacuum ejector for water soluble coolant removal Series Application ZH ZU ZL112/212 (Special order product) (Special order product) (Special order product) Liquid removal Liquid removal Vacuum Vacuum Vacuum Liquid removal Page 226 228 229 234 235 236 Vacuum Equipment 225 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 226 Vacuum Ejector Box Type (with Built-in Silencer) Body Ported Type Series ZH Liquid Removal Nozzle diameter —— ø0.5, ø0.7, ø1.0, ø1.3, ø1.5, ø1.8, ø2.0 Type ——————— S: Standard L: Large flow capacity Compact and Lightweight SUP Composite resin nozzle and body for compact and lightweight construction Nozzle diameter ø0.5 … 28 g Box type (with built-in silencer) and body ported type Two types are available in the series: Box type with silenced exhaust and body ported type with individual exhaust. EXH Silenced exhaust One-touch and threaded connections can be combined. VAC Depending on the operating conditions, port connections can be combined with a choice of One-touch and threaded connections. Body can be mounted and secured. Mounting holes for securing the body are provided for body ported type also. Common exhaust type Ejector symbol Mounting holes Body ported type (without silencer) ZHD Box type (built-in silencer) ZHB Models/Specifications Model ZH05B ZH07B ZH10B ZH13B ZH05D ZH07D ZH10D ZH13D ZH15D ZH18D ZH20D Nozzle diameter mm 0.5 0.7 1.0 1.3 0.5 0.7 1.0 1.3 1.5 1.8 2.0 Body type Box type (with built-in silencer) Body ported type (without silencer) Body ported type (without silencer) Maximum vacuum pressure∗ Maximum suction flow Air consumption l/min (ANR) l/min (ANR) (kPa) S type L type S type L type S type/L type 13 8 5 23 20 12 –88 –48 46 34 24 78 70 40 13 8 5 23 20 12 –88 –48 46 34 24 78 70 40 95 75 55 150 110 65 –88 –53 185 135 85 Connection (One-touch/Threaded) SUP VAC ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø8/Rc 1/8 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 EXH — ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø8/Rc 1/8 ø8/Rc 1/8 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø16/Rc 1/2 ø16/Rc 1/2 Weight (g) 28 28 33 66 11 12 16 27 43 55 95 ∗ Supply pressure: 0.45MPa. 226 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 227 Vacuum Ejector Box Type (with Built-in Silencer)/Body Ported Type Series ZH How to Order Note) Refer to tables and below for SUP/VAC/EXH port connection combinations and port sizes. Box Type (with Built-in Silencer) ZH 07 B S 06 06 Body Ported Type (without Silencer) ZH 07 D S 01 01 EXH port size Note) Nozzle diameter 05 07 10 13 15 18 20 Symbol 06 08 10 12 16 01 02 03 04 ø0.5 mm ø0.7 mm ø1.0 mm ø1.3 mm ø1.5 mm ø1.8 mm ø2.0 mm Maximum vacuum pressure S L Size ø6 ø8 ø10 ø12 Rc 1/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Note) Type One-touch One-touch One-touch One-touch Threaded Threaded Threaded Body ported type (without silencer) SUP One-touch One-touch Threaded One-touch One-touch Threaded VAC EXH One-touch — Threaded — Threaded — One-touch One-touch Threaded One-touch Threaded Threaded Table 2. Port sizes Model ZH05B ZH07B ZH10B ZH13B ZH05D ZH07D ZH10D ZH13D ZH15D ZH18D ZH20D Connection (one-touch/threaded) SUP VAC EXH ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø8/Rc 1/8 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 — ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø6/Rc 1/8 ø8/Rc 1/8 ø8/Rc 1/8 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø10/Rc 1/4 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø12/Rc 3/8 ø16/Rc 1/2 ø16/Rc 1/2 227 Vacuum Equipment Box type (with built-in silencer) Type One-touch One-touch One-touch One-touch One-touch Threaded Threaded Threaded Threaded VAC port size Note) Symbol Size Type One-touch 06 ø6 One-touch 10 ø10 One-touch 12 ø12 One-touch 16 ø16 Threaded Rc 1/8 01 Threaded Rc 1/4 02 Threaded Rc 3/8 03 Threaded 04 Rc 1/2 Table 1. Connection combinations Body type Size ø6 ø8 ø10 ø12 ø16 Rc 1/8 Rc 1/4 Rc 3/8 Rc 1/2 –88 kPa –48 kPa SUP port size Symbol 06 08 10 12 01 02 03 01 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 228 In-line Type Vacuum Ejector Series ZU Liquid Removal Space-saving ejector that can be installed in-line with the piping EXH Body Nozzle diameter: ø0.5, ø0.7 Diffuser VAC SUP Type S: High vacuum One-touch fitting L: Large flow capacity One-touch fitting Vacuum port and supply port are aligned in a straight line to facilitate piping Lightweight construction achieved through the use of a resin body Nozzle diameter ø0.5: 6.5 g ø0.7: 7.0 g The white color matches bright operating environments Built-in One-touch fittings (copper free) How to Order ZU 05 S Maximum vacuum pressure S –85 kPa L –48 kPa Nozzle diameter 05 ø0.5 mm 07 ø0.7 mm Specifications Air Fluid Maximum operating pressure 0.7 MPa Standard supply pressure 0.45 MPa Operating temperature range 5 to 60°C Applicable tube O.D. SUP port: ø6, VAC port: ø6 Models Type Model ZU05S ZU07S Large flow ZU05L capacity ZU07L High vacuum Maximum Maximum Nozzle vacuum suction flow Air consumption Weight diameter (g) l/min (ANR) ø (mm) pressure∗ (kPa) l/min (ANR) 0.5 –85 7 9.5 6.5 0.7 –85 12 19.0 7.0 0.5 –48 12 9.5 6.5 0.7 –48 21 19.0 7.0 ∗ Supply pressure: 0.45 MPa 228 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 229 Multistage Ejector Series ZL112/212 Vacuum Energy saving, large flow rate, 3-stage diffuser construction Vacuum pressure ance rform e pe 1-stag Suction flow rate increased 250% and air consumption reduced 20% with 3-stage diffuser construction Q1 Q2 Q2 Q1 2-stage (Versus ø1.3, one-stage model) Q3 Maximum suction flow rate Air consumption l/min (ANR) l/min (ANR) Q3 perform ance 3-stage performance 250 % suction flow rate increase Suction flow rate ZL112 ZL212 100 200 63 126 Series ZL212 Diffusers stacked and integrated Compact size and large flow rate (twice the flow rate of the ZL112) Series ZL112 valve option now available (ZL112 only) Release valve Release flow rate adjustment needle Supply valve Exhaust port options One-touch fitting feature Built-in silencer Simplifies piping work (ZL112 only) Vacuum pressure sensor With digital vacuum pressure switch SMC PRESSURE SWITCH SMC PRESSURE SWITCH RESET RESET SET SET Vacuum Equipment SMC PRESSURE SWITCH Ported exhaust UNIT RESET SET LCD display/ZSE4 LCD display with back light/ZSE4B With vacuum adapter With vacuum pressure gauge LED display/ZSE4E Series variations Series Vacuum pressure sensor options Air Maximum suction flow rate consumption l/min (ANR) l/min (ANR) ZL112 100 63 ZL212 200 126 Exhaust port Built-in silencer Ported exhaust With valve With With supply valve/ release valve supply valve Digital vacuum pressure switch ZSE4E ZSE4B ZSE4 Vacuum pressure gauge Vacuum adapter 229 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Series Page 230 ZL112/212 How to Order Without valve With valve ZL1 12 ZL1 12 K1 5 M Z E 25 Lead wire length Nozzle diameter ø1.2 mm 12 Nil L Exhaust specification Nil P Digital vacuum pressure switch specification Built-in silencer Ported exhaust For E (ZSE4) EB (ZSE4B) 25 NPN output Lead wire length 0.5 (2.9) m 26 Analog output Lead wire length 0.5 (2.9) m 65 PNP output Lead wire length 0.5 (2.9) m Exhaust port thread specification (ported exhaust only) For EE (ZSE4E) Rc 1/2 G 1/2 1/2-14NPT 1/2-14NPTF Nil F N T 27 NPN output Lead wire length 0.5 (2.9) m 26 Analog output Lead wire length 0.5 (2.9) m 67 PNP output Lead wire length 0.5 (2.9) m ∗ Not required when none (Nil), vacuum adapter (GN) or vacuum pressure gauge (G) is specified for vacuum pressure sensor. Supply valve/Release valve combination K1 K2 Vacuum pressure sensor With supply and release valves With supply valve Nil GN G E EB EE Rated voltage DC specifications 5 24 VDC 6 12 VDC V 6 VDC S 5 VDC R 3 VDC AC specifications (50/60 Hz) 100 VAC 1 200 VAC 2 110 VAC [115 V] 3 220 VAC [230 V] 4 Electrical entry G H L LN LO M MN MO 230 0.5 m 2.9 m Lead wire length 0.3 m Grommet Lead wire length 0.6 m Lead wire length 0.3 m L type plug Without lead wire connector Without connector Lead wire length 0.3 m M type plug Without lead wire connector Without connector None Vacuum adapter Rc 1/8 With vacuum pressure gauge With digital vacuum pressure switch ZSE4 With digital vacuum pressure switch ZSE4B With digital vacuum pressure switch ZSE4E Manual override Nil D Non-locking push type Push-turn slotted locking type Indicator light/Surge voltage suppressor Nil S Z U Without indicator light/surge voltage suppressor With surge voltage suppressor With indicator light/surge voltage suppressor With indicator light/surge voltage suppressor (non-polar type) Note 1) Type “U” is for 24 or 12 VDC only. Note 2) Since surge voltage is prevented by a rectifier in the case of AC, there is no “S” type. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 231 Multistage Ejector Series ZL112/212 Series ZL112 Ejector Specifications Standard type Model Nozzle diameter Maximum suction flow rate Air consumption Maximum vacuum pressure Maximum operating pressure Supply pressure range Standard supply pressure Operating temperature range With valve ZL112 ø1.2 mm 100 l/min (ANR) 63 l/min (ANR) –84 kPa 0.7 MPa 0.2 to 0.5 MPa 0.4 MPa 5 to 50°C Supply/Release Valve Specifications SYJ514- Part number Type of actuation N.C. Fluid Air Operating pressure range Internal pilot type Ambient and fluid temperature 0.2 to 0.5 MPa Response time (for 0.5 MPa) Note 1) 25 ms or less 5 to 50°C Maximum operating frequency Manual operation With vacuum pressure gauge 5 Hz Non-locking push type, Push-turn slotted locking type Pilot valve individual exhaust type, Main valve/pilot valve common exhaust Pilot exhaust type Lubrication Not required Mounting orientation Free 150/30 m/s2 Impact/Vibration resistance Note 2) Enclosure Dust proof Note 1) Based on JIS B8374-1981 dynamic performance test (coil temperature 20°C, at rated voltage, without surge voltage suppressor) Note 2) Impact resistance: No malfunction when tested with a drop tester in the axial direction and at a right angle to the main valve and armature, one time each in both energized and de-energized states. (initial value) Vibration resistance: No malfunction when tested with one sweep of 8.3 to 2000 Hz in the axial direction and at a right angle to the main valve and armature, one time each in both energized and deenergized states. (initial value) Vacuum Equipment Adapter Option Specifications Vacuum pressure gauge specifications GZ30S Part number Fluid Pressure range Scale range (angular) Accuracy Ported exhaust Class Operating temperature range Material Air –100 to 100 kPa 230° ± 3% F.S. (full span) Class 3 0 to 50°C Case: Polycarbonate/ABS resin Symbol Standard type P V 231 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Series Page 232 ZL112/212 Option Specifications With digital vacuum pressure switch (ZSE4) Digital vacuum pressure switch specifications Part number Display Pressure setting range Maximum operating pressure Indicator light (lights up when ON) Response frequency Hysteresis Hysteresis mode ZSE4-00--X105 ZSE4B-00--X105 ZSE4E-00--X105 LCD LCD with backlight LED –101 to 10 kPa (–760 to 75 mmHg) 200 kPa 200 Hz (5 ms) Variable (3 digits or more) Window comparator mode Current consumption Pressure indication Self diagnostic function Operating temperature range Variable (can be set from 0) Fixed (3 digits) Air, Non-corrosive gas Fluid Temperature characteristics Repeatability Operating voltage OUT1: Green OUT2: Red Green ±3% F.S. or less ±1% F.S. or less 12 to 24VDC (ripple ±10% or less ) 25 mA or less 45 mA or less –26, –27: 50 mA or less –67: 60 mA or less 3 1/2 digits (character height 8 mm) (Overcurrent Note)), Excess pressure, Data error, Presence of pressure at zero clear 0 to 50°C (with no condensation) 500 Vp-p, Pulse width: 1 µS, Start up: 1 nS Noise resistance Withstand voltage 1000 VAC 50/60 Hz for 1 min. between external terminal block and case Insulation resistance 2 MΩ (at 500 VDC) between external terminal block and case Vibration resistance 10 to 500 Hz at whichever is smaller, amplitude 1.5 mm or acceleration 10 G, in X, Y, Z directions for 2 hrs. each Impact resistance 100 G in X, Y, Z directions, 3 times each Note) Not available on analog output type. Output specifications ZSE4 ZSE4B ZSE4E 232 -25 (L) 1 output, NPN open collector 30 V, 80 mA or less -26 (L) Analog output (1 to 5 V) -67 (L) 1 output, PNP open collector 80 mA or less -26 (L) Analog output (1 to 5 V) -27 (L) 2 outputs, NPN open collector 30 V, 80 mA or less -67 (L) 2 outputs, PNP open collector 80 mA or less ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 233 Multistage Ejector Series ZL112/212 How to Order Standard type ZL2 12 Nozzle diameter 12 With vacuum pressure gauge ø1.2 mm Lead wire length 0.5 m 2.9 m Nil L Exhaust specification Built-in silencer Ported exhaust Nil P Digital vacuum pressure switch specification For E (ZSE4) EB (ZSE4B) Vacuum pressure sensor Nil GN G E EB EE With digital vacuum pressure switch None Adaptor Rc 1/8 With vacuum pressure gauge With digital vacuum pressure switch ZSE4 With digital vacuum pressure switch ZSE4B With digital vacuum pressure switch ZSE4E 25 NPN output Lead wire length 0.6 (3.0) m 26 Analog output Lead wire length 0.6 (3.0) m Lead wire length 0.6 (3.0) m 65 PNP output For EE (ZSE4E) 27 NPN output Lead wire length 0.6 (3.0) m 26 Analog output Lead wire length 0.6 (3.0) m Lead wire length 0.6 (3.0) m 67 PNP output ∗ Not required when none (Nil), vacuum adapter (GN) or vacuum pressure gauge (G) is specified for vacuum pressure sensor. Ejector Specifications With adaptor Ported exhaust ZL212 ø1.2 mm x 2 200 l/min (ANR) 126 l /min (ANR) –84 kPa 0.7 MPa 0.2 to 0.5 MPa 0.4 MPa 5 to 50°C Vacuum Equipment Model Nozzle diameter Maximum suction flow rate Air consumption Maximum vacuum pressure Maximum operating pressure Supply pressure range Standard supply pressure Operating temperature range Symbol Standard type P V 233 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 234 Vacuum Ejector with Check Valve Special Order Product Vacuum ZM1-K5LZ-E15L-X142 How to Order ZM 88 1 K 5 LZ E15 L X142 Switch type M5 x 0.8 through hole Conforms to the standard product. (P.E.) 1.5 600 Electrical entry Conforms to the standard product. Supply 112 Power supply voltage 30 ZM∗∗1∗—K5LZ-E15L-X142 24 VDC Vacuum With air supply valve/ vacuum release valve Standard supply pressure 10 V 26 62 74 70 85.4 P 15.5 H M S Vacuum 20 2-ø4.5 Mounting hole 30 Body type Conforms to the standard product. 3-Rc 1/8 Nozzle diameter 05 07 10 13 15 V 13 80 103 113 (118) 8 5 (stroke) 0.5 MPa 0.35 MPa (except 05) 0.45 MPa (13, 15 only) 0.5 mm (H type only) 0.7 mm (except S type) 1.0 mm (except S type) 1.3 mm 1.5 mm (S type only) Consult with SMC for details. ZM1-K5LZ-E15L-X235 No.1 No.4 No.2 No.3 SET H ZM 88 4 1 How to Order HYS L 1 K 5 L Z E15L X235 3 2 ø14 Connector pin number Power supply voltage 44 24 VDC With air supply valve/ vacuum release valve ø3.4 112 Supply ZM∗∗1∗—K5LZ-E15L-X235 H M S Vacuum 0.5 MPa 0.35 MPa (except 05) 0.45 MPa (13,15 only) Body type Conforms to the standard product. 10 26 30 85.4 74 70 62 Standard supply pressure M5 x 0.8 through hole (P.E.) P V 500 1.5 Nozzle diameter 15.5 Vacuum 20 30 05 07 10 13 15 0.5 mm (H type only) 0.7 mm (except S type) 1.0 mm (except S type) 1.3 mm 1.5 mm (S type only) V 3-Rc 1/8 2-ø4.5 Mounting hole 13 8 5 (stroke) 234 80 103 113 (118) Consult with SMC for details. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 235 Pad with Check Valve Special Order Product Vacuum Connecting multiple pads to a single ejector is possible. Prevents leakage from pads that are not used for suction of workpieces. How to Order INO-3769-2431-U INO-3769-1964-C Pad material N: NBR S: Silicon rubber U: Urethane rubber F: Fluoro rubber GN: Conductive NBR GS: Conductive silicon GF: Conductive fluoro rubber Pad configuration U: Flat Pad diameter 06: ø6 (for ZP06, 08U) 08: ø8 Vacuum 12 End pin Y Pad material End pin material NBR Silicon rubber Fluoro rubber Urethane rubber Fluoro rubber Conductive NBR Conductive silicon Conductive fluoro rubber Conductive fluoro rubber (for ZP20 to 32C) Pad diameter 20: ø20 25: ø25 M5 x 0.8 32: ø32 Width across flats 10 M14 x 1 ø1.6 Model INO-3769-2431-06U INO-3769-2431-08U øA øB A B Y 6 7 0.8 8 9 1 Width across flats 19 I 5 5 20 15.5 M6 x 1 Gasket Width across flats 7 Buffer stroke 10: 10 mm 20: 20 mm 30: 30 mm 50: 50 mm Buffer specification J: Without rotation prevention K: With rotation prevention Pad material N: NBR S: Silicon rubber U: Urethane rubber F: Fluoro rubber GN: Conductive NBR GS: Conductive silicon rubber Pad configuration C: Plain with rib Vacuum 12 End pin Y 20 15.5 M5 x 0.8 Gasket Width across flats 7 ø1.6 øA øB Pad material End pin material NBR Silicon rubber Fluoro rubber Urethane rubber Fluoro rubber Conductive NBR Conductive silicon Conductive fluoro rubber Conductive fluoro rubber Model INO-3769-2478-06U INO-3769-2478-08U A B Y 6 7 0.8 8 9 1 H Width across flats 12 G Gasket F Y C D E Pad material N: NBR S: Silicon rubber U: Urethane rubber F: Fluoro rubber GN: Conductive NBR GS: Conductive silicon GF: Conductive fluoro rubber Pad configuration U: Flat Pad diameter 06: ø6 (for ZP06, 08U ) 08: ø8 Vacuum Equipment INO-3769-2478-U ø1.2 øA øB 10 mm stroke dimensions A Model INO-3769-1964-20C10 20 INO-3769-1964-25C10 25 INO-3769-1964-32C10 32 B C D E F G H I Y 23 1.7 14 26.5 42.5 2.5 55 120 50 1.8 28 55.5 120.5 35 14.5 27 43 2 2.3 Dimensions for other strokes Stroke 20 mm 30 mm 50 mm G +10 +20 +40 H +4 +14 +59 I 0 +25 Add an appropriate value from the 10 mm stroke dimensions table. 235 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 236 Vacuum Ejector for Water Soluble Coolant Removal Special Order Product Liquid Removal ø18.5 INO-3971-77-4 21.5 39.5 57.1 124.1 25 6.5 18 Vacuum 13 27 Exhaust ø25 13 37 52 Supply 2-ø5.5 ø16.5 ø10 ø12 Rc 3/8 Supply pressure Vacuum pressure 0.5 MPa –300 mmhg 236 Suction flow 320 l/min (ANR) Flow consumption 320 l/min (ANR) ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 237 Industrial Filters Industrial filter Low maintenance filter Series FG FN1 Application Coolant Air line maintenance, Coolant Page 238 240 Industrial Filters 237 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 238 Industrial Filters Series FG Coolant Standard Industrial Filters Vessel Type Series FGD, FGE, FGG FGD type Series FGA, FGB, FGC FGA type FGE type FGB type FGG type • FGD type: Ideal for low flow filtration • FGE type: Ideal for medium flow rate filtration • FGG type: Ideal for high flow filtration • Connection: Rc 3/8 to Rc 2 • Number of elements: 1 to 28 • Operating temperature: Maximum 80°C FGC type • FGA type: High flow vertical element type • FGB type: High flow suspended type • FGC type: High pressure low flow rate type • Connection: Flange JIS10K1B to 6B Flange JIS and ANS1 1/2B to 1B (FGC type) • Number of elements: 1 to 83 • Operating temperature: Maximum 80°C Application example Bag filter 238 Bag Filter Series FGF • Highly effective for filtration of high temperature and high viscosity fluids • Ideal for high flow filtration • Easy handling of filtered impurities • Operating pressure: 0.5 MPa • Operating temperature: 80°C to 120°C • Connection: Rc 2 • Number of elements: 1, 3, & 5 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 239 Series FG Filter Elements Fiber Element • Nominal filtration accuracy: 0.5 to 100 µm • Low cost, disposable • Material can be selected depending on the fluid • Ideal for relatively large amount of impurities • Ideal for use as a prefilter • Material: • Cotton • Viscose rayon • Glass fiber Paper Element • Absolute filtration accuracy: 0.2, 0.4 µm • Long life due to high porosity rate and low pressure loss • Ideal for filtration of pure water used for rinsing in the semi conductor field, etc. • All elements inspected for quality assurance • 0.2 µm item: Pre-rinsed with ultra pure water, germ removal efficiency of LRV = 7 or more PP Fiber Element EXM-X3 For standard washing • Nominal filtration accuracy: 5, 10, 20, 50 µm • Large filtration capacity and long element life • Highly economical fiber element • For all cleaning solvents and prefilter for high accuracy filters • Material Filter material: Polypropylene Core: Polypropylene with brass • Nominal filtration accuracy: 5 to 105 µm • High filtration accuracy with stainless steel mesh • Pleated type provides 3 times larger filtration area than cylinder type • Easy to wash the element for regeneration • Nominal filtration accuracy: 2 to 120 µm • With excellent mechanical strength, thermal resistance, and chemical resistance • Wide operating temperature range • High filtration accuracy with sintered fine powder metal • Element can be washed for regeneration Bag Element • Nominal filtration accuracy: 5 to 100 µm • Low cost, disposable • Ideal for large amount of impurities • Easy to handle since all impurities are captured inside the bag element • Exclusive element for bag filters HEPO II Element EJ • Unwoven cloth element with high filtration accuracy of 99% or more prevents drainage of fibers or release of chemical components • Washing for electronic parts and precision machined parts • Material Filter material: Unwoven long fiber polyester Core: Polypropylene Industrial Filters • Nominal filtration accuracy: 5, 10, 20 µm • Pleated type cartridge provides large filtration area • Low cost, disposable • Material: Filter paper (cotton, resin impregnated phenol) Membrane Element Micromesh Element Sintered Stainless Steel Bronze Element 239 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 240 Low Maintenance Filter Air Line Maintenance Series FN1 Coolant No more element replacement! Our unique element construction with back-flushing capability The element of the filter is constructed of a series of grooved filter plates and wave washers places one above the other Element construction When compressed Filter plate Groove 5 µmm, 20 µmm Wave washer Gaps between the filter plates and wave washers filter foreign matter. When decompressed Filter plate Wave washer Decompressing the element widens the gap between filter plates and wave washers. While the gap is widened, dust and foreign particles caught between plates can be washed away by back flushing the element. This restores the element and enables repeated use of the element. The gaps between filter plates are equally maintained by the wave washers to allow stable back-flush operation. 2 types of elements are available according to the type of dust. Cylindrical type (5 µm, 20 µm) Step type (5 µm) Maximum 240 flow rate: 40 l/min, 80 l/min. Options • Reservoir tank: Series FNR To store the fluid required to back-flush the clogged element. • Dust removal filter: Series FND To remove dust and foreign particles from the fluid after back-flushing the element. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 241 Low Maintenance Filter Operating principle Series Flow flow Air flow Cylinder Back-flushing Cylinder Filtering FN1 The element compressed by the cylinder filters the fluid. As the cylinder extends downward, the element is decompressed. Air pressure forces the fluid in the reservoir out to the filter and back-flushes the element. Automatic back-flushing System circuit allows the automatic back-flushing when the element is clogged. Air B Setting up filters in a line and flushing the fluid alternately allow continuous operation during back-flushing. A Fluid Fluid direction when filtering Fluid direction when back-flushing Back-flushing Filtering OUT IN Fluid Fluid Industrial Filters Back-flushing Filtering DRAIN Tank for dust removal filter 241 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Series Page 242 FN1 How to Order FN1 1 0 1 N 10 S 020 Pressure gauge Without pressure gauge (with plug) Nil Housing material 1 Stainless steel SUS304 G Note) 0 1 Note) G46-15-02 (Wetted part: Brass) Note) Contact SMC for the pressure gauge specification for stainless steel wetted parts. Element type Cylindrical type Step type Filtration 005 5 µm (Cylindrical type, Step type) 020 20 µm (Cylindrical type) Note) Only 5 µm of filtration is available. Element length 250 mm 1 500 mm 2 Element material S Stainless steel SUS304 Seal material NBR N FPM V Port size Rc 1 10 Specifications Filter Model Element dimension Fluid Operating pressure Operating fluid temperature Flow rate Note2) Bore size Material Element Material Construction Filtration Differential pressure proof Weight FN1111 FN1101 FN1102 FN1112 ø65 x 250 l ø65 x 500 l Cleaning solvent, Coolant Note1) Max. 1.0 MPa Max. 80C 40 l/min 80 l/min Rc 1 (IN, OUT, DRAIN) Case and cover: Stainless steel 304, O-ring: NBR/FPM Stainless steel 304 Cylindrical type Step type Cylindrical type Step type 5 µm, 20 µm0 5 µm 5 µm, 20 µm 5 µm 13 kg 0.6 MPa 12.5 kg 15 kg 14.5 kg Note 1) Refer to the fluid compatibility table on page 243 for details. Note 2) Values under the following conditions: Fluid: Water; Filtration: 20 µm; Pressure drop: 0.02 MPa or less. Operating part Lock Model Auto switch Fluid Operating pressure Ambient and fluid temperature Unlocking pressure Locking pressure Locking direction CDLQB63-D-F Without auto switch (built-in magnet) Note 1) Air 0.2 to 1.0 MPa Note 2) 10 to 70C (with no freezing) Note 3) 0.2 MPa or more 0.05 MPa or more Extension locking Note 1) Auto switch must be ordered separately. Refer to Series CLQ (Compact Cylinder with Lock) catalog for details. Note 2) The minimum operating pressure for the cylinder is 0.1 MPa when the cylinder port and the lock port are separately piped. Note 3) The temperature will be 0°C to 60°C when the auto switch is mounted on the cylinder. 242 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 243 Low Maintenance Filter Series FN1 Option Reservoir FNR100N-10 FNR100V-10 FNR101N-10 FNR101V-10 Model Tank capacity Port size Bowl & Cover Material O-ring Weight Applicable filter 1.1 l 1.8 l Rc 1 Stainless steel 304 FPM NBR NBR 1.5 kg FN11 1 (Element 250 mm) FPM 1.9 kg FN11 2 (Element 500 mm) FND100N-10-M149X0 FND100V-10-M149X0 Dust recovery filter Model Port size Bowl & Cover Material O-ring Element Element filtration Weight R1 Stainless steel 304 FPM NBR Stainless steel 304 149 µm 7.5 kg Note) Produced upon receipt of order. Fluid Compatibility (Guide) Water Fluid Potable water Seal material Nitrile rubber NBR Fluoro rubber FPM Most compatible Industrial water Compatible Coolant Distilled water Water soluble Petroleum Oil-based Gas oil Kerosene Xylene Alkali Ammonium Sodium hydroxide hydroxide Not compatible Note 1) Contact SMC when PTFE is required for seal material. Note 2) Contact SMC regarding the compatibility of the seal and pressure gauge. Cylindrical Type and Step Type Elements 1. Cylinder type element (5 µm, 20 µm) The cylindrical type construction has a smooth peripheral surface Cylindrical type Wave washer Filter plate Industrial Filters since the dimension of the filter plate and wave washer is the same. The use of the entire peripheral surface of the element to collect dust allows larger filtration area and easy dust separation. For this reason, this type of element is ideal for filtering the fluids that contain dust with the same particle size. If the cylindrical type element is used for fluids containing dust particles with a great variance in sizes, large-size dust particles can cover the element's peripheral surface. This can clog the element prematurely and thus you may no longer use it. (Especially for soft and sticky foreign matter) (Example: the cylindrical type is recommended to filter polishing chips and the step type for cutting chips) 2. Step type element (5 µm) The step type construction has an uneven (stepped) surface since the dimension of the filter plate is smaller than that of the wave washer. When filtering uneven dust particles, larger particles are caught on the peripheral surface of the wave washers, and smaller particles are filtered out with filter plates. This construction can extend the element life and make the effective filtering possible when filtering fluids containing dust particles with a great variance in sizes. Select the appropriate element type (cylindrical or step type) depending on the dust size variance in the fluid. Step type Wave washer Filter plate 243 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Series Page 244 FN1 Flow Characteristics (Initial Value) Test fluid: Potable water Liquid temperature: 17 to 20C (room temperature) Test method: Per SMC test method (sanitary test stand) Element length 250 mm: FN111-10-S Element length 500 mm: FN112-10-S .1 .05 .05 .005 11 12 -1 0S0 05 (5 µm ) Pressure loss (MPa) .01 20 S0 0 -1 21 1 FN ) µm FN 11 1 .01 -1 0S0 20 FN 11 (2 0 1 Pressure loss (MPa) -1 0S0 05 (5 µm ) .1 .005 0 (2 ) µm 1 FN .001 .001 10 30 50 70 100 10 30 Q (l/min) 50 70 100 Q (l/min) Filtration Efficiency (Initial Value) Fluid: Potable water Flow rate: 20l/min Liquid temperature: Room temperature Test dust: AC course Amount of dust: 0.2mg/min Test method: Per SMC test method (sanitary test stand, HIAC particle counter) 100 -SS02 0 60 40 20 60 40 20 0 0 5 10 20 50 Particle diameter (µm) 244 -10 80 Filtration efficiency (%) Filtration efficiency (%) 80 m) 0µ (2 FN 11 01 N FN 11 01 N10 -S 00 5 100 ) µm (5 75 20 25 35 65 Particle diameter (µm) 90 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 245 Low Maintenance Filter Series FN1 Blocking Characteristics (Repeatability Characteristics) Fluid: Potable water Supply pressure: 0.2 MPa Flow rate: 20 l/min Test dust: AC course test dust Test method: Per SMC test method Filter part no.: FN1101N-10-020 Element: END100-020 (cylindrical type with 20 µm filtration) Pressure loss (MPa) 0.2 0.1 0.01 0.01 0.001 0 2 4 0 4.5 100% 2 4 4.5 100% 0 2 4 0 4.6 102% 2 4 0 4.4 98% 2 4 4.5 100% Time it takes to clog the filter (min) The values in percentage indicate the percentage of times when the time it took to clog the filter for the first time is set to 100% Introduce a certain concentration of dust and back-flush the filter when the pressure loss reaches 0.2 MPa. Repeat filtering and back flushing process (up to five times shown in the graphs). The graphs above show that the initial pressure loss ( P=0.015 MPa) and time it takes to reach the pressure loss of P=0.2 MPa return to the rough initial value even after repeated back-flushing. Measurement Circuit Dust feeder Tank Industrial Filters Differential pressure gauge Flow meter Pressure gauge T Measuring filter Pump Upstream side sampling Downstream side sampling Automatic particle measuring instrument 245 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Series Page 246 FN1 Piping Example Series FN1 Low Maintenance Filter cannot be used alone. Please follow the component configuration and operation steps illustrated below. q (ø6) Cylinder for element decompression and compression y w B A r e OUT IN Series FN1 Low Maintenance Filter Liquid (Coolant) (Connections are all 1.) Series FNR Reservoir Tank to store liquid for back flushing (liquid coolant) Air Series FND Dust removal filter Filter to collect foreign matter in back flushing (produced upon receipt of order) Fluid direction at the time of filtering Back flushing fluid direction t Dust DRAIN Tank for dust removal filter Example of connection device No. q w e Description Device Cylinder driving valve 5-port solenoid valve (Series SY) Air supply valve Process valve (Series VNB) IN side valve Coolant valve (Ball type) No. Description r t y OUT side valve Coolant valve (Series VNC) Device Drain valve Coolant valve (Ball type) Speed controller Speed controller (Series AS) Series inside ( ) indicate SMC products. Contact SMC regarding the valves e to t. Filtration Fluid replenishment w Air introduction valve e IN side valve ON OFF Open Close Open Close r OUT side valve Open Close t Drain valve Open Close 4 3 246 2 5 Operation description Step e IN side valve: Close Stops fluid supply to the filter. 2 r OUT side valve: Close Seals the filter and reservoir containing fluid. 3 w Air supply valve: Open Supply the fluid in the reservoir to the filter. 4 q Cylinder driving valve: Lowers the cylinder to decompress the element. 5 t Drain valve: Open 1 q Cylinder driving valve: 2 3 4 5 w Air supply valve: Close Stops pressure feed. t Drain valve: Open r OUT side valve: Open e IN side valve: Open 1 1 1 ON 2 4 5 ∗ Back flushing switch Filtration Back flushing Fluid replenishment 3 ON OFF ∗ The M/C stop signal and a signal for element clogging (differential signal switch) are used to start back flushing. Numbers in the chart indicate the operation order for each operation. At the time of filtering operation q Cylinder valve driving Back flushing start Back flushing Actuation example OFF The fluid in the reservoir passes through the decompressed element and forces out to the tank. Raises the cylinder to compress the element. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 247 Low Maintenance Filter Series FN1 Caution 1. Cylinder for element decompression and compression Do not overthrottle the speed controller when adjusting the cylinder retraction speed (element decompression). If the element is decompressed too slowly, the back flushing may become ineffective. 2. Reservoir installation Installation of a reservoir (optional) is recommended to store fluid for back flushing. If a reservoir is not going to be installed, make sure to allow piping capacity equivalent to a size of reservoir between the low maintenance filter and air supply valve. 3. Air pressure Set the pressure of the air supply valve to 0.25 to 0.3 MPa. Increasing the pressure will not improve the back flushing effect. Use the same set pressure for the supply pressure of the lock cylinder. Exceeding this pressure range may increase the load applied to the filtering plate when the element is compressed, causing malfunction. 4. Air pressure Devise the by-pass circuit on the upstream side of IN side valve to prevent the line pressure during back flushing from rising and to protect the pump. 5. Maintenance The filter should be back flushed until the differential pressure reaches 0.1 MPa to avoid a drop in the flow rate due to the element clogging and to maintain back flushing efficiency. Time it takes to clog the element varies depending on the dust condition. Monitor the clogging condition of the element using a detection switch for differential pressure. The detection switch for differential pressure is sold separately. Contact SMC for more information. Since the element of this low maintenance filter provides rough filtration efficiency (with conventional notch wire level), it can be used as a pre-filter to extend the life of the check filter depending on the fluid condition in use. Installing these low maintenance filters side by side to use them alternately enables continuous operation during back flushing. Use an element with 500 mm in length for highly contaminated fluid. A sufficient flow rate can be ensured by installing two to three low maintenance filters in a row in case of the insufficient flow capacity. Industrial Filters 247 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Series Page 248 FN1 Construction r i u y o q t OUT IN OUT IN w e DRAIN DRAIN FN11 2 For element length ø65 x 500 mm Parts list No. Replacement parts Description Material Note 1 Cover 2 Bowl SCS13 3 Element Stainless steel 304 ø65 x 250 mm 4 Compact cylinder with lock FN11 1 FN11 2 SCS13 No. Description 5 O-ring 6 Seal 7 O-ring ø65 x 500 mm 8 Scraper CDLQB63-30D-F 9 O-ring Material NBR FPM CDLQB63-50D-F Replacement parts: Seal kit 248 Model Order no. Material FN11 N FN11 V KT-FN11N NBR KT-FN11V FPM Note Items t through o from the above chart. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 249 Series Low Maintenance Filter FN1 Dimensions ∗ Rc 1/4 0° 315° 45° IN OUT B.C .D2 30 135° 225° ø42 4-ø11 G46-15-02 Pressure gauge port size Rc 1/4 Note) Use the Pc 1/4 port marked with an asterisk when designing an air release circuit. Rc 1/4 Head end cylinder port 108 D (Stroke) Rc 1/4 Rod end cylinder port Dustproof cover (Manual lock release) Rc 1/8 Unlocking port OUT IN C (125) A B (ø102) 195 Rc 1 Industrial Filters DRAIN (ø270) Dimensions (mm) Model Bore size (Nominal size B) FN111 FN112 Rc 1 A B C D 610 (730) (844) 20 860 (1000) (1134) 40 249 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Series Page 250 FN1 Options Reservoir Dust removal filter 108 32 70 70 (80) P.C. D.22 50 AIR VENT G1/4 4-ø11 180° 0 90° 135° (266) q (43) q 45° 270° 225° (60) 0° 315° IN OUT e e B r t A ø188 w 327 (519) ø150 w ø84 OUT 120 2-R1 r 53 IN DRAIN G1/4 Dimensions Model (mm) Bore size (Nominal size B) FNR100 NV -10 FNR101NV -10 Rc 1 Parts list A B No. 194 (257) 332 (385) 1 2 3 Description Material Cover Stainless steel 304 Bowl Stainless steel 304 V-band Stainless steel 304 Note Parts list No. 1 2 3 Description Material Note Stainless steel 304 No. Bowl Stainless steel 304 4 Element V-band Stainless steel 304 5 O-ring Replacement parts No. 4 250 Replacement parts Cover Description O-ring Material Note NBR JIS B 2401-1A-P85 FPM JIS B 2401-4D-P85 Description Material Stainless steel 304 Note EZH710AS-149 NBR JIS B 2401-1A-P185 FPM JIS B 2401-4D-P185 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 251 Other (CD-ROM) Application Model Selection Software Ver. 3.00 Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 SMC Pneumatics CAD System Ver. 2.6 Actuator Air blow, Air tool, Coolant Actuator Page 252 257 259 Other (CD-ROM) 251 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 252 Model Selection Software Ver. 3.00 Actuator Pneumatic equipment with minimum energy consumption is automatically selected. Automatic selection of optimum product groups that meet your energy-saving requirements Highly accurate calculation with dynamic characteristics simulation (within ±10%) Calculation of shock absorbing capacity and estimation of dew condensation probability Compliant with ISO6358 flow characteristics standard Multiple users can simultaneously access to this program from the website. Newly added functions for Ver. 3.00 Characteristics Calculation of Branch and Interflow Circuits Model Selection of General Circuits Automatically selects the most suitable equipment. Interactively enter the specifications and operating conditions required. When a series is selected, the software automatically selects the model number of the minimal equipment that meets the requirements and shows the calculation result. Characteristics Calculation of Manifold Circuit Characteristic Calculation of General Circuits Use this simulation procedure when the desired model number is known, or when verifying the current system. Make changes to the model number and conditions, etc., of the model selection result, and then run a new simulation. Shock Absorber Selection By entering the bumping and operating conditions, the optimum shock absorber part number is selected. A comprehensive number of products registered in the database 58 cylinder cylinder series series 58 16 solenoid solenoid valve valve series series 16 16 flow control equipment series 16 flow control equipment series Contains both both Japanese Japanese and and English English versions. versions. Contains 252 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 253 Model Selection Software Model Selection Software Ver. 3.00 can handle branch and interflow circuits (single valve and multiple cylinders) or a manifold circuit (multiple valves and cylinders). Characteristics Calculation of Branch and Interflow Circuits Compatible with max. 10 cylinders 1 2 10 Single and double acting cylinders can be operated at the same time using a single valve. Duplicating, adding or deleting a branch circuit is possible. Linked to shock absorbing capacity calculation and shock absorber selection. Entering individual specifications The type of solenoid valve, part nos. of piping at interflow, solenoid valve and silencer as well as operating condition should be entered. Part nos. of cylinder, flow control equipment, piping components as well as operating and load conditions should be entered. Total circuit result Individual circuit result Other (CD-ROM) Entering general specifications Characteristics such as full stroke time, warm-up time for piston, mean velocity and stroke end velocity are outputted. 253 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 254 Model Selection Software Charactiristics Calculation of a Manifold Circuit Compatible with max. 20 solenoid valve stations 1 2 3 4 20 Individual SUP/EXH Specifying the manifold SUP/EXH points is possible. Specifying the number of valves that operate simultaneously is possible. Linked to shock absorbing capacity calculation and shock absorber selection. Entering general specifications Entering individual specifications Part nos. of manifold, silencer as well as operating conditions should be entered. Part nos. of cylinder, solenoid valve, flow control equipment, piping components as well as operating and load conditions should be entered. Total circuit result Individual circuit result Characteristics such as full stroke time, warm-up time for piston, mean velocity and stroke end velocity are outputted. 254 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 255 Model Selection Software Simplified Operation Limitation of equipment Setting the specific parameters Equipment to be selected is limited. The unit of measurements and the input values that are most frequently used should be entered. Help Function Contains definition of terminologies, explanations of functions, calculation methods, updated version information, detailed explanations of registered products, etc. Press F1 key to display. Prior to use Configulation of the functions Updates Database of registered equipment Supplement Glossary Dynamic characteristics analysis method Flow characteristics conform to ISO. Condensation Load Load ratio Air consumption and required air volume Shock absorber selection Specific moment calculation Other (CD-ROM) 255 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 256 Air Blow Air Tool Energy Saving Program Ver. 2 Coolant Various calculations required for the pneumatic energy saving improvement are possible. This program contributes to the energy savings of a pneumatic system from the design stage to analysis of the present state and simulation of possible improvements. This energy saving program was developed to provide a better understanding about the different states of air (e.g. consumption, flow, pressure, and humidity) between the air supply and related equipment within a facility. Calculation of gas, liquid, and steam Pressure/Flow rate graph Conductance search Simplified input operation Air Supply Compressed air cost Energy conversion Unit conversion Terminal Equipment Air consumption Selection of an air-blow system and calculation of its characteristics Flow rate and conductance Composition of conductance Conductance search Regulators and Tanks Selection of regulator Selection of booster Selection of air tank Charge and discharge to/from tank Dryer Selection of air dryer Selection of aftercooler Selection of air filter Conversion of humidity and dew points Drain amount calculation State of air change Piping Pressure drop of main piping Air pipeline network Air leakage cost Coolant pipelines Supply of “Energy saving program Ver.2-Web service version” “Energy saving program Ver.2-Web service version” on the Internet is registered on SMC’s web site (http://www.smcworld.com). It provides both Japanese and English versions. 256 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 257 Energy Saving Program Menu Pneumatic basic calculation Calculation for energy savings at a plant Setting of devices ● Humidity conversion ● Drain volume calculation ● State change of the air ● Flow rate and conductance ● Synthesis of conductance ● Replenishment and discharge of a tank ● Volume of air consumption for the devices ● Conductance search ● Cost for air compression ● Power for compressors ● Energy conversion ● Pressure decrease of the main piping ● Maximum recommended flow rate for the main piping ● Calculation for a pneumatic line net ● Loss cost resulting from air leakage ● Blow nozzle selection for air ● Characteristic calculation for an air blow nozzle ● Selection of upstream piping for a blow nozzle ● Characteristic calculation for the upstream piping ● Selection of a regulator ● Selection of a booster regulator ● Selection of an air tank ● Selection of an air dryer ● Selection of an aftercooler ● Selection of an air filter ● Calculation of gases, liquids Other and saturated steam calculations ● Coolant circuits Indicates the added features and improvements in ver. 2. Selection and characteristic calculation for an air blow system It is possible to select and calculate the characteristics of different air blow nozzles and upstream piping. Pressure distribution can also be calculated. Easy visual understanding with the help of graphs Air consumption of devices Air consumption calculations for actuators and air blowers are possible. Cost can be calculated. Accumulation function The air consumption of each device can be calculated. The total volume of air consumption by device and line can be determined, as well as the total cost. A total of 88 different actuators are registered. Complicated calculations no longer need to be manually performed. The program offers quick calculation results! Other (CD-ROM) Air consumption saving is possible by setting 2 different pressures. Complicated calculations such as the volume of air consumption and pressure drop are no longer required. Calculation results can be acquired by simply inputting user conditions. Now, the program can calculate and simulate the followings which can not be conducted manually: • Pressure decrease and flow rate calculation in a pneumatic pressure line net (divert piping and loop piping). • Pressure change simulation of replenishment and discharge of a tank. 257 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 258 Energy Saving Program Pneumatic line net Calculation of pressure loss in a compound pipeline networks is possible. It is possible to successfully work with more complicated pipeline networks by using this new version. The network lattice number is increased from 7×4 to 13×8. Simplified input operation Simultaneous input is possible when duplicate conditions are entered. Possible to work with diverted piping and loop piping Calculations can be performed on complicated pipeline networks which cannot be manually calculated. Possible to work with a variety of pipelines. Charge and discharge to/from a tank Calculation on the charge and discharge between two tanks has been added. Calculation of gases, liquids and saturated steam It is possible to work with a variety of gases and fluids by entering their specific gravity. Improvement of energy savings consciousness 258 Cost calculations for air and energy conversions, CO2 discharge are possible, as a result by studying these values, energy savings consciousness can be improved and promoted. Selection of devices Selection of the following has been added: Aftercooler, air filter, regulator, booster regulator, and air tank. Search for the conductance of registered devices It is possible to search for the conductance of devices registered in this program. The program can be used globally because it uses the JIS B 8390 (ISO standard) flow rate measuring method. Our flow rate calculation formula conforms to ISO 6358 and its accuracy is an improvement over the existing formula. ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 259 Note: CD is available only in the Japanese version. For the English version, visit http://www.smcworld.com. New CAD Electronic Catalog SMC Pneumatics CAD System Ver. 2.6 Actuator “SMC Pneumatics CAD System” and “SMC Electronic Catalog II Search System can be viewed on the same screen. The location of the stored/saved file can be decided by the user. Output data format: DXF, MCADAM, DMNDOS, and AutoCAD Programs available on a CD: Model Selection Program for Rotary Actuators Calculation of Moment for Guide Cylinders The output data is linked to the complete part numbers. CAD data can be downloaded for the “SMC Electronic Catalog II Search System”. Clicking on the buttons can start the program when the complete part numbers have been programmed. The following type of specifications are programmed in “SMC Pneumatics CAD System Ver. 2.6”. 1) Specifications for outputting data compatible with the complete part numbers among the main product line. (Pneumatic CAD System) Data output compatible with the complete part numbers from the main product line. (Pneumatic CAD System) OS Windows98/Me/XP/2000/NT4(SP6) CPU Pentium 150 or higher is recommended. Display 800 x 600 pixels or more Registered products Determination of part numbers Main functions 186 series The complete part number will be created automatically. (Directly input part no. or search by part no., name, or series.) Data can be outputted. Drawing data output according to the complete part numbers in a parametric way. Able to confirm CAD drawings. Confirmation of selected drawings (dimensional display, CAD measurement as desired), Selection of background screen color (White/Black) OLE compliant Output CAD drawing in a BMP, EMF, or WMF format. Able to download CAD drawings. Output data format Output sheet can be selected among 6 views. 1) M/CADAM (Ver.3, Helix) direct output 2) DMNDOS, and DXF (equivalent to GX3) 3) Direct output to AutoCAD(up to 2002) screen (Ver. 2.4) 2) Specifications for outputting data from all products. (Electronic Catalog II Search System) Data output compatible with all the part numbers of the products. (Electronic Catalog II Search System) OS Windows98/Me/XP/2000/NT4 (SP6) CPU Pentium 150 or higher is recommended. Display 800 x 600 pixels or more Registered products 652 series Can confirm the file contents by searching the registered file from the product's classification. Two types of file contents 1) Drawing data which contains the multiple graphics in a single file. 2) Drawing data based on the complete part numbers. Output data format 1) Data output in a DXF format 2) Data output in a DOS (DMNDOS) format Other (CD-ROM) Main functions Search by product classiication Note) Please consult with us for additional data not listed above because it is available in another CD-ROM. 259 Table of Contents Energy Saving Proposals & Energy Saving Equipment List Front matter 1, 2 Recognizing the current state 3 What are approach energy saving measures? 4 Energy Saving Proposals Proposal 1 Air Line Maintenance Proposal 2 Non-operation Proposal 3 Air Blow 8, 9, 10 Proposal 4 Air Tools 11 Proposal 5 Air Leakage Proposal 6 Air Purge (Air Micro) 14 Proposal 7 Paint Stirring 15 Proposal 8 Actuators 16, 17 Proposal 9 Vacuum Ejectors 18, 19 Proposal 10 Liquid Removal 20, 21 Proposal 11 Coolant (Cleaning) Pump 22, 23 Proposal 12 Cooling Water 24 Proposal 13 Hydraulic Clamp 25 Proposal 14 Low Power Consumption/Long Service Life 26 Table of Contents 1 Front matter 5, 6 7 12, 13 Table of Contents Energy Saving Proposals & Energy Saving Equipment List Front matter 1, 2 Recognizing the current state 3 What are approach energy saving measures? 4 Energy Saving Proposals Proposal 1 Air Line Maintenance Proposal 2 Non-operation Proposal 3 Air Blow 8, 9, 10 Proposal 4 Air Tools 11 Proposal 5 Air Leakage Proposal 6 Air Purge (Air Micro) 14 Proposal 7 Paint Stirring 15 Proposal 8 Actuators 16, 17 Proposal 9 Vacuum Ejectors 18, 19 Proposal 10 Liquid Removal 20, 21 Proposal 11 Coolant (Cleaning) Pump 22, 23 Proposal 12 Cooling Water 24 Proposal 13 Hydraulic Clamp 25 Proposal 14 Low Power Consumption/Long Service Life 26 Table of Contents 1 Front matter 5, 6 7 12, 13 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 260 Safety Instructions These safety instructions are intended to prevent a hazardous situation and/or equipment damage. These instructions indicate the level of potential hazard by a label of "Caution", "Warning" or "Danger". To ensure safety, be sure to observe ISO 4414 Note 1), JIS B 8370 Note 2) and other safety practices. Caution : Operator error could result in injury or equipment damage. Warning : Operator error could result in serious injury or loss of life. Danger : In extreme conditions, there is a possible result of serious injury or loss of life. Note 1) ISO 4414: Pneumatic fluid power--General rules relating to systems. Note 2) JIS B 8370: General Rules for Pneumatic Equipment Warning 1. The compatibility of the pneumatic equipment is the responsibility of the person who designs the pneumatic system or decides its specifications. Since the products specified here are used in various operating conditions, their compatibility for the specific pneumatic system must be based on specifications or post analysis and/or tests to meet the specific requirements. The expected performance and safety assurance are the responsibility of the person who has determined the compatibility of the system. This person should continuously review the suitability of all items specified, referring to the latest catalog information with a view to giving due consideration to any possibility of equipment failure when configuring a system. 2. Only trained personnel should operate pneumatically operated machinery and equipment. Compressed air can be dangerous if handled incorrectly. Assembly, handling or repair of pneumatic systems should be performed by trained and experienced operators. 3. Do not service machinery/equipment or attempt to remove components until safety is confirmed. 1. Inspection and maintenance of machinery/equipment should only be performed once measures to prevent falling or runaway of the driver objects have been confirmed. 2. When equipment is removed, confirm that safety process as mentioned above. Turn off the supply pressure for this equipment and exhaust all residual compressed air in the system. 3. Before machinery/equipment is restarted, take measures to prevent quick extension of a cylinder piston rod, etc. 4. Contact SMC if the product will be used in any of the following conditions: 1. Conditions and environments beyond the given specifications, or if product is used outdoors. 2. Installation on equipment in conjunction with atomic energy, railway, air navigation, vehicles, medical equipment, food and beverages, recreation equipment, emergency stop circuits, clutch and brake circuits in press applications, or safety equipment. 3. An application which has the possibility of having negative effects on people, property, or animals, requiring special safety analysis. 4. If the products are used in an interlock circuit, prepare a double interlock style circuit with a mechanical protection function for the prevention of a breakdown. And, examine the devices periodically if they function normally or not. Specific Product Precautions Be sure to read specific product precautions in each product catalog before handling. 260 ECOPS.qxd 05.9.5 11:29 AM Page 261 EUROPE AUSTRIA SMC Pneumatik GmbH BELGIUM SMC Pneumatics N.V./S.A. BULGARIA SMC Industrial Automation Bulgaria EOOD CROATIA SMC Industrijska automatika d.o.o. CZECH REPUBLIC SMC Industrial Automation CZ s.r.o. DENMARK SMC Pneumatik A/S ESTONIA SMC Pneumatics Estonia OÜ FINLAND SMC Pneumatics Finland OY FRANCE SMC Pneumatique SA GERMANY SMC Pneumatik GmbH HUNGARY SMC Hungary Ipari Automatizálási Kft. IRELAND SMC Pneumatics (Ireland) Ltd. ITALY SMC Italia S.p.A. LATVIA SMC Pnuematics Latvia SIA NETHERLANDS SMC Pneumatics BV. NORWAY SMC Pneumatics Norway A/S POLAND SMC Industrial Automation Polska Sp.z.o.o. ROMANIA SMC Romania s.r.l. RUSSIA SMC Pneumatik LLC. SLOVAKIA SMC Priemyselná automatizáciá, s.r.o. SLOVENIA SMC INDUSTRIJSKA AVTOMATIKA d.o.o. SPAIN/PORTUGAL SMC España, S.A. SWEDEN SMC Pneumatics Sweden AB SWITZERLAND SMC Pneumatik AG. UK SMC Pneumatics (U.K.) Ltd. ASIA CHINA SMC (China) Co., Ltd. HONG KONG SMC Pneumatics (Hong Kong) Ltd. INDIA SMC Pneumatics (India) Pvt. Ltd. INDONESIA PT. SMC Pneumatics Indonesia MALAYSIA SMC Pneumatics (S.E.A.) Sdn. Bhd. PHILIPPINES SHOKETSU-SMC Corporation SINGAPORE SMC Pneumatics (S.E.A.) Pte. Ltd. SOUTH KOREA SMC Pneumatics Korea Co., Ltd. TAIWAN SMC Pneumatics (Taiwan) Co., Ltd. THAILAND SMC Thailand Ltd. NORTH AMERICA CANADA SMC Pneumatics (Canada) Ltd. MEXICO SMC Corporation (Mexico) S.A. de C.V. USA SMC Corporation of America SOUTH AMERICA ARGENTINA SMC Argentina S.A. BOLIVIA SMC Pneumatics Bolivia S.R.L. BRAZIL SMC Pneumaticos Do Brazil Ltda. CHILE SMC Pneumatics (Chile) S.A. VENEZUELA SMC Neumatica Venezuela S.A. OCEANIA AUSTRALIA SMC Pneumatics (Australia) Pty. Ltd. NEW ZEALAND SMC Pneumatics (N.Z.) Ltd. 1-16-4 Shimbashi, Minato-ku, Tokyo 105-8659 JAPAN Tel: 03-3502-2740 Fax: 03-3508-2480 URL http://www.smcworld.com SMC supports innovations in energy saving production systems. As countermeasures for global warming are coming into effect, "energy savings" has become a key theme for corporate reforms. At the Kyoto Conference on Climate Change (December 1997), a 6% reduction of CO2 emissions from the 1990 emission rate was set as a target to be achieved by 2010. Also, as amendment of the energy saving law in Japan suggests, it is predicted that the trend for energy savings involving corporations will become increasingly demanding. In this climate, SMC will strive for innovations of production systems with energy savings in mind. With cooperation from customers, we will promote energy saving programs for pneumatic systems. © 2005 SMC Corporation All Rights Reserved Specifications are subject to change without prior notice and any obligation on the part of the manufacturer. Proposals for Energy Saving Pneumatic Systems SMC ECOLOGY PNEUMATICS SYSTEM SMC'S GLOBAL MANUFACTURING, DISTRIBUTION AND SERVICE NETWORK Proposals for Energy Saving Pneumatic Systems CAT.E02-21 B D-DN 1st printing FR printing JV 120DN Printed in Japan. This catalog is printed on recycled paper with concern for the global environment.